Attached files

file filename
EX-8.1 - OPINION OF VINSON & ELKINS L.L.P. RELATING TO TAX MATTERS - Hi-Crush Inc.d345519dex81.htm
EX-23.1 - CONSENT OF PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS LLP - Hi-Crush Inc.d345519dex231.htm
EX-10.4 - FORM OF CREDIT AGREEMENT - Hi-Crush Inc.d345519dex104.htm
Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 3, 2012

Registration No. 333-182574

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

AMENDMENT NO. 2 TO

FORM S-1

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

UNDER

THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

 

 

Hi-Crush Partners LP

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

 

 

 

Delaware   1400  

90-0840530

(State or Other Jurisdiction of Incorporation or Organization)   (Primary Standard Industrial Classification Code Number)  

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification Number)

Three Riverway, Suite 1550

Houston, Texas 77056

(Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number, Including Area Code, of Registrant’s Principal Executive Offices)

 

 

Robert E. Rasmus/James M. Whipkey

Three Riverway, Suite 1550

Houston, Texas 77056

(713) 963-0099

(Name, Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number, Including Area Code, of Agent for Service)

 

 

Copies to:

 

David Palmer Oelman

E. Ramey Layne

Vinson & Elkins L.L.P.

1001 Fannin Street, Suite 2500

Houston, Texas 77002

Tel: (713) 758-2222

Fax: (713) 758-2346

 

Charles L. Strauss

P. Kevin Trautner

Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P.

Fulbright Tower

1301 McKinney, Suite 5100

Houston, Texas 77010

Tel: (713) 651-5151

Fax: (713) 651-5246

 

 

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public:

As soon as practicable after this registration statement becomes effective.

 

 

 

If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box.  ¨

If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ¨

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ¨

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer   ¨    Accelerated filer   ¨
Non-accelerated filer   x  (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)    Smaller reporting company   ¨

 

 

The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this registration statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission becomes effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and we are not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

 

Subject to Completion, dated August 3, 2012

 

PR OSPECTUS

 

 

 

LOGO

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Common Units

Representing Limited Partner Interests

 

 

This is the initial public offering of our common units representing limited partner interests. Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, or the selling unitholder, is offering              common units. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of common units by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common units. We currently expect the initial public offering price to be between $         and $         per common unit. Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “HCLP,” subject to official notice of issuance.

 

 

Investing in our common units involves risks. Please read “Risk Factors” beginning on page 24.

These risks include the following:

 

 

We may not have sufficient cash from operations following the payment of costs and expenses to enable us to pay the minimum quarterly distribution to our unitholders.

 

 

On a pro forma basis we would not have had sufficient cash available for distribution to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all units for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012.

 

 

Inaccuracies in estimates of volumes and qualities of our sand reserves could result in lower than expected sales and higher than expected production costs.

 

 

Substantially all of our sales are generated under contracts with four customers, and the loss of or reduced purchasing by any of them could adversely affect our results of operations.

 

 

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC controls our general partner, which has sole responsibility for managing our operations. Our general partner and Hi-Crush Proppants LLC have conflicts of interest with us and limited duties, and they may favor their own interests to the detriment of us and our unitholders.

 

 

Our partnership agreement does not require us to pay distributions.

 

 

Holders of our common units have limited voting rights and are not entitled to elect our general partner or its directors.

 

 

Unitholders will experience immediate and substantial dilution of $         per common unit.

 

 

If the IRS were to treat us as a corporation for federal income tax purposes, then our cash available for distribution could be substantially reduced.

 

 

You will be required to pay taxes on your share of our income even if you do not receive any cash distributions from us.

In addition, we qualify as an “emerging growth company” as defined in Section 2(a)(19) of the Securities Act of 1933 and, as such, are allowed to provide in this prospectus more limited disclosures than an issuer that would not so qualify. Furthermore, for so long as we remain an emerging growth company, we will qualify for certain limited exceptions from investor protection laws such as the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002 and the Investor Protection and Securities Reform Act of 2010. Please read “Risk Factors” and “Summary—Emerging Growth Company Status.”

 

 

 

     Per Common Unit      Total  

Public Offering Price

   $                    $                

Underwriting Discount(1)

   $         $     

Proceeds to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

   $         $     

 

(1) Excludes a structuring fee of     % of the gross proceeds of this offering payable to Barclays Capital Inc. Please read “Underwriting.”

The underwriters may purchase up to an additional              common units from Hi-Crush Proppants LLC at the public offering price, less the underwriting discount, within 30 days from the date of this prospectus to cover over-allotments.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

The underwriters expect to deliver the common units to purchasers on or about                     , 2012 through the book-entry facilities of The Depository Trust Company.

 

 

 

Barclays   Morgan Stanley

 

Credit Suisse   UBS Investment Bank

 

Raymond James   RBC Capital Markets   Baird
 

Prospectus dated                     , 2012

 

 


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

 

LOGO

 

 


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

You should rely only on the information contained in this prospectus, any free writing prospectus prepared by or on behalf of us and the selling unitholder or any other information to which we have referred you in connection with this offering. Neither we, nor the selling unitholder nor the underwriters have authorized any other person to provide you with additional or different information. Neither the delivery of this prospectus nor sale of our common units means that information contained in this prospectus is correct after the date of this prospectus. This prospectus is not an offer to sell or solicitation of an offer to buy our common units in any circumstances under which the offer or solicitation is unlawful.

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

SUMMARY

     1   

Hi-Crush Partners LP

     1   

Our Business and Properties

     2   

Industry Dynamics

     4   

Business Strategies

     5   

Competitive Strengths

     6   

Risk Factors

     7   

Our Management

     9   

Our Relationship with Our Sponsor

     10   

Summary of Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties

     11   

Principal Executive Offices

     12   

Emerging Growth Company Status

     12   

Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure

     13   

Organizational Structure

     14   

The Offering

     15   

Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data

     19   

RISK FACTORS

     24   

Risks Inherent in Our Business

     24   

Risks Related to Environmental, Mining and Other Regulation

     36   

Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us

     39   

Tax Risks to Common Unitholders

     50   

USE OF PROCEEDS

     54   

CAPITALIZATION

     55   

DILUTION

     56   

CASH DISTRIBUTION POLICY AND RESTRICTIONS ON DISTRIBUTIONS

     57   

General

     57   

Our Minimum Quarterly Distribution

     59   

Subordinated Units

     59   

Pro Forma Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve and Six Months Ended June 30, 2012

     60   

Estimated Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve Months Ending September 30, 2013

     62   

HOW WE MAKE DISTRIBUTIONS TO OUR PARTNERS

     69   

General

     69   

Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus

     69   

Capital Expenditures

     71   

Subordination Period

     73   

Distributions From Operating Surplus During the Subordination Period

     75   

Distributions From Operating Surplus After the Subordination Period

     75   

General Partner Interest

     75   

Incentive Distribution Rights

     75   

Percentage Allocations of Distributions From Operating Surplus

     76   

 

i


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our Sponsor’s Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels

     76   

Distributions From Capital Surplus

     79   

Adjustment to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels

     79   

Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation

     80   

SELECTED HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA

     83   

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     87   

Basis of Presentation

     87   

Overview

     87   

Overall Trends and Outlook

     88   

How We Generate Revenue

     89   

Costs of Conducting Our Business

     90   

How We Evaluate Our Operations

     91   

Factors Impacting Comparability of Our Financial Results

     92   

Results of Operations

     93   

Liquidity and Capital Resources

     95   

Customer Concentration

     99   

Contractual Obligations

     99   

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure of Market Risks

     100   

Internal Controls and Procedures

     101   

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

     102   

New and Revised Financial Accounting Standards

     102   

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

     102   

Environmental Matters

     104   

PROPPANT INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

     105   

Our Industry

     105   

Historical and Projected Proppant Demand

     109   

Historical and Projected North American Rig Count

     109   

Historical and Projected North American Wells and Proppant Intensity

     109   

BUSINESS

     112   

Overview

     112   

Business Strategies

     113   

Competitive Strengths

     114   

Assets and Business Operations

     115   

Quality Control

     121   

Customers

     121   

Contracts

     122   

Competition

     123   

Our History and Relationship with Our Sponsor

     123   

Our Management and Employees

     125   

Environmental and Occupational Safety and Health Regulation

     125   

Permits

     128   

Safety and Maintenance

     129   

Seasonality

     129   

Principal Executive Offices

     129   

Legal Proceedings

     129   

MANAGEMENT

     130   

Management of Hi-Crush Partners LP

     130   

Executive Officers and Directors of Our General Partner

     131   

Involvement in Certain Legal Proceedings

    
134
  

 

ii


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Director Independence

     134   

Committees of the Board of Directors

     134   

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION AND OTHER INFORMATION

     136   

Summary Compensation Table

     136   

Narrative Disclosure to the Summary Compensation Table

     136   

Outstanding Equity Awards at 2011 Fiscal Year-End

     137   

Additional Narrative Disclosure

     137   

Director Compensation

     138   

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

     139   

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

     141   

Distributions and Payments to Affiliates of Our General Partner

     141   

Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions

     142   

Other Transactions with Related Persons

     145   

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST AND FIDUCIARY DUTIES

     147   

Conflicts of Interest

     147   

Fiduciary Duties

     151   

DESCRIPTION OF THE COMMON UNITS

     154   

The Units

     154   

Transfer Agent and Registrar

     154   

Transfer of Common Units

     154   

THE PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT

     156   

Organization and Duration

     156   

Purpose

     156   

Cash Distributions

     156   

Capital Contributions

     156   

Voting Rights

     157   

Applicable Law; Forum, Venue and Jurisdiction

     158   

Limited Liability

     158   

Issuance of Additional Interests

     159   

Amendment of the Partnership Agreement

     160   

Merger, Consolidation, Conversion, Sale or Other Disposition of Assets

     162   

Dissolution

     162   

Liquidation and Distribution of Proceeds

     162   

Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner

     163   

Transfer of General Partner Interest

     164   

Transfer of Ownership Interests in the General Partner

     164   

Transfer of Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights

     164   

Change of Management Provisions

     165   

Limited Call Right

     165   

Non-Taxpaying Holders; Redemption

     165   

Non-Citizen Assignees; Redemption

     166   

Meetings; Voting

     166   

Voting Rights of Incentive Distribution Rights

     167   

Status as Limited Partner

     167   

Indemnification

     167   

Reimbursement of Expenses

     168   

Books and Reports

     168   

Right to Inspect Our Books and Records

     168   

Registration Rights

     169   

 

iii


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

UNITS ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

     170   

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

     172   

Taxation of the Partnership

     172   

Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership

     173   

Tax Treatment of Operations

     178   

Disposition of Units

     180   

Uniformity of Units

     182   

Tax-Exempt Organizations and Other Investors

     182   

Administrative Matters

     183   

State, Local and Other Tax Considerations

     184   

INVESTMENT IN HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP BY EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

     185   

UNDERWRITING

     186   

Commissions and Expenses

     186   

Option to Purchase Additional Common Units

     187   

Lock-Up Agreements

     187   

Offering Price Determination

     188   

Indemnification

     188   

Stabilization, Short Positions and Penalty Bids

     188   

Electronic Distribution

     189   

New York Stock Exchange

     190   

Discretionary Sales

     190   

Stamp Taxes

     190   

Relationships

     190   

FINRA

     190   

Selling Restrictions

     191   

VALIDITY OF OUR COMMON UNITS

     193   

EXPERTS

     193   

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

     193   

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

     194   

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     F-1   

APPENDIX A—AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

     A-1   

APPENDIX B—GLOSSARY OF TERMS.

     B-1   

Industry and Market Data

This prospectus includes industry data and forecasts that we obtained from industry publications and surveys, public filings and internal company sources. Industry publications and surveys and forecasts generally state that the information contained therein has been obtained from sources believed to be reliable, but there can be no assurance as to the accuracy or completeness of the included information. Statements as to our market position and market estimates are based on management’s estimates and assumptions about our markets and our internal research, together with the following industry publications and surveys:

 

   

The Freedonia Group, Inc., Industry Study #2867, Well Stimulation Materials, March 2012;

 

   

Baker Hughes North America Rotary Rig Count; and

 

   

Spears & Associates, Inc., Oilfield Market Report 1999-2012, March 2012.

While we are not aware of any misstatements regarding the market, industry or similar data presented herein, such data involve risks and uncertainties and are subject to change based on various factors, including those discussed under the headings “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” in this prospectus.

 

iv


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

SUMMARY

This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus. You should read the entire prospectus carefully, including the historical and pro forma financial statements and the notes to those financial statements, before investing in our common units. The information presented in this prospectus assumes an initial public offering price of $         per common unit (the mid-point of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus) and, unless otherwise indicated, that the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units is not exercised. You should read “Risk Factors” for information about important risks that you should consider before buying our common units.

References in this prospectus to “Hi-Crush Partners LP,” “we,” “our,” “us” or like terms when used in a historical context refer to the business of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, which is our accounting predecessor and is contributing certain of its subsidiaries to Hi-Crush Partners LP in connection with this offering. When used in the present tense or prospectively, those terms refer to Hi-Crush Partners LP and its subsidiaries. References in this prospectus to “Hi-Crush Proppants LLC,” “our predecessor,” “our sponsor” and “the selling unitholder” refer to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. We include a glossary of some of the terms used in this prospectus as Appendix B.

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Overview

We are a pure play, low-cost, domestic producer of premium monocrystalline sand, a specialized mineral that is used as a “proppant” to enhance the recovery rates of hydrocarbons from oil and natural gas wells. Our reserves consist of “Northern White” sand, a resource existing predominately in Wisconsin and limited portions of the upper Midwest region of the United States, which is highly valued as a preferred proppant because it exceeds all American Petroleum Institute (“API”) specifications. We own, operate and develop sand reserves and related excavation and processing facilities and will seek to acquire or develop additional facilities. Our 561-acre facility with integrated rail infrastructure, located near Wyeville, Wisconsin, enables us to process and cost-effectively deliver approximately 1,600,000 tons of frac sand per year. Substantially all of our frac sand production is sold to leading investment grade-rated pressure pumping service providers under long-term, take-or-pay contracts that require our customers to pay a specified price for a specified volume of frac sand each month.

Over the past decade, exploration and production companies have increasingly focused on exploiting the vast hydrocarbon reserves contained in North America’s unconventional oil and natural gas reservoirs through advanced techniques, such as horizontal drilling and hydraulic fracturing. In recent years, this focus has resulted in exploration and production companies drilling more and longer horizontal wells, completing more hydraulic fracturing stages per well and utilizing more proppant per stage in an attempt to efficiently maximize the volume of hydrocarbon recoveries per wellbore. As a result, North American demand for proppant has increased rapidly, growing at an average annual rate of 28.0% from 2006 to 2011, with total annual sales of $3.7 billion in 2011, according to The Freedonia Group, a leading international business research company. We believe that the market for raw frac sand will continue to grow based on the expected long-term development of North America’s unconventional oil and natural gas reservoirs.

We intend to utilize the significant oil and natural gas industry experience of our management team to take advantage of what we believe are favorable, long-term market dynamics as we execute our growth strategy, which includes both the acquisition of additional frac sand reserves and the development of new excavation and processing facilities. We expect to have the opportunity to acquire significant additional acreage and reserves currently owned or under an agreement to be acquired by our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, including approximately 1,700 acres of additional land and associated reserves in western Wisconsin to which we have a

 

 

1


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

right of first offer, in addition to potential acquisitions from third parties. Our sponsor will not, however, be required to accept any offer we make, and may, following good faith negotiations with us, sell the assets subject to our right of first offer to third parties that may compete with us. Our sponsor may also elect to develop, retain and operate properties in competition with us or develop new assets that are not subject to our right of first offer.

We intend to remain solely focused on the frac sand market as we believe it offers attractive long-term growth fundamentals.

Our Business and Properties

Assets and Operations

We own and operate the Wyeville facility, which is located in Monroe County, Wisconsin and, as of December 31, 2011, contained 48.4 million tons of proven recoverable sand reserves of mesh sizes we have currently contracted to sell. According to John T. Boyd Company, a leading mining consulting firm focused on the mineral and natural gas industries (“John T. Boyd”), our proven reserves consist entirely of coarse grade Northern White sand (which is also referred to as “Ottawa” sand) exceeding API specifications. Analysis of our sand by independent third-party testing companies indicates that it demonstrates characteristics in excess of API specifications with regard to crush strength (ability to withstand high pressures), turbidity (low levels of contaminants) and roundness and sphericity (facilitates hydrocarbon flow, or conductivity). For more information regarding the evaluation and estimation of our sand reserves, please read “Business—Assets and Business Operations—Sand Reserves.”

We acquired the Wyeville acreage and commenced construction of the Wyeville facility in January 2011. We completed construction of the Wyeville facility and commenced sand excavation and processing in June 2011 with an initial plant processing capacity of 950,000 tons per year, and customer shipments were initiated in July 2011. From the Wyeville in-service date to June 30, 2012, we have processed and sold 871,850 tons of frac sand. We completed an expansion in March 2012 that increased our annual expected processing capacity to approximately 1,600,000 tons per year. We have contracted approximately 91% of this capacity for the remainder of 2012 and through the second quarter of 2014, and approximately 71% of this capacity for the remainder of 2014 and through the second quarter 2016. Based on currently contracted production rates and a reserve report prepared by John T. Boyd, our Wyeville facility has an implied 33-year reserve life as of December 31, 2011.

All of our product is shipped by rail from our three 5,000-foot rail spurs that connect our processing and storage facilities to a Union Pacific Railroad mainline. The length of these rail spurs and the capacity of the associated product storage silos allow us to accommodate a large number of rail cars. It also enables us to accommodate unit trains, which significantly increases our efficiency in meeting our customers’ frac sand transportation needs. Unit trains, typically 80 rail cars in length or longer, are dedicated trains chartered for a single delivery destination. Generally, unit trains receive priority scheduling and do not switch cars at various intermediate junctions, which results in a more cost-effective and efficient method of shipping than the standard method of rail shipment.

Customers and Contracts

Our current customer base is comprised of subsidiaries of four of North America’s largest providers of pressure pumping services: Baker Hughes Incorporated (“Baker Hughes”), FTS International, LLC. (“FTS International”), Halliburton Company (“Halliburton”) and Weatherford International Ltd. (“Weatherford”). Our largest customers based on current contracts, Baker Hughes and Halliburton, are each rated A2 / A by Moody’s and Standard & Poor’s, respectively, and Weatherford is rated Baa2 / BBB by these agencies. FTS International Services LLC, the subsidiary of FTS International that is the counterparty to our customer contract, is rated Ba3 / B by these agencies. Spears and Associates estimates that these four companies controlled 47% of North

 

 

2


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

American pressure pumping fleet in 2011 and accounted for greater than 50% of the North American pressure pumping market, based on 2011 revenue. For the year ended December 31, 2011, sales to Halliburton and Weatherford accounted for 64% and 36% of our total revenues, respectively. Sales under our contracts with Baker Hughes and FTS International commenced in May 2012.

We sell substantially all of the frac sand we produce under long-term, take-or-pay contracts that significantly reduce our exposure to short-term fluctuations in the price of and demand for frac sand. For the year ended December 31, 2011 and the first quarter of 2012, we generated 99% of our revenues from frac sand delivered under our long-term sand sales contracts, and we expect to continue selling a significant majority of our sand under long-term contracts. As of June 30, 2012, we had four long-term sand sales contracts with a weighted average remaining life of approximately 4.6 years. The following table presents a summary of our contracted volumes and revenues from 2011 through 2015, as well as the average contract sales price and make-whole price our customers are obligated to pay in the event they decline to accept delivery of the required product volumes under their respective contracts.

 

    Year Ended December 31,  
    2011     2012     2013     2014     2015  

Contracted Volumes (tons)

    331,667        1,216,667        1,460,000        1,295,000        1,130,000   

% of Processing Capacity(1)

    79     85     91     81     71

Contracted Revenue

  $ 19,916,667      $ 78,966,667      $ 96,466,667      $ 88,350,000      $ 80,100,000   

Average Sales Price per ton

    $60        $65        $66        $68        $71   

Average Make-Whole Price per ton

    $60        $49        $49        $51        $51   

 

(1) Percentage of processing capacity for 2011 and 2012 based on weighted average processing capacity for such periods.

As the above table illustrates, when one of our contracts expires in 2014, the average contracted price per ton will increase. The expiring contract provides for sales prices lower than current market prices. Prior to this contract’s expiration, we will seek to renew or replace this contract on pricing terms more comparable to market prices at the time. Occasionally, if we have excess production and market conditions are favorable, we may elect to sell frac sand in spot market transactions.

The terms of our customer contracts, including sand quality requirements, quantity parameters, permitted sources of supply, effects of future regulatory changes, force majeure and termination and assignment provisions, vary by customer. As indicated in the above table, our customer contracts contain penalties for non-performance by our customers, with make-whole prices averaging approximately $49 per ton in 2012. If one of our customers fails to meet its minimum obligations to us, we would expect that the make-whole payment, combined with a decrease in our variable costs (such as royalty payments and excavation costs), would substantially mitigate any adverse impact on our cash flow from such failure. We would also have the ability to sell the sand volumes for which we receive make-whole payments to third parties. Our customer contracts also contain penalties for our non-performance. If we are unable to deliver contracted volumes within three months of contract year end, or otherwise arrange for delivery from a third party, we are required to pay make-whole payments averaging approximately $49 per ton in 2012. We believe our expanded Wyeville facility, substantial reserves and our on-site processing and logistics capabilities reduce our risk of non-performance. In addition, we intentionally maintain long-term contracted volume commitments to our customers at less than 100% of our processing capacity to provide excess capacity to further reduce the likelihood of failing to meet the requirements of our contracts. We believe our levels of inventory combined with our three month cure period starting at contract year end should be more than sufficient to prevent us from paying make-whole payments as a result of plant shutdowns due to repairs to our facilities necessitated by reasonably foreseeable mechanical interruptions.

 

 

3


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Industry Dynamics

Demand Trends

The North American proppant market, including raw frac sand, ceramic and resin-coated proppants, was approximately 22 million tons in 2011. Industry estimates for 2011 indicate that the raw frac sand market represented approximately 17 million tons, or 77.2% of the total proppant market by weight. Over the past five years, proppant demand by weight has increased by 28.0% annually, and the market is projected to continue growing by 7.2% per year through 2016, representing an increase of approximately nine million tons in annual proppant demand over that time period. The total North American proppant market size in dollars was $3.7 billion in 2011 and is projected to grow 10.5% annually through 2016, according to The Freedonia Group. The following chart illustrates historical and forecasted proppant demand for certain years from 2001 to 2021.

Historical and Projected Proppant Demand

 

LOGO

Source: The Freedonia Group

Demand growth for frac sand and other proppants is primarily due to advancements in oil and natural gas drilling and well completion technology and techniques, such as horizontal drilling and hydraulic fracturing. These advancements have made the extraction of oil and natural gas increasingly cost-effective in formations that historically would have been uneconomic to develop. Over the past five years, North American rig count has increased by 2.6% annually, while the demand for proppant by weight has grown at a rate of 28.0% annually. We believe that demand for proppant has and will continue to increase at a rate greater than rig count as a result of the following additional demand drivers:

 

   

improved drilling rig productivity, resulting in more wells drilled per rig per year;

 

   

increases in the percentage of rigs that are drilling horizontal wells;

 

   

increases in the length of the typical horizontal wellbore;

 

   

increases in the number of fracture stages per foot in the typical completed horizontal wellbore;

 

   

increases in the volume of proppant used per fracturing stage; and

 

   

recurring efforts to offset steep production declines in unconventional oil and natural gas reservoirs, including the drilling of new wells and secondary hydraulic fracturing of existing wells.

Furthermore, recent growth in demand for raw frac sand has outpaced growth in demand for other proppants, and industry analysts predict that this trend will continue. According to The Freedonia Group, North American demand for all types of proppants, in dollar terms, is projected to increase 10.5% annually from 2011 through 2016, while demand for raw frac sand is projected to increase 12.1% annually over that time period. As well completion costs have increased as a proportion of total well costs, operators have increasingly looked for ways to improve per well economics by lowering costs without sacrificing production performance. To this end,

 

 

4


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

the oil and natural gas industry is shifting away from the use of higher-cost proppants towards more cost-effective proppants, such as raw frac sand. The substantial increase in activity in North American oil and liquids-rich resource plays has further accelerated the demand growth for raw frac sand. Within these oil and liquids-rich basins, Northern White sand with coarser mesh sizes is often preferred due to its performance characteristics.

Supply Trends

As demand for raw frac sand has increased dramatically in recent years, the supply of raw frac sand has failed to keep pace, resulting in a supply-demand disparity. While a number of existing and new competitors have announced supply expansions and greenfield projects, we do not expect the magnitude of these expansions to meet expected demand. There are several key constraints to increasing raw frac sand production on an industry-wide basis, including:

 

   

the difficulty of finding frac sand reserves that meet API specifications;

 

   

the difficulty of securing contiguous frac sand reserves large enough to justify the capital investment required to develop a processing facility;

 

   

the challenges of identifying reserves with the above characteristics that either are located in close proximity to oil and natural gas reservoirs or have rail access needed for low-cost transportation to major shale basins;

 

   

the hurdles of securing mining, production, water, air, refuse and other federal, state and local operating permits from the proper authorities;

 

   

local opposition to development of facilities, especially those that require the use of on-road transportation, including moratoria on raw frac sand facilities in multiple counties in Wisconsin which hold potential sand reserves; and

 

   

the long lead time required to design and construct sand processing facilities that can efficiently process large quantities of high quality frac sand.

Business Strategies

Our primary business objective is to increase our cash distributions per unit over time. We intend to accomplish this objective by executing the following strategies:

 

   

Focusing on stable, long-term, take-or-pay contracts with key customers. A key component of our business model is our contracting strategy, which seeks to secure a high percentage of our cash flows under long-term, fixed price contracts with take-or-pay provisions, while also staggering the tenors of our contracts so that they expire at different times. We believe this contracting strategy significantly mitigates our exposure to the potential price volatility of the spot market for frac sand in the short-term, allows us to take advantage of any increase in frac sand prices over the medium-term and provides us with long-term cash flow stability. As current contracts expire or as we add new processing capacity, we intend to pursue similar long-term contracts with our current customers and with other leading pressure pumping service providers. We intend to utilize nearly all of our processing capacity to fulfill these contracts, with any excess processed frac sand first offered to existing customers and the remaining amount sold opportunistically in the spot market.

 

   

Pursuing accretive acquisitions from our sponsor and third parties. We expect to pursue accretive acquisitions of frac sand facilities from our sponsor, including through our right of first offer to acquire an aggregate of 1,700 acres of additional land in western Wisconsin with approximately 79.2 million tons of proven recoverable reserves of frac sand according to John T. Boyd, as well as from third-party frac sand producers. As we evaluate acquisition opportunities, we intend to remain focused on

 

 

5


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
 

operations that complement our reserves of premium frac sand and that provide or would accommodate the development and construction of rail or other advantaged logistics capabilities. We believe these factors are critical to our business model and are important characteristics for any potential acquisitions.

 

   

Expanding our proved reserve base and processing capacity. We seek to identify and evaluate economically attractive expansion and facility enhancement opportunities to increase our proved reserves and processing capacity. At Wyeville and any future sites, we expect to pursue add-on acreage acquisitions near our facilities to expand our reserve base and increase our reserve life. In March 2012, we completed an expansion of our Wyeville facility, increasing annual processing capacity from 950,000 tons per year to approximately 1,600,000 tons per year by adding wet and dry plant capacity and additional sand storage silos. We will continue to analyze and pursue other organic expansion efforts that will similarly allow us to cost-effectively optimize our existing assets and meet the customer demand for our high quality frac sand.

 

   

Capitalizing on compelling industry fundamentals. We intend to continue to position ourselves as a pure play producer of high quality frac sand, as we believe the frac sand market offers attractive long-term growth fundamentals. The growth of horizontal drilling in shale and other unconventional oil and natural gas plays has resulted in greater demand for frac sand. This demand growth is underpinned by increased horizontal drilling, higher proppant use per well and cost advantages over resin-coated sand and manufactured ceramics. We believe frac sand supply will continue to be constrained by the difficulty in finding reserves that meet the technical specifications of the API in contiguous quantities large enough to justify the capital investment required and the challenges associated with successfully obtaining the necessary local, state and federal permits required for operations.

 

   

Maintaining financial flexibility and conservative leverage. We plan to pursue a disciplined financial policy and maintain a conservative capital structure. We expect to have no indebtedness at the closing of this offering and $104.7 million of liquidity in the form of $6.2 million of cash on hand and undrawn borrowing capacity under our new $100.0 million revolving credit facility, taking into account $1.5 million of letters of credit expected to be in place at closing. We believe that our borrowing capacity and ability to access debt and equity capital markets after this offering will provide us with the financial flexibility necessary to achieve our organic expansion and acquisition strategy.

Competitive Strengths

We believe that we are well positioned to successfully execute our strategy and achieve our primary business objective because of the following competitive strengths:

 

   

Long-term contracted cash flow stability. We will generate substantially all of our revenues from the sale of frac sand under long-term contracts that require subsidiaries of Baker Hughes, FTS International, Halliburton and Weatherford to pay specified prices for specified volumes of product each month. We believe that the take-or-pay volume and pricing provisions and the long-term nature of our contracts will provide us with a stable base of cash flows and limit the risks associated with price movements in the spot market and any changes in product demand during the contract period. We are currently contracted to sell 1,460,000 tons of frac sand annually from our Wyeville facility, and as of June 30, 2012, our contracts had a weighted average remaining life of approximately 4.6 years.

 

   

Long-lived, high quality reserve base. Our Wyeville facility contains approximately 48.4 million tons of proven recoverable coarse grade reserves as of December 31, 2011, based on a third-party reserve report by John T. Boyd and has an implied 33-year reserve life at currently contracted production rates. These reserves consist of high quality Northern White frac sand. Analysis by independent third-party testing companies indicates that our sand demonstrates characteristics in excess of API specifications with regard to crush strength, turbidity and roundness and sphericity. As a result, our raw frac sand is particularly well suited for and is experiencing significant demand from customers for use in the hydraulic fracturing of unconventional oil and natural gas wells.

 

 

6


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

Intrinsic logistics and infrastructure advantage. The strategic location and logistics capabilities of our Wyeville facility enable us to serve all major U.S. oil and natural gas producing basins. Our on-site transportation assets include three 5,000-foot rail spurs off a Union Pacific Railroad mainline that are capable of accommodating unit trains, allowing our customers to receive priority scheduling, expedited delivery and a more cost-effective shipping alternative. Our logistics capabilities enable efficient loading of sand and minimize rail car turnaround times at the facility, and we expect to acquire or develop similar logistics capabilities at any facilities we own in the future. We believe we are one of the few frac sand producers with a facility initially designed to deliver frac sand meeting API specifications to all of the major U.S. oil and natural gas producing basins by on-site rail facilities, including on-site storage capacity accommodating unit trains.

 

   

Competitive operating cost structure. Our operations have been strategically designed to provide low per-unit production costs with a significant variable component for the excavation and processing of our sand. Our sand reserves do not require blasting or crushing to be processed and, due to the shallow overburden at our Wyeville facility, we are able to use surface mining equipment in our operations, which provides for a lower cost structure than underground mining operations. Our mining operations are subcontracted to Gerke Excavating, Inc. at a fixed cost of $2.09 per ton excavated, subject to a diesel fuel surcharge, under a three-year contract. Unlike some competitors, our processing and rail loading facilities are located on-site, which eliminates the requirement for on-road transportation, lowers product movement costs and minimizes the reduction in sand quality due to handling.

 

   

Experienced and incentivized management team. Our management team has extensive experience investing and operating in the oil and natural gas industry and will be focused on optimizing our current business and expanding our operations through disciplined development and accretive acquisitions. We believe our management team’s substantial experience and relationships with participants in the oilfield services and exploration and production industries provide us with an extensive operational and commercial understanding of the markets in which our customers operate. The expertise of our management and operations teams covers a wide range of disciplines, with an emphasis on development, construction and operation of frac sand processing facilities, frac sand supply chain management and consulting and bulk solids material handling. Members of our management team are strongly incentivized to profitably grow our business and cash flows through their 39% interest in our sponsor, which will own              of our common units and all of our subordinated units and incentive distribution rights following this offering.

Risk Factors

An investment in our common units involves risks. You should carefully consider the following risk factors, those other risks described in “Risk Factors” and the other information in this prospectus, before deciding whether to invest in our common units. The following risks and others are discussed in more detail in “Risk Factors.”

Risks Inherent in Our Business

 

   

We may not have sufficient cash from operations following the establishment of cash reserves and payment of costs and expenses, including cost reimbursements to our general partner and its affiliates, to enable us to pay the minimum quarterly distribution to our unitholders.

 

   

On a pro forma basis we would not have had sufficient cash available for distribution to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all units for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012.

 

   

The amount of cash we have available for distribution to holders of our units depends primarily on our cash flow and not solely on profitability, which may prevent us from making cash distributions during periods when we record net income.

 

 

7


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

None of the proceeds from the sale of common units in this offering will be available to us to fund our operations or to pay distributions to public unitholders.

 

   

The assumptions underlying our forecast of cash available for distribution included in “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions” are inherently uncertain and subject to significant business, economic, financial, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause cash available for distribution to differ materially from those estimates.

 

   

Inaccuracies in estimates of volumes and qualities of our sand reserves could result in lower than expected sales and higher than expected production costs.

 

   

Substantially all of our sales are generated under contracts with four customers, and the loss of, or significant reduction in purchases by, any of them could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

   

If we are unable to make acquisitions on economically acceptable terms, our future growth would be limited, and any acquisitions we make may reduce, rather than increase, our cash generated from operations on a per unit basis.

 

   

Our long-term business and financial performance depends on the level of drilling and completion activity in the oil and natural gas industry.

 

   

All of our sales are generated at one facility. Any adverse developments at our Wyeville facility could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

   

An increase in the supply of raw frac sand having similar characteristics as the raw frac sand we produce could make it more difficult for us to renew or replace our existing contracts on favorable terms or at all.

 

   

Federal, state and local legislative and regulatory initiatives relating to hydraulic fracturing and the potential for related litigation could result in increased costs, additional operating restrictions or delays for our customers, which could cause a decline in the demand for our frac sand and negatively impact our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

   

Because we have a limited operating history, you may not be able to evaluate our current business and future earnings prospects accurately.

Risks Related to Environmental, Mining and Other Regulations

 

   

We and our customers are subject to extensive environmental and health and safety regulations that impose, and will continue to impose, significant costs and liabilities. In addition, future regulations, or more stringent enforcement of existing regulations, could increase those costs and liabilities, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

 

   

Silica-related legislation, health issues and litigation could have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation or results of operations.

 

   

We are subject to the Federal Mine Safety and Health Act of 1977, which imposes stringent health and safety standards on numerous aspects of our operations.

 

   

We and our customers are subject to other extensive regulations, including licensing, plant and wildlife protection and reclamation regulation, that impose, and will continue to impose, significant costs and liabilities. In addition, future regulations, or more stringent enforcement of existing regulations, could increase those costs and liabilities, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

 

   

Our inability to acquire, maintain or renew financial assurances related to the reclamation and restoration of mining property could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

 

8


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us

 

   

Our sponsor owns and controls our general partner, which has sole responsibility for conducting our business and managing our operations. Our general partner and its affiliates, including our sponsor, have conflicts of interest with us and limited duties, and they may favor their own interests to the detriment of us and our unitholders.

 

   

The board of directors of our general partner may modify or revoke our cash distribution policy at any time at its discretion. Our partnership agreement does not require us to pay any distributions at all.

 

   

Our sponsor competes with us, and other affiliates of our general partner will have the ability to compete with us.

 

   

Holders of our common units have limited voting rights and are not entitled to elect our general partner or its directors, which could reduce the price at which our common units will trade.

 

   

Unitholders will experience immediate and substantial dilution of $         per common unit.

 

   

There is no existing market for our common units, and a trading market that will provide you with adequate liquidity may not develop. The price of our common units may fluctuate significantly, and unitholders could lose all or part of their investment.

 

   

Our sponsor, which is our accounting predecessor for financial reporting purposes, has a material weakness in its internal control over financial reporting. If we fail to establish and maintain effective internal control over financial reporting, our ability to accurately report our financial results could be adversely affected.

Tax Risks to Common Unitholders

 

   

Our tax treatment depends on our status as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, as well as our not being subject to a material amount of entity-level taxation by individual states. If the IRS were to treat us as a corporation for federal income tax purposes or we were to become subject to material additional amounts of entity-level taxation for state tax purposes, then our cash available for distribution to you could be substantially reduced.

 

   

The tax treatment of publicly-traded partnerships or an investment in our units could be subject to potential legislative, judicial or administrative changes and differing interpretations, possibly on a retroactive basis.

 

   

You will be required to pay taxes on your share of our income even if you do not receive any cash distributions from us.

Our Management

We are managed and operated by the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner, Hi-Crush GP LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary of our sponsor. As a result of owning our general partner, our sponsor will have the right to appoint all members of the board of directors of our general partner, including at least three independent directors meeting the independence standards established by the NYSE. At least one of our independent directors will be appointed prior to the date our common units are listed for trading on the NYSE. Our unitholders will not be entitled to elect our general partner or its directors or otherwise directly participate in our management or operations. For more information about the executive officers and directors of our general partner, please read “Management.”

 

 

9


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our Relationship with Our Sponsor

Overview and History

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, our sponsor, was formed in 2010 in Houston, Texas. Members of our sponsor’s management team have, on average, more than 20 years of experience investing in and operating businesses in the oil and natural gas and sand mining industries. Members of our management team have partnered with major oilfield services companies and exploration and production companies in the development of oil and natural gas reservoirs. In this capacity, members of our management team gained valuable expertise and developed strong relationships in the oilfield services industry. Recognizing the increasing demand for proppants as a result of rapidly evolving hydraulic fracturing techniques, members of our management team chose to leverage their expertise and relationships to capitalize on this increasing demand by developing raw frac sand reserves and facilities. In addition, our Chief Operating Officer has overseen the design, construction and staffing for multiple sand mining and processing facilities. The expertise of our management and operations teams covers a wide range of disciplines, with an emphasis on development, construction and operation of frac sand processing facilities, frac sand supply chain management and consulting and bulk solids material handling.

Our sponsor’s lead investor is Avista Capital Partners, a leading private equity firm with significant investing and operating expertise in the energy industry. Founded in 2005 by senior investment professionals who worked together at DLJ Merchant Banking Partners (“DLJMB”), then one of the world’s largest and most successful private equity franchises, Avista makes controlling or influential minority investments in connection with various transaction structures. The energy team at Avista is comprised of experienced professionals and industry executives with relevant expertise in the energy sector. Avista principals have led over $2.7 billion in equity investments in energy companies while at Avista and DLJMB, including Basic Energy Services, Inc., Brigham Exploration Company, Copano Energy, L.L.C., Seabulk International, Inc., and joint-ventures with Carrizo Oil & Gas, Inc.

Our Sponsor’s Assets and Our Right of First Offer

In connection with this offering, our sponsor is contributing to us its sand reserves and related excavation and processing facilities located in Wyeville, Wisconsin, which are being contributed to us because of Wyeville’s established operating history and the fact that it is our sponsor’s most fully-contracted facility. In addition to the Wyeville facility, our sponsor owns or has options to acquire several other sand mining locations where it could develop similar logistics capabilities as the Wyeville facility, and it will retain these assets following this offering. Pursuant to the terms of an omnibus agreement we expect to enter into with our sponsor, we will have a right of first offer with respect to certain of our sponsor’s current assets, which are located in Augusta, Wisconsin and Tomah, Wisconsin, and are described in more detail below. Our sponsor’s success in identifying and acquiring these locations resulted from its expertise in identifying quality sand reserves, as well as its efficient construction of the Wyeville facility and its on-site approach to excavation and logistics, which minimizes community impact during the production process.

The Augusta excavation and processing facility in Eau Claire County, Wisconsin is currently operational, and our sponsor expects to commence shipments from Augusta in the third quarter of 2012. John T. Boyd estimated that, as of December 31, 2011, the Augusta site had 46.2 million tons of proven recoverable coarse grade sand reserves located on approximately 1,000 acres. Our sponsor recently completed construction of a 1,600,000 ton per year processing facility at Augusta, and John T. Boyd estimates that the site has a reserve life of approximately 39 years based on currently contracted production levels. After taking into account our sponsor’s agreement to assume one of our customer contracts, our sponsor has contracted for the sale of 1,200,000 tons of sand per year from the Augusta facility with two of our existing customers under take-or-pay contracts with a weighted average life of approximately 4.8 years that specify both volumes and price. The customers will take delivery of the sand at on-site rail facilities that, like the Wyeville facility, can accommodate unit trains.

 

 

10


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our sponsor has agreed to acquire approximately 700 acres in Tomah, Wisconsin, which is six miles south of the Wyeville facility in Monroe County. The Tomah site has access to the same Union Pacific Railroad mainline as the Wyeville facility, which runs adjacent to the property, and could accommodate similar rail logistics as the Wyeville facility. Extensive core samples have been taken at Tomah and independently tested with results indicating a high quality sand reserve similar to the Wyeville site. According to a John T. Boyd reserve report, the Tomah site had proven recoverable sand reserves of 33 million tons as of December 31, 2011, which represents a 51-year reserve life assuming construction of a 650,000 ton per year processing facility.

In addition, our sponsor is evaluating a number of additional development locations and adds potential projects to its development backlog regularly.

Our sponsor’s retained sand facilities represent a significant potential growth opportunity for us. Our sponsor continually evaluates acquisitions and may elect to acquire, construct or dispose of assets in the future, including sales of assets to us. As the owner of our general partner,              of our common units, all              of our subordinated units and all of our incentive distribution rights following this offering, our sponsor is well aligned and highly motivated to promote and support the successful execution of our business strategies, including utilizing our partnership as a growth vehicle for its sand mining operations. Although we expect to have the opportunity to make additional acquisitions directly from our sponsor in the future, including the sand excavation and processing facilities described above that are subject to our right of first offer, our sponsor is under no obligation to accept any offer we make, and may, following good faith negotiations with us, sell the assets subject to our right of first offer to third parties that may compete with us. Our sponsor may also elect to develop, retain and operate properties in competition with us or develop new assets that are not subject to our right of first offer.

In addition, while we believe our relationship with our sponsor is a significant positive attribute, it may also be a source of conflict. For example, our sponsor is not restricted in its ability to compete with us, and beginning with the commencement of operations at our sponsor’s Augusta facility scheduled for the third quarter of 2012, our sponsor will operate frac sand excavation and processing facilities that will compete directly with us for new and existing customers. We expect that our sponsor will develop additional frac sand excavation and processing facilities in the future, which may also compete with us. While we expect that our management team, which also manages our sponsor’s retained assets, and our sponsor will allocate new and replacement customer contracts between us and our sponsor in a manner that balances the interests of both parties, they are under no obligation to do so. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.”

Summary of Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties

Our general partner has a legal duty to manage us in a manner it believes is in our best interest. However, the officers and directors of our general partner also have fiduciary duties to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to our sponsor, the owner of our general partner. As a result, conflicts of interest may arise in the future between us or our unitholders, on the one hand, and our sponsor and our general partner, on the other hand.

Our partnership agreement limits the liability of and replaces the duties owed by our general partner to our unitholders. Our partnership agreement also restricts the remedies available to our unitholders for actions that might otherwise constitute a breach of our general partner’s duties. By purchasing a common unit, the purchaser agrees to be bound by the terms of our partnership agreement, and each unitholder is treated as having consented to various actions and potential conflicts of interest contemplated in the partnership agreement that might otherwise be considered a breach of fiduciary or other duties under Delaware law.

We expect that the board of directors of our general partner will delegate to a conflicts committee of the board of directors the authority to approve material transactions with related parties.

 

 

11


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

For a more detailed description of the conflicts of interest and duties of our general partner, please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.” For a description of other relationships with our affiliates, please read “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions.”

Principal Executive Offices

We are a Delaware limited partnership formed in May 2012. Our principal executive offices are located at Three Riverway, Suite 1550, Houston, Texas 77056, and our telephone number is (713) 963-0099. Our website address will be www.hicrushpartners.com. We intend to make our periodic reports and other information filed with or furnished to the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC, available, free of charge, through our website, as soon as reasonably practicable after those reports and other information are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Information on our website or any other website is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus and does not constitute a part of this prospectus.

Emerging Growth Company Status

We are an “emerging growth company” as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act, or “JOBS Act.” For as long as we are an emerging growth company, unlike other public companies, we will not be required to:

 

   

provide an auditor’s attestation report on management’s assessment of the effectiveness of our system of internal control over financial reporting pursuant to Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002;

 

   

comply with any new requirements adopted by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, or the PCAOB, requiring mandatory audit firm rotation or a supplement to the auditor’s report in which the auditor would be required to provide additional information about the audit and the financial statements of the issuer;

 

   

comply with any new audit rules adopted by the PCAOB after April 5, 2012, unless the Securities and Exchange Commission determines otherwise;

 

   

provide certain disclosure regarding executive compensation required of larger public companies; or

 

   

obtain shareholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved.

We will cease to be an “emerging growth company” upon the earliest of:

 

   

when we have $1.0 billion or more in annual revenues;

 

   

when we have at least $700 million in market value of our common units held by non-affiliates;

 

   

when we issue more than $1.0 billion of non-convertible debt over a three-year period; or

 

   

the last day of the fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of our initial public offering.

In addition, Section 107 of the JOBS Act also provides that an emerging growth company can take advantage of the extended transition period provided in Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act for complying with new or revised accounting standards. In other words, an emerging growth company can delay the adoption of certain accounting standards until those standards would otherwise apply to private companies. However, we are choosing to “opt out” of such extended transition period, and as a result, we will comply with new or revised accounting standards on the relevant dates on which adoption of such standards is required for non-emerging growth companies. Section 107 of the JOBS Act provides that our decision to opt out of the extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards is irrevocable.

 

 

12


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure

We are a Delaware limited partnership formed in May 2012 by our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, to own and operate certain of the businesses that have historically been conducted by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC.

In connection with the closing of this offering, the following will occur:

 

   

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will contribute Hi-Crush Chambers LLC, Hi-Crush Railroad LLC, Hi-Crush Wyeville LLC and Hi-Crush Operating LLC to us;

 

   

our sponsor will contribute to us an amount of cash, which we currently expect will be approximately $6.2 million. This is the amount we expect to remain as of the closing of this offering related to prepayments for volumes of sand to be delivered during the six months ended December 31, 2012. Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will retain all other cash and cash equivalents;

 

   

we will issue to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC              common units,              subordinated units and all of our incentive distribution rights;

 

   

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will sell          common units to the public in this offering and will receive gross proceeds of $         million from the sale of such units at an assumed initial public offering price of $         per unit;

 

   

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will use a portion of the proceeds received by it from this offering to pay underwriting discounts and the structuring fee totaling approximately $         million;

 

   

to the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase          additional common units, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will sell such units to the public, pay the related underwriting discounts and structuring fee and retain the net proceeds;

 

   

we will enter into a new $100.0 million revolving credit facility; and

 

   

we will enter into an omnibus agreement with Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, our general partner and certain of its affiliates pursuant to which:

 

   

we will agree to reimburse Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and its affiliates for the payment of certain capital expenditures, operating expenses and for providing various general and administrative services;

 

   

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will indemnify us for certain environmental, toxic tort, title and right-of-way defects and other matters;

 

   

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will assume our customer contract with FTS International beginning on May 1, 2013; and

 

   

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC will grant us a right of first offer with respect to its Augusta and Tomah acreage and related assets, which are being retained by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC in connection with this offering.

 

 

13


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Organizational Structure

The following is a simplified diagram of our ownership structure after giving effect to this offering and the related transactions.

 

LOGO

 

Public Common Units

          %(1) 

Interests of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC:

  

Common Units

          %(1) 

Subordinated Units

         

Incentive Distribution Rights

        (2) 

Non-Economic General Partner Interest

     0.0 %(3) 
  

 

 

 
     100.0
  

 

 

 

 

(1) Assumes no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units. If and to the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units from the selling unitholder, the units purchased pursuant to such exercise will be sold to the public.
(2) Incentive distribution rights represent a variable interest in distributions and thus are not expressed as a fixed percentage. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Incentive Distribution Rights.” Distributions with respect to the incentive distribution rights will be classified as distributions with respect to equity interests. Incentive distribution rights will be issued to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC.
(3) Our general partner owns a non-economic general partner interest in us. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—General Partner Interest.”

 

 

14


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The Offering

 

Common units offered to the public by the selling unitholder

             common units.

 

Option to purchase additional common units from the selling unitholder

If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full, the selling unitholder will sell an additional              common units to the public.

 

Units outstanding after this offering

             common units and              subordinated units for a total of              limited partner units. If and to the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units, the selling unitholder, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, will sell the number of common units purchased by the underwriters pursuant to such exercise and the remainder, if any, will be retained by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. Accordingly, the exercise of the underwriters’ option will not affect the total number of common units outstanding. In addition, our general partner will own a non-economic general partner interest in us.

 

Use of proceeds

We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of common units by the selling unitholder in this offering.

 

Cash distributions

We expect to make a minimum quarterly distribution of $         per common unit and subordinated unit ($         per common unit and subordinated unit on an annualized basis) to the extent we have sufficient cash after establishment of cash reserves and payment of fees and expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. Our ability to pay the minimum quarterly distribution is subject to various restrictions and other factors described in more detail under the caption “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

 

  For the first quarter that we are publicly-traded, we will pay a prorated distribution covering the period from the completion of this offering through                     , 2012, based on the actual length of that period.

 

  Our partnership agreement generally provides that we will distribute cash each quarter in the following manner:

 

   

first, to the holders of common units, until each common unit has received the minimum quarterly distribution of $         plus any arrearages from prior quarters;

 

   

second, to the holders of subordinated units, until each subordinated unit has received the minimum quarterly distribution of $        ; and

 

   

third, to the holders of common units and subordinated units pro rata until each has received a distribution of $            .

 

 

15


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
  If cash distributions to our unitholders exceed $         per common unit and subordinated unit in any quarter, our unitholders and our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) will receive distributions according to the following percentage allocations:

 

Total Quarterly Distribution
Target Amount

   Marginal Percentage Interest
in Distributions
 
   Unitholders     Sponsor
(as Holder of
Our Incentive
Distribution Rights)
 

above $             up to $            

     85.0     15.0

above $             up to $            

     75.0     25.0

above $            

     50.0     50.0

 

  We refer to the additional increasing distributions to our sponsor as “incentive distributions.” Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Incentive Distribution Rights.”

 

  Our pro forma cash available for distribution for the six months ended June 30, 2012 was approximately $21.0 million (or $         per common unit). This amount would have been insufficient to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common and subordinated units for the six months ended June 30, 2012 by approximately $         million. As a result, for the six months ended June 30, 2012 we would have generated cash available for distribution sufficient to pay 100% of the minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common units, but only approximately         % of the minimum quarterly distribution on our subordinated units during that period.

 

  We believe, based on our financial forecast and related assumptions included in “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions,” that we will have sufficient cash available for distribution to pay the minimum quarterly distribution of $         on all of our common units and subordinated units for each quarter in the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. However, we do not have a legal or contractual obligation to pay quarterly distributions at our minimum quarterly distribution rate or at any other rate and there is no guarantee that we will pay distributions to our unitholders in any quarter. Please read “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

 

Subordinated units

Our sponsor will initially own all of our subordinated units. The principal difference between our common units and subordinated units is that in any quarter during the subordination period, holders of the subordinated units are not entitled to receive any distribution until the common units have received the minimum quarterly distribution plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution from prior quarters. Subordinated units will not accrue arrearages.

 

 

16


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Conversion of subordinated units

The subordination period will end on the first business day after we have earned and paid at least (1) $         (the minimum quarterly distribution on an annualized basis) on each outstanding common unit and subordinated unit for each of three consecutive, non-overlapping four quarter periods ending on or after                     , 2015 or (2) $         (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on each outstanding common unit and subordinated unit and the related distribution on the incentive distribution rights for a four-quarter period ending on or after                     , 2013, in each case provided there are no arrearages on our common units at that time. For the period after the closing of this offering through                     , 2012, we will adjust the quarterly distribution based on the actual length of the period, and use such adjusted distribution in determining whether the test described in this paragraph has been satisfied for the quarter ending                     , 2012.

 

  The subordination period also will end upon the removal of our general partner other than for cause if no subordinated units or common units held by the holder(s) of subordinated units or their affiliates are voted in favor of that removal.

 

  When the subordination period ends, all subordinated units will convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, and all common units thereafter will no longer be entitled to arrearages.

 

Our sponsor’s right to reset the target distribution levels

Our sponsor, as the initial holder of our incentive distribution rights, has the right, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and it has received incentive distributions at the highest level to which it is entitled (50.0%) for the prior four consecutive whole fiscal quarters, to reset the initial target distribution levels at higher levels based on our cash distributions at the time of the exercise of the reset election. If our sponsor transfers all or a portion of our incentive distribution rights in the future, then the holder or holders of a majority of our incentive distribution rights will be entitled to exercise this right. The following assumes that our sponsor holds all of the incentive distribution rights at the time that a reset election is made. Following a reset election, the minimum quarterly distribution will be adjusted to equal the reset minimum quarterly distribution, and the target distribution levels will be reset to correspondingly higher levels based on the same percentage increases above the reset minimum quarterly distribution as the current target distribution levels.

 

  If our sponsor elects to reset the target distribution levels, it will be entitled to receive a number of common units. The number of common units to be issued to our sponsor will equal the number of common units that would have entitled the holder to an aggregate quarterly cash distribution in the quarter prior to the reset election equal to the distribution to our sponsor on the incentive distribution rights in the quarter prior to the reset election. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Our Sponsor’s Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels.”

 

 

17


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Issuance of additional units

Our partnership agreement authorizes us to issue an unlimited number of additional units without the approval of our unitholders. Please read “Units Eligible for Future Sale” and “The Partnership Agreement—Issuance of Additional Interests.”

 

Limited voting rights

Our general partner will manage and operate us. Unlike the holders of common stock in a corporation, our unitholders will have only limited voting rights on matters affecting our business. Our unitholders will have no right to elect our general partner or its directors on an annual or other continuing basis. Our general partner may not be removed except by a vote of the holders of at least 66 2/3% of the outstanding units, including any units owned by our general partner and its affiliates, voting together as a single class. Upon consummation of this offering, our sponsor will own an aggregate of     % of our outstanding units (or     % of our outstanding units, if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full). This will give our sponsor the ability to prevent the removal of our general partner. Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Voting Rights.”

 

Limited call right

If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the outstanding common units, our general partner has the right, but not the obligation, to purchase all of the remaining common units at a price equal to the greater of (1) the average of the daily closing price of the common units over the 20 trading days preceding the date three days before notice of exercise of the call right is first mailed and (2) the highest per-unit price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for common units during the 90-day period preceding the date such notice is first mailed. Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Limited Call Right.”

 

Estimated ratio of taxable income to distributions

We estimate that if you own the common units you purchase in this offering through the record date for distributions for the period ending December 31, 2014, you will be allocated, on a cumulative basis, an amount of federal taxable income for that period that will be less than     % of the cash distributed to you with respect to that period. For example, if you receive an annual distribution of $         per unit, we estimate that your average allocable federal taxable income per year will be no more than approximately $         per unit. Thereafter, the ratio of allocable taxable income to cash distributions to you could substantially increase. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership” beginning on page 173 for the basis of this estimate.

 

Material federal income tax consequences

For a discussion of the material federal income tax consequences that may be relevant to prospective unitholders who are individual citizens or residents of the United States, please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences.”

 

Exchange listing

Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “HCLP,” subject to official notice of issuance.

 

 

18


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data

The partnership was formed in May 2012 and does not have historical financial statements. Therefore, in this prospectus we present the historical financial statements of our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, which is our accounting predecessor for financial reporting purposes. In connection with the closing of this offering, our sponsor will contribute all of the outstanding equity interests in certain of its operating subsidiaries, which account for substantially all of our sponsor’s historical business, to us. The following table presents summary historical financial and operating data of our sponsor and summary pro forma financial and operating data of Hi-Crush Partners LP as of the dates and for the periods indicated.

Our sponsor was formed in October 2010 to develop excavation, processing and logistics facilities for raw frac sand used in hydraulic fracturing operations in oil and natural gas wells. Since its formation, our sponsor acquired our assets in a number of separate acquisitions. As a result of our sponsor’s recent formation, we have limited operating history upon which you can base an evaluation of our current business and our future earnings prospects. This prospectus includes audited financial statements only as of December 31, 2011 and for the period from inception (October 28, 2010) to December 31, 2010 and unaudited financial information as of and for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2012 and 2011. In this prospectus, we refer to the period from inception to December 31, 2010 as the two-month period ended December 31, 2010. We have not completed or provided in this prospectus any stand-alone pre-acquisition financial statements for the assets we acquired in the transactions described above. As a result, and given our recent date of formation, we have not provided in this prospectus three years of audited financial statements that normally would be included in a prospectus forming part of an SEC registration statement or two years of audited financial statements as would normally be included in a prospectus forming part of an SEC registration statement filed by an emerging growth company.

The summary historical financial data presented as of December 31, 2010 and 2011, for the two-month period ended December 31, 2010 and for the year ended December 31, 2011 is derived from the audited historical financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC that are included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary historical financial data presented as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and 2012 are derived from the unaudited historical financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC included elsewhere in this prospectus.

The summary pro forma financial data presented as of and for the year ended December 31, 2011 and as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2012 is derived from our unaudited pro forma financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Our unaudited pro forma financial statements give pro forma effect to the following:

 

   

the contribution of Hi-Crush Chambers LLC, Hi-Crush Railroad LLC, Hi-Crush Wyeville LLC and Hi-Crush Operating LLC to us by our sponsor;

 

   

a reduction in general and administrative expenses as a result of allocations between our Wyeville facility and our sponsor’s other assets and activities that will not be contributed to us in connection with this offering;

 

   

the removal of other operating expenses of our sponsor related to assets and operations that will be retained by our sponsor following the completion of this offering;

 

   

the elimination of all cash and cash equivalents reflected on our balance sheet as of June 30, 2012, which will be retained by our sponsor; and

 

   

the issuance of              common units and              subordinated units to our sponsor.

 

 

19


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Each of the adjustments described above are either directly related to this offering or are required by or are a consequence of the contribution to us by our sponsor of the Wyeville facility and related assets, the closing of which is a condition precedent to the closing of this offering.

The unaudited pro forma balance sheet as of June 30, 2012 assumes the events listed above occurred as of June 30, 2012. The unaudited pro forma statements of income data for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012 assume the events listed above occurred as of January 1, 2011.

We have not given pro forma effect to incremental general and administrative expenses of approximately $2.1 million that we expect to incur annually as a result of operating as a publicly traded partnership, such as expenses associated with annual and quarterly reporting; tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution expenses; Sarbanes-Oxley compliance expenses; expenses associated with listing on the NYSE; independent auditor fees; legal fees; investor relations expenses; registrar and transfer agent fees; director and officer insurance expenses; and director and officer compensation expenses. We also have not given pro forma effect to additional general and administrative expenses that we expect to incur to support our recent expansion, including management level positions in operations, human resources, legal, accounting and reporting, as well as license fees associated with upgrading accounting and reporting software. We expect these incremental growth associated expenses to gradually increase over time as we hire additional personnel, from about $0.7 million for the year ending December 31, 2012 to $1.7 million on an annualized basis by September 30, 2013.

For a detailed discussion of the summary historical financial information contained in the following table, please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” The following table should also be read in conjunction with “Use of Proceeds,” “Business—Our History and Relationship with Our Sponsor” and the audited and unaudited historical financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and our unaudited pro forma financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Among other things, the historical and unaudited pro forma financial statements include more detailed information regarding the basis of presentation for the information in the following table.

The following table presents non-GAAP financial measures, EBITDA and production costs, which we use in our business as important supplemental measures of our performance. EBITDA represents net income (loss) before interest expense, income taxes and depreciation and depletion. Production costs represents costs of goods sold, excluding depreciation and depletion. EBITDA and production costs are not calculated or presented in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP. We explain these measures under “—Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below and reconcile them to their most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.

 

 

20


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
    Predecessor Historical     Hi-Crush Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
    Inception
to
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six  Months
Ended

June 30,
2012
 
        2011     2012      
    (in thousands, except per unit and operating information)  

Statement of Operations Data:

           

Revenues

  $      $ 20,353      $      $ 34,175      $ 20,353      $ 34,175   

Production costs (1)

           5,998               9,603        5,998        9,603   

Depreciation and depletion

           449               668        449        668   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cost of goods sold

           6,447               10,271        6,447        10,271   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

           13,906               23,904        13,906        23,904   

General and administrative

    26        2,324        647        3,137        1,689        1,577   

Other operating expenses

           381               419                 

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

           28               12        28        12   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

    (26     11,173        (647     20,336        12,189        22,315   

Other expense:

           

Interest expense, net

           (1,893            (2,385              

Other

                                         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income (expense)

           (1,893            (2,385              

Income (loss) before tax expense

    (26     9,280        (647     17,951        12,189        22,315   

Income tax expense

                                         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ (26   $ 9,280      $ (647   $ 17,951      $ 12,189      $ 22,315   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pro forma net income per limited partner unit:

           

Common unit

           

Subordinated unit

           

Statement of Cash Flow Data:

           

Net cash provided by (used in):

           

Operating activities

  $ (14   $ 18,788      $ 15,781      $ 5,063       

Investing activities

    (322     (50,199     (28,775     (50,296    

Financing activities

    336        42,465        14,463        45,929       

Other Financial Data:

           

EBITDA (1)

  $ (26   $ 11,622      $ (647   $ 21,004      $ 12,638      $ 22,983   

Capital expenditures (2)

    72        50,169        28,745        50,326       

Operating Data:

           

Total tons sold

           332,593               539,257        332,593        539,257   

Average realized price (per ton)

  $      $ 61.19      $      $ 63.37      $ 61.19      $ 63.37   

Production costs (per ton) (1)

         $ 18.03             $ 17.81      $ 18.03      $ 17.81   

Balance Sheet Data (at period end):

           

Cash and cash equivalents

  $      $ 11,054      $ 1,469      $ 11,750        $   

Total assets

    614        72,229        36,497        142,914          72,328   

Long-term debt (including current portion)

           46,112        15,185        96,421            

Total liabilities

    304        61,942        36,571        114,902          5,981   

Members’/Partners’ capital

    310        10,287        (74     28,012          66,347   

 

(1) For more information, please read “—Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below.
(2) Expansion capital expenditures are capital expenditures made to increase the long-term operating capacity of our asset base whether through construction or acquisitions. Please read “How We Make Distributions to Our Partners—Capital Expenditures.”

 

 

21


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

EBITDA

We define EBITDA as net income (loss) before net interest expense, income tax expense and depreciation and depletion expense. EBITDA is not a presentation made in accordance with GAAP.

EBITDA is a non-GAAP supplemental financial measure that management and external users of our financial statements, such as industry analysts, investors, lenders and rating agencies, may use to assess:

 

   

our operating performance as compared to other publicly-traded companies in the proppants industry, without regard to historical cost basis or financing methods; and

 

   

the viability of acquisitions and other capital expenditure projects and the returns on investment of various investment opportunities.

We believe that the presentation of EBITDA will provide useful information to investors in assessing our financial condition and results of operations. The GAAP measure most directly comparable to EBITDA is net income. Our non-GAAP financial measure of EBITDA should not be considered as an alternative to GAAP net income. EBITDA has important limitations as an analytical tool because it excludes some but not all items that affect net income. You should not consider EBITDA in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under GAAP. Because EBITDA may be defined differently by other companies in our industry, our definition of EBITDA may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies, thereby diminishing its utility.

The following table presents a reconciliation of EBITDA to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, on a historical basis and pro forma basis, as applicable, for each of the periods indicated.

 

    Predecessor Historical     Hi-Crush Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
    Inception
to
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months
Ended
June 30, 2012
 
            2011             2012          
    (in thousands)  

Reconciliation of EBITDA to net income (loss):

           

Net income (loss)

  $   (26   $ 9,280      $ (647   $ 17,951      $ 12,189      $ 22,315   

Depreciation and depletion expense

           449               668        449        668   

Income tax expense

                                         

Interest expense, net

           1,893               2,385                 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

EBITDA

  $   (26   $ 11,622      $ (647   $ 21,004      $ 12,638      $ 22,983   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

22


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Production Costs

We define production costs as costs of goods sold, excluding depreciation and depletion. We believe production costs is a meaningful measure because it provides a measure of operating performance that is unaffected by historical cost basis. The GAAP measure most directly comparable to production costs is costs of goods sold. Our non-GAAP financial measure of production costs should not be considered as an alternative to GAAP costs of goods sold. Production costs has important limitations as an analytical tool because it excludes some but not all items that affect costs of goods sold. You should not consider production costs in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under GAAP. Because production costs may be defined differently by other companies in our industry, our definition of production costs may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies, thereby diminishing its utility.

The following table presents a reconciliation of production costs to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, on a historical basis and pro forma basis, as applicable, for each of the periods indicated.

 

    Predecessor Historical     Hi-Crush Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
    Inception
to
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months
Ended
June 30, 2012
 
            2011             2012          
    (in thousands, except operating information)  

Reconciliation of production costs to costs of goods sold:

           

Costs of goods sold

  $   —      $ 6,447      $   —      $ 9,603      $ 6,447      $ 9,603   

Depreciation and depletion expense

           449               668        449        668   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Production costs

  $   —      $ 5,998      $   —      $ 10,271      $ 5,998      $ 10,271   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs of goods sold per ton

    $ 19.38        $ 19.05      $ 19.38      $ 19.05   
   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Production costs per ton

    $ 18.03        $ 17.81      $ 18.03      $ 17.81   
   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

23


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

RISK FACTORS

Limited partner interests are inherently different from the capital stock of a corporation, although many of the business risks to which we are subject are similar to those that would be faced by a corporation engaged in a similar business. You should carefully consider the following risk factors together with all of the other information included in this prospectus in evaluating an investment in our common units.

If any of the following risks were to occur, our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash available for distribution could be materially adversely affected. In that case, we might not be able to make distributions on our common units, the trading price of our common units could decline, and you could lose all or part of your investment.

Risks Inherent in Our Business

We may not have sufficient cash from operations following the establishment of cash reserves and payment of costs and expenses, including cost reimbursements to our general partner and its affiliates, to enable us to pay the minimum quarterly distribution to our unitholders.

We may not have sufficient cash each quarter to pay the full amount of our minimum quarterly distribution of $         per unit, or $         per unit per year, which will require us to have cash available for distribution of approximately $         million per quarter, or $         million per year, based on the number of common and subordinated units that will be outstanding after the completion of this offering. The amount of cash we can distribute on our common and subordinated units principally depends upon the amount of cash we generate from our operations, which will fluctuate from quarter to quarter based on the following factors, some of which are beyond our control:

 

   

the amount of frac sand we are able to excavate and process, which could be adversely affected by, among other things, operating difficulties and unusual or unfavorable geologic conditions;

 

   

the volume of frac sand we are able to sell;

 

   

the price at which we are able to sell frac sand;

 

   

changes in the price and availability of natural gas or electricity;

 

   

changes in prevailing economic conditions;

 

   

unanticipated ground, grade or water conditions;

 

   

inclement or hazardous weather conditions, including flooding, and the physical impacts of climate change;

 

   

environmental hazards;

 

   

industrial accidents;

 

   

changes in laws and regulations (or the interpretation thereof) related to the mining and hydraulic fracturing industries, silica dust exposure or the environment;

 

   

inability to acquire or maintain necessary permits or mining or water rights;

 

   

facility shutdowns in response to environmental regulatory actions;

 

   

inability to obtain necessary production equipment or replacement parts;

 

   

reduction in the amount of water available for processing;

 

   

technical difficulties or failures;

 

   

labor disputes and disputes with our excavation contractor;

 

   

late delivery of supplies;

 

24


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

difficulty collecting receivables;

 

   

inability of our customers to take delivery;

 

   

changes in the price and availability of transportation;

 

   

fires, explosions or other accidents; and

 

   

cave-ins, pit wall failures or rock falls.

In addition, the actual amount of cash we will have available for distribution will depend on other factors, some of which are beyond our control, including:

 

   

the level of capital expenditures we make;

 

   

the cost of acquisitions;

 

   

our debt service requirements and other liabilities;

 

   

fluctuations in our working capital needs;

 

   

our ability to borrow funds and access capital markets;

 

   

restrictions contained in debt agreements to which we are a party; and

 

   

the amount of cash reserves established by our general partner.

For a description of additional restrictions and factors that may affect our ability to pay cash distributions, please read “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

On a pro forma basis we would not have had sufficient cash available for distribution to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all units for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012.

The amount of cash we need to pay the minimum quarterly distribution for four quarters on all of our units to be outstanding immediately after this offering is approximately $         million. The amount of pro forma cash available for distribution generated during the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 would have been insufficient to allow us to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common units during that period. For a calculation of our ability to make distributions to unitholders based on our pro forma results for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, please read “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

The amount of cash we have available for distribution to holders of our units depends primarily on our cash flow and not solely on profitability, which may prevent us from making cash distributions during periods when we record net income.

The amount of cash we have available for distribution depends primarily upon our cash flow, including cash flow from reserves and working capital or other borrowings, and not solely on profitability, which will be affected by non-cash items. As a result, we may pay cash distributions during periods when we record net losses for financial accounting purposes and may not pay cash distributions during periods when we record net income.

None of the proceeds from the sale of common units in this offering will be available to us to fund our operations or to pay distributions to public unitholders.

We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of common units by the selling unitholder in this offering, including proceeds from the sale of additional common units by the selling unitholder pursuant to the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units. Consequently, none of the proceeds from this offering will be available to us to fund our operations or to pay distributions to the public unitholders. Please read “Use of Proceeds.”

 

25


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The assumptions underlying our forecast of cash available for distribution included in “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions” are inherently uncertain and subject to significant business, economic, financial, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause cash available for distribution to differ materially from those estimates.

The forecast of cash available for distribution set forth in “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions” includes our forecast of our results of operations and cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. Our ability to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution in the forecast period is based on a number of assumptions that may not prove to be correct, which are discussed in “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

Our forecast of cash available for distribution has been prepared by management, and we have not received an opinion or report on it from any independent registered public accountants. The assumptions underlying our forecast of cash available for distribution are inherently uncertain and are subject to significant business, economic, financial, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause cash available for distribution to differ materially from that which is forecasted. If we do not achieve our forecasted results, we may not be able to pay the minimum quarterly distribution or any amount on our common units or subordinated units, in which event the market price of our common units may decline materially. Please read “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

Inaccuracies in estimates of volumes and qualities of our sand reserves could result in lower than expected sales and higher than expected production costs.

John T. Boyd, our independent reserve engineers, prepared estimates of our reserves based on engineering, economic and geological data assembled and analyzed by our engineers and geologists. However, frac sand reserve estimates are by nature imprecise and depend to some extent on statistical inferences drawn from available data, which may prove unreliable. There are numerous uncertainties inherent in estimating quantities and qualities of reserves and non-reserve frac sand deposits and costs to mine recoverable reserves, including many factors beyond our control. Estimates of economically recoverable frac sand reserves necessarily depend on a number of factors and assumptions, all of which may vary considerably from actual results, such as:

 

   

geological and mining conditions and/or effects from prior mining that may not be fully identified by available data or that may differ from experience;

 

   

assumptions concerning future prices of frac sand, operating costs, mining technology improvements, development costs and reclamation costs; and

 

   

assumptions concerning future effects of regulation, including the issuance of required permits and taxes by governmental agencies.

Any inaccuracy in John T. Boyd’s estimates related to our frac sand reserves and non-reserve frac sand deposits could result in lower than expected sales and higher than expected costs. For example, John T. Boyd’s estimates of our proven reserves assume that our revenue and cost structure will remain relatively constant over the life of our reserves. If these assumptions prove to be inaccurate, some or all of our reserves may not be economically mineable, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and cash flows. In addition, we pay a fixed price per ton of sand excavated regardless of the quality of the frac sand, and our current customer contracts require us to deliver frac sand that meets certain specifications. If John T. Boyd’s estimates of the quality of our reserves, including the volumes of the various specifications of those reserves, prove to be inaccurate, we may incur significantly higher excavation costs without corresponding increases in revenues, we may not be able to meet our contractual obligations, or our facilities may have a shorter than expected reserve life, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and cash flows.

 

26


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Substantially all of our sales are generated under contracts with four customers, and the loss of, or significant reduction in purchases by, any of them could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

During the year ended December 31, 2011, subsidiaries of Weatherford and Halliburton accounted for 100% of our sales. We commenced sales under our new contracts with subsidiaries of Baker Hughes and FTS International in May 2012, and expect that our four customers will represent all of our sales in 2012. We have fixed price, take-or-pay supply agreements with each of these customers, with remaining terms ranging from 10 to 70 months, as of June 30, 2012. Upon the expiration of these current supply agreements, however, our customers may not continue to purchase the same levels of our frac sand due to a variety of reasons. In addition, we may choose to renegotiate our existing contracts on less favorable terms and at reduced volumes in order to preserve relationships with our customers. Furthermore, some of our customers could exit the pressure pumping business or be acquired by other companies that purchase the same products and services we provide from other third-party providers. Our current customers also may seek to acquire frac sand from other providers that offer more competitive pricing or superior logistics or to capture and develop their own sources of frac sand.

In addition, upon the expiration of our current contract terms, we may be unable to renew our existing contracts or enter into new contracts on terms favorable to us, or at all. The demand for frac sand or prevailing prices at the time our current supply agreements expire may render entry into new long-term supply agreements difficult or impossible. Any reduction in the amount of frac sand purchased by our customers, renegotiation on less favorable terms, or inability to enter into new contracts on economically acceptable terms upon the expiration of our current contracts could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

If we are unable to make acquisitions on economically acceptable terms, our future growth would be limited, and any acquisitions we make may reduce, rather than increase, our cash generated from operations on a per unit basis.

A portion of our strategy to grow our business and increase distributions to unitholders is dependent on our ability to make acquisitions that result in an increase in our cash available for distribution per unit. If we are unable to make acquisitions from third parties, including from our sponsor and its affiliates, because we are unable to identify attractive acquisition candidates or negotiate acceptable purchase contracts, we are unable to obtain financing for these acquisitions on economically acceptable terms or we are outbid by competitors, our future growth and ability to increase distributions will be limited. Furthermore, even if we do consummate acquisitions that we believe will be accretive, they may in fact result in a decrease in our cash available for distribution per unit. Any acquisition involves potential risks, some of which are beyond our control, including, among other things:

 

   

mistaken assumptions about revenues and costs, including synergies;

 

   

inability to integrate successfully the businesses we acquire;

 

   

inability to hire, train or retain qualified personnel to manage and operate our business and newly acquired assets;

 

   

the assumption of unknown liabilities;

 

   

limitations on rights to indemnity from the seller;

 

   

mistaken assumptions about the overall costs of equity or debt;

 

   

the diversion of management’s attention from other business concerns;

 

   

unforeseen difficulties operating in new product areas or new geographic areas; and

 

   

customer or key employee losses at the acquired businesses.

If we consummate any future acquisitions, our capitalization and results of operations may change significantly, and unitholders will not have the opportunity to evaluate the economic, financial and other relevant information that we will consider in determining the application of these funds and other resources.

 

27


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our right of first offer to acquire certain of our sponsor’s existing assets is subject to risks and uncertainty, and ultimately we may not acquire any of those assets.

Our omnibus agreement will provide us with a right of first offer on our sponsor’s sand reserves and any related assets that have been or will be constructed on its acreage in Augusta, Wisconsin and Tomah, Wisconsin for a period of three years after the closing of this offering. The consummation and timing of any future acquisitions of these assets will depend upon, among other things, our sponsor’s willingness to offer these assets for sale, our ability to negotiate acceptable customer contracts and other agreements with respect to the assets and our ability to obtain financing on acceptable terms. We can offer no assurance that we will be able to successfully consummate any future acquisitions pursuant to our right of first offer, and our sponsor is under no obligation to accept any offer that we may choose to make. For these or a variety of other reasons, we may decide not to exercise our right of first offer if and when any assets are offered for sale, and our decision will not be subject to unitholder approval. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement—Right of First Offer with Respect to Augusta and Tomah Assets.”

Our long-term business and financial performance depends on the level of drilling and completion activity in the oil and natural gas industry.

Our primary exposure to market risk occurs at the time existing customer contracts expire and are subject to renegotiation, renewal or replacement. Our ability to renew existing customer contracts or enter into new customer contracts on favorable terms is dependent on the market for frac sand at such times. Demand for frac sand is materially dependent on the levels of activity in natural gas and oil exploration, development and production, and more specifically, the number of natural gas and oil wells completed in geological formations where sand-based proppants are used in hydraulic fracturing treatments and the amount of frac sand customarily used in the completion of such wells.

While the aggregate rig count has exhibited consistent growth, the number of rigs drilling for natural gas has recently declined to its lowest level in 13 years as a result of low natural gas prices, while the number of rigs drilling for oil has more than offset this decline as a result of relatively high prices for oil. To the extent that the recent fluctuations in global crude oil prices develop into a prolonged decline, this drop could result in a reduction in the growth rate of active oil rigs and a decline in the number of active oil rigs from current levels.

Oil and natural gas producers’ expectations for lower market prices for oil and natural gas, as well as the availability of capital for operating and capital expenditures, may cause them to curtail spending, thereby reducing hydraulic fracturing activity and the demand for frac sand. Industry conditions that impact the activity levels of oil and natural gas producers are influenced by numerous factors over which we have no control, including:

 

   

governmental regulations, including the policies of governments regarding the exploration for and production and development of their oil and natural gas reserves;

 

   

global weather conditions and natural disasters;

 

   

worldwide political, military, and economic conditions;

 

   

the cost of producing and delivering oil and natural gas;

 

   

commodity prices; and

 

   

potential acceleration of development of alternative energy sources.

A prolonged reduction in natural gas and oil prices would generally depress the level of natural gas and oil exploration, development, production and well completion activity and result in a corresponding decline in the demand for the frac sand we produce. In addition, any future decreases in the rate at which oil and natural gas reserves are developed, whether due to increased governmental regulation, limitations on exploration and drilling activity or other factors, could have a material adverse effect on our business, even in a stronger natural gas and

 

28


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

oil price environment. If there is a sustained decrease in the demand for frac sand, we may be unable to renew contracts for our products, be forced to renegotiate our existing contracts, or be forced to reduce the prices at which we enter into new contracts, any of which would reduce the amount of cash we generate.

In addition, to the extent we make spot sales of our frac sand, the price we receive for those sales will be impacted by short term fluctuations in the market for frac sand, and any negative fluctuations in this market could have an adverse effect on our results of operations and cash flows.

All of our sales are generated at one facility. Any adverse developments at our Wyeville facility could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

All of our sales are currently derived from our Wyeville facility located in Wyeville, Wisconsin. Any adverse development at this facility due to catastrophic events or weather, or any other event that would cause us to curtail, suspend or terminate operations at our Wyeville facility, could result in us being unable to meet our contracted sand deliveries. If we are unable to deliver contracted volumes within three months of contract year end, or otherwise arrange for delivery from a third party, we will be required to pay make-whole payments to our customers that could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We may be adversely affected by decreased demand for raw frac sand due to the development of either effective alternative proppants or new processes to replace hydraulic fracturing.

Raw frac sand is a proppant used in the completion and re-completion of oil and natural gas wells to stimulate and maintain oil and natural gas production through the process of hydraulic fracturing. Raw frac sand is the most commonly used proppant and is less expensive than other proppants, such as resin-coated sand and manufactured ceramics. A significant shift in demand from frac sand to other proppants, or the development of new processes to replace hydraulic fracturing altogether, could cause a decline in the demand for the frac sand we produce and result in a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

An increase in the supply of raw frac sand having similar characteristics as the raw frac sand we produce could make it more difficult for us to renew or replace our existing contracts on favorable terms or at all.

We believe that the supply of raw frac sand has not kept pace with the increasing demand for raw frac sand, which has been a contributing factor to steadily increasing prices for raw frac sand over the last decade. If significant new reserves of raw frac sand are discovered and developed, and those frac sands have similar characteristics to the raw frac sand we produce, we may be unable to renew or replace our existing contracts on favorable terms or at all. Specifically, if high quality frac sand becomes more readily available, our customers may not be willing to enter into long-term, take-or-pay contracts, may demand lower prices or both, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and cash flows over the long-term.

Federal, state, and local legislative and regulatory initiatives relating to hydraulic fracturing and the potential for related litigation could result in increased costs, additional operating restrictions or delays for our customers, which could cause a decline in the demand for our frac sand and negatively impact our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We supply frac sand to hydraulic fracturing operators in the oil and natural gas industry. Hydraulic fracturing is an important and increasingly common practice that is used to stimulate production of natural gas and/or oil from low permeability hydrocarbon bearing subsurface rock formations. The hydraulic fracturing process involves the injection of water, proppants, and chemicals under pressure into the formation to fracture the surrounding rock, increase permeability and stimulate production. Increased regulation of hydraulic fracturing may adversely impact our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

 

29


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Although we do not directly engage in hydraulic fracturing activities, our customers purchase our frac sand for use in their hydraulic fracturing activities. The federal Safe Drinking Water Act (“SDWA”) regulates the underground injection of substances through the Underground Injection Control Program (“UIC Program”). Currently, with the exception of certain hydraulic fracturing activities involving the use of diesel, hydraulic fracturing is exempt from federal regulation under the UIC Program, and the hydraulic fracturing process is typically regulated by state or local governmental authorities. However, the practice of hydraulic fracturing has become controversial and is undergoing increased political and regulatory scrutiny. Several federal agencies, regulatory authorities, and legislative entities are investigating the potential environmental impacts of hydraulic fracturing and whether additional regulation may be necessary. On April 13, 2012, President Obama issued an executive order creating a task force to coordinate federal oversight over domestic natural gas production and hydraulic fracturing. The U.S. Department of the Interior proposed new regulations on May 4, 2012, which would require oil and natural gas operators to disclose the chemicals they use during hydraulic fracturing on federal lands. It would also strengthen standards for wellbore integrity and the management of fluids that return to the surface during and after fracturing operations on federal lands. These proposed changes are partially in response to recommendations issued by a subcommittee of the Secretary of Energy Advisory Board (the “SEAB”) of the U.S. Department of Energy. The SEAB had been tasked with recommending steps to improve the safety and environmental performance of hydraulic fracturing. The SEAB subcommittee had issued a preliminary report in August 2011 recommending, among other things, measures to improve and protect air and water quality, improvements in communication among state and federal regulators, disclosure of fracturing fluid composition, and the creation of a publicly accessible database organizing all publicly disclosed information with respect to hydraulic fracturing operations. The SEAB subcommittee subsequently issued a report in November 2011 on how federal agencies, states, and others can implement its August 2011 recommendations. In addition, the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency continues to study the potential environmental impacts of hydraulic fracturing activities and has announced plans to propose standards for the treatment and discharge of wastewater resulting from hydraulic fracturing by 2014. These studies and activities, depending on their results, could spur proposals or initiatives to regulate hydraulic fracturing under the SDWA or otherwise. Legislation is currently before Congress to provide for federal regulation of hydraulic fracturing under the SDWA and to require disclosure of the chemicals used in the hydraulic fracturing process. If this or similar legislation becomes law, the legislation could establish an additional level of regulation that may lead to additional permitting requirements or other operating restrictions applicable to our customers, making it more difficult for them to complete unconventional oil and natural gas wells. This could increase our customers’ costs of compliance and doing business or otherwise adversely affect the hydraulic fracturing services they perform, which may negatively impact demand for our frac sand.

In addition, various state, local, and foreign governments have implemented, or are considering, increased regulatory oversight of hydraulic fracturing through additional permitting requirements, operational restrictions, disclosure requirements, and temporary or permanent bans on hydraulic fracturing in certain areas such as environmentally sensitive watersheds. For example, eleven states—Arkansas, Colorado, Louisiana, Michigan, Montana, New Mexico, North Dakota, Ohio, Pennsylvania, Texas, and Wyoming—have imposed disclosure requirements on hydraulic fracturing well owners and operators. In addition, many local governments have adopted ordinances to severely restrict or prohibit hydraulic fracturing activities within their jurisdictions.

The adoption of new laws or regulations at the federal, state, local, or foreign levels imposing reporting obligations on, or otherwise limiting or delaying, the hydraulic fracturing process could make it more difficult to complete natural gas wells, increase our customers’ costs of compliance and doing business, and otherwise adversely affect the hydraulic fracturing services they perform, which could negatively impact demand for our frac sand. In addition, heightened political, regulatory, and public scrutiny of hydraulic fracturing practices could expose us or our customers to increased legal and regulatory proceedings, which could be time-consuming, costly, or result in substantial legal liability or significant reputational harm. We could be directly affected by adverse litigation involving us, or indirectly affected if the cost of compliance limits the ability of our customers to operate. Such costs and scrutiny could directly or indirectly, through reduced demand for our frac sand, have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

30


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our long-term, fixed price contracts may preclude us from taking advantage of increasing prices for frac sand or mitigating the effect of increased operational costs during the term of our long-term, fixed price contracts.

The long-term supply contracts we have may negatively impact our results of operations. All of our long-term contracts are for sales at fixed prices. As a result, in periods with increasing prices our sales will grow at a slower rate than industry spot prices.

Additionally, if our operational costs increase during the terms of our long-term supply contracts, we will not be able to pass any of those increased costs to our customers. If we are unable to otherwise mitigate these increased operational costs, our net income and available cash for distributions could decline.

We are exposed to the credit risk of our customers, and any material nonpayment or nonperformance by our customers could adversely affect our financial results and cash available for distribution.

We are subject to the risk of loss resulting from nonpayment or nonperformance by our customers, whose operations are concentrated in a single industry, the global oilfield services industry. Our credit procedures and policies may not be adequate to fully eliminate customer credit risk. If we fail to adequately assess the creditworthiness of existing or future customers or unanticipated deterioration in their creditworthiness, any resulting increase in nonpayment or nonperformance by them and our inability to re-market or otherwise use the production could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and ability to pay distributions to our unitholders.

Our operations are subject to operational hazards and unforeseen interruptions for which we may not be adequately insured.

Our operations are exposed to potential natural disasters, including blizzards, tornadoes, storms, floods and earthquakes. If any of these events were to occur, we could incur substantial losses because of personal injury or loss of life, severe damage to and destruction of property and equipment, and pollution or other environmental damage resulting in curtailment or suspension of our operations.

We are not fully insured against all risks incident to our business, including the risk of our operations being interrupted due to severe weather and natural disasters. Certain of the insurance policies covering entities that will be contributed to us and their operations also provide coverage to entities that will not be contributed to us as a part of our initial public offering. The coverage available under those insurance policies has historically been allocated among the entities that will be contributed to us and those entities that will not be contributed to us. This allocation may result in limiting the amount of recovery available to us for purposes of covered losses.

Furthermore, we may be unable to maintain or obtain insurance of the type and amount we desire at reasonable rates. As a result of market conditions, premiums and deductibles for certain of our insurance policies have increased and could escalate further. In addition sub-limits have been imposed for certain risks. In some instances, certain insurance could become unavailable or available only for reduced amounts of coverage. If we were to incur a significant liability for which we are not fully insured, it could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and cash available for distribution to unitholders.

Because we have a limited operating history, you may not be able to evaluate our current business and future earnings prospects accurately.

Our sponsor, which is our accounting predecessor for financial reporting purposes, was formed in October 2010 to develop excavation, processing and logistics facilities for raw frac sands used in hydraulic fracturing operations in oil and natural gas wells. We did not commence commercial operations until the third quarter of 2011, when our Wyeville facility became operational. As a result, we have limited operating history upon which you can base an evaluation of our current business and our future earnings prospects.

 

31


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

In addition, this prospectus includes audited financial statements only as of and for the year ended December 31, 2011 and as of and for the period from inception (October 28, 2010) to December 31, 2010. As a result, and given our recent date of formation, you have limited information upon which to make your decision to invest in our common units.

Our future performance will depend on our ability to succeed in competitive markets, and on our ability to appropriately react to potential fluctuations in the demand for and supply of frac sand.

We operate in a highly competitive market that is characterized by a small number of large, national producers and a larger number of small, regional or local producers. Competition in the industry is based on price, consistency and quality of product, site location, distribution and logistics capabilities, customer service, reliability of supply and breadth of product offering.

We compete with large, national producers such as Badger Mining Corporation, Fairmount Minerals, Ltd., Preferred Proppants LLC, Unimin Corporation and U.S. Silica Holdings Inc. Our larger competitors may have greater financial and other resources than we do, may develop technology superior to ours or may have production facilities that are located closer to key customers than ours. Should the demand for hydraulic fracturing services decrease, prices in the frac sand market could materially decrease as smaller, regional producers may exit the market, selling frac sand at below market prices. In addition, oil and natural gas exploration and production companies and other providers of hydraulic fracturing services could acquire their own frac sand reserves, expand their existing frac sand production capacity or otherwise fulfill their own proppant requirements and existing or new frac sand producers could add to or expand their frac sand production capacity, which may negatively impact pricing and demand for our frac sand. We may not be able to compete successfully against either our larger or smaller competitors in the future, and competition could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Fluctuations in transportation costs and the availability or reliability of rail transportation could reduce revenues by causing us to reduce our production or by impairing the ability of our customers to take delivery.

Transportation costs represent a significant portion of the total cost of frac sand for our customers and, as a result, the cost of transportation is a critical factor in a customer’s purchasing decision. Disruption of transportation services due to shortages of rail cars, weather-related problems, flooding, drought, accidents, mechanical difficulties, strikes, lockouts, bottlenecks or other events could temporarily impair the ability of our customers to take delivery and, in certain circumstances, constitute a force majeure event under our customer contracts, permitting our customers to suspend taking delivery of and paying for our frac sand. Accordingly, if there are disruptions of the rail transportation services utilized by our customers, and they are unable to find alternative transportation providers to transport frac sand, our business could be adversely affected.

Our production process consumes large amounts of natural gas and electricity. An increase in the price or a significant interruption in the supply of these or any other energy sources could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations.

Energy costs, primarily natural gas and electricity, represented approximately 2.9% of our total sales and 9.8% of our total production costs in 2011. Natural gas is the primary fuel source used for drying in the frac sand production process and, as such, our profitability is impacted by the price and availability of natural gas we purchase from third parties. Because we have not contracted for the provision of natural gas on a fixed-price basis, our costs and profitability will be impacted by fluctuations in prices for natural gas. The price and supply of natural gas are unpredictable and can fluctuate significantly based on international, political and economic circumstances, as well as other events outside our control, such as changes in supply and demand due to weather conditions, actions by OPEC and other oil and natural gas producers, regional production patterns and environmental concerns. In addition, potential climate change regulations or carbon or emissions taxes could result in higher production costs for energy, which may be passed on to us in whole or in part. The price of

 

32


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

natural gas has been extremely volatile over the last two years, from a high of $4.92 per million British Thermal Units (“BTUs”) in June 2011 to a low of $1.82 per million BTUs in April 2012, and this volatility may continue. In order to manage this risk, we may hedge natural gas prices through the use of derivative financial instruments, such as forwards, swaps and futures. However, these measures carry risk (including nonperformance by counterparties) and do not in any event entirely eliminate the risk of decreased margins as a result of natural gas price increases. A significant increase in the price of energy that is not recovered through an increase in the price of our products or covered through our hedging arrangements or an extended interruption in the supply of natural gas or electricity to our production facilities could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and prospects.

Increases in the price of diesel fuel may adversely affect our results of operations.

Diesel fuel costs generally fluctuate with increasing and decreasing world crude oil prices, and accordingly are subject to political, economic and market factors that are outside of our control. Our operations are dependent on earthmoving equipment, railcars and tractor trailers, and diesel fuel costs are a significant component of the operating expense of these vehicles. We contract with a third party to excavate raw frac sand, deliver the raw frac sand to our processing facility and move the sand from our wet plant to our dry plant, and pay a fixed price per ton of sand delivered to our wet plant, subject to a fuel surcharge based on the price of diesel fuel. Accordingly, increased diesel fuel costs could have an adverse effect on our results of operations and cash flows.

We may be required to make substantial capital expenditures to maintain, develop and increase our asset base. The inability to obtain needed capital or financing on satisfactory terms, or at all, could have an adverse effect on our growth and profitability.

Although we currently use a significant amount of our cash reserves and cash generated from our operations to fund the development of our existing frac sand reserves, we may depend on the availability of credit to fund future capital expenditures. Our ability to obtain bank financing or to access the capital markets for future equity or debt offerings may be limited by our financial condition at the time of any such financing or offering, the covenants contained in the credit facility we expect to enter into in connection with this offering or other future debt agreements, adverse market conditions or other contingencies and uncertainties that are beyond our control. Our failure to obtain the funds necessary to maintain, develop and increase our asset base could adversely impact our growth and profitability.

Even if we are able to obtain financing or access the capital markets, incurring additional debt may significantly increase our interest expense and financial leverage, and our level of indebtedness could restrict our ability to fund future development and acquisition activities. In addition, the issuance of additional equity interests may result in significant dilution to our existing unitholders.

We expect to enter into a new credit facility in connection with this offering that will likely contain restrictions and financial covenants that may restrict our business and financing activities.

The credit facility that we expect to enter into in connection with this offering, and any other future financing agreements that we may enter into will likely contain, operating and financial restrictions and covenants that may restrict our ability to finance future operations or capital needs, to engage in, expand or pursue our business activities or to make distributions to our unitholders. For example, we expect our new revolving credit facility will contain covenants requiring us to maintain a leverage ratio (as such term is defined in our new revolving credit agreement) of not more than 3.00 to 1.00, which may increase to up to 3.50 to 1.00 during specified periods following a permitted acquisition, and a minimum interest coverage ratio (as such term is defined in our new revolving credit agreement) of not less than 2.50 to 1.00. Please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Credit Facilities.”

Our ability to comply with any such restrictions and covenants is uncertain and will be affected by the levels of cash flow from our operations and events or circumstances beyond our control. If market or other economic

 

33


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

conditions deteriorate, our ability to comply with these covenants may be impaired. If we violate any of the restrictions, covenants, ratios or tests in the credit facility that we expect to enter into, a significant portion of our indebtedness may become immediately due and payable and our lenders’ commitment to make further loans to us may terminate. We might not have, or be able to obtain, sufficient funds to make these accelerated payments.

A facility closure entails substantial costs, and if we close our facility sooner than anticipated, our results of operations may be adversely affected.

We base our assumptions regarding the life of our Wyeville excavation facility on detailed studies that we perform from time to time, but our studies and assumptions may not prove to be accurate. If we close our Wyeville facility sooner than expected, sales will decline unless we are able to acquire and develop additional facilities, which may not be possible. The closure of our Wyeville facility would involve significant fixed closure costs, including accelerated employment legacy costs, severance-related obligations, reclamation and other environmental costs and the costs of terminating long-term obligations, including energy contracts and equipment leases. We accrue for the costs of reclaiming open pits, stockpiles, non-saleable sand, ponds, roads and other mining support areas over the estimated mining life of our property. If we were to reduce the estimated life of our Wyeville facility, the fixed facility closure costs would be applied to a shorter period of production, which would increase production costs per ton produced and could materially and adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.

Applicable statutes and regulations require that mining property be reclaimed following a mine closure in accordance with specified standards and an approved reclamation plan. The plan addresses matters such as removal of facilities and equipment, regrading, prevention of erosion and other forms of water pollution, re-vegetation and post-mining land use. We may be required to post a surety bond or other form of financial assurance equal to the cost of reclamation as set forth in the approved reclamation plan. The establishment of the final mine closure reclamation liability is based on permit requirements and requires various estimates and assumptions, principally associated with reclamation costs and production levels. If our accruals for expected reclamation and other costs associated with facility closures for which we will be responsible were later determined to be insufficient, our business, results of operations and financial condition would be adversely affected.

Our operations are dependent on our rights and ability to mine our properties and on our having renewed or received the required permits and approvals from governmental authorities and other third parties.

We hold numerous governmental, environmental, mining, and other permits, water rights, and approvals authorizing operations at our facility. For our extraction and processing in Wisconsin, the permitting process is subject to federal, state and local authority. For example, on the federal level, a Mine Identification Request (MSHA Form 7000-51) must be filed and obtained before mining commences. If wetlands are implicated, a U.S. Army Corps of Engineers Wetland Permit is required. At the state level, a series of permits are required related to air quality, wetlands, water quality (waste water, storm water), grading permits, endangered species, archeological assessments, and high capacity wells in addition to others depending upon site specific factors and operational detail. At the local level, zoning, building, storm water, erosion control, wellhead protection, road usage and access are all regulated and require permitting to some degree. A non-metallic mining reclamation permit is required. A decision by a governmental agency or other third party to deny or delay issuing a new or renewed permit or approval, or to revoke or substantially modify an existing permit or approval, could have a material adverse effect on our ability to continue operations.

Title to, and the area of, mineral properties and water rights may also be disputed. Mineral properties sometimes contain claims or transfer histories that examiners cannot verify. A successful claim that we do not have title to our property or lack appropriate water rights could cause us to lose any rights to explore, develop, and extract minerals, without compensation for our prior expenditures relating to such property. Our business may suffer a material adverse effect in the event we have title deficiencies.

 

34


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

In some instances, we have received access rights or easements from third parties, which allow for a more efficient operation than would exist without the access or easement. A third party could take action to suspend the access or easement, and any such action could be materially adverse to our results of operations or financial condition.

A shortage of skilled labor together with rising labor costs in the excavation industry may further increase operating costs, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

Efficient sand excavation using modern techniques and equipment requires skilled laborers, preferably with several years of experience and proficiency in multiple tasks, including processing of mined minerals. Our mining operations are subcontracted to Gerke Excavating, Inc., but there is a shortage of skilled mining labor in Wisconsin. If the shortage of experienced labor continues or worsens, we may find it difficult to renew or replace that contract upon its expiration on acceptable terms, and we may be unable to hire or train the necessary number of skilled laborers to perform our own operations. In either event, there could be an adverse impact on our labor productivity and costs and our ability to expand production.

Our business may suffer if we lose, or are unable to attract and retain, key personnel.

We depend to a large extent on the services of our senior management team and other key personnel, and we are seeking to hire several key management personnel in the near term. Members of our senior management and other key employees have extensive experience and expertise in evaluating and analyzing sand reserves, maximizing production from such properties, marketing frac sand production and developing and executing financing strategies, as well as substantial experience and relationships with participants in the oilfield services and exploration and production industries. Competition for management and key personnel is intense, and the pool of qualified candidates is limited. The loss of any of these individuals or the failure to attract additional personnel, as needed, could have a material adverse effect on our operations and could lead to higher labor costs or the use of less-qualified personnel. In addition, if any of our executives or other key employees were to join a competitor or form a competing company, we could lose customers, suppliers, know-how and key personnel. We do not maintain key-man life insurance with respect to any of our employees. Our success will be dependent on our ability to continue to attract, employ and retain highly skilled personnel.

Failure to maintain effective quality control systems at our mining, processing and production facilities could have a material adverse effect on our business and operations.

The performance and quality of our products are critical to the success of our business. These factors depend significantly on the effectiveness of our quality control systems, which, in turn, depends on a number of factors, including the design of our quality control systems, our quality-training program and our ability to ensure that our employees adhere to our quality control policies and guidelines. Any significant failure or deterioration of our quality control systems could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and reputation.

Seasonal and severe weather conditions could have a material adverse impact on our business.

Our business could be materially adversely affected by severe weather conditions. Severe weather conditions may affect our customers’ operations, thus reducing their need for our products, impact our operations by resulting in weather-related damage to our facilities and equipment and impact our customers’ ability to take delivery of our products at our plant site. Any weather-related interference with our operations could force us to delay or curtail services and potentially breach our contractual obligations to delivery minimum volumes or result in a loss of productivity and an increase in our operating costs.

In addition, severe winter weather conditions impact our operations by causing us to halt our excavation and wet plant related production activities during the winter months. During non-winter months, we excavate excess

 

35


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

sand to build a stockpile that will feed the dry plant which continues to operate during the winter months. Unexpected winter conditions (e.g., if winter comes earlier than expected or lasts longer than expected) may result in us not having a sufficient sand stockpile to supply feedstock for our dry plant during winter months, which could result in us being unable to meet our contracted sand deliveries during such time and lead to a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operation and reputation.

Our cash flow fluctuates on a seasonal basis.

Our cash flow is affected by a variety of factors, including weather conditions and seasonal periods. Seasonal fluctuations in weather impact the production levels at our wet processing plant. While our sales and finished product production levels are contracted evenly throughout the year, our mining and wet sand processing activities are limited to non-winter months. As a consequence, we experience lower cash costs in the first and fourth quarter of each calendar year.

Diminished access to water may adversely affect our operations.

The excavation and processing activities in which we engage require significant amounts of water. As a result, securing water rights and water access is necessary for the operation of our processing facilities. If future excavation and processing activities are located in an area that is water-constrained, there may be additional costs associated with securing water access. We have obtained water rights that we currently use to service the activities on our property, and we plan to obtain all required water rights to service other properties we may develop or acquire in the future. However, the amount of water that we are entitled to use pursuant to our water rights must be determined by the appropriate regulatory authorities in the jurisdictions in which we operate. Such regulatory authorities may amend the regulations regarding such water rights, increase the cost of maintaining such water rights or eliminate our current water rights, and we may be unable to retain all or a portion of such water rights. These new regulations, which could also affect local municipalities and other industrial operations, could have a material adverse effect on our operating costs if implemented. Such changes in laws, regulations or government policy and related interpretations pertaining to water rights may alter the environment in which we do business, which may have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Additionally, a water discharge permit may be required to properly dispose of water at our processing site. The water discharge permitting process is also subject to regulatory discretion, and any inability to obtain the necessary permits could have an adverse effect on financial condition and results of operations.

A terrorist attack or armed conflict could harm our business.

Terrorist activities, anti-terrorist efforts and other armed conflicts involving the United States could adversely affect the U.S. and global economies and could prevent us from meeting financial and other obligations. We could experience loss of business, delays or defaults in payments from payors or disruptions of fuel supplies and markets if pipelines, production facilities, processing plants or refineries are direct targets or indirect casualties of an act of terror or war. Such activities could reduce the overall demand for oil and natural gas, which, in turn, could also reduce the demand for our frac sand. Terrorist activities and the threat of potential terrorist activities and any resulting economic downturn could adversely affect our results of operations, impair our ability to raise capital or otherwise adversely impact our ability to realize certain business strategies.

Risks Related to Environmental, Mining and Other Regulation

We and our customers are subject to extensive environmental and health and safety regulations that impose, and will continue to impose, significant costs and liabilities. In addition, future regulations, or more stringent enforcement of existing regulations, could increase those costs and liabilities, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

We are subject to a variety of federal, state, and local regulatory environmental requirements affecting the mining and mineral processing industry, including among others, those relating to employee health and safety,

 

36


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

environmental permitting and licensing, air and water emissions, water pollution, waste management, remediation of soil and groundwater contamination, land use, reclamation and restoration of properties, hazardous materials, and natural resources. These laws, regulations, and permits have had, and will continue to have, a significant effect on our business. Some environmental laws impose substantial penalties for noncompliance, and others, such as the federal Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act (“CERCLA”), impose strict, retroactive, and joint and several liability for the remediation of releases of hazardous substances. Liability under CERCLA, or similar state and local laws, may be imposed as a result of conduct that was lawful at the time it occurred or for the conduct of, or conditions caused by, prior operators or other third parties. Failure to properly handle, transport, store, or dispose of hazardous materials or otherwise conduct our operations in compliance with environmental laws could expose us to liability for governmental penalties, cleanup costs, and civil or criminal liability associated with releases of such materials into the environment, damages to property, or natural resources and other damages, as well as potentially impair our ability to conduct our operations. In addition, future environmental laws and regulations could restrict our ability to expand our facilities or extract our mineral deposits or could require us to acquire costly equipment or to incur other significant expenses in connection with our business. Future events, including changes in any environmental requirements (or their interpretation or enforcement) and the costs associated with complying with such requirements, could have a material adverse effect on us.

Any failure by us to comply with applicable environmental laws and regulations may cause governmental authorities to take actions that could adversely impact our operations and financial condition, including:

 

   

issuance of administrative, civil, or criminal penalties;

 

   

denial, modification, or revocation of permits or other authorizations;

 

   

imposition of injunctive obligations or other limitations on our operations, including cessation of operations; and

 

   

requirements to perform site investigatory, remedial, or other corrective actions.

Any such regulations could require us to modify existing permits or obtain new permits, implement additional pollution control technology, curtail operations, increase significantly our operating costs, or impose additional operating restrictions among our customers that reduce demand for our services.

We may not be able to comply with any new laws and regulations that are adopted, and any new laws and regulations could have a material adverse effect on our operating results by requiring us to modify our operations or equipment or shut down our facility. Additionally, our customers may not be able to comply with any new laws and regulations, which could cause our customers to curtail or cease operations. We cannot at this time reasonably estimate our costs of compliance or the timing of any costs associated with any new laws and regulations, or any material adverse effect that any new standards will have on our customers and, consequently, on our operations.

Silica-related legislation, health issues and litigation could have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation or results of operations.

We are subject to laws and regulations relating to human exposure to crystalline silica. Several federal and state regulatory authorities, including the U.S. Mining Safety and Health Administration, may continue to propose changes in their regulations regarding workplace exposure to crystalline silica, such as permissible exposure limits and required controls and personal protective equipment. We may not be able to comply with any new laws and regulations that are adopted, and any new laws and regulations could have a material adverse effect on our operating results by requiring us to modify or cease our operations.

In addition, the inhalation of respirable crystalline silica is associated with the lung disease silicosis. There is recent evidence of an association between crystalline silica exposure or silicosis and lung cancer and a possible

 

37


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

association with other diseases, including immune system disorders such as scleroderma. These health risks have been, and may continue to be, a significant issue confronting the frac sand industry. Concerns over silicosis and other potential adverse health effects, as well as concerns regarding potential liability from the use of frac sand, may have the effect of discouraging our customers’ use of our frac sand. The actual or perceived health risks of mining, processing and handling frac sand could materially and adversely affect frac sand producers, including us, through reduced use of frac sand, the threat of product liability or employee lawsuits, increased scrutiny by federal, state and local regulatory authorities of us and our customers or reduced financing sources available to the frac sand industry.

We are subject to the Federal Mine Safety and Health Act of 1977, which imposes stringent health and safety standards on numerous aspects of our operations.

Our operations are subject to the Federal Mine Safety and Health Act of 1977, as amended by the Mine Improvement and New Emergency Response Act of 2006, which imposes stringent health and safety standards on numerous aspects of mineral extraction and processing operations, including the training of personnel, operating procedures, operating equipment, and other matters. Our failure to comply with such standards, or changes in such standards or the interpretation or enforcement thereof, could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial condition or otherwise impose significant restrictions on our ability to conduct mineral extraction and processing operations.

We and our customers are subject to other extensive regulations, including licensing, plant and wildlife protection and reclamation regulation, that impose, and will continue to impose, significant costs and liabilities. In addition, future regulations, or more stringent enforcement of existing regulations, could increase those costs and liabilities, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

In addition to the regulatory matters described above, we and our customers are subject to extensive governmental regulation on matters such as permitting and licensing requirements, plant and wildlife protection, wetlands protection, reclamation and restoration activities at mining properties after mining is completed, the discharge of materials into the environment, and the effects that mining and hydraulic fracturing have on groundwater quality and availability. Our future success depends, among other things, on the quantity and quality of our frac sand deposits, our ability to extract these deposits profitably, and our customers being able to operate their businesses as they currently do.

In order to obtain permits and renewals of permits in the future, we may be required to prepare and present data to governmental authorities pertaining to the potential adverse impact that any proposed excavation or production activities, individually or in the aggregate, may have on the environment. Certain approval procedures may require preparation of archaeological surveys, endangered species studies, and other studies to assess the environmental impact of new sites or the expansion of existing sites. Compliance with these regulatory requirements is expensive and significantly lengthens the time needed to develop a site. Finally, obtaining or renewing required permits is sometimes delayed or prevented due to community opposition and other factors beyond our control. The denial of a permit essential to our operations or the imposition of conditions with which it is not practicable or feasible to comply could impair or prevent our ability to develop or expand a site. Significant opposition to a permit by neighboring property owners, members of the public, or other third parties, or delay in the environmental review and permitting process also could delay or impair our ability to develop or expand a site. New legal requirements, including those related to the protection of the environment, could be adopted that could materially adversely affect our mining operations (including our ability to extract or the pace of extraction of mineral deposits), our cost structure, or our customers’ ability to use our frac sand. Such current or future regulations could have a material adverse effect on our business and we may not be able to obtain or renew permits in the future.

 

38


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our inability to acquire, maintain or renew financial assurances related to the reclamation and restoration of mining property could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are generally obligated to restore property in accordance with regulatory standards and our approved reclamation plan after it has been mined. We are required under federal, state, and local laws to maintain financial assurances, such as surety bonds, to secure such obligations. The inability to acquire, maintain or renew such assurances, as required by federal, state, and local laws, could subject us to fines and penalties as well as the revocation of our operating permits. Such inability could result from a variety of factors, including:

 

   

the lack of availability, higher expense, or unreasonable terms of such financial assurances;

 

   

the ability of current and future financial assurance counterparties to increase required collateral; and

 

   

the exercise by financial assurance counterparties of any rights to refuse to renew the financial assurance instruments.

Our inability to acquire, maintain, or renew necessary financial assurances related to the reclamation and restoration of mining property could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us

Our sponsor owns and controls our general partner, which has sole responsibility for conducting our business and managing our operations. Our general partner and its affiliates, including our sponsor, have conflicts of interest with us and limited duties, and they may favor their own interests to the detriment of us and our unitholders.

Following the offering, our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, will own and control our general partner and will appoint all of the directors of our general partner. Although our general partner has a duty to manage us in a manner it believes to be in our best interests, the executive officers and directors of our general partner have a fiduciary duty to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to our sponsor. Therefore, conflicts of interest may arise between our sponsor or any of its affiliates, including our general partner, on the one hand, and us or any of our unitholders, on the other hand. In resolving these conflicts of interest, our general partner may favor its own interests and the interests of its affiliates over the interests of our common unitholders. These conflicts include the following situations, among others:

 

   

our general partner is allowed to take into account the interests of parties other than us, such as our sponsor, in exercising certain rights under our partnership agreement, which has the effect of limiting its duty to our unitholders;

 

   

neither our partnership agreement nor any other agreement requires our sponsor to pursue a business strategy that favors us;

 

   

our partnership agreement replaces the fiduciary duties that would otherwise be owed by our general partner with contractual standards governing its duties, limits our general partner’s liabilities and restricts the remedies available to our unitholders for actions that, without such limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty;

 

   

except in limited circumstances, our general partner has the power and authority to conduct our business without unitholder approval;

 

   

our general partner determines the amount and timing of asset purchases and sales, borrowings, issuances of additional partnership securities and the level of reserves, each of which can affect the amount of cash that is distributed to our unitholders;

 

39


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

our general partner determines the amount and timing of any capital expenditure and whether a capital expenditure is classified as a maintenance capital expenditure, which reduces operating surplus, or an expansion capital expenditure, which does not reduce operating surplus. Please read “How We Make Distributions to Our Partners—Capital Expenditures” for a discussion on when a capital expenditure constitutes a maintenance capital expenditure or an expansion capital expenditure. This determination can affect the amount of cash that is distributed to our unitholders which, in turn, may affect the ability of the subordinated units to convert. Please read “How We Make Distributions to Our Partners—Subordination Period”;

 

   

our general partner may cause us to borrow funds in order to permit the payment of cash distributions, even if the purpose or effect of the borrowing is to make a distribution on the subordinated units, to make incentive distributions or to accelerate the expiration of the subordination period;

 

   

our partnership agreement permits us to distribute up to $         million as operating surplus, even if it is generated from asset sales, non-working capital borrowings or other sources that would otherwise constitute capital surplus. This cash may be used to fund distributions on our subordinated units or the incentive distribution rights;

 

   

our general partner determines which costs incurred by it and its affiliates are reimbursable by us;

 

   

our partnership agreement does not restrict our general partner from causing us to pay it or its affiliates for any services rendered to us or entering into additional contractual arrangements with its affiliates on our behalf;

 

   

our general partner intends to limit its liability regarding our contractual and other obligations;

 

   

our general partner may exercise its right to call and purchase common units if it and its affiliates own more than 80% of the common units;

 

   

our general partner controls the enforcement of obligations that it and its affiliates owe to us;

 

   

our general partner decides whether to retain separate counsel, accountants or others to perform services for us; and

 

   

our sponsor may elect to cause us to issue common units to it in connection with a resetting of the target distribution levels related to our sponsor’s incentive distribution rights without the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner or the unitholders. This election may result in lower distributions to the common unitholders in certain situations.

In addition, we may compete directly with entities in which our sponsor has an interest for acquisition opportunities and potentially will compete with these entities for new and existing customers. In particular, our sponsor’s Augusta facility competes with us for new and existing frac sand customers. Please read “—Our sponsor competes with us, and other affiliates of our general partner will have the ability to compete with us.” and “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.”

The board of directors of our general partner may modify or revoke our cash distribution policy at any time at its discretion. Our partnership agreement does not require us to pay any distributions at all.

The board of directors of our general partner will adopt a cash distribution policy pursuant to which we intend to distribute quarterly at least $         per unit on all of our units to the extent we have sufficient cash after the establishment of cash reserves and the payment of our expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. However, the board may change such policy at any time at its discretion and could elect not to pay distributions for one or more quarters. Please read “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

 

40


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

In addition, our partnership agreement does not require us to pay any distributions at all. Accordingly, investors are cautioned not to place undue reliance on the permanence of such a policy in making an investment decision. Any modification or revocation of our cash distribution policy could substantially reduce or eliminate the amounts of distributions to our unitholders. The amount of distributions we make, if any, and the decision to make any distribution at all will be determined by the board of directors of our general partner, whose interests may differ from those of our common unitholders. Our general partner has limited duties to our unitholders, which may permit it to favor its own interests or the interests of our sponsor to the detriment of our common unitholders.

Our general partner intends to limit its liability regarding our obligations.

Our general partner intends to limit its liability under contractual arrangements between us and third parties so that the counterparties to such arrangements have recourse only against our assets, and not against our general partner or its assets. Our general partner may therefore cause us to incur indebtedness or other obligations that are nonrecourse to our general partner. Our partnership agreement provides that any action taken by our general partner to limit its liability is not a breach of our general partner’s duties, even if we could have obtained more favorable terms without the limitation on liability. In addition, we are obligated to reimburse or indemnify our general partner to the extent that it incurs obligations on our behalf. Any such reimbursement or indemnification payments would reduce the amount of cash otherwise available for distribution to our unitholders.

Our sponsor competes with us, and other affiliates of our general partner have the ability to compete with us.

Affiliates of our general partner, including our sponsor, are not prohibited from engaging in other businesses or activities, including those that might be in direct competition with us. Our sponsor has investments in entities that acquire, own and operate frac sand excavation and processing facilities and may make additional investments in the future. These investments and acquisitions may include entities or assets that we would have been interested in acquiring. Therefore, our sponsor may compete with us for investment opportunities. In addition, our sponsor owns an entity that competes with us and we expect that it will acquire interests in additional entities that will compete with us following the offering. For example, our sponsor recently completed construction of the Augusta excavation and processing facility in Eau Claire County, Wisconsin, and expects to commence shipments from the Augusta facility in the third quarter of 2012. Our sponsor has contracted for the sale of 1,200,000 tons per year of coarse grain Northern White sand from the Augusta facility with two of our existing customers and may seek additional contracts from other of our current and potential customers in direct competition with us as we seek to renew or replace our existing contracts. We share our management team with our sponsor, and despite our sponsor’s and management team’s meaningful economic interest in us, the shared management team is under no obligation to offer new and replacement customer contracts to us before offering them to our sponsor, which could have a material adverse impact on our ability to renew or replace existing customer contracts on favorable terms or at all.

Pursuant to the terms of our partnership agreement, the doctrine of corporate opportunity, or any analogous doctrine, does not apply to our general partner or any of its affiliates, including its executive officers and directors and our sponsor. Any such person or entity that becomes aware of a potential transaction, agreement, arrangement or other matter that may be an opportunity for us will not have any duty to communicate or offer such opportunity to us. Any such person or entity will not be liable to us or to any limited partner for breach of any fiduciary duty or other duty by reason of the fact that such person or entity pursues or acquires such opportunity for itself, directs such opportunity to another person or entity or does not communicate such opportunity or information to us. This may create actual or potential conflicts of interest between us and affiliates of our general partner and result in less than favorable treatment of us and our unitholders. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.”

 

41


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

It is our policy to distribute a significant portion of our cash available for distribution to our partners, which could limit our ability to grow and make acquisitions.

We plan to distribute most of our cash available for distribution, which may cause our growth to proceed at a slower pace than that of businesses that reinvest their cash to expand ongoing operations. To the extent we issue additional units in connection with any acquisitions or expansion capital expenditures, the payment of distributions on those additional units may increase the risk that we will be unable to maintain or increase our per unit distribution level. There are no limitations in our partnership agreement on our ability to issue additional units, including units ranking senior to the common units. The incurrence of additional commercial borrowings or other debt to finance our growth strategy would result in increased interest expense, which, in turn, may impact the cash that we have available to distribute to our unitholders.

Our partnership agreement replaces our general partner’s fiduciary duties to holders of our units.

Our partnership agreement contains provisions that eliminate and replace the fiduciary standards to which our general partner would otherwise be held by state fiduciary duty law. For example, our partnership agreement permits our general partner to make a number of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner, or otherwise free of fiduciary duties to us and our unitholders. This entitles our general partner to consider only the interests and factors that it desires and relieves it of any duty or obligation to give any consideration to any interest of, or factors affecting, us, our affiliates or our limited partners. Examples of decisions that our general partner may make in its individual capacity include:

 

   

how to allocate business opportunities among us and its affiliates;

 

   

whether to exercise its call right;

 

   

how to exercise its voting rights with respect to the units it owns;

 

   

whether to exercise its registration rights;

 

   

whether to elect to reset target distribution levels; and

 

   

whether or not to consent to any merger or consolidation of the partnership or amendment to the partnership agreement.

By purchasing a common unit, a unitholder is treated as having consented to the provisions in the partnership agreement, including the provisions discussed above. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties—Fiduciary Duties.”

Our partnership agreement restricts the remedies available to holders of our units for actions taken by our general partner that might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty.

Our partnership agreement contains provisions that restrict the remedies available to unitholders for actions taken by our general partner that might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty under state fiduciary duty law. For example, our partnership agreement provides that:

 

   

whenever our general partner makes a determination or takes, or declines to take, any other action in its capacity as our general partner, our general partner is required to make such determination, or take or decline to take such other action, in good faith, and will not be subject to any other or different standard imposed by our partnership agreement, Delaware law, or any other law, rule or regulation, or at equity;

 

   

our general partner will not have any liability to us or our unitholders for decisions made in its capacity as a general partner so long as it acted in good faith, meaning that it believed that the decision was in the best interest of our partnership;

 

42


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

our general partner and its officers and directors will not be liable for monetary damages to us or our limited partners resulting from any act or omission unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that our general partner or its officers and directors, as the case may be, acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the conduct was criminal; and

 

   

our general partner will not be in breach of its obligations under the partnership agreement or its duties to us or our limited partners if a transaction with an affiliate or the resolution of a conflict of interest is:

 

  (1) approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner, although our general partner is not obligated to seek such approval; or

 

  (2) approved by the vote of a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding any common units owned by our general partner and its affiliates.

In connection with a situation involving a transaction with an affiliate or a conflict of interest, any determination by our general partner must be made in good faith. If an affiliate transaction or the resolution of a conflict of interest is not approved by our common unitholders or the conflicts committee then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, taking any action or failing to act, the board of directors acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.”

Our sponsor may elect to cause us to issue common units to it in connection with a resetting of the target distribution levels related to its incentive distribution rights, without the approval of the conflicts committee of its board of directors or the holders of our common units. This could result in lower distributions to holders of our common units.

Our sponsor has the right, as the initial holder of our incentive distribution rights, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and it has received incentive distributions at the highest level to which it is entitled (50.0%) for the prior four consecutive fiscal quarters, to reset the initial target distribution levels at higher levels based on our distributions at the time of the exercise of the reset election. Following a reset election by our sponsor, the minimum quarterly distribution will be adjusted to equal the reset minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels will be reset to correspondingly higher levels based on percentage increases above the reset minimum quarterly distribution.

If our sponsor elects to reset the target distribution levels, it will be entitled to receive a number of common units. The number of common units to be issued to our sponsor will equal the number of common units that would have entitled the holder to an aggregate quarterly cash distribution in the quarter prior to the reset election equal to the distribution to our sponsor on the incentive distribution rights in the quarter prior to the reset election. We anticipate that our sponsor would exercise this reset right in order to facilitate acquisitions or internal growth projects that would not be sufficiently accretive to cash distributions per common unit without such conversion. It is possible, however, that our sponsor could exercise this reset election at a time when it is experiencing, or expects to experience, declines in the cash distributions it receives related to its incentive distribution rights and may, therefore, desire to be issued common units rather than retain the right to receive incentive distributions based on the initial target distribution levels. This risk could be elevated if our incentive distribution rights have been transferred to a third party. As a result, a reset election may cause our common unitholders to experience a reduction in the amount of cash distributions that our common unitholders would have otherwise received had we not issued new common units to our sponsor in connection with resetting the target distribution levels. Please read “How We Make Distributions to Our Partners—Our Sponsor’s Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels.”

 

43


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Holders of our common units have limited voting rights and are not entitled to elect our general partner or its directors, which could reduce the price at which our common units will trade.

Unlike the holders of common stock in a corporation, unitholders have only limited voting rights on matters affecting our business and, therefore, limited ability to influence management’s decisions regarding our business. Unitholders will have no right on an annual or ongoing basis to elect our general partner or its board of directors. The board of directors of our general partner, including the independent directors, is chosen entirely by our sponsor, as a result of it owning our general partner, and not by our unitholders. Please read “Management—Management of Hi-Crush Partners LP” and “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions.” Unlike publicly-traded corporations, we will not conduct annual meetings of our unitholders to elect directors or conduct other matters routinely conducted at annual meetings of stockholders of corporations. As a result of these limitations, the price at which the common units will trade could be diminished because of the absence or reduction of a takeover premium in the trading price.

Even if holders of our common units are dissatisfied, they cannot initially remove our general partner without its consent.

If our unitholders are dissatisfied with the performance of our general partner, they will have limited ability to remove our general partner. Unitholders initially will be unable to remove our general partner without its consent because our general partner and its affiliates will own sufficient units upon the completion of this offering to be able to prevent its removal. The vote of the holders of at least 66 2/3% of all outstanding common and subordinated units voting together as a single class is required to remove our general partner. Following the closing of this offering, our sponsor will own an aggregate of     % of our common and subordinated units (or     % of our common and subordinated units, if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full). Also, if our general partner is removed without cause during the subordination period and no units held by the holders of the subordinated units or their affiliates are voted in favor of that removal, all remaining subordinated units will automatically be converted into common units and any existing arrearages on the common units will be extinguished. Cause is narrowly defined in our partnership agreement to mean that a court of competent jurisdiction has entered a final, non-appealable judgment finding our general partner liable for actual fraud or willful or wanton misconduct in its capacity as our general partner. Cause does not include most cases of charges of poor management of the business.

Unitholders will experience immediate and substantial dilution of $         per common unit.

The assumed initial public offering price of $         per common unit (the mid-point of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus) exceeds our pro forma net tangible book value of $         per common unit. Based on the assumed initial public offering price of $         per common unit, unitholders will incur immediate and substantial dilution of $         per common unit. This dilution results primarily because the assets contributed to us by affiliates of our general partner are recorded at their historical cost in accordance with GAAP, and not their fair value. Please read “Dilution.”

Our general partner interest or the control of our general partner may be transferred to a third party without unitholder consent.

Our general partner may transfer its general partner interest to a third party in a merger or in a sale of all or substantially all of its assets without the consent of our unitholders. Furthermore, our partnership agreement does not restrict the ability of the members of our general partner to transfer their respective membership interests in our general partner to a third party. The new members of our general partner would then be in a position to replace the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner with their own designees and thereby exert significant control over the decisions taken by the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner. This effectively permits a “change of control” without the vote or consent of the unitholders.

 

44


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The incentive distribution rights held by our sponsor may be transferred to a third party without unitholder consent.

Our sponsor may transfer the incentive distribution rights to a third party at any time without the consent of our unitholders. If our sponsor transfers the incentive distribution rights to a third party but retains its ownership interest in our general partner, our general partner may not have the same incentive to grow our partnership and increase quarterly distributions to unitholders over time as it would if our sponsor had retained ownership of the incentive distribution rights. For example, a transfer of incentive distribution rights by our sponsor could reduce the likelihood of our sponsor accepting offers made by us relating to assets owned by it, as it would have less of an economic incentive to grow our business, which in turn would impact our ability to grow our asset base.

Our general partner has a call right that may require unitholders to sell their common units at an undesirable time or price.

If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the common units, our general partner will have the right, but not the obligation, which it may assign to any of its affiliates or to us, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the common units held by unaffiliated persons at a price equal to the greater of (1) the average of the daily closing price of the common units over the 20 trading days preceding the date three days before notice of exercise of the call right is first mailed and (2) the highest per-unit price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for common units during the 90-day period preceding the date such notice is first mailed. As a result, unitholders may be required to sell their common units at an undesirable time or price and may not receive any return or a negative return on their investment. Unitholders may also incur a tax liability upon a sale of their units. Our general partner is not obligated to obtain a fairness opinion regarding the value of the common units to be repurchased by it upon exercise of the limited call right. There is no restriction in our partnership agreement that prevents our general partner from issuing additional common units and exercising its call right. If our general partner exercised its limited call right, the effect would be to take us private and, if the units were subsequently deregistered, we would no longer be subject to the reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or the Exchange Act. Upon consummation of this offering, and assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units, our sponsor will own an aggregate of     % of our common and subordinated units. At the end of the subordination period, assuming no additional issuances of units (other than upon the conversion of the subordinated units), our sponsor will own     % of our common units. For additional information about the limited call right, please read “The Partnership Agreement—Limited Call Right.”

We may issue additional units without unitholder approval, which would dilute existing unitholder ownership interests.

Our partnership agreement does not limit the number of additional limited partner interests we may issue at any time without the approval of our unitholders. The issuance of additional common units or other equity interests of equal or senior rank will have the following effects:

 

   

our existing unitholders’ proportionate ownership interest in us will decrease;

 

   

the amount of cash available for distribution on each unit may decrease;

 

   

because a lower percentage of total outstanding units will be subordinated units, the risk that a shortfall in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution will be borne by our common unitholders will increase;

 

   

the ratio of taxable income to distributions may increase;

 

   

the relative voting strength of each previously outstanding unit may be diminished; and

 

   

the market price of the common units may decline.

 

45


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

There are no limitations in our partnership agreement on our ability to issue units ranking senior to the common units.

In accordance with Delaware law and the provisions of our partnership agreement, we may issue additional partnership interests that are senior to the common units in right of distribution, liquidation and voting. The issuance by us of units of senior rank may (i) reduce or eliminate the amount of cash available for distribution to our common unitholders; (ii) diminish the relative voting strength of the total common units outstanding as a class; or (iii) subordinate the claims of the common unitholders to our assets in the event of our liquidation.

The market price of our common units could be adversely affected by sales of substantial amounts of our common units in the public or private markets, including sales by our sponsor or other large holders.

After this offering, we will have              common units and              subordinated units outstanding, which includes the              common units the selling unitholder is selling in this offering (or              common units if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full) that may be resold in the public market immediately. All of the subordinated units will convert into common units on a one-for-one basis at the end of the subordination period. All of              common units (or              common units if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full) that are issued to our sponsor and not sold by our sponsor as the selling unitholder in this offering will be subject to resale restrictions under a 180-day lock-up agreement with the underwriters. Each of the lock-up agreements with the underwriters may be waived in the discretion of certain of the underwriters. Sales by our sponsor or other large holders of a substantial number of our common units in the public markets following this offering, or the perception that such sales might occur, could have a material adverse effect on the price of our common units or could impair our ability to obtain capital through an offering of equity securities. In addition, we have agreed to provide registration rights to our sponsor. Under our agreement, our general partner and its affiliates have registration rights relating to the offer and sale of any units that they hold, subject to certain limitations. Please read “Units Eligible for Future Sale.”

Our partnership agreement restricts the voting rights of unitholders owning 20% or more of our common units.

Our partnership agreement restricts unitholders’ voting rights by providing that any units held by a person or group that owns 20% or more of any class of units then outstanding, other than our general partner and its affiliates, their transferees and persons who acquired such units with the prior approval of the board of directors of our general partner, cannot vote on any matter.

Cost reimbursements due to our general partner and its affiliates for services provided to us or on our behalf will reduce cash available for distribution to our unitholders. The amount and timing of such reimbursements will be determined by our general partner.

Prior to making any distribution on the common units, we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for all expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. These expenses include salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf and expenses allocated to our general partner by its affiliates. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. The reimbursement of expenses and payment of fees, if any, to our general partner and its affiliates will reduce the amount of cash available for distribution to our unitholders. Please read “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

 

46


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

There is no existing market for our common units, and a trading market that will provide you with adequate liquidity may not develop. The price of our common units may fluctuate significantly, and unitholders could lose all or part of their investment.

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the common units. After this offering, there will be only              publicly-traded common units held by our public unitholders (or              common units if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full). We do not know the extent to which investor interest will lead to the development of a trading market or how liquid that market might be. Unitholders may not be able to resell their common units at or above the initial public offering price. Additionally, the lack of liquidity may result in wide bid-ask spreads, contribute to significant fluctuations in the market price of the common units and limit the number of investors who are able to buy the common units.

The initial public offering price for our common units will be determined by negotiations between the selling unitholder and the representatives of the underwriters and may not be indicative of the market price of the common units that will prevail in the trading market. The market price of our common units may decline below the initial public offering price. The market price of our common units may also be influenced by many factors, some of which are beyond our control, including:

 

   

our quarterly distributions;

 

   

our quarterly or annual earnings or those of other companies in our industry;

 

   

announcements by us or our competitors of significant contracts or acquisitions;

 

   

changes in accounting standards, policies, guidance, interpretations or principles;

 

   

general economic conditions;

 

   

the failure of securities analysts to cover our common units after this offering or changes in financial estimates by analysts;

 

   

future sales of our common units; and

 

   

the other factors described in these “Risk Factors.”

Your liability may not be limited if a court finds that unitholder action constitutes control of our business.

A general partner of a partnership generally has unlimited liability for the obligations of the partnership, except for those contractual obligations of the partnership that are expressly made without recourse to the general partner. Our partnership is organized under Delaware law, and we conduct business in a number of other states. The limitations on the liability of holders of limited partner interests for the obligations of a limited partnership have not been clearly established in some jurisdictions. You could be liable for our obligations as if you were a general partner if a court or government agency were to determine that:

 

   

we were conducting business in a state but had not complied with that particular state’s partnership statute; or

 

   

your right to act with other unitholders to remove or replace the general partner, to approve some amendments to our partnership agreement or to take other actions under our partnership agreement constitute “control” of our business.

Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Limited Liability” for a discussion of the implications of the limitations of liability on a unitholder.

Unitholders may have liability to repay distributions and in certain circumstances may be personally liable for the obligations of the partnership.

Under certain circumstances, unitholders may have to repay amounts wrongfully returned or distributed to them. Under Section 17-607 of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act, or the Delaware Act, we

 

47


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

may not make a distribution to our unitholders if the distribution would cause our liabilities to exceed the fair value of our assets. Delaware law provides that for a period of three years from the date of the impermissible distribution, limited partners who received the distribution and who knew at the time of the distribution that it violated Delaware law will be liable to the limited partnership for the distribution amount. Liabilities to partners on account of their partnership interests and liabilities that are non-recourse to the partnership are not counted for purposes of determining whether a distribution is permitted.

For as long as we are an emerging growth company, we will not be required to comply with certain reporting requirements, including those relating to accounting standards and disclosure about our executive compensation, that apply to other public companies.

In April 2012, President Obama signed into law the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act, or the JOBS Act. The JOBS Act contains provisions that, among other things, relax certain reporting requirements for “emerging growth companies,” including certain requirements relating to accounting standards and compensation disclosure. We are classified as an emerging growth company. For as long as we are an emerging growth company, which may be up to five full fiscal years, unlike other public companies, we will not be required to, among other things, (1) provide an auditor’s attestation report on management’s assessment of the effectiveness of our system of internal control over financial reporting pursuant to Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, (2) comply with any new requirements adopted by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, or the PCAOB, requiring mandatory audit firm rotation or a supplement to the auditor’s report in which the auditor would be required to provide additional information about the audit and the financial statements of the issuer, (3) comply with any new audit rules adopted by the PCAOB after April 5, 2012 unless the SEC determines otherwise, (4) provide certain disclosure regarding executive compensation required of larger public companies or (5) hold unitholder advisory votes on executive compensation.

Our sponsor, which is our accounting predecessor for financial reporting purposes, has a material weakness in its internal control over financial reporting. If we fail to establish and maintain effective internal control over financial reporting, our ability to accurately report our financial results could be adversely affected.

Prior to the completion of this offering, our sponsor has been a private entity with limited accounting personnel and other supervisory resources to adequately execute its accounting processes and address its internal control over financial reporting. In connection with our sponsor’s audit for the year ended December 31, 2011, our sponsor’s independent registered public accounting firm identified and communicated a material weakness related to the failure to maintain a sufficient complement of qualified accounting personnel, which contributed to our sponsor’s inability to maintain appropriate segregation of duties within the organization and effective review and supervision over the financial reporting process. A “material weakness” is a deficiency, or combination of deficiencies, in internal controls such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of our sponsor’s financial statements will not be prevented, or detected on a timely basis. This material weakness resulted in audit adjustments to our sponsor’s financial statements, which were identified by our independent registered public accounting firm.

After the closing of this offering, our management team and financial reporting oversight personnel will be those of our sponsor and thus, we may face the same material weakness described above.

We are in the early phases of evaluating the design and operation of our internal control over financial reporting and will not complete our review until after this offering is completed. We cannot predict the outcome of our review at this time. During the course of the review, we may identify additional control deficiencies, which could give rise to significant deficiencies and other material weaknesses, in addition to the material weakness described above. The material weakness described above could result in a misstatement of our accounts or disclosures that would result in a material misstatement of our annual or interim financial statements that would not be prevented or detected. We cannot assure you that the measures we have taken to date, or any measures we may take in the future, will be sufficient to remediate the material weakness described above or avoid potential future material weaknesses.

 

48


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

We are not currently required to comply with the SEC’s rules implementing Section 404 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, and are therefore not required to make a formal assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting for that purpose. Upon becoming a publicly traded partnership, we will be required to comply with the SEC’s rules implementing Sections 302 and 404 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, which will require our management to certify financial and other information in our quarterly and annual reports and provide an annual management report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. Though we will be required to disclose material changes made to our internal controls and procedures on a quarterly basis, we will not be required to make our first annual assessment of our internal control over financial reporting pursuant to Section 404 until the year following our first annual report required to be filed with the SEC. To comply with the requirements of being a publicly traded partnership, we will need to implement additional internal controls, reporting systems and procedures and hire additional accounting, finance and legal staff. Furthermore, while we generally must comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002 for our fiscal year ending December 31, 2012, we are not required to have our independent registered public accounting firm attest to the effectiveness of our internal controls until our first annual report subsequent to our ceasing to be an “emerging growth company” within the meaning of Section 2(a)(19) of the Securities Act. Accordingly, we may not be required to have our independent registered public accounting firm attest to the effectiveness of our internal controls until our annual report for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2017. Once it is required to do so, our independent registered public accounting firm may issue a report that is adverse in the event it is not satisfied with the level at which our controls are documented, designed, operated or reviewed.

If we fail to develop or maintain an effective system of internal controls, we may not be able to accurately report our financial results or prevent fraud. As a result, current and potential unitholders could lose confidence in our financial reporting, which would harm our business and the trading price of our units.

Effective internal controls are necessary for us to provide reliable financial reports, prevent fraud and operate successfully as a public company. If we cannot provide reliable financial reports or prevent fraud, our reputation and operating results would be harmed. We cannot be certain that our efforts to develop and maintain our internal controls will be successful, that we will be able to maintain adequate controls over our financial processes and reporting in the future or that we will be able to comply with our obligations under Section 404 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002. Any failure to develop or maintain effective internal controls, or difficulties encountered in implementing or improving our internal controls, could harm our operating results or cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations. Ineffective internal controls could also cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information, which would likely have a negative effect on the trading price of our units.

The New York Stock Exchange does not require a publicly-traded partnership like us to comply with certain of its corporate governance requirements.

Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “HCLP,” subject to official notice of issuance. Because we will be a publicly-traded partnership, the NYSE does not require us to have a majority of independent directors on our general partner’s board of directors or to establish a compensation committee or a nominating and corporate governance committee. Accordingly, unitholders will not have the same protections afforded to certain corporations that are subject to all of the NYSE corporate governance requirements. Please read “Management—Management of Hi-Crush Partners LP.”

We will incur increased costs as a result of being a publicly-traded partnership.

We have no history operating as a publicly-traded partnership. As a publicly-traded partnership, we will incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not incur prior to this offering. In addition, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as well as rules implemented by the SEC and the NYSE, require publicly-traded entities to adopt various corporate governance practices that will further increase our costs. Before we are able to make distributions to our unitholders, we must first pay or reserve cash for our expenses, including the costs of being a publicly-traded partnership. As a result, the amount of cash we have available for distribution to our unitholders will be affected by the costs associated with being a public company.

 

49


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Prior to this offering, we have not filed reports with the SEC. Following this offering, we will become subject to the public reporting requirements of the Exchange Act. We expect these rules and regulations to increase certain of our legal and financial compliance costs and to make activities more time-consuming and costly. For example, as a result of becoming a publicly-traded company, we are required to have at least three independent directors, create an audit committee and adopt policies regarding internal controls and disclosure controls and procedures, including the preparation of reports on internal controls over financial reporting. In addition, we will incur additional costs associated with our SEC reporting requirements.

We also expect to incur significant expense in order to obtain director and officer liability insurance. Because of the limitations in coverage for directors, it may be more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified persons to serve on our board or as executive officers.

We estimate that we will incur approximately $2.1 million of incremental costs per year associated with being a publicly-traded partnership; however, it is possible that our actual incremental costs of being a publicly-traded partnership will be higher than we currently estimate.

Tax Risks to Common Unitholders

In addition to reading the following risk factors, please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences” for a more complete discussion of the expected material federal income tax consequences of owning and disposing of common units.

Our tax treatment depends on our status as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, as well as our not being subject to a material amount of entity-level taxation by individual states. If the IRS were to treat us as a corporation for federal income tax purposes or we were to become subject to material additional amounts of entity-level taxation for state tax purposes, then our cash available for distribution to you could be substantially reduced.

The anticipated after-tax economic benefit of an investment in our common units depends largely on our being treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes.

Despite the fact that we are organized as a limited partnership under Delaware law, it is possible in certain circumstances for a partnership such as ours to be treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes. Although we do not believe, based upon our current operations, that we will be so treated, a change in our business (or a change in current law) could cause us to be treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes or otherwise subject us to taxation as an entity.

If we were treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes, we would pay federal income tax on our taxable income at the corporate tax rate, which is currently a maximum of 35%, and would likely pay state income tax at varying rates. Distributions to you would generally be taxed again as corporate distributions, and no income, gains, losses, deductions or credits would flow through to you. Because a tax would be imposed upon us as a corporation, our cash available for distribution to you would be substantially reduced. Therefore, treatment of us as a corporation would result in a material reduction in the anticipated cash flow and after-tax return to the unitholders, likely causing a substantial reduction in the value of our common units.

Our partnership agreement provides that if a law is enacted or existing law is modified or interpreted in a manner that subjects us to taxation as a corporation or otherwise subjects us to entity-level taxation for federal, state or local income tax purposes, the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution amounts may be adjusted to reflect the impact of that law on us.

 

50


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The tax treatment of publicly-traded partnerships or an investment in our units could be subject to potential legislative, judicial or administrative changes and differing interpretations, possibly on a retroactive basis.

The present federal income tax treatment of publicly-traded partnerships, including us, or an investment in our common units may be modified by administrative, legislative or judicial changes or differing interpretations at any time. For example, members of Congress have recently considered substantive changes to the existing federal income tax laws that affect publicly-traded partnerships. Any modification to the federal income tax laws may be applied retroactively and could make it more difficult or impossible to meet the exception for certain publicly-traded partnerships to be treated as partnerships for federal income tax purposes. Although the considered legislation would not appear to have affected our treatment as a partnership, we are unable to predict whether any of these changes, or other proposals will be reintroduced or will ultimately be enacted. Any such changes could negatively impact the value of an investment in our common units.

You will be required to pay taxes on your share of our income even if you do not receive any cash distributions from us.

Because our unitholders will be treated as partners to whom we will allocate taxable income that could be different in amount than the cash we distribute, you will be required to pay federal income taxes and, in some cases, state and local income taxes on your share of our taxable income whether or not you receive cash distributions from us. You may not receive cash distributions from us equal to your share of our taxable income or even equal to the actual tax liability that results from that income.

The sale or exchange of 50% or more of our capital and profits interests during any twelve-month period will result in the termination of our partnership for federal income tax purposes.

We will be considered to have terminated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes if there is a sale or exchange of 50% or more of the total interests in our capital and profits within a twelve-month period. Immediately following this offering, our sponsor will directly and indirectly own more than 50% of the total interests in our capital and profits. Therefore, a transfer by our sponsor of all or a portion of its interests in us could result in a termination of us as a partnership for federal income tax purposes. Our termination would, among other things, result in the closing of our taxable year for all unitholders and could result in a deferral of depreciation deductions allowable in computing our taxable income. In the case of a unitholder reporting on a taxable year other than the calendar year, the closing of our taxable year may also result in more than twelve months of our taxable income or loss being includable in his taxable income for the year of termination. Our termination currently would not affect our classification as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, but instead, after our termination we would be treated as a new partnership for federal income tax purposes. If treated as a new partnership, we must make new tax elections and could be subject to penalties if we are unable to determine that a termination occurred. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Disposition of Units—Constructive Termination” for a discussion of the consequences of our termination for federal income tax purposes.

Tax gain or loss on the disposition of our common units could be more or less than expected.

If you sell your common units, you will recognize a gain or loss equal to the difference between the amount realized and your tax basis in those common units. Because distributions in excess of your allocable share of our net taxable income result in a decrease in your tax basis in your common units, the amount, if any, of such prior excess distributions with respect to the units you sell will, in effect, become taxable income to you if you sell such units at a price greater than your tax basis in those units, even if the price you receive is less than your original cost. Furthermore, a substantial portion of the amount realized, whether or not representing gain, may be taxed as ordinary income due to potential recapture of depreciation and depletion deductions and certain other items. In addition, because the amount realized includes a unitholder’s share of our nonrecourse liabilities, if you sell your units, you may incur a tax liability in excess of the amount of cash you receive from the sale. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss” for a further discussion of the foregoing.

 

51


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Tax-exempt entities and non-U.S. persons face unique tax issues from owning common units that may result in adverse tax consequences to them.

Investments in common units by tax-exempt entities, such as employee benefit plans and individual retirement accounts (or “IRAs”), and non-U.S. persons raises issues unique to them. For example, virtually all of our income allocated to organizations that are exempt from federal income tax, including IRAs and other retirement plans, will be unrelated business taxable income and will be taxable to them. Distributions to non-U.S. persons will be reduced by withholding taxes, and non-U.S. persons will be required to file federal tax returns and pay tax on their shares of our taxable income. If you are a tax-exempt entity or a non-U.S. person, you should consult your tax advisor before investing in our common units.

If the IRS contests the federal income tax positions we take, the market for our common units may be adversely impacted and the cost of any IRS contest will reduce our cash available for distribution to you.

The IRS may adopt positions that differ from the positions we take. It may be necessary to resort to administrative or court proceedings to sustain some or all of the positions we take. A court may not agree with some or all of the positions we take. Any contest by the IRS may materially and adversely impact the market for our common units and the price at which they trade. Our costs of any contest by the IRS will be borne indirectly by our unitholders and our general partner because the costs will reduce our cash available for distribution.

We will treat each purchaser of our common units as having the same tax benefits without regard to the actual common units purchased. The IRS may challenge this treatment, which could adversely affect the value of the common units.

Because we cannot match transferors and transferees of common units, we will adopt depreciation and amortization positions that may not conform to all aspects of existing Treasury Regulations. A successful IRS challenge to those positions could adversely affect the amount of tax benefits available to you. It also could affect the timing of these tax benefits or the amount of gain from your sale of common units and could have a negative impact on the value of our common units or result in audit adjustments to your tax returns. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election” for a further discussion of the effect of the depreciation and amortization positions we adopt.

We will prorate our items of income, gain, loss and deduction between transferors and transferees of our units each month based upon the ownership of our units on the first day of each month, instead of on the basis of the date a particular unit is transferred. The IRS may challenge this treatment, which could change the allocation of items of income, gain, loss and deduction among our unitholders.

We generally prorate our items of income, gain, loss and deduction between transferors and transferees of our common units each month based upon the ownership of our common units on the first day of each month, instead of on the basis of the date a particular common unit is transferred. Nonetheless, we allocate certain deductions for depreciation of capital additions based upon the date the underlying property is placed in service. The use of this proration method may not be permitted under existing Treasury Regulations, and although the U.S. Treasury Department issued proposed Treasury Regulations allowing a similar monthly simplifying convention, such regulations are not final and do not specifically authorize the use of the proration method we have adopted. Accordingly, our counsel is unable to opine as to the validity of this method. If the IRS were to successfully challenge our proration method, we may be required to change the allocation of items of income, gain, loss, and deduction among our unitholders.

 

52


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

A unitholder whose common units are the subject of a securities loan (e.g., a loan to a “short seller” to cover a short sale of common units) may be considered as having disposed of those common units. If so, he would no longer be treated for tax purposes as a partner with respect to those common units during the period of the loan and may recognize gain or loss from the disposition.

Because there is no tax concept of loaning a partnership interest, a unitholder whose common units are the subject of a securities loan may be considered as having disposed of the loaned units. In that case, he may no longer be treated for tax purposes as a partner with respect to those common units during the period of the loan to the short seller and the unitholder may recognize gain or loss from such disposition. Moreover, during the period of the loan, any of our income, gain, loss or deduction with respect to those common units may not be reportable by the unitholder and any cash distributions received by the unitholder as to those common units could be fully taxable as ordinary income. Unitholders desiring to assure their status as partners and avoid the risk of gain recognition from a loan to a short seller should modify any applicable brokerage account agreements to prohibit their brokers from borrowing their common units.

You will likely be subject to state and local taxes and return filing requirements in states where you do not live as a result of investing in our common units.

In addition to federal income taxes, you will likely be subject to other taxes, including state and local taxes, unincorporated business taxes and estate, inheritance or intangible taxes that are imposed by the various jurisdictions in which we conduct business or own property now or in the future, even if you do not live in any of those jurisdictions. We will initially own assets and conduct business in the states of Wisconsin and Texas. Wisconsin currently imposes a personal income tax and also imposes income taxes on corporations and other entities. You may be required to file state and local income tax returns and pay state and local income taxes in Wisconsin. Further, you may be subject to penalties for failure to comply with those requirements. As we make acquisitions or expand our business, we may own assets or conduct business in additional states or foreign jurisdictions that impose a personal income tax. It is your responsibility to file all U.S. federal, foreign, state and local tax returns. Our counsel has not rendered an opinion on the foreign, state or local tax consequences of an investment in our common units.

 

53


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

USE OF PROCEEDS

The common units being offered by this prospectus, including the common units offered if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units, are solely for the account of the selling unitholder. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of our common units by the selling unitholder. The selling unitholder will pay all underwriting discounts, structuring fees and other offering expenses incurred in connection with this offering and any exercise by the underwriters of their option to purchase additional common units.

The selling unitholder has granted the underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up to                          additional common units. The exercise of the underwriters’ option will not affect the total number of units outstanding.

 

54


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

CAPITALIZATION

The following table shows our capitalization as of June 30, 2012:

 

   

on an actual basis for our accounting predecessor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC;

 

   

on a pro forma basis to give effect to the elimination of certain assets not contributed to us and the other transactions described under “Summary—Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure.”

This table is derived from, and should be read together with, the unaudited pro forma financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. You should also read this table in conjunction with “Summary—Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure,” “Use of Proceeds” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

 

     As of June 30, 2012  
     Actual      Pro Forma  
     (in thousands)  

Cash and cash equivalents (1)

   $ 11,750       $   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Long-term debt:

     

Predecessor debt (2)

   $ 96,421       $   

New revolving credit facility (3)

               
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total long-term debt

     96,421           

Members’ equity/Partners’ capital

     28,012         66,347   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total capitalization

     124,433       $ 66,347   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) On July 6, 2012, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC received a cash prepayment of $8.3 million for volumes of sand to be delivered during the six months ending December 31, 2012. We expect that approximately $6.2 million of cash from such prepayment will remain on hand and be contributed to us by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC in connection with the closing of this offering.
(2) Hi-Crush Proppants LLC is party to various subordinated promissory notes and a senior secured revolving credit facility. As of June 30, 2012, there was approximately $57.7 million outstanding under the subordinated promissory notes and $38.7 million outstanding under the senior secured credit facility. We expect Hi-Crush Proppants LLC to continue as borrower under the senior secured credit facility and the subordinated promissory notes, and that we will have no ongoing obligations with respect to any borrowings thereunder upon completion of this offering.
(3) In connection with the closing of this offering, we intend to enter into a new credit facility in the aggregate principal amount of up to $100.0 million. We do not expect to have any borrowings outstanding under this facility at the completion of this offering.

 

55


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

DILUTION

Dilution is the amount by which the offering price paid by the purchasers of common units sold in this offering will exceed the net tangible book value per common unit after the offering. On a pro forma basis as of June 30, 2012, our net tangible book value would have been approximately $         million, or $         per common unit. This remains unchanged when adjusted for the sale by the selling unitholder of common units in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $         per common unit (the mid-point of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus). Purchasers of our common units in this offering will experience substantial and immediate dilution in net tangible book value per common unit for financial accounting purposes, as illustrated in the following table.

 

Assumed initial public offering price per common unit

   $                

Pro forma net tangible book value per common unit before and after the offering (1)

  

Immediate dilution in net tangible book value per common unit to purchasers in the offering (2)

   $     
  

 

 

 

 

(1) Determined by dividing the pro forma net tangible book value of the contributed assets and liabilities by the number of units (             common units and              subordinated units) to be issued to our general partner and its affiliates for their contribution of assets and liabilities to us.
(2) Because the total number of units outstanding following this offering will not be impacted by any exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units from the selling unitholder and we will not receive any net proceeds from such exercise, there will be no change to the dilution in net tangible book value per common unit to purchasers in the offering due to any such exercise of the option.

 

56


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

CASH DISTRIBUTION POLICY AND RESTRICTIONS ON DISTRIBUTIONS

You should read the following discussion of our cash distribution policy in conjunction with “—Assumptions and Considerations” below, which includes the factors and assumptions upon which we base our cash distribution policy. In addition, you should read “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” for information regarding statements that do not relate strictly to historical or current facts and certain risks inherent in our business.

For additional information regarding our historical and pro forma results of operations, you should refer to the audited historical financial statements as of December 31, 2010 and 2011, for the two-month period ended December 31, 2010 and for the year ended December 31, 2011, the unaudited historical financial statements as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and 2012 and our unaudited pro forma financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2011 and as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2012, included elsewhere in this prospectus.

General

Rationale for Our Cash Distribution Policy

It is our intent to distribute at least the minimum quarterly distribution of $         per unit ($         per unit on an annualized basis) on all of our units to the extent we have sufficient cash after the establishment of cash reserves and payment of our expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. Furthermore, we expect that if we are successful in executing our business strategy, we will grow our business in a steady and sustainable manner and distribute to our unitholders a portion of any increase in our cash available for distribution resulting from such growth. Our cash distribution policy reflects a judgment that our unitholders will be better served by our distributing rather than retaining our cash available for distribution.

Limitations on Cash Distributions and Our Ability to Change Our Cash Distribution Policy

There is no guarantee that we will distribute quarterly cash distributions to our unitholders. We do not have a legal or contractual obligation to pay quarterly distributions at our minimum quarterly distribution rate or at any other rate. Our cash distribution policy is subject to certain restrictions and may be changed at any time. The reasons for such uncertainties in our stated cash distribution policy include the following factors:

 

   

Our cash distribution policy will be subject to restrictions on distributions under the revolving credit facility that we expect to enter into in connection with this offering (“our new credit facility”), which will contain financial tests and covenants that we must satisfy. These financial tests and covenants are described in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Credit Facilities—Our New Credit Facility.” Should we be unable to satisfy these restrictions or if we are otherwise in default under our new credit facility, we will be prohibited from making cash distributions to you notwithstanding our stated cash distribution policy.

 

   

Our general partner will have the authority to establish cash reserves for the prudent conduct of our business, including for future cash distributions to our unitholders, and the establishment of or increase in those reserves could result in a reduction in cash distributions from levels we currently anticipate pursuant to our stated cash distribution policy. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of cash reserves that our general partner may establish. Any decision to establish cash reserves made by our general partner in good faith will be binding on our unitholders.

 

57


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

Prior to making any distribution on the common units, we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for all direct and indirect expenses they incur on our behalf. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. These expenses include salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf and expenses allocated to our general partner by its affiliates. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. The reimbursement of expenses and payment of fees, if any, to our general partner and its affiliates will reduce the amount of cash available for distribution to pay distributions to our unitholders.

 

   

Even if our cash distribution policy is not modified or revoked, the amount of distributions we pay under our cash distribution policy and the decision to make any distribution is determined by our general partner.

 

   

Under Section 17-607 of the Delaware Act, we may not make a distribution if the distribution would cause our liabilities to exceed the fair value of our assets.

 

   

We may lack sufficient cash to pay distributions to our unitholders due to cash flow shortfalls attributable to a number of operational, commercial or other factors as well as increases in our operating or general and administrative expenses, principal and interest payments on our outstanding debt, tax expenses, working capital requirements and anticipated cash needs. While our general partner may cause us to borrow funds in order to permit the payment of cash distributions on our common units, subordinated units and incentive distribution rights, it has no obligation to cause us to do so.

 

   

If we make distributions out of capital surplus, as opposed to operating surplus, any such distributions would constitute a return of capital and would result in a reduction in the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Adjustment to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels.” We do not anticipate that we will make any distributions from capital surplus.

 

   

Our ability to make distributions to our unitholders depends on the performance of our subsidiaries and their ability to distribute cash to us. The ability of our subsidiaries to make distributions to us may be restricted by, among other things, the provisions of future indebtedness, applicable state limited liability company laws and other laws and regulations.

Our Ability to Grow may be Dependent on Our Ability to Access External Expansion Capital

We expect to generally distribute a significant percentage of our cash from operations to our unitholders on a quarterly basis, after the establishment of cash reserves and payment of our expenses. Therefore, our growth may not be as fast as businesses that reinvest most or all of their cash to expand ongoing operations. Moreover, our future growth may be slower than our historical growth. We expect that we will rely primarily upon external financing sources, including bank borrowings and issuances of debt and equity interests, to fund our expansion capital expenditures. To the extent we are unable to finance growth externally, our cash distribution policy will significantly impair our ability to grow.

 

58


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our Minimum Quarterly Distribution

Pursuant to our distribution policy, we intend upon completion of this offering to declare a minimum quarterly distribution of $         per unit for each complete quarter, or $         per unit on an annualized basis. Quarterly distributions, if any, will be made within 60 days after the end of each quarter. The payment of the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of the common units and subordinated units to be outstanding after completion of this offering would require us to have cash available for distribution of approximately $         million per quarter, or $         million per year. Our ability to make cash distributions at the minimum quarterly distribution rate will be subject to the factors described above under “—General—Limitations on Cash Distributions and Our Ability to Change Our Cash Distribution Policy.” The table below sets forth the amount of common units and subordinated units that will be outstanding immediately after this offering, assuming the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase additional common units from the selling unitholder, and the cash available for distribution needed to pay the aggregate minimum quarterly distribution on all of such units for a single fiscal quarter and a four quarter period:

 

          Distributions  
     Number of
Units
   One
Quarter
     Annualized  

Publicly held common units

      $                    $                

Common units held by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

        

Subordinated units held by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

        
  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

      $         $     
  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

If and to the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units, the selling unitholder, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, will sell the number of common units purchased by the underwriters pursuant to such exercise and the remainder, if any, will be retained by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. Accordingly, the exercise of the underwriters’ option will not affect the total number of units outstanding or the amount of cash needed to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on all units. Please read “Underwriting.”

Our sponsor will initially hold the incentive distribution rights, which entitle the holder to increasing percentages, up to a maximum of 50.0%, of the cash we distribute in excess of $         per unit per quarter.

We expect to pay our distributions on or about the last day of each of February, May, August and November to holders of record on or about the 15th day of each such month. If the distribution date does not fall on a business day, we will make the distribution on the business day immediately preceding the indicated distribution date. We will adjust the quarterly distribution for the period after the closing of this offering through                     , 2012 based on the actual length of the period.

Subordinated Units

Our sponsor will initially own all of our subordinated units. The principal difference between our common units and subordinated units is that in any quarter during the subordination period, holders of the subordinated units are not entitled to receive any distribution until the common units have received the minimum quarterly distribution plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution from prior quarters. Subordinated units will not accrue arrearages. When the subordination period ends, all of the subordinated units will convert into an equal number of common units.

To the extent we do not pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our common units, our common unitholders will not be entitled to receive such payments in the future except during the subordination period. To the extent we have cash available for distribution in any future quarter during the subordination period in excess of the amount necessary to pay the minimum quarterly distribution to holders of our common units, we will use this excess cash available for distribution to pay any distribution arrearages on common units related to prior quarters before any cash distribution is made to holders of subordinated units. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Subordination Period.”

 

59


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Pro Forma Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve and Six Months Ended June 30, 2012

If we had completed the transactions contemplated in this prospectus on January 1, 2011, our pro forma cash available for distribution for the twelve and six months ended June 30, 2012 would have been approximately $32.7 million and $21.0 million, respectively. This amount would have been sufficient to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common units for the twelve and six months ended June 30, 2012. However, these amounts would have been insufficient to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common and subordinated units for the twelve and six months ended June 30, 2012, by approximately $         million and $         million, respectively. This shortfall is primarily attributable to the fact that neither the twelve nor six months ended June 30, 2012 reflected the full impact of our Wyeville plant expansion, which was completed in March 2012, and sales under new contracts with subsidiaries of Baker Hughes and FTS International associated with the expansion, which commenced in May 2012.

The pro forma financial statements, upon which pro forma cash available for distribution is based, do not purport to present our results of operations had the transactions contemplated in this prospectus actually been completed as of the date indicated. Furthermore, cash available for distribution is a cash accounting concept, while our pro forma financial statements have been prepared on an accrual basis. We derived the amounts of pro forma cash available for distribution in the manner described in the table below. As a result, the amount of pro forma cash available for distribution should only be viewed as a general indication of the amount of cash available for distribution that we might have generated had we been formed in an earlier period.

Following the completion of this offering, we estimate that we will incur $3.8 million of incremental annual general and administrative expenses as a result of operating as a publicly traded partnership and our recent expansion. These incremental general and administrative expenses are not reflected in our unaudited pro forma financial statements and consist of $2.1 million of expenses that we expect to incur as a result of operating as a publicly traded partnership, such as expenses associated with annual and quarterly reporting, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution expenses, Sarbanes-Oxley compliance expenses, expenses associated with listing on the NYSE, independent auditor fees, legal fees, investor relations expenses, registrar and transfer agent fees, director and officer insurance expenses and director and officer compensation expenses, as well as incremental administrative expenses to support our recent expansion, including management level positions in operations, human resources, legal, accounting and reporting, as well as license fees associated with upgrading accounting and reporting software. We expect the incremental expenses related to our recent expansion to gradually increase over time as we hire additional personnel, from about $0.7 million for the year ending December 31, 2012 to $1.7 million on an annualized basis by September 30, 2013, the end of the projection period provided under “—Estimated Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve Months Ending September 30, 2013.”

Our unaudited pro forma financial statements are derived from the audited and unaudited historical financial statements of our accounting predecessor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, included elsewhere in this prospectus and Hi-Crush Proppants LLC’s accounting records, which are unaudited. Our unaudited pro forma financial statements should be read together with “Selected Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and the audited and unaudited historical financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and the notes to those statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.

The following table illustrates, on a pro forma basis for the six and the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, the amount of cash that would have been available for distribution to our unitholders, assuming that the transactions contemplated in this prospectus had been consummated on January 1, 2011. Certain of the adjustments reflected or presented below are explained in the footnotes to such adjustments.

 

60


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Cash Available for Distribution

 

     Pro Forma for the
Twelve Months Ended

June 30, 2012 (2)
     Pro Forma for the
Six Months Ended

June 30, 2012 (2)
 
    

(in thousands,

except per unit data)

    

(in thousands,

except per unit data)

 

Operating revenues

   $ 54,528       $ 34,175   

Operating expenses:

     

Production costs (1)

     15,601         9,603   

Depreciation and depletion

     1,117         668   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Costs of goods sold

     16,718         10,271   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     37,810         23,904   

General and administrative expenses

     2,619         1,577   

Accretion of asset retirement obligations

     40         12   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating income

     35,151         22,315   

Interest expense, net

               
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (2)

     35,151         22,315   

Adjustments to reconcile net income to EBITDA:

     

Add:

     

Depreciation and depletion

     1,117         668   

Interest expense, net

               
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

EBITDA (1)

     36,268         22,983   

Less:

     

Cash interest expense (3)

     375         188   

Maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, including accrual for reserve replacement (4)

     1,177         728   

Incremental general and administrative expenses (5)

     2,100         1,050   

Plus:

     

Accretion of asset retirement obligations

     40         12   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Estimated cash available for distribution by Hi-Crush Partners LP

   $ 32,656       $ 21,029   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Minimum distribution per unit (based on a minimum quarterly distribution rate of $         per unit)

     

Annual distributions to:

     

Public common unitholders

     

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC:

     

Common units

     

Subordinated units

     

Total distributions to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

     

Total distributions to our unitholders at the minimum distribution rate

     

Shortfall

     

 

(1) For more information, please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
(2) Reflects our pro forma operating results for the periods indicated, derived from or prepared on a basis consistent with our unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The pro forma adjustments reflected in our unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements for the six and twelve months ended June 30, 2012 have been prepared as if this offering had taken place on January 1, 2011.

 

61


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
(3) Cash interest expense represents commitment fees on our new credit facility.
(4) Maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, including accrual for reserve replacement, was determined based on $1.35 per ton of sand sold during the periods presented. This reflects an estimate of reserve replacement cost, but it is not a reserve or requirement to spend the capital. Please read “—Estimated Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve Months Ending September 30, 2013—Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures.”
(5) Reflects an adjustment to our EBITDA for approximately $2.1 million of incremental general and administrative expenses that we expect to incur as a result of operating as a publicly traded partnership that are not reflected in our unaudited pro forma financial statements.

Estimated Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve Months Ending September 30, 2013

Set forth below is a statement of Estimated Cash Available for Distribution that reflects a forecast of our ability to generate sufficient cash flows to make the minimum quarterly distribution on all of our outstanding limited partner units for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, based on assumptions we believe to be reasonable. These assumptions include adjustments giving effect to this offering.

Our estimated cash available for distribution reflects our judgment as of the date of this prospectus of conditions we expect to exist and the course of action we expect to take during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. The assumptions disclosed under “—Assumptions and Considerations” below are those that we believe are significant to our ability to generate such estimated cash available for distribution. We believe our actual results of operations and cash flows for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 will be sufficient to generate our estimated cash available for distribution for such period; however, we can give you no assurance that such estimated cash available for distribution will be achieved. There will likely be differences between our estimated cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 and our actual results for such period and those differences could be material. If we fail to generate the estimated cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, we may not be able to pay cash distributions on our common units at the minimum quarterly distribution rate or at any rate.

We do not as a matter of course make public projections as to future operations, earnings or other results. However, management has prepared the estimated cash available for distribution and assumptions set forth below to substantiate our belief that we will have sufficient cash available to make the minimum quarterly distribution to our unitholders for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. This prospective financial information was not prepared with a view toward compliance with published guidelines of the SEC or the guidelines established by the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants for preparation and presentation of prospective financial information, but, in the view of our management, was prepared on a reasonable basis, reflects the best currently available estimates and judgments and presents, to the best of management’s knowledge and belief, the assumptions on which we base our belief that we can generate the estimated cash available for distribution necessary for us to have sufficient cash available for distribution to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution to all of our unitholders for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. However, this information is not historical fact and should not be relied upon as being necessarily indicative of future results, and readers of this prospectus are cautioned not to place undue reliance on the prospective financial information. The prospective financial information included in this offering document has been prepared by, and is the responsibility of, the Company’s management. PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP has neither examined, compiled nor performed any procedures with respect to the accompanying prospective financial information and, accordingly, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP does not express an opinion or any other form of assurance with respect thereto. The PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP report included in this offering document relates to the Company’s historical financial information. It does not extend to the prospective financial information and should not be read to do so.

 

62


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

When considering the estimated cash available for distribution set forth below you should keep in mind the risk factors and other cautionary statements under “Risk Factors.” Any of the risks discussed in this prospectus could cause our actual results of operations to vary significantly from those supporting such estimated available cash. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that the forecast is indicative of our future performance. Inclusion of the forecast in this prospectus is not a representation by any person, including us or the underwriters, that the results in the forecast will be achieved.

We are providing the estimated cash available for distribution and related assumptions for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 to supplement our pro forma and historical financial statements in support of our belief that we will have sufficient available cash to allow us to pay cash distributions on all of our outstanding common and subordinated units for each quarter in the twelve-month period ending September 30, 2013 at our stated minimum quarterly distribution rate. Please read below under “—Assumptions and Considerations” for further information as to the assumptions we have made for the preparation of the estimated cash available for distribution set forth below. The narrative descriptions of our assumptions in “—Assumptions and Considerations” generally compare our estimated cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 with the unaudited pro forma cash available for distribution for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 presented under “—Pro Forma Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve and Six Months Ended June 30, 2012.” We have not provided any narrative comparison to our unaudited pro forma cash available for distribution for the six months ended June 30, 2012, as we do not believe comparing a six-month period to a twelve-month period is useful to investors.

We do not undertake any obligation to release publicly the results of any future revisions we may make to the assumptions used in generating our estimated cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 or to update those assumptions to reflect events or circumstances after the date of this prospectus. Therefore, you are cautioned not to place undue reliance on this information.

 

63


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Estimated Cash Available for Distribution

(Unaudited)

 

     Three Months Ending      Twelve
Months
Ending
September 30,
2013
 
     December 31,
2012
     March 31,
2013
     June 30,
2013
     September 30,
2013
    
     (in millions, except per unit data)  

Operating revenues

   $ 24.1       $ 24.1       $ 24.1       $ 24.1       $ 96.4   

Operating expenses:

              

Production costs (1)

     6.2         7.2         6.1         6.1         25.6   

Depreciation and depletion

     0.5         0.4         0.4         0.4         1.7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cost of goods sold

     6.7         7.6         6.5         6.5         27.3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     17.4         16.5         17.6         17.6         69.1   

General and administrative expenses (2)

     1.6         1.5         1.5         1.6         6.2   

Accretion of asset retirement obligations

                                       
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating income

     15.8         15.0         16.1         16.0         62.9   

Interest expense, net (3)

     0.1         0.1         0.1         0.2         0.5   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 15.7       $ 14.9       $ 16.0       $ 15.8       $ 62.4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to estimated EBITDA:

              

Add:

              

Depreciation and depletion

     0.5         0.4         0.4         0.4         1.7   

Interest expense, net (3)

     0.1         0.1         0.1         0.2         0.5   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

EBITDA (1)

   $ 16.3       $ 15.4       $ 16.5       $ 16.4       $ 64.6   

Adjustments to reconcile estimated EBITDA to estimated cash available for distribution:

              

Less:

              

Cash interest expense

     0.1         0.1         0.1         0.1         0.4   

Estimated maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, including accrual for reserve replacement (4)

     0.5         0.5         0.5         0.5         2.0   

Costs associated with inventory buildup (5)

                     1.2         1.2         2.4   

Plus:

              

Accretion of asset retirement obligations

                                       

Costs allocated to inventory drawdown (5)

             2.4                         2.4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Estimated cash available for distribution

   $ 15.7       $ 17.2       $ 14.7       $ 14.6       $ 62.2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Minimum distributions per unit (based on minimum quarterly distribution rate of $             per unit)

              

Distributions to public common unitholders

              

Distributions to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC—common units

              

Distributions to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC—subordinated units

              

Total Distributions

              

Excess of cash available for distributions over aggregate minimum quarterly cash distributions

              

 

(1) For more information, please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
(2) Includes general and administrative expenses of $2.4 million allocated from Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and its affiliates, an incremental $1.7 million of administrative expenses to support our recent expansion and $2.1 million of incremental general and administrative expenses that we expect to incur as a result of operating as a publicly-traded partnership.

 

64


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
(3) Reflects the pro forma amortization during the forecast period of the $0.5 million in credit facility arrangement fees, which will be amortized over a four-year period, and commitment fees of $0.4 million. We expect to have no indebtedness outstanding during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. Please read “—Assumptions and Considerations—Our Financing” below for additional detail on the calculation of interest expense.
(4) Maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, including accrual for reserve replacement, was determined based on $1.35 per ton of sand sold during the projected period. This reflects an estimate of reserve replacement cost, but it is not a reserve or requirement to spend the capital. Because Northern White sand is a limited resource, costs of acquiring Northern White sand reserves may increase in the future, which could cause our future reserve replacement costs to exceed the $1.35 per ton estimated reserve replacement cost we have assumed for purposes of estimating our cash available for distribution over the forecast period. Please read “Estimated Cash Available for Distribution for the Twelve Months Ending September 30, 2013—Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures.”
(5) Reflects adjustments to reconcile the cash flows associated with excavation costs when calculating our estimated cash available for distribution. Please see “—Assumptions and Considerations—Our Expenses” below for additional information regarding these adjustments.

Assumptions and Considerations

We believe that our cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 will not be less than $62.2 million. This amount of estimated cash available for distribution is approximately $29.5 million more than the $32.7 million pro forma cash available for distribution we generated for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, due in part to only nine months of operating revenue from the Wyeville facility, which commenced operations in July 2011. As we discuss in further detail below, we believe that increased income from a full year’s operation of the Wyeville facility, the completion of our plant expansion in March 2012, the termination of certain royalty agreements in July 2012 and commencement of deliveries under our contracts with subsidiaries of Baker Hughes and FTS International in May 2012 will result in our generating higher cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. The assumptions and estimates we have made to support our ability to generate the estimated cash available for distribution are set forth below.

Our Operating Revenue

We estimate that we will generate approximately $96.4 million in total revenues for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. Prior to the acquisition of our Wyeville sand reserves and construction of the Wyeville facility, our mines were nonoperational and accordingly generated no revenue. From the Wyeville in-service date through June 30, 2012, our Wyeville assets produced revenue of approximately $54.5 million.

All of the revenues estimated for the forecast period are expected to be generated from long-term sales contracts that require our customers to pay a specified price for a specified volume each month. Accordingly, our estimate of total revenue for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 is based on our current operating capacity and the pricing terms and volume commitments specified in our long-term sales contracts rather than on our historical revenues. Our estimate assumes that we will make sales of our total contracted volume of 1,460,000 tons of frac sand at contract prices over the forecast period. We generated $54.5 million in revenues for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012. The expected $41.9 million increase in our revenues from the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, compared to the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, is primarily due to 588,150 tons of incremental frac sand sales that were contracted as part of the March 2012 plant expansion.

 

65


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our Expenses

We estimate that our production costs will be approximately $25.6 million for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, as compared to pro forma production costs of approximately $15.6 million for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012. The increase results from:

 

   

increased excavation, personnel and plant operating expenses of $11.7 million primarily related to increased production volumes associated with our recent expansion; and

 

   

decreased royalties of $1.7 million resulting from our termination of certain royalty agreements in July 2012, which reduced our royalty costs from $6.15 per ton sold to $2.50 per ton sold, partially offset by royalties on the increased volumes of sand sold.

Because our excavation costs and royalties are fixed on a per ton basis, our estimate of those expenses for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 is based on our expectation that we will produce and sell 1,460,000 tons of frac sand over the contract period. Our estimate of personnel and plant operating expenses is based on our historical costs, adjusted to account for the additional expenses we will incur as a result of our recent plant expansion and a full twelve months of operations.

We estimate that our general and administrative expenses will be approximately $6.2 million for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, as compared to pro forma general and administrative expenses of approximately $2.6 million for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012. The change is primarily due to:

 

   

approximately $2.1 million of incremental general and administrative expenses resulting from our being a publicly traded limited partnership; and

 

   

an incremental $1.7 million of general and administrative expenses to support our recent expansion, including management level positions in operations, human resources, legal, accounting and reporting, as well as license fees associated with upgrading accounting and reporting software.

We estimate our depreciation and depletion expense for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 for the Wyeville facility will be approximately $1.7 million, as compared to pro forma depreciation and depletion expense of approximately $1.1 million for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012. The increase in estimated depreciation and depletion expense is primarily due to completion of the plant expansion in March 2012 and as a result of operating for the full twelve-month period.

Because our excavation and wet plant related production activities halt during the winter months consistent with industry practice, we excavate excess sand to build a stockpile that will feed the dry plant, which continues to operate during the winter months. We are excavating excess sand in the six month period, which began on March 31, 2012 and ends on September 30, 2012, for use in the winter months. We also expect to excavate excess volumes for a portion of the three month period ending December 31, 2012; however, we estimate that excess volumes excavated during the first part of this period will also be consumed during the portion of this time period in which we are not excavating volumes. In the three months ending March 31, 2013, no excavation is expected to occur, and all sand is expected to be sold from our work-in-process inventory, which was created during the six month period ending September 30, 2012.

In the period in which sand is stockpiled, the associated cash excavation costs are included in the value of our work-in-process inventory and not reflected in cost of goods sold on our income statement. These excavation costs are recognized as cost of goods sold on our income statement in a later period when the stockpiled sand is processed by the dry plant and sold. We have made adjustments to reconcile the cash flows associated with excavation costs when calculating our estimated cash available for distribution. In the three months ending March 31, 2013, we add the costs allocated to inventory drawdown to reflect prior period excavation costs that are included in cost of goods sold. We subtract the costs associated with inventory buildup in the six months ending September 30, 2013 to reflect extraction costs that are paid in these periods but will be included in the value of our work-in-process inventory. Over the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, costs allocated to inventory drawdown are expected to equal the costs associated with inventory buildup.

 

66


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our Capital Expenditures

We estimate that maintenance and replacement capital expenditures relating to the Wyeville facility will be approximately $2.0 million for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. This amount is calculated based on $1.35 per ton of sand sold and the 1,460,000 tons of sand contracted to be sold during the period. The increase from $1.2 million for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 is attributable to the increase in tons of sand sold as a result of the plant expansion that was completed in March 2012 and a full twelve-month period of operations. Please read “—Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures.”

Our Financing

Our interest and debt expense for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 is based on the following assumptions:

 

   

At the closing of this offering we will not have any borrowings under our new $100.0 million credit facility.

 

   

Because the cash we have on hand at the closing of this offering together with cash we expect to generate in excess of distributions for the forecast period should provide us with sufficient working capital during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, we do not expect to incur borrowings during such period.

 

   

Our new credit facility will have a commitment fee of 0.375%.

 

   

We will remain in compliance with the financial and other covenants in our new credit facility.

Our Regulatory, Industry and Economic Factors

Our forecast of our results of operations for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 is based on the following assumptions related to regulatory, industry and economic factors:

 

   

There will not be any new federal, state or local regulations affecting our operations or those of our customers, or any new interpretations of existing regulations, that will be materially adverse to our business during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013.

 

   

There will not be any major adverse changes affecting our operations or those of our customers during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013.

 

   

There will not be any material accidents, weather-related incidents, unscheduled downtime or similar unanticipated events with respect to our facilities or those of third parties on which we depend.

 

   

Industry, insurance and overall economic conditions will not change substantially during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013.

 

   

There will not be any material non-performance by our customers.

Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures

For our purposes, maintenance and replacement capital expenditures are those capital expenditures required to maintain, over the long term, the operating capacity of our capital assets, and expansion capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that increase, over the long term, the operating capacity of our capital assets. Examples of maintenance and replacement capital expenditures include expenditures associated with the replacement of equipment and sand reserves, to the extent such expenditures are made to maintain our long-term operating capacity.

 

67


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Because our maintenance and replacement capital expenditures can be irregular, the amount of our actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures may differ substantially from period to period, which could cause similar fluctuations in the amounts of cash available for distribution. We do not expect to spend capital to replace our reserves ratably quarter-over-quarter or year-over-year but expect, over the long term, to invest capital to maintain our operating capacity. We currently expense costs associated with maintaining our wet and dry plants as they are incurred. However, for purposes of calculating our pro forma estimated cash available for distribution for the six and twelve months ended June 30, 2012 and our estimated cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, maintenance and replacement capital expenditures were determined based on an estimated reserve replacement cost of $1.35 per ton of sand sold. This estimate was developed by considering the actual and projected capital expenditures required to acquire the Wyeville and Augusta reserves as well as the capital required to develop and construct the plant and infrastructure at each location, divided by the estimated, sellable reserves product at each site as determined by John T. Boyd. We believe this methodology is an appropriate proxy for the long-term future costs to maintain our existing reserve base. We believe reserves can also be replaced at our existing Wyeville facility through acquisitions of additional acreage without incurring the cost of building an additional processing facility. While this reflects a reserve replacement cost, it is not a reserve or requirement to spend capital.

 

68


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

HOW WE MAKE DISTRIBUTIONS TO OUR PARTNERS

Set forth below is a summary of the significant provisions of our partnership agreement that relate to cash distributions.

General

Intent to Distribute the Minimum Quarterly Distribution

Within 60 days after the end of each quarter, beginning with the quarter ending                     , 2012, we intend to distribute to the holders of common and subordinated units on a quarterly basis at least the minimum quarterly distribution of $         per unit, or $         on an annualized basis, to the extent we have sufficient cash after establishment of cash reserves and payment of fees and expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. We will adjust the minimum quarterly distribution for the period after the closing of the offering through                     , 2012.

Even if our cash distribution policy is not modified or revoked, the amount of distributions paid under our policy and the decision to make any distribution is determined by our general partner. Our partnership agreement does not contain a requirement for us to pay distributions to our unitholders, and there is no guarantee that we will pay the minimum quarterly distribution, or any distribution, on the units in any quarter. However, it does contain provisions intended to motivate our general partner to make steady, increasing and sustainable distributions over time.

General Partner Interest

Our general partner owns a non-economic general partner interest in us, which does not entitle it to receive cash distributions. However, our general partner may in the future own common units or other equity securities in us and will be entitled to receive distributions on any such interests.

Incentive Distribution Rights

Our sponsor currently holds incentive distribution rights that entitle it to receive increasing percentages, up to a maximum of 50.0%, of the cash we distribute from operating surplus (as defined below) in excess of $         per unit per quarter. The maximum distribution of 50.0% does not include any distributions that our sponsor may receive on any limited partner units that it owns.

Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus

General

Any distributions we make will be characterized as made from “operating surplus” or “capital surplus.” Distributions from operating surplus are made differently than cash distributions that we would make from capital surplus. Operating surplus distributions will be made to our unitholders and, if we make quarterly distributions above the first target distribution level described below, to the holder of our incentive distribution rights. We do not anticipate that we will make any distributions from capital surplus. In such an event, however, any capital surplus distribution would be made pro rata to all unitholders, but the holder of the incentive distribution rights would generally not participate in any capital surplus distributions with respect to those rights.

Operating Surplus

We define operating surplus as:

 

   

$         million (as described below); plus

 

   

all of our cash receipts after the closing of this offering, excluding cash from interim capital transactions (as defined below); plus

 

69


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

working capital borrowings made after the end of a period but on or before the date of determination of operating surplus for the period; plus

 

   

cash distributions paid in respect of equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights), other than equity issued on the closing date of this offering, to finance all or a portion of expansion capital expenditures or expenditures for a replacement capital asset in respect of the period from such financing until the earlier to occur of the date the capital asset commences commercial service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of; plus

 

   

an amount of cash to be indirectly contributed to us in accordance with the contribution agreement equal to the amount of deferred revenue that would have been reflected on our balance sheet on the closing date of this offering, which shall be included in operating surplus for the quarters ending September 30, 2012 and December 31, 2012 in amounts calculated, for each quarter, by multiplying such cash amount by a fraction, (x) the numerator of which is the number of days in such quarter and (y) the denominator of which is the aggregate number of days in the quarters ending September 30, 2012 and December 31, 2012; less

 

   

cash distributions paid in respect of equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights) to pay the construction period interest on debt incurred, or to pay construction period distributions on equity issued, to finance the expansion capital expenditures or expenditures for a replacement capital asset referred to above, in each case, in respect of the period from such financing until the earlier to occur of the date the capital asset is placed in service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of; less

 

   

all of our operating expenditures (as defined below) after the closing of this offering; less

 

   

the amount of cash reserves established by our general partner to provide funds for future operating expenditures; less

 

   

all working capital borrowings not repaid within twelve months after having been incurred, or repaid within such twelve-month period with the proceeds of additional working capital borrowings; less

 

   

any loss realized on disposition of an investment capital expenditure.

As described above, operating surplus does not reflect actual cash on hand that is available for distribution to our unitholders and is not limited to cash generated by our operations. For example, it includes a basket of $             million that will enable us, if we choose, to distribute as operating surplus cash we receive in the future from non-operating sources such as asset sales, issuances of securities and long-term borrowings that would otherwise be distributed as capital surplus. In addition, the effect of including, as described above, certain cash distributions on equity interests in operating surplus will be to increase operating surplus by the amount of any such cash distributions. As a result, we may also distribute as operating surplus up to the amount of any such cash that we receive from non-operating sources.

The proceeds of working capital borrowings increase operating surplus and repayments of working capital borrowings are generally operating expenditures, as described below, and thus reduce operating surplus when made. However, if a working capital borrowing is not repaid during the twelve-month period following the borrowing, it will be deemed repaid at the end of such period, thus decreasing operating surplus at such time. When such working capital borrowing is in fact repaid, it will be excluded from operating expenditures because operating surplus will have been previously reduced by the deemed repayment.

We define operating expenditures in our partnership agreement, which generally means all of our cash expenditures, including, but not limited to, taxes, reimbursement of expenses to our general partner or its affiliates, payments made under interest rate hedge agreements or commodity hedge agreements (provided that (1) with respect to amounts paid in connection with the initial purchase of an interest rate hedge contract or a commodity hedge contract, such amounts will be amortized over the life of the applicable interest rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract and (2) payments made in connection with the termination of any interest

 

70


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract prior to the expiration of its stipulated settlement or termination date will be included in operating expenditures in equal quarterly installments over the remaining scheduled life of such interest rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract), officer compensation, repayment of working capital borrowings, debt service payments and estimated maintenance and replacement capital expenditures (as discussed in further detail below), provided that operating expenditures will not include:

 

   

repayment of working capital borrowings deducted from operating surplus pursuant to the penultimate bullet point of the definition of operating surplus above when such repayment actually occurs;

 

   

payments (including prepayments and prepayment penalties and the purchase price of indebtedness that is repurchased and cancelled) of principal of and premium on indebtedness, other than working capital borrowings;

 

   

expansion capital expenditures;

 

   

actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures (as discussed in further detail below);

 

   

investment capital expenditures;

 

   

payment of transaction expenses relating to interim capital transactions;

 

   

distributions to our partners (including distributions in respect of our incentive distribution rights); or

 

   

repurchases of equity interests except to fund obligations under employee benefit plans.

Capital Surplus

Capital surplus is defined in our partnership agreement as any cash and cash equivalents distributed in excess of our operating surplus. Accordingly, capital surplus would generally be generated only by the following (which we refer to as “interim capital transactions”):

 

   

borrowings other than working capital borrowings;

 

   

sales of our equity and debt securities; and

 

   

sales or other dispositions of assets for cash, other than inventory, accounts receivable and other assets sold in the ordinary course of business or as part of normal retirement or replacement of assets.

Characterization of Cash Distributions

Our partnership agreement requires that we treat all cash distributed as coming from operating surplus until the sum of all cash distributed since the closing of this offering equals the operating surplus from the closing of this offering through the end of the quarter immediately preceding that distribution. Our partnership agreement requires that we treat any amount distributed in excess of operating surplus, regardless of its source, as distributions of capital surplus. As described above, operating surplus includes up to $         million, which does not reflect actual cash on hand that is available for distribution to our unitholders. Rather, it is a provision that will enable us, if we choose, to distribute as operating surplus up to this amount that would otherwise be distributed as capital surplus. We do not anticipate that we will make any distributions from capital surplus.

Capital Expenditures

Estimated maintenance and replacement capital expenditures reduce operating surplus, but expansion capital expenditures, actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures and investment capital expenditures do not. Maintenance and replacement capital expenditures are those capital expenditures required to maintain our long-term operating capacity. Examples of maintenance and replacement capital expenditures include expenditures associated with the replacement of equipment and sand reserves, to the extent such expenditures are made to maintain our long-term operating capacity. Maintenance and replacement capital expenditures will also include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions on equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights) to finance all or any portion of the construction or development of a

 

71


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

replacement asset that is paid in respect of the period that begins when we enter into a binding obligation to commence constructing or developing a replacement asset and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that any such replacement asset commences commercial service and the date that such asset is abandoned or disposed. Capital expenditures made solely for investment purposes will not be considered maintenance and replacement capital expenditures.

Because our maintenance and replacement capital expenditures can be irregular, the amount of our actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures may differ substantially from period to period, which could cause similar fluctuations in the amounts of operating surplus and adjusted operating surplus if we subtracted actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures from operating surplus.

Our partnership agreement will require that an estimate of the average quarterly maintenance and replacement capital expenditures necessary to maintain our operating capacity over the long-term be subtracted from operating surplus each quarter as opposed to the actual amounts spent. The amount of estimated maintenance and replacement capital expenditures deducted from operating surplus for those periods will be subject to review and change by our general partner at least once a year, provided that any change is approved by our conflicts committee. The estimate will be made at least annually and whenever an event occurs that is likely to result in a material adjustment to the amount of our maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, such as a major acquisition or the introduction of new governmental regulations that will impact our business. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of maintenance and replacement capital expenditures that our general partner may estimate. For purposes of calculating operating surplus, any adjustment to this estimate will be prospective only. For a discussion of the amounts we have allocated toward estimated maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, please read “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”

The use of estimated maintenance and replacement capital expenditures in calculating operating surplus will have the following effects:

 

   

the amount of actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures in any quarter will not directly reduce operating surplus but will instead be factored into the estimate of the average quarterly maintenance and replacement capital expenditures. This may result in the subordinated units converting into common units when the use of actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures would result in lower operating surplus during the subordination period and potentially result in the tests for conversion of the subordinated units not being satisfied;

 

   

it may increase our ability to distribute as operating surplus cash we receive from non-operating sources; and

 

   

it may be more difficult for us to raise our distribution above the minimum quarterly distribution and pay incentive distributions on the incentive distribution rights held by our sponsor.

Expansion capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that we expect will increase our operating capacity over the long term. Examples of expansion capital expenditures include the acquisition of new reserves or equipment, development of a new surface mine or the expansion of an existing surface mine, to the extent such capital expenditures are expected to expand our long-term operating capacity. Expansion capital expenditures will also include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions on equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights) to finance all or any portion of the construction of such capital improvement in respect of the period that commences when we enter into a binding obligation to commence construction of a capital improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of the date any such capital improvement commences commercial service and the date that it is disposed of or abandoned. Capital expenditures made solely for investment purposes will not be considered expansion capital expenditures.

Investment capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that are neither maintenance and replacement capital expenditures nor expansion capital expenditures. Investment capital expenditures largely will consist of

 

72


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

capital expenditures made for investment purposes. Examples of investment capital expenditures include traditional capital expenditures for investment purposes, such as purchases of securities, as well as other capital expenditures that might be made in lieu of such traditional investment capital expenditures, such as the acquisition of a capital asset for investment purposes or development of assets that are in excess of the maintenance of our existing operating capacity, but which are not expected to expand, for more than the short term, our operating capacity.

As described below, neither investment capital expenditures nor expansion capital expenditures are included in operating expenditures, and thus will not reduce operating surplus. Because expansion capital expenditures include interest payments (and related fees) on debt incurred to finance all or a portion of the construction, replacement or improvement of a capital asset in respect of a period that begins when we enter into a binding obligation to commence construction of a capital improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of the date any such capital asset commences commercial service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of, such interest payments also do not reduce operating surplus. Losses on disposition of an investment capital expenditure will reduce operating surplus when realized and cash receipts from an investment capital expenditure will be treated as a cash receipt for purposes of calculating operating surplus only to the extent the cash receipt is a return on principal.

Capital expenditures that are made in part for maintenance and replacement capital purposes, investment capital purposes and/or expansion capital purposes will be allocated as maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, investment capital expenditures or expansion capital expenditures by our general partner.

Subordination Period

General

Our partnership agreement provides that, during the subordination period (which we describe below), the common units will have the right to receive distributions from operating surplus each quarter in an amount equal to $         per common unit, which amount is defined in our partnership agreement as the minimum quarterly distribution, plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units from prior quarters, before any distributions from operating surplus may be made on the subordinated units. These units are deemed “subordinated” because for a period of time, referred to as the subordination period, the subordinated units will not be entitled to receive any distributions from operating surplus until the common units have received the minimum quarterly distribution plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution from prior quarters. Furthermore, no arrearages will be paid on the subordinated units. The practical effect of the subordinated units is to increase the likelihood that during the subordination period there will be sufficient cash from operating surplus to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.

Determination of Subordination Period

Our sponsor will initially own all of our subordinated units. Except as described below, the subordination period will begin on the closing date of this offering and expire on the first business day after the distribution to unitholders in respect of any quarter, beginning with the quarter ending                     , 2015, if each of the following has occurred:

 

   

distributions from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common and subordinated units equaled or exceeded the minimum quarterly distribution for each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date;

 

   

the “adjusted operating surplus” (as defined below) generated during each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of the minimum quarterly distribution on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units during those periods on a fully diluted weighted average basis; and

 

   

there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.

 

73


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

For the period after closing of this offering through September 30, 2012, we will adjust the quarterly distribution based on the actual length of the period, and use such adjusted distribution in determining whether the test described above has been satisfied for the quarter ending September 30, 2012.

Early Termination of Subordination Period

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the subordination period will automatically terminate, and all of the subordinated units will convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, on the first business day after the distribution to unitholders in respect of any quarter, beginning with the quarter ending                     , 2013, if each of the following has occurred:

 

   

distributions from operating surplus exceeded $         (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on all outstanding common units and subordinated units, plus the related distributions on the incentive distribution rights for a four-quarter period immediately preceding that date;

 

   

the “adjusted operating surplus” (as defined below) generated during the four-quarter period immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of $         (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units during that period on a fully diluted weighted average basis, plus the related distribution on the incentive distribution rights; and

 

   

there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distributions on the common units.

For the period after the closing of this offering through                     , 2012, we will adjust the quarterly distribution based on the actual length of the period, and use such adjusted distribution in determining whether the test described in this paragraph has been satisfied for the quarter ending                     , 2012.

Expiration Upon Removal of the General Partner

In addition, if the unitholders remove our general partner other than for cause:

 

   

the subordinated units held by any person will immediately and automatically convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, provided (1) neither such person nor any of its affiliates voted any of its units in favor of the removal and (2) such person is not an affiliate of the successor general partner; and

 

   

if all of the subordinated units convert pursuant to the foregoing, all cumulative common unit arrearages on the common units will be extinguished and the subordination period will end.

Expiration of the Subordination Period

When the subordination period ends, each outstanding subordinated unit will convert into one common unit and will then participate pro rata with the other common units in distributions.

Adjusted Operating Surplus

Adjusted operating surplus is intended to reflect the cash generated from operations during a particular period and therefore excludes net increases in working capital borrowings and net drawdowns of reserves of cash generated in prior periods. Adjusted operating surplus consists of:

 

   

operating surplus generated with respect to that period (excluding any amounts attributable to the items described in the first bullet point under “—Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus—Operating Surplus” above); less

 

   

any net increase in working capital borrowings with respect to that period; less

 

   

any net decrease in cash reserves for operating expenditures with respect to that period not relating to an operating expenditure made with respect to that period; plus

 

   

any net decrease in working capital borrowings with respect to that period; plus

 

74


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

any net increase in cash reserves for operating expenditures with respect to that period required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium; plus

 

   

any net decrease made in subsequent periods in cash reserves for operating expenditures initially established with respect to such period to the extent such decrease results in a reduction of adjusted operating surplus in subsequent periods pursuant to the third bullet point above.

Distributions From Operating Surplus During the Subordination Period

If we make a distribution from operating surplus for any quarter during the subordination period, our partnership agreement requires that we make the distribution in the following manner:

 

   

first, to the common unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each common unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter and any arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units for any prior quarters;

 

   

second, to the subordinated unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each subordinated unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter; and

 

   

thereafter, in the manner described in “—Incentive Distribution Rights” below.

Distributions From Operating Surplus After the Subordination Period

If we make distributions of cash from operating surplus for any quarter after the subordination period, our partnership agreement requires that we make the distribution in the following manner:

 

   

first, to all common unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each common unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter; and

 

   

thereafter, in the manner described in “—Incentive Distribution Rights” below.

General Partner Interest

Our general partner owns a non-economic general partner interest in us, which does not entitle it to receive cash distributions. However, our general partner may in the future own common units or other equity securities in us and will be entitled to receive distributions on any such interests.

Incentive Distribution Rights

Incentive distribution rights represent the right to receive increasing percentages (15.0%, 25.0% and 50.0%) of quarterly distributions from operating surplus after the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels have been achieved. Our sponsor currently holds the incentive distribution rights, but may transfer these rights at any time.

If for any quarter:

 

   

we have distributed cash from operating surplus to the common and subordinated unitholders in an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution; and

 

   

we have distributed cash from operating surplus on outstanding common units in an amount necessary to eliminate any cumulative arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution;

then we will make additional distributions from operating surplus for that quarter among the unitholders and the sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) in the following manner:

 

   

first, to all unitholders, pro rata, until each unitholder receives a total of $         per unit for that quarter (the “first target distribution”);

 

   

second, 85.0% to all common unitholders and subordinated unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to the holders of our incentive distribution rights, until each unitholder receives a total of $         per unit for that quarter (the “second target distribution”);

 

75


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

third, 75.0% to all common unitholders and subordinated unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to the holders of our incentive distribution rights, until each unitholder receives a total of $         per unit for that quarter (the “third target distribution”); and

 

   

thereafter, 50.0% to all common unitholders and subordinated unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% to the holders of our incentive distribution rights.

Percentage Allocations of Distributions From Operating Surplus

The following table illustrates the percentage allocations of distributions from operating surplus between the unitholders and our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) based on the specified target distribution levels. The amounts set forth under the column heading “Marginal Percentage Interest in Distributions” are the percentage interests of our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) and the unitholders in any distributions from operating surplus we distribute up to and including the corresponding amount in the column “Total Quarterly Distribution Per Unit.” The percentage interests shown for our unitholders and our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) for the minimum quarterly distribution are also applicable to quarterly distribution amounts that are less than the minimum quarterly distribution. The percentage interests set forth below assume our sponsor has not transferred its incentive distribution rights and there are no arrearages on common units.

 

     Total Quarterly Distribution
Per Common Unit and
Subordinated Unit
     Marginal Percentage
Interest in Distributions
 
        Unitholders     Sponsor
(as Holder of
Our Incentive
Distribution Rights)
 

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

   up to $                      100.0     0

First Target Distribution

   above $          up to $                 100.0     0

Second Target Distribution

   above $          up to $                 85.0     15.0

Third Target Distribution

   above $          up to $                 75.0     25.0

Thereafter

   above $                  50.0     50.0

Our Sponsor’s Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels

Our sponsor, as the initial holder of our incentive distribution rights, has the right under our partnership agreement to elect to relinquish the right to receive incentive distribution payments based on the initial target distribution levels and to reset, at higher levels, the target distribution levels upon which the incentive distribution payments to our sponsor would be set. If our sponsor transfers all or a portion of our incentive distribution rights in the future, then the holder or holders of a majority of our incentive distribution rights will be entitled to exercise this right. The following discussion assumes that our sponsor holds all of the incentive distribution rights at the time that a reset election is made. The right to reset the target distribution levels upon which the incentive distributions are based may be exercised, without approval of our unitholders or the conflicts committee of our general partner, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and we have made cash distributions to the holders of the incentive distribution rights at the highest level of incentive distribution for the prior four consecutive fiscal quarters. The reset target distribution levels will be higher than the target distribution levels prior to the reset such that there will be no incentive distributions paid under the reset target distribution levels until cash distributions per unit following the reset event increase as described below. We anticipate that our sponsor would exercise this reset right in order to facilitate acquisitions or internal growth projects that would otherwise not be sufficiently accretive to cash distributions per common unit, taking into account the existing levels of incentive distribution payments being made to our sponsor.

In connection with the resetting of the target distribution levels and the corresponding relinquishment by our sponsor of incentive distribution payments based on the target cash distributions prior to the reset, our sponsor will be entitled to receive a number of newly issued common units based on a predetermined formula described

 

76


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

below that takes into account the “cash parity” value of the cash distributions related to the incentive distribution rights received by our sponsor for the quarter prior to the reset event as compared to the cash distribution per common unit in such quarter.

The number of common units that our sponsor would be entitled to receive from us in connection with a resetting of the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution levels then in effect would be equal to the quotient determined by dividing (x) the amount of cash distributions received by our sponsor in respect of its incentive distribution rights for the fiscal quarter ended immediately prior to the date of such reset election by (y) the amount of cash distributed per common unit with respect to such quarter. Our sponsor would be entitled to receive distributions in respect of these common units pro rata in subsequent periods.

Following a reset election, a baseline minimum quarterly distribution amount will be calculated as an amount equal to the cash distribution amount per unit for the fiscal quarter immediately preceding the reset election (which amount we refer to as the “reset minimum quarterly distribution”) and the target distribution levels will be reset to be correspondingly higher such that we would make distributions from operating surplus for each quarter thereafter as follows:

 

   

first, to all common unitholders, pro rata, until each unitholder receives an amount per unit equal to 115.0% of the reset minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter;

 

   

second, 85.0% to all common unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to our sponsor, until each unitholder receives an amount per unit equal to 125.0% of the reset minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter;

 

   

third, 75.0% to all common unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to our sponsor, until each unitholder receives an amount per unit equal to 150.0% of the reset minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter; and

 

   

thereafter, 50.0% to all common unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% to our sponsor.

Because a reset election can only occur after the subordination period expires, the reset minimum quarterly distribution will have no significance except as a baseline for the target distribution levels.

The following table illustrates the percentage allocation of distributions from operating surplus between the unitholders and our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) at various distribution levels (1) pursuant to the distribution provisions of our partnership agreement in effect at the closing of this offering, as well as (2) following a hypothetical reset of the target distribution levels based on the assumption that the quarterly distribution amount per common unit during the fiscal quarter immediately preceding the reset election was $        .

 

    Quarterly
Distribution Per Unit
               Prior to Reset              
  Unitholders     Sponsor
(as Holder
of Our
Incentive
Distribution
Rights)
    Quarterly Distribution Per
Unit Following
              Hypothetical Reset              

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

  up to $             100.0     0.0               up to $                   (1)

First Target Distribution

  above $        up to $             100.0     0.0   above $         up to $          (2)

Second Target Distribution

  above $        up to $             85.0     15.0   above $         up to $          (3)

Third Target Distribution

  above $        up to $             75.0     25.0   above $         up to $          (4)

Thereafter

  above $             50.0     50.0   above $        

 

(1) This amount is equal to the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.
(2) This amount is 115.0% of the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.
(3) This amount is 125.0% of the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.
(4) This amount is 150.0% of the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.

 

77


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The following table illustrates the total amount of distributions from operating surplus that would be distributed to the unitholders and our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), in respect of its incentive distribution rights, based on the amount distributed for the quarter immediately prior to the reset. The table assumes that immediately prior to the reset there would be              common units outstanding and the distribution to each common unit would be $         per quarter for the quarter prior to the reset.

 

    

Quarterly Distribution
Per Unit Prior to Reset

   Cash
Distributions to
Common
Unitholders
Prior to Reset
     Cash Distributions to
Sponsor (as Holder
of Our Incentive
Distribution Rights)
Prior to Reset
     Total
Distributions
 

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

   up to $        $              $    —       $        

First Target Distribution

   above $        up to $            $                  $    —       $            

Second Target Distribution

   above $        up to $                 

Third Target Distribution

   above $        up to $                 

Thereafter

   above $                 
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
      $              $         $          
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table illustrates the total amount of distributions from operating surplus that would be distributed to the unitholders and our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) in respect of its incentive distribution rights, with respect to the quarter in which the reset occurs. The table reflects that as a result of the reset there would be              common units outstanding and the distribution to each common unit would be $        . The number of common units to be issued to our sponsor upon the reset was calculated by dividing (1) the amount received by our sponsor in respect of its incentive distribution rights for the quarter prior to the reset as shown in the table above, or $        , by (2) the cash distributed on each common unit for the quarter prior to the reset as shown in the table above, or $        .

 

   

Quarterly Distribution
Per Unit After Reset

  Cash
Distributions to
Common
Unitholders
After Reset
    Cash Distributions to

Sponsor (as Holder of Our
Incentive Distribution Rights)
After Reset
       
        Common
Units(1)
    Incentive
Distribution
Rights
    Total     Total
Distributions
 

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

  up to $       $           $             $    —      $           $          

First Target Distribution

  above $        up to $           $      $     —     $     —      $     —      $     —   

Second Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                                           

Third Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                                           

Thereafter

  above $                                           
    $             $             $      $             $          
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Represents distributions in respect of the common units issued to our sponsor upon the reset.

Our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) will be entitled to cause the target distribution levels to be reset on more than one occasion, provided that it may not make a reset election except at a time when it has received incentive distributions for the prior four consecutive fiscal quarters based on the highest level of incentive distributions that it is entitled to receive under our partnership agreement.

 

78


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Distributions From Capital Surplus

How Distributions From Capital Surplus Will Be Made

Our partnership agreement requires that we make distributions from capital surplus, if any, in the following manner:

 

   

first, to all common unitholders and subordinated unitholders, pro rata, until the minimum quarterly distribution is reduced to zero, as described below;

 

   

second, to the common unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each common unit an amount from capital surplus equal to any unpaid arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units; and

 

   

thereafter, we will make all distributions from capital surplus as if they were from operating surplus.

Effect of a Distribution From Capital Surplus

Our partnership agreement treats a distribution of capital surplus as the repayment of the initial unit price from this initial public offering, which is a return of capital. Each time a distribution of capital surplus is made, the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels will be reduced in the same proportion as the corresponding reduction in relation to the fair market value of the common units prior to the announcement of the distribution. Because distributions of capital surplus will reduce the minimum quarterly distribution and target distribution levels after any of these distributions are made, it may be easier for our sponsor to receive incentive distributions and for the subordinated units to convert into common units. However, any distribution of capital surplus before the minimum quarterly distribution is reduced to zero cannot be applied to the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution or any arrearages.

Once we reduce the minimum quarterly distribution and target distribution levels to zero, all future distributions will be made such that 50.0% is paid to all unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% is paid to the holder or holders of incentive distribution rights, pro rata.

Adjustment to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels

In addition to adjusting the minimum quarterly distribution and target distribution levels to reflect a distribution of capital surplus, if we combine our common units into fewer common units or subdivide our common units into a greater number of common units, our partnership agreement specifies that the following items will be proportionately adjusted:

 

   

the minimum quarterly distribution;

 

   

the target distribution levels;

 

   

the initial unit price, as described below under “—Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation”;

 

   

the per unit amount of any outstanding arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units; and

 

   

the number of subordinated units.

For example, if a two-for-one split of the common units should occur, the minimum quarterly distribution, the target distribution levels and the initial unit price would each be reduced to 50.0% of its initial level. If we combine our common units into a lesser number of units or subdivide our common units into a greater number of units, we will combine or subdivide our subordinated units using the same ratio applied to the common units. Our partnership agreement provides that we do not make any adjustment by reason of the issuance of additional units for cash or property.

 

79


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

In addition, if as a result of a change in law or interpretation thereof, we or any of our subsidiaries is treated as an association taxable as a corporation or is otherwise subject to additional taxation as an entity for U.S. federal, state, local or non-U.S. income or withholding tax purposes, our general partner may, in its sole discretion, reduce the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels for each quarter by multiplying each distribution level by a fraction, the numerator of which is cash for that quarter (after deducting our general partner’s estimate of our additional aggregate liability for the quarter for such income and withholdings taxes payable by reason of such change in law or interpretation) and the denominator of which is the sum of (1) cash for that quarter, plus (2) our general partner’s estimate of our additional aggregate liability for the quarter for such income and withholding taxes payable by reason of such change in law or interpretation thereof. To the extent that the actual tax liability differs from the estimated tax liability for any quarter, the difference will be accounted for in distributions with respect to subsequent quarters.

Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation

General

If we dissolve in accordance with the partnership agreement, we will sell or otherwise dispose of our assets in a process called liquidation. We will first apply the proceeds of liquidation to the payment of our creditors. We will distribute any remaining proceeds to the unitholders and the holders of the incentive distribution rights, in accordance with their capital account balances, as adjusted to reflect any gain or loss upon the sale or other disposition of our assets in liquidation.

The allocations of gain and loss upon liquidation are intended, to the extent possible, to entitle the holders of units to a repayment of the initial value contributed by unitholders for their units in this offering, which we refer to as the “initial unit price” for each unit. The allocations of gain and loss upon liquidation are also intended, to the extent possible, to entitle the holders of common units to a preference over the holders of subordinated units upon our liquidation, to the extent required to permit common unitholders to receive their initial unit price plus the minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter during which liquidation occurs plus any unpaid arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units. However, there may not be sufficient gain upon our liquidation to enable the common unitholders to fully recover all of these amounts, even though there may be cash available for distribution to the holders of subordinated units. Any further net gain recognized upon liquidation will be allocated in a manner that takes into account the incentive distribution rights of our sponsor.

Manner of Adjustments for Gain

The manner of the adjustment for gain is set forth in the partnership agreement. If our liquidation occurs before the end of the subordination period, we will generally allocate any gain to the partners in the following manner:

 

   

first, to our general partner to the extent of certain prior losses specially allocated to our general partner;

 

   

second, to the common unitholders, pro rata, until the capital account for each common unit is equal to the sum of: (1) the initial unit price; (2) the amount of the minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter during which our liquidation occurs; and (3) any unpaid arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution;

 

   

third, to the subordinated unitholders, pro rata, until the capital account for each subordinated unit is equal to the sum of: (1) the initial unit price; and (2) the amount of the minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter during which our liquidation occurs;

 

   

fourth, to all unitholders, pro rata, until we allocate under this paragraph an amount per unit equal to: (1) the sum of the excess of the first target distribution per unit over the minimum quarterly distribution per unit for each quarter of our existence; less (2) the cumulative amount per unit of any distributions from operating surplus in excess of the minimum quarterly distribution per unit that we distributed to the unitholders, pro rata, for each quarter of our existence;

 

80


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

fifth, 85.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until we allocate under this paragraph an amount per unit equal to: (1) the sum of the excess of the second target distribution per unit over the first target distribution per unit for each quarter of our existence; less (2) the cumulative amount per unit of any distributions from operating surplus in excess of the first target distribution per unit that we distributed 85.0% to the unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to our general partner for each quarter of our existence;

 

   

sixth, 75.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until we allocate under this paragraph an amount per unit equal to: (1) the sum of the excess of the third target distribution per unit over the second target distribution per unit for each quarter of our existence; less (2) the cumulative amount per unit of any distributions from operating surplus in excess of the second target distribution per unit that we distributed 75.0% to the unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) for each quarter of our existence; and

 

   

thereafter, 50.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% to our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights).

The percentage interests set forth above for our sponsor assume our sponsor has not transferred the incentive distribution rights.

If the liquidation occurs after the end of the subordination period, the distinction between common units and subordinated units will disappear, so that clause (3) of the second bullet point above and all of the third bullet point above will no longer be applicable.

We may make special allocations of gain among the partners in a manner to create economic uniformity among the common units into which the subordinated units convert and the common units held by public unitholders.

Manner of Adjustments for Losses

If our liquidation occurs before the end of the subordination period, we will generally allocate any loss to our general partner and the unitholders in the following manner:

 

   

first, to holders of subordinated units in proportion to the positive balances in their capital accounts until the capital accounts of the subordinated unitholders have been reduced to zero;

 

   

second, to the holders of common units in proportion to the positive balances in their capital accounts, until the capital accounts of the common unitholders have been reduced to zero; and

 

   

thereafter, 100.0% to our general partner.

If the liquidation occurs after the end of the subordination period, the distinction between common units and subordinated units will disappear, so that all of the first bullet point above will no longer be applicable.

We may make special allocations of loss among the partners in a manner to create economic uniformity among the common units into which the subordinated units convert and the common units held by public unitholders.

 

81


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Adjustments to Capital Accounts

Our partnership agreement requires that we make adjustments to capital accounts upon the issuance of additional units. In this regard, our partnership agreement specifies that we allocate any unrealized and, for federal income tax purposes, unrecognized gain resulting from the adjustments to the unitholders and sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) in the same manner as we allocate gain upon liquidation. In the event that we make positive adjustments to the capital accounts upon the issuance of additional units, our partnership agreement requires that we generally allocate any later negative adjustments to the capital accounts resulting from the issuance of additional units or upon our liquidation in a manner which results, to the extent possible, in the partners’ capital account balances equaling the amount which they would have been if no earlier positive adjustments to the capital accounts had been made. By contrast to the allocations of gain, and except as provided above, we generally will allocate any unrealized and unrecognized loss resulting from the adjustments to capital accounts upon the issuance of additional units to the unitholders and our general partner based on their respective percentage ownership of us. In this manner, prior to the end of the subordination period, we generally will allocate any such loss equally with respect to our common and subordinated units. In the event we make negative adjustments to the capital accounts as a result of such loss, future positive adjustments resulting from the issuance of additional units will be allocated in a manner designed to reverse the prior negative adjustments, and special allocations will be made upon liquidation in a manner that results, to the extent possible, in our unitholders’ capital account balances equaling the amounts they would have been if no earlier adjustments for loss had been made.

 

82


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

SELECTED HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA

Hi-Crush Partners LP was formed in May 2012 and does not have historical financial statements. Therefore, in this prospectus we present the historical financial statements of our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, which is our accounting predecessor for financial reporting purposes. In connection with the closing of this offering, our sponsor will contribute all of the outstanding equity interests in certain of its operating subsidiaries, which account for substantially all of our sponsor’s historical business, to us. The following table presents summary historical financial and operating data of our sponsor and summary pro forma financial and operating data of Hi-Crush Partners LP as of the dates and for the periods indicated.

Our sponsor was formed in October 2010 to develop excavation, processing and logistics facilities for raw frac sand used in hydraulic fracturing operations in oil and natural gas wells. Since its formation, our sponsor acquired our assets in a number of separate acquisitions. As a result of our sponsor’s recent formation, we have limited operating history upon which you can base an evaluation of our current business and our future earnings prospects. This prospectus includes audited financial statements only as of December 31, 2011 and for the period from inception (October 28, 2010) to December 31, 2010 and unaudited financial information as of and for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2012 and 2011. In this prospectus, we refer to the period from inception to December 31, 2010 as the two-month period ended December 31, 2010. We have not completed or provided in this prospectus any stand-alone pre-acquisition financial statements for the assets we acquired in the transactions described above. As a result, and given our recent date of formation, we have not provided in this prospectus three years of audited financial statements that normally would be included in a prospectus forming part of an SEC registration statement or two years of audited financial statements as would normally be included in a prospectus forming part of an SEC registration statement filed by an emerging growth company.

The summary historical financial data presented as of December 31, 2010 and 2011, for the two-month period ended December 31, 2010 and for the year ended December 31, 2011 is derived from the audited historical financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC that are included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary historical financial data presented as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and 2012 are derived from the unaudited historical financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC included elsewhere in this prospectus.

The summary pro forma financial data presented as of and for the year ended December 31, 2011 and as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2012 is derived from our unaudited pro forma financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Our unaudited pro forma financial statements give pro forma effect to the following:

 

   

the contribution of Hi-Crush Chambers LLC, Hi-Crush Railroad LLC, Hi-Crush Wyeville LLC and Hi-Crush Operating LLC to us by our sponsor;

 

   

a reduction in general and administrative expenses as a result of allocations between our Wyeville facility and our sponsor’s other assets and activities that will not be contributed to us in connection with this offering;

 

   

the removal of other operating expenses of our sponsor related to assets and operations that will be retained by our sponsor following the completion of this offering;

 

   

the elimination of all cash and cash equivalents reflected on our balance sheet as of June 30, 2012, which will be retained by our sponsor; and

 

   

the issuance of              common units and              subordinated units to our sponsor.

Each of the adjustments described above are either directly related to this offering or are required by or are a consequence of the contribution to us by our sponsor of the Wyeville facility and related assets, the closing of which is a condition precedent to the closing of this offering.

 

83


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The unaudited pro forma balance sheet as of June 30, 2012 assumes the events listed above occurred as of June 30, 2012. The unaudited pro forma statements of income data for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012 assume the events listed above occurred as of January 1, 2011.

We have not given pro forma effect to incremental general and administrative expenses of approximately $2.1 million that we expect to incur annually as a result of operating as a publicly traded partnership, such as expenses associated with annual and quarterly reporting; tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution expenses; Sarbanes-Oxley compliance expenses; expenses associated with listing on the NYSE; independent auditor fees; legal fees; investor relations expenses; registrar and transfer agent fees; director and officer insurance expenses; and director and officer compensation expenses. We also have not given pro forma effect to additional general and administrative expenses that we expect to incur to support our recent expansion, including management level positions in operations, human resources, legal, accounting and reporting, as well as license fees associated with upgrading accounting and reporting software. We expect these incremental growth associated expenses to gradually increase over time as we hire additional personnel, from about $0.7 million for the year ending December 31, 2012 to $1.7 million on an annualized basis by September 30, 2013.

For a detailed discussion of the summary historical financial information contained in the following table, please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” The following table should also be read in conjunction with “Use of Proceeds,” “Business—Our History and Relationship with Our Sponsor” and the audited and unaudited historical financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and our unaudited pro forma financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Among other things, the historical and unaudited pro forma financial statements include more detailed information regarding the basis of presentation for the information in the following table.

 

84


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The following table presents non-GAAP financial measures, EBITDA and production costs, which we use in our business as important supplemental measures of our performance. EBITDA represents net income before interest expense, income taxes and depreciation and depletion. Production costs represents costs of goods sold, excluding depreciation and depletion. EBITDA and production costs are not calculated or presented in accordance with GAAP. We explain these measures under “—Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below and reconcile them to their most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP. Please also read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”

 

    Predecessor Historical     Hi-Crush Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
    Inception
to
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months
Ended
June 30,

2012
 
      2011     2012      
    (in thousands, except per unit and operating information)  

Statement of Operations Data:

           

Revenues

  $      $ 20,353      $      $ 34,175      $ 20,353      $ 34,175   

Production costs (1)

           5,998               9,603        5,998        9,603   

Depreciation and depletion

           449               668        449        668   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cost of goods sold

           6,447               10,271        6,447        10,271   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

           13,906               23,904        13,906        23,904   

General and administrative

    26        2,324        647        3,137        1,689        1,577   

Other operating expenses

           381               419                 

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

           28               12        28        12   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

    (26     11,173        (647     20,336        12,189        22,315   

Other expense:

           

Interest expense, net

           (1,893            (2,385              

Other

                                         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income (expense)

           (1,893            (2,385              

Income (loss) before tax expense

    (26     9,280        (647     17,951        12,189        22,315   

Income tax expense

                                         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ (26   $ 9,280      $ (647   $ 17,951      $ 12,189      $ 22,315   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pro forma net income per limited partner unit:

           

Common unit

           

Subordinated unit

           

Statement of Cash Flow Data:

           

Net cash provided by (used in):

           

Operating activities

  $ (14   $ 18,788      $ 15,781      $ 5,063       

Investing activities

    (322     (50,199     (28,775     (50,296    

Financing activities

    336        42,465        14,463        45,929       

Other Financial Data:

           

EBITDA (1)

  $ (26   $ 11,622      $ (647   $ 21,004      $ 12,638      $ 22,983   

Capital expenditures (2)

    72        50,169        28,745        50,326       

Operating Data:

           

Total tons sold

           332,593               539,257        332,593        539,257   

Average realized price (per ton)

  $      $ 61.19      $      $ 63.37      $ 61.19      $ 63.37   

Production costs (per ton) (1)

           18.03               17.81        18.03        17.81   

Balance Sheet Data (at period end):

           

Cash and cash equivalents

  $      $ 11,054      $ 1,469      $ 11,750        $   

Total assets

    614        72,229        36,497        142,914          72,328   

Long-term debt (including current portion)

           46,112       
15,185
  
    96,421        `          

Total liabilities

    304        61,942        36,571        114,902          5,981   

Members’/Partners’ capital

    310        10,287        (74     28,012          66,347   

 

(1) For more information, please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
(2) Expansion capital expenditures are capital expenditures made to increase the long-term operating capacity of our asset base whether through construction or acquisitions. Please read “How We Make Distributions to Our Partners—Capital Expenditures.”

 

85


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

For a discussion of the non-GAAP financial measure EBITDA, please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.” The following table presents a reconciliation of EBITDA to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, on a historical basis and pro forma basis, as applicable, for each of the periods indicated.

 

    Predecessor Historical     Hi-Crush Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
    Inception
to
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months Ended
June  30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months
Ended
June 30, 2012
 
            2011             2012          
    (in thousands)  

Reconciliation of EBITDA to net
income:

           

Net income (loss)

  $   (26   $ 9,280      $   (647   $ 17,951      $   12,189      $   22,315   

Depreciation and depletion

           449               668        449        668   

Income tax expense

                                         

Interest expense, net

           1,893               2,385                 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

EBITDA

  $   (26   $ 11,622      $ (647   $ 21,004      $ 12,638      $ 22,983   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

For a discussion of the non-GAAP financial measure production costs, please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.” The following table presents a reconciliation of production costs to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, on a historical basis and pro forma basis, as applicable, for each of the periods indicated.

 

    Predecessor Historical     Hi-Crush Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
    Inception
to
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months Ended
June  30,
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
    Six Months
Ended
June 30, 2012
 
            2011             2012          
    (in thousands, except operating information)  

Reconciliation of production costs to costs of goods sold:

           

Costs of goods sold

  $   —      $   6,447      $   —      $   9,603      $   6,447      $   9,603   

Depreciation and depletion

           449               668        449        668   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Production costs

  $   —      $ 5,998      $      $ 10,271      $ 5,998      $ 10,271   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs of goods sold per ton

    $ 19.38        $ 19.05      $ 19.38      $ 19.05   
   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Production costs per ton

    $ 18.03        $ 17.81      $ 18.03      $ 17.81   
   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

86


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF

FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

You should read the following discussion of our historical performance, financial condition and future prospects in conjunction with our predecessor’s audited financial statements as of December 31, 2010 and 2011, for the two-month period ended December 31, 2010 and for the year ended December 31, 2011 and our predecessor’s unaudited financial statements as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and 2012, and notes thereto, included elsewhere in this prospectus. The information provided below supplements, but does not form part of, our predecessor’s financial statements. This discussion contains forward-looking statements that are based on the views and beliefs of our management, as well as assumptions and estimates made by our management. Actual results could differ materially from such forward-looking statements as a result of various risk factors, including those that may not be in the control of management. For further information on items that could impact our future operating performance or financial condition, see the section entitled “Risk Factors” elsewhere in this prospectus.

Basis of Presentation

The following discussion of our historical performance and financial condition is derived from the historical financial statements of our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, which is our accounting predecessor for financial reporting purposes. Our sponsor is contributing some but not all of its assets and liabilities to us in connection with this offering. Accordingly, the historical financial results discussed below include capital expenditures and other costs related to assets that are not being contributed to us in connection with this offering as well as long-term debt and related expenses that will be retained by our sponsor following the completion of this offering. For additional information about the assets and liabilities reflected in our sponsor’s financial statements that will not be contributed to us in connection with this offering, please read our unaudited pro forma financial statements and the notes to those financial statements provided elsewhere in this prospectus.

In addition, our sponsor’s historical results of operations and cash flows are not indicative of results of operations and cash flows to be expected in the future because, in addition to the factors discussed above:

 

   

our Wyeville facility did not generate sales until we commenced operations in July 2011;

 

   

we completed an expansion of our Wyeville facility in March 2012, which significantly increased our production capacity and for which volumes are contracted;

 

   

we will incur general and administrative expenses as a publicly traded partnership that we have not previously incurred; and

 

   

we will incur additional general and administrative expenses as a result of our recent expansion that we expect to occur following the completion of this offering.

Unless otherwise indicated, references in this “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” to “Hi-Crush Partners LP,” “we,” “our,” “us” or like terms when used in a historical context refer to the business and results of operations of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, and when used in the present tense or prospectively, those terms refer to Hi-Crush Partners LP and its subsidiaries following the formation transactions described in “Summary—Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure.”

Overview

We are a pure play, low-cost, domestic producer of premium monocrystalline sand, a specialized mineral that is used as a proppant to enhance the recovery rates of hydrocarbons from oil and natural gas wells. Our reserves consist of “Northern White” sand, a resource existing predominately in Wisconsin and limited portions of the upper Midwest region of the United States, which is highly valued as a preferred proppant because it exceeds all API specifications. We own, operate and develop sand reserves and related excavation and processing facilities and will seek to acquire or develop additional facilities. Our 561-acre facility with integrated rail

 

87


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

infrastructure, located near Wyeville, Wisconsin, enables us to process and cost-effectively deliver approximately 1,600,000 tons of frac sand per year. Substantially all of our frac sand production is sold to leading investment grade-rated pressure pumping service providers under long-term, take-or-pay contracts that require our customers to pay a specified price for a specified volume of frac sand each month.

Our Assets and Operations

We own and operate the Wyeville facility, which is located in Monroe County, Wisconsin and, as of December 31, 2011, contained 48.4 million tons of proven recoverable sand reserves of mesh sizes we currently have contracted to sell. According to John T. Boyd, our proven reserves consist entirely of coarse grade Northern White sand (which is also referred to as “Ottawa” sand) exceeding API specifications. Analysis of our sand by independent third-party testing companies indicates that it demonstrates characteristics in excess of API specifications with regard to crush strength, turbidity and roundness and sphericity.

We acquired the Wyeville acreage and commenced construction of the Wyeville facility in January 2011. We completed construction of the Wyeville facility and commenced sand excavation and processing in June 2011 with an initial plant processing capacity of 950,000 tons per year, and customer shipments were initiated in July 2011. From the Wyeville in-service date to June 30, 2012, we have processed and sold 871,850 tons of frac sand. We completed an expansion in March 2012 that increased our annual expected processing capacity to approximately 1,600,000 tons per year. We have contracted approximately 91% of this capacity for the remainder of 2012 and through the second quarter of 2014, and approximately 71% of this capacity for the remainder of 2014 and through the second quarter of 2016. Based on currently contracted production rates and a reserve report prepared by John T. Boyd, our Wyeville facility has an implied 33-year reserve life as of December 31, 2011.

Overall Trends and Outlook

Demand

The North American proppant market, including raw frac sand, ceramic and resin-coated proppants, was approximately 22 million tons in 2011. Industry estimates for 2011 indicate that the raw frac sand market represented approximately 17 million tons, or 77.2% of the total proppant market by weight. Over the past five years, proppant demand by weight has increased by 28.0% annually, and the market is projected to continue growing by 7.2% per year through 2016, representing an increase of approximately nine million tons in annual proppant demand over that time period. The total North American proppant market size in dollars was $3.7 billion in 2011 and is projected to grow 10.5% annually through 2016, according to The Freedonia Group.

Demand growth for frac sand and other proppants is primarily due to advancements in oil and natural gas drilling and well completion technology and techniques, such as horizontal drilling and hydraulic fracturing. These advancements have made the extraction of oil and natural gas increasingly cost-effective in formations that historically would have been uneconomic to develop. Over the past five years, North American rig count has increased by 2.6% annually, while the demand for proppant by weight has grown at a rate of 28.0% annually. We believe that demand for proppant has and will continue to increase at a rate greater than rig count as a result of the following additional demand drivers:

 

   

improved drilling rig productivity, resulting in more wells drilled per rig per year;

 

   

increases in the percentage of rigs that are drilling horizontal wells;

 

   

increases in the length of the typical horizontal wellbore;

 

   

increases in the number of fracture stages per foot in the typical completed horizontal wellbore;

 

   

increases in the volume of proppant used per fracturing stage; and

 

   

recurring efforts to offset steep production declines in unconventional oil and natural gas reservoirs, including the drilling of new wells and secondary hydraulic fracturing of existing wells.

 

88


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Furthermore, recent growth in demand for raw frac sand has outpaced growth in demand for other proppants, and industry analysts predict that this trend will continue. According to The Freedonia Group, North American demand for all types of proppants, in dollar terms, is projected to increase 10.5% annually from 2011 through 2016, while demand for raw frac sand is projected to increase 12.1% annually over that time period. As well completion costs have increased as a proportion of total well costs, operators have increasingly looked for ways to improve per well economics by lowering costs without sacrificing production performance. To this end, the oil and natural gas industry is shifting away from the use of higher-cost proppants towards more cost-effective proppants, such as raw frac sand. The substantial increase in activity in North American oil and liquids-rich resource plays, has further accelerated the demand growth for raw frac sand. Within these oil and liquids-rich basins, Northern White sand with coarser mesh sizes is often preferred due to its performance characteristics.

Supply

As demand for raw frac sand has increased dramatically in recent years, the supply of raw frac sand has failed to keep pace, resulting in a supply-demand disparity. While a number of existing and new competitors have announced supply expansions and greenfield projects, we do not expect the magnitude of these expansions to meet expected demand. There are several key constraints to increasing raw frac sand production on an industry-wide basis, including:

 

   

the difficulty of finding frac sand reserves that meet API specifications;

 

   

the difficulty of securing contiguous frac sand reserves large enough to justify the capital investment required to develop a processing facility;

 

   

the challenges of identifying reserves with the above characteristics that either are located in close proximity to oil and natural gas reservoirs or have rail access needed for low-cost transportation to major shale basins;

 

   

the hurdles to securing mining, production, water, air, refuse and other federal, state and local operating permits from the proper authorities;

 

   

local opposition to development of facilities, especially those that require the use of on-road transportation, including moratoria on raw frac sand facilities in multiple counties in Wisconsin which hold potential sand reserves; and

 

   

the long lead time required to design and construct sand processing facilities that can efficiently process large quantities of high quality frac sand.

Pricing

Raw frac sand has exhibited steady pricing increases over the past decade. While there are numerous grades and sizes of proppant which sell at varying prices, the overall pricing trend tends to be consistent across the various grades and sizes. If demand for frac sand continues to grow faster than supply, then we expect that prices for frac sand will remain strong.

How We Generate Revenue

We generate revenue by excavating and processing frac sand, which we sell to our customers primarily under fixed price take-or-pay contracts, with current terms expiring between 2014 and 2018. During the period from July 21, 2011 through April 30, 2012, we delivered frac sand under such contracts to two customers, subsidiaries of Halliburton and Weatherford. Beginning May 1, 2012, we commenced shipments to two additional customers, subsidiaries of Baker Hughes and FTS International, under similar contracts. Each contract defines the minimum volume of frac sand that the customer is required to purchase monthly and annually, the volume that we are required to make available, the technical specifications of the product, the price per ton and liquidated damages in the event either we or the customer fails to meet minimum requirements. Prices in our current contracts are fixed for the entire term of the contracts. As a result, our revenue over the duration of these contracts may not follow broader industry pricing trends. Occasionally, if we have excess production and market conditions are favorable, we may elect to sell frac sand in spot market transactions.

 

89


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

As of December 31, 2011, our facility had the capacity to produce 950,000 tons per year, and we had 730,000 tons per year subject to existing long-term, take-or-pay contracts. In March 2012, we completed an expansion project to increase capacity to approximately 1,600,000 tons per year, and supported the expansion by signing contracts that increased annual contracted volumes for the remainder of 2012 and through the second quarter of 2014 to 1,460,000 tons, or approximately 91% of our production capacity. These contracts had a weighted average remaining life of 4.6 years as of June 30, 2012.

Due to sustained freezing temperatures in our area of operation during winter months, it is industry practice to halt excavation activities and operation of the wet plant during those months. As a result, we excavate and wash sand in excess of current delivery requirements during the months when those facilities are operational. This excess sand is placed in stockpiles that feed the dry plant and fill customer orders throughout the year. For more information, please read “Business—Assets and Business Operations—Processing Facilities.”

Costs of Conducting Our Business

The principal expenses involved in operating our business are excavation costs, labor, utilities, maintenance and royalties.

We have a contract with a third party to excavate raw frac sand, deliver the raw frac sand to our processing facility and move the sand from our wet plant to our dry plant. We pay a fixed price of $2.09 per ton excavated and delivered without regard to the amount of sand excavated that meets API specifications. Accordingly, we incur excavation costs with respect to the excavation of sand and other materials from which we ultimately do not derive revenue. However, the ratio of rejected materials to total amounts excavated has been, and we believe will continue to be, in line with our expectations, given the extensive core sampling and other testing we undertook at the Wyeville facility. For more information regarding our reserves testing procedures, please read “Business— Assets and Business Operations—Sand Reserves.”

We incurred excavation costs of $2.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2011. For the three months and six months ended June 30, 2012, we incurred $2.0 million and $2.3 million of excavation costs, respectively. We did not incur excavation costs for the three months or six months ended June 30, 2011.

Labor costs associated with employees at our processing facility represent the most significant cost of converting raw frac sand to finished product. We incurred labor costs of $1.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, $1.1 million for the three months ended June 30, 2012 and $2.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012. We did not incur any labor costs at the processing facility for the three months or six months ended June 30, 2011. We incur utility costs in connection with the operation of our processing facility, primarily electricity and natural gas, which are both susceptible to fluctuations. We incurred utility costs of $0.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, $0.4 million for the three months ended June 30, 2012 and $0.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012. We did not incur any utility costs for the three months or six months ended June 30, 2011. Our facilities require periodic scheduled maintenance to ensure efficient operation and to minimize downtime.

Excavation costs, direct and indirect labor, utilities and maintenance costs are capitalized as a component of inventory and are reflected in cost of goods sold when inventory is sold.

We initially paid royalties to third parties at an aggregate rate of $6.15 per ton of sand excavated, delivered at our on-site rail facility and paid for by our customers. We incurred royalties of $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, $1.9 million for the three months ended June 30, 2012 and $3.3 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012. We did not incur any royalties for the three months or six months ended June 30, 2011. Effective July 2012, we terminated certain royalty agreements for a one-time cash payment of $14.0 million, which will reduce our ongoing royalty costs from $6.15 to $2.50 per ton of sand excavated, delivered and paid for.

 

90


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Each customer takes delivery of purchased product when it is loaded on rail cars at our facility. As a result we generally do not incur shipping expenses.

We incur general and administrative costs related to our corporate operations.

How We Evaluate Our Operations

Gross Profit and Production Costs

Approximately 91% of our processing capacity at the Wyeville facility for the remainder of 2012 and through the second quarter of 2014 is contracted for sale under our existing fixed price, take-or-pay contracts with our customers, and 71% of our processing capacity is contracted for the remainder of 2014 through the second quarter of 2016. Excavation costs are fixed based on tons excavated, and royalties are generally fixed based on tons excavated, delivered and paid for. Accordingly, gross profit will primarily be affected by our ability to control other direct and indirect costs associated with processing frac sand. We also use production costs, which we define as costs of goods sold, excluding depreciation and depletion to measure our financial performance. We believe production costs is a meaningful measure because it provides a measure of operating performance that is unaffected by historical cost basis. Please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”

As a result, production volumes, costs of goods sold per ton, production costs per ton and gross profit are key metrics used by management to evaluate our results of operations.

EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow

We view EBITDA as an important indicator of performance. We define EBITDA as net income plus depreciation and depletion and interest and debt expense, net of interest income. See “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.” Although we have not quantified distributable cash flow on a historical basis, after the closing of this offering we intend to use distributable cash flow, which we define as EBITDA less cash paid for interest expense and maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, including accrual for reserve replacement, plus accretion of asset retirement obligations, to evaluate whether we are generating sufficient cash flow to support distributions to our unitholders. Distributable cash flow will not reflect changes in working capital balances. EBITDA is a supplemental measure utilized by our management and other users of our financial statements such as investors, commercial banks, research analysts and others, to assess the financial performance of our assets without regard to financing methods, capital structure or historical cost basis. Distributable cash flow is a supplemental measure used to measure the ability of our assets to generate cash sufficient to support our indebtedness and make cash distributions to our unitholders.

Note Regarding Non-GAAP Financial Measures

Production costs, EBITDA and distributable cash flow are not financial measures presented in accordance with GAAP. We believe that the presentation of these non-GAAP financial measures will provide useful information to investors in assessing our financial condition and results of operations. Costs of goods sold is the GAAP measure most directly comparable to production costs, net income is the GAAP measure most directly comparable to EBITDA and the GAAP measure most directly comparable to distributable cash flow is net cash provided by operating activities. Our non-GAAP financial measures should not be considered as alternatives to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure. Each of these non-GAAP financial measures has important limitations as analytical tools because they exclude some but not all items that affect the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures. You should not consider production costs, EBITDA or distributable cash flow in isolation or as substitutes for analysis of our results as reported under GAAP. Because production costs, EBITDA and distributable cash flow may be defined differently by other companies in our industry, our definitions of these non-GAAP financial measures may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies, thereby diminishing their utility. Please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”

 

91


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Factors Impacting Comparability of Our Financial Results

Our historical results of operations and cash flows are not indicative of results of operations and cash flows to be expected in the future, principally for the following reasons:

 

   

Our Wyeville facility did not generate sales until we commenced operations in July 2011. Our first shipment of frac sand to a customer from our Wyeville facility occurred on July 21, 2011. Accordingly, our financial statements for the two-month period ended December 31, 2010 reflect neither revenues nor costs of operations, and the financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2011 reflect operations only from July 21, 2011 through the end of the year.

 

   

We completed an expansion of our Wyeville facility in March 2012. In March 2012, we completed an expansion of our Wyeville facility that increased processing capacity from 950,000 to approximately 1,600,000 tons per year. In connection with that expansion, we increased our annual contracted volumes from 730,000 tons to 1,460,000 tons, or approximately 91% of our expanded processing capacity for the remainder of 2012 and through the second quarter of 2014, with delivery commencing under such contracts in May 2012. We processed and delivered 78,619 and 120,513 tons of frac sand in April and June of 2012, respectively.

 

   

Our historical financial results include certain capital expenditures and other costs related to assets outside of our Wyeville facility, which are not being contributed to us by our sponsor in connection with this offering. For the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012, we had capital expenditures that related to the acquisition, development and construction of property, plant and equipment at sites other than our Wyeville facility, which are not being contributed to us in connection with this offering, of approximately $1.7 million and $53.9 million, respectively. In addition, for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012, our sponsor incurred operating expenses, consisting of general and administrative expenses and exploration costs, in connection with these non-Wyeville operations of $1.0 million and $2.0 million, respectively.

 

   

Our historical financial results include long-term debt and related expenses that are not being contributed to us by our sponsor in connection with this offering. Our sponsor has indebtedness outstanding under various subordinated promissory notes and a senior secured revolving credit facility, all of which will be retained by our sponsor following the completion of this offering. For the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012, our sponsor incurred interest expense related to the subordinated promissory notes and senior secured credit facility of $1.9 million and $2.4 million, respectively. We do not expect to have any indebtedness outstanding as of the closing of this offering.

 

   

We terminated certain royalty agreements in July 2012, which resulted in a reduction in our royalty costs. Effective July 2012, we terminated certain royalty agreements for a one time cash payment of $14.0 million. The termination of these royalty agreements resulted in a reduction in our ongoing royalty costs from $6.15 per ton of sand excavated, delivered and paid for to $2.50 per ton of sand excavated, delivered and paid for. If we produce and sell 1,460,000 tons of frac sand annually, we would expect the reduction in our royalty costs due to the termination of these agreements will be $5.3 million per year.

 

   

We will incur additional general and administrative expenses as a publicly traded partnership. We expect we will incur approximately $2.1 million in additional general and administrative expenses as a publicly traded limited partnership that we have not previously incurred, including costs associated with compliance under the Exchange Act, annual and quarterly reports to unitholders, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution, investor relations, registrar and transfer agent fees, audit fees, incremental director and officer liability insurance costs and director and officer compensation. These incremental expenses exclude the costs of this offering, as well as the costs associated with the initial implementation of our Sarbanes-Oxley Section 404 internal control reviews and testing.

 

92


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

We will incur additional general and administrative expenses as a result of our recent expansion. We expect we will incur additional general and administrative expenses to support our recent expansion, including management level positions in operations, human resources, legal, accounting and reporting, as well as license fees associated with upgraded accounting and reporting software. We expect these incremental growth associated expenses to gradually increase over time as we hire additional personnel, from about $0.7 million for the year ending December 31, 2012 to $1.7 million on an annualized basis by September 30, 2013.

Results of Operations

The following table summarizes our revenue and expenses for the periods indicated.

 

     Inception to
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2011
     Six Months Ended  
        June 30,
2011
    June 30,
2012
 
     (in thousands)  

Revenues

   $      $ 20,353       $      $ 34,175   

Production costs (1)

            5,998                9,603   

Depreciation and depletion

            449                668   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs of goods sold

            6,447                10,271   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit (2)

            13,906                23,904   

General and administrative expenses

     26        2,324         647        3,137   

Accretion of asset retirement obligations

            28                12   

Other operating expenses

            381                419   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     (26     11,173         (647     20,336   

Interest expense, net

            1,893                2,385   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ (26   $ 9,280       $ (647   $ 17,951   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Production costs is defined as costs of goods sold, excluding depreciation and depletion. For more information, please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
(2) Gross profit equals revenues less costs of goods sold (including depreciation and depletion).

Six Months Ended June 30, 2012 Compared to Six Months Ended June 30, 2011

We were formed in October 2010 and commenced construction of our Wyeville facility in February 2011. We completed construction of our Wyeville facility and began selling sand to our customers in July 2011. Our historical financial statements for the six months ended June 30, 2011 reflect only start-up activities, reflected as general and administrative expenses, as we had no operations during such period.

Revenue

We commenced operations in July 2011 upon completion of our Wyeville facility. Accordingly, we had no revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2011. Revenue was $34.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012, during which we sold 539,257 tons of frac sand under four long-term, take-or-pay contracts, two of which commenced on May 1, 2012.

Production Costs

Production costs were $9.6 million, or $17.81 per ton sold, for the six months ended June 30, 2012. Please read “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.” The GAAP measure most directly comparable to production costs is costs of goods sold, which was $10.3 million, or $19.05 per ton sold, for the six months ended June 30, 2012. We did not process or sell any frac sand during the six months ended June 30, 2011, and accordingly incurred no production costs or costs of goods sold.

 

93


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Gross Profit

Gross profit equals revenues less costs of goods sold. Gross profit was $23.9 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012. We did not process or sell any frac sand during the six months ended June 30, 2011, and accordingly had no gross profit. Due to the nature of the fixed price, take-or-pay contracts with our customers, gross profit is primarily affected by royalties and the cost to excavate and process sand. We pay royalties to third parties based on the volume of sand excavated, delivered at our on-site rail facility and paid for by our customers. We have outsourced all excavation activities to a third party with primarily fixed terms. Our excavation costs per ton is fixed, with the exception of a fuel surcharge based on the price of diesel fuel. We incurred no surcharge for the six months ended June 30, 2012.

General and Administrative Expenses

General and administrative expenses increased $2.5 million from $0.6 million for the six months ended June 30, 2011 to $3.1 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012. We were in a start-up phase during the six months ended June 30, 2011 and did not incur the level of general and administrative expenses required to support an operating company.

Interest Expense

Our sponsor incurred $3.7 million of interest expense for the six months ended June 30, 2012, which includes interest on our sponsor’s senior secured credit facility, paid-in-kind interest under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes and amortization of deferred financing costs. Approximately $2.4 million was charged to interest expense and $1.3 million was capitalized related to the expansion of the Wyeville and Augusta facilities. The paid-in-kind interest is added to the outstanding balance of the notes. Our sponsor has the option of paying cash interest, but has not yet elected to do so. Our sponsor incurred interest on its indebtedness of $0.2 million during the six months ended June 30, 2011, all of which was capitalized in connection with the construction of the Wyeville facility. We do not expect to have any indebtedness outstanding as of the closing of this offering.

Net Income

Net income was $18.0 million for six months ended June 30, 2012 compared to a net loss of $0.6 million for the six months ended June 30, 2011.

Year Ended December 31, 2011 Compared to Period from Inception to December 31, 2010

We were formed in October 2010 and commenced construction of our Wyeville facility in February 2011. Our historical financial statements for the two months ended December 31, 2010 reflect only start-up activities, as we had no operations during such period. Given the limited nature of our activities during the two months ended December 31, 2010, we do not believe that we can provide a meaningful comparative analysis of such period against any comparable period in 2011. Accordingly, we have not provided such a comparison.

Revenue

The financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2011, reflect the operations of the facility from the date we commenced commercial operations in July 2011 to December 31, 2011. During such period, we sold 332,593 tons of frac sand under two long-term, take-or-pay contracts generating revenue of $20.4 million.

Production Costs

Production costs were $6.0 million, or $18.03 per ton sold, for the year ended December 31, 2011. See “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.” The GAAP measure most directly comparable to production costs is costs of goods sold, which was $6.5 million, or $19.38 per ton sold, for the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

94


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Gross Profit

Gross profit equals revenues less costs of goods sold. Gross profit was $13.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2011. Due to the nature of the fixed price, take-or-pay contracts with our customers, gross profit is primarily affected by royalties and the cost to excavate and process sand. We pay royalties to third parties based on the volume of sand excavated, delivered at our on-site rail facility and paid for by our customers. We have outsourced all excavation activities to a third party with primarily fixed terms. Our cost per ton excavated is fixed, with the exception of a fuel surcharge based on the price of diesel fuel. During the year ended December 31, 2011, the market price for diesel escalated which resulted in us paying the fuel surcharge. The total surcharge was $0.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2011.

General and Administrative Expenses

General and administrative expenses were $2.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2011.

Interest Expense

Our sponsor incurred $2.6 million of interest expense in the year ended December 31, 2011, which includes paid-in-kind interest under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes and amortization of deferred financing costs. Approximately $1.9 million was charged to interest expense and $0.7 million was capitalized in connection with the Wyeville facility construction. Paid-in-kind interest is added to the outstanding balance of the note and becomes due upon maturity. Our sponsor has the option of paying cash interest, but has not yet elected to do so. We do not expect to have any indebtedness outstanding as of the closing of this offering.

Net Income

Net income was $9.3 million for the year ended December  31, 2011.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Overview

Our sponsor’s principal liquidity requirements for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012 were to fund capital expenditures for the purchase of the Wyeville land, construction and expansion of the related sand processing facility, construction of railway spurs and to meet working capital needs. Our sponsor met its liquidity needs with a combination of funds generated through operations, proceeds from long-term indebtedness and prepayments under one of our long-term sales contracts.

We expect that our future principal uses of cash will be for working capital, capital expenditures, funding our debt service obligations and, following the completion of this offering, paying distributions to our unitholders. We intend to pay a minimum quarterly distribution of $        per common and subordinated unit per quarter, which equates to $        per quarter, or $        per year, based on the number of common and subordinated units to be outstanding immediately after completion of this offering, to the extent we have sufficient cash from our operations after establishment of cash reserves and payment of fees and expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. We do not have a legal or contractual obligation to pay this distribution. We expect our principal sources of liquidity will be cash generated by our operations, borrowings under a new revolving credit facility that we expect to enter into in connection with this offering and issuances of debt and equity securities, and we believe that cash from these sources will be sufficient to meet our short-term working capital requirements and long-term capital expenditure requirements.

 

95


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Working Capital

Working capital is the amount by which current assets exceed current liabilities and is a measure of our ability to pay our liabilities as they become due. We anticipate that at the closing of this offering all non-cash current assets related to the Wyeville operations and cash on hand equal to approximately $6.2 million remaining from a July 2012 prepayment of $8.3 million for volumes of sand by one of our customers, will be contributed to us. All other cash, all current assets relating to the Augusta facility and all other excluded assets will be retained by our sponsor. Our working capital was $2.8 million at December 31, 2011 and $4.4 million at June 30, 2012. Working capital included deferred revenue of $9.2 million at December 31, 2011 that was satisfied with the delivery of frac sand through June 2012. As such, no deferred revenue balance remained as of June 30, 2012. The following table presents the components of our working capital as of December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012.

 

    December 31, 2011     June 30, 2012  
    (in thousands)  

Current assets

   

Cash

  $ 11,054      $ 11,750   

Restricted cash

    30        —     

Accounts receivable

    4,026        11,618   

Inventories

    2,374        3,110   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

    294        2,047   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

    17,778        28,525   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current liabilities

   

Accounts payable

    4,954        13,752   

Accrued liabilities

    866        3,885   

Current portion of long-term debt

    —          6,500   

Deferred revenue

    9,178        —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

    14,998        24,137   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Working capital

  $ 2,780      $ 4,388   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accounts receivable increased by $7.6 million during the six months ended June 30, 2012, primarily due to an increase in frac sand volumes attributable to the March 2012 plant expansion. Substantially all of the incremental frac sand volume was sold to customers who do not prepay for deliveries.

Our inventory consists primarily of sand that has been excavated and processed through the wet plant. Because we do not excavate sand or operate the wet plant in the winter months, we excavate and process sand through the wet plant in excess of current needs throughout the year. This resulted in the increase in inventory from December 31, 2011 to June 30, 2012.

Accounts payable includes $11.4 million of capital related items as of June 30, 2012, primarily related to the construction by our sponsor of the Augusta facility, which will not be contributed to us in connection with this offering. This amount will be funded through our sponsor’s senior secured credit facility. Accounts payable included $1.8 million of capital related items as of December 31, 2011, primarily related to expansion of the Wyeville facility.

Deferred revenue represents prepayments from a customer for future deliveries of frac sand, the majority of which is not currently reflected in inventory. We received a prepayment of $16.5 million from one customer in the year ended December 31, 2011. We recognized approximately $7.3 million and $9.2 million of revenue related to this prepayment as we shipped sand in the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012, respectively.

Deferred revenue increased by $9.2 million in the year ended December 31, 2011, and subsequently decreased by $9.2 million in the six months ended June 30, 2012, representing a significant portion of the difference between operating income and net cash provided by operating activities in each of the respective periods.

 

96


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Operating Activities

Net cash provided by operating activities was $18.8 million and $5.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012, respectively. Operating cash flows include $9.3 million and $18.0 million in net earnings generated from the sale of frac sand to our customers in the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012, respectively. The net earnings in each period were offset by production costs, general and administrative expenses and cash interest expense, adjusted for changes in working capital to the extent they are positive or negative.

Investing Activities

Net cash used in investing activities was $50.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and $50.3 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012.

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2011
    Six Months
Ended
June 30, 2012
 
     (in thousands)  

Wyeville:

    

Expansion

   $ 9,811      $ 4,291   

Plant

     27,263        1,240   

Land

     8,939        185   

Rail & rail equipment

     5,232        267   

Assets to be retained by our sponsor:

    

Augusta

     312        53,879   

Other

     1,238        57   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total additions to PP&E

     52,795        59,919   

Non-cash capital expenditures (1)

     (2,626     (9,593
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash capital expenditures

   $ 50,169      $ 50,326   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Non-cash capital expenditures is primarily comprised of capital expenditures in accounts payable and will be funded in future periods.

Financing Activities

Net cash provided by financing activities was $42.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, which included $48.7 million of proceeds under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes and capital contributions of $0.7 million. Additionally, our sponsor incurred loan origination costs of $1.9 million and repaid $5.0 million of debt.

Net cash provided by financing activities was $45.9 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012, which included additional borrowings of $8.5 million under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes and $40.0 million in borrowings under the new senior secured credit facility, offset by a $1.3 million repayment of borrowings under the senior secured credit facility, $1.1 million of loan origination costs, and $0.2 million of owner distributions.

Off Balance Sheet Arrangements

We do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or are likely to have a material effect on our current or future financial condition, changes in financial condition, sales, expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

 

97


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Capital Requirements

We expect to pay $11.4 million in the third quarter of 2012 related to fixed asset additions that were capitalized in the six months ended June 30, 2012, all of which relates to the Augusta facility. The expansion of the Wyeville facility is complete, and accordingly we have no related capital expenditures planned for the remainder of the year ending December 31, 2012.

Credit Facilities

Our New Credit Facility

In connection with the completion of this offering, we intend to enter into a new $100.0 million senior secured revolving credit facility, with a term of four years. The credit facility will be available to fund working capital and general corporate purposes, including the making of certain restricted payments permitted therein. Our credit facility will have an accordion feature that will allow us to increase the available revolving borrowings under the facility up to an aggregate amount of $200.0 million in $5.0 million increments, subject to our receiving increased commitments from existing lenders or new commitments from new lenders and the satisfaction of certain other conditions. We expect our credit facility will be available for loans including a sublimit of $5.0 million for swing line loans, and, subject to a sublimit of $15.0 million, letters of credit. We expect that borrowings under our new revolving credit facility will be secured by substantially all of our assets.

We expect that loans under the credit facility will bear interest at a floating rate based upon our leverage ratio, equal to, at our option, either (a) a base rate plus a range from 150 to 250 basis points per annum or (b) a LIBOR rate, plus a range of 250 to 350 basis points. The base rate is established as the highest of (i) the U.S. prime rate, (ii) daily one-month LIBOR plus 100 basis points and (iii) the federal funds rate plus 0.50%. The unused portion of our credit facility will be subject to a commitment fee calculated based upon our leverage ratio ranging from 0.375% to 0.50% per annum. Upon any event of default, the interest rate shall, upon the request of the lenders holding a majority of the commitments, be increased by 2.0% per annum for the period during which the event of default exists.

We expect that the new credit facility will contain certain customary representations and warranties, affirmative covenants, negative covenants and events of default. We expect the negative covenants to include restrictions on our ability to incur additional indebtedness, acquire and sell assets, create liens, make investments and make distributions.

We also expect that our new credit facility will require us to maintain a leverage ratio (as such term is defined in our new revolving credit agreement) of not more than 3.00 to 1.00, which may increase to up to 3.50 to 1.00 during specified periods following a permitted acquisition, and a minimum interest coverage ratio (as such term is defined in our new revolving credit agreement) of not less than 2.50 to 1.00.

If an event of default (as such term is defined in our new revolving credit agreement) occurs, the agent would be entitled to take various actions, including the acceleration of amounts due under the credit facility, termination of the commitments under the credit facility and all remedial actions available to a secured creditor. We expect the events of default to include customary events for a financing agreement of this type, including, without limitation, payment defaults, material inaccuracies of representations and warranties, defaults in the performance of affirmative or negative covenants (including financial covenants), bankruptcy or related defaults, defaults relating to judgments, breach or nonperformance under a material contract and the occurrence of a change in control.

In connection with the credit facility, we and our subsidiaries expect to enter into certain customary ancillary agreements and arrangements, which, among other things, provide that the indebtedness, obligations and liabilities arising under or in connection with the facility are unconditionally guaranteed by our subsidiaries.

 

98


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our Sponsor’s Credit Facilities

Our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, which is our accounting predecessor for financial reporting purposes, is party to various subordinated promissory notes and a senior secured credit facility, which we describe below. We expect that upon the completion of this offering we will have no ongoing liabilities and obligations under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes and senior secured credit facility and that the liens on our assets securing borrowings under these agreements will be released.

Subordinated Promissory Notes. On July 20, 2011, our sponsor entered into various subordinated promissory notes with certain equity investors, including Avista Capital Partners, and their affiliates in an aggregate original principal amount of approximately $52.2 million. Borrowings under the subordinated promissory notes bear interest, at our sponsor’s option, at a rate of 10.0% for cash interest and 12.0% for paid-in-kind interest (“PIK interest”). As of December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012, there was $46.1 million and $57.7 million of outstanding indebtedness under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes, respectively. The outstanding balance includes $2.4 million and $5.5 million of PIK interest as of December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012, respectively. The subordinated promissory notes mature in July 2016.

Senior Secured Credit Facility. On April 6, 2012, our sponsor entered into a $62.5 million senior secured credit facility with Amegy Bank, National Association and a syndicate of other financial institutions. The senior secured credit facility consists of the following commitments: (1) a four-year $25.0 million term loan, (2) a four-year $30.0 million advancing term loan commitment and (3) a four-year $7.5 million revolving loan commitment. In addition, the senior secured credit facility includes sub-facilities providing for letters of credit and swing line borrowings of up to $5.0 million and $2.5 million, respectively.

Borrowings under our sponsor’s senior secured facility are collateralized by substantially all of our assets and bear interest at a floating rate based upon our sponsor’s leverage ratio equal to, at our sponsor’s option, either (a) a base rate plus a range from 225 basis points and 325 basis points per annum or (b) a Eurodollar rate, plus a range of 325 basis points to 425 basis points per annum. The base rate is established as the highest of (i) the U.S. prime rate, (ii) the federal funds rate plus 50 basis points and (iii) daily one-month LIBOR plus 100 basis points. The senior secured credit facility provides for a commitment fee of 0.5% on the unused portion.

In addition to the $25.0 million term loan that was immediately funded in April 2012, we drew down $15 million on the advancing term loan, the proceeds of which are to be used by our sponsor for certain identified capital expenditures and to fund general operations. If not repaid earlier, the outstanding principal amount is required to be repaid by April 6, 2016.

Customer Concentration

For the year ended December 31, 2011, sales to Halliburton accounted for 64.0% of total revenue, and sales to Weatherford accounted for 36.0% of total revenue. For the six months ended June 30, 2012, sales to Halliburton accounted for 52.9% of total revenue, while sales to Weatherford accounted for 31.0% of total revenue. In October 2011, we signed a long term, take-or-pay contract with a third customer, a subsidiary of Baker Hughes. In May 2012, we signed a one year take-or-pay contract with a fourth customer, a subsidiary of FTS International. Sales to Baker Hughes and FTS International accounted for the balance of revenue in the six months ended June 30, 2012. Based on contracted volumes and pricing, sales to Halliburton, Weatherford, Baker Hughes and FTS International will represent 49.1%, 20.9%, 18.2% and 11.8% of our contracted revenue in 2012, respectively. The terms of each contract provide for liquidated damages in the event that a customer does not purchase minimum monthly volumes of frac sand. The liquidated damages payable per ton of sand not purchased average approximately 75% of the contracted selling price per ton.

 

99


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Contractual Obligations

The following table presents our contractual obligations and other commitments as of December 31, 2011.

 

Contractual Obligations

   Total      Less than
1 year
     1-3 years      3-5 years      More than
5 years
 
     (in thousands)  

Long-term debt (1)

   $ 46,112       $       $     —       $ 46,112       $   

Land purchase agreement (2)

     6,250         6,250             —                   

Plant construction (3)

     4,300         4,300             —                   

Asset retirement obligations (4)

     832                     —                 832   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 57,494       $ 10,550       $     —       $ 46,112       $ 832   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) As of December 31, 2011 our sponsor had $46.1 million outstanding under its subordinated promissory notes. Borrowings under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes bear interest at a rate of 10% per annum if paid in cash, or 12% if paid-in-kind. Principal is payable in a single balloon payment due in July 2016. The balance under the subordinated promissory notes increased to $57.7 million as June 30, 2012. On April 6, 2012, our sponsor entered into a $62.5 million senior secured credit facility, of which $38.8 million is currently outstanding. Repayments of outstanding principal under our sponsor’s senior secured credit facility are required to be made quarterly, on March 31, June 30, September 30 and December 31 each year, based on a minimum of 5% of the borrowed original principal amount of the loan. In addition, our sponsor may be required to make additional annual repayments of outstanding principal on May 15 of each year, depending on its level of excess cash flows, as defined in the related credit agreement. If not repaid earlier, the outstanding principal amount is required to be repaid by April 6, 2016. Neither our sponsor’s senior secured credit facility nor its subordinated promissory notes will be contributed to, or assumed by, us in connection with this offering, and we expect to have no indebtedness outstanding as of the closing of this offering.
(2) Our sponsor signed a purchase agreement for approximately 700 acres of land in Tomah, Wisconsin. Our sponsor expects to fund the purchase price in the third quarter of 2012. This land will not be contributed to us in connection with this offering.
(3) As of December 31, 2011, we had $4.3 million of remaining contractual commitments related to the expansion of the Wyeville facility and the purchase of related equipment. Additionally, during the six months ended June 30, 2012, our sponsor entered into contracts related to the construction of the Augusta facility in the amount of $37.0 million, under which approximately $22.0 million in remaining payments are expected to become due as construction is completed in the third quarter of 2012.
(4) The asset retirement obligation represents the fair value of post closure reclamation and site restoration commitments for the Wyeville property and processing facility.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure of Market Risks

Market risk is the risk of loss arising from adverse changes in market rates and prices. Historically, our sponsor’s risks have been predominantly related to potential changes in the fair value of its long-term debt due to fluctuations in applicable market interest rates. Going forward our market risk exposure generally will be limited to those risks that arise in the normal course of business, as we do not engage in speculative, non-operating transactions, nor do we utilize financial instruments or derivative instruments for trading purposes.

The market for frac sand is indirectly exposed to fluctuations in the prices of crude oil and natural gas to the extent such fluctuations impact drilling and completion activity levels and thus impact the activity levels of our customers in the pressure pumping industry. However, because we generate substantially all of our revenues under long-term, take-or-pay contracts, we believe we have only limited exposure to short-term fluctuations in the prices of crude oil and natural gas. We do not intend to hedge our indirect exposure to commodity risk.

 

100


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Interest Rate Risk

As of June 30, 2012, our sponsor had $57.7 million in fixed rate long-term debt outstanding under its subordinated promissory notes, which is due July 2016 and bears interest at a fixed rate of 10% per annum for cash interest and 12% per annum for PIK interest. The fair value of our fixed rate long-term debt at June 30, 2012 was approximately $64.9 million, reflecting the application of current interest rates offered for debt with similar remaining terms and maturities. As an indication of this debt’s sensitivity to changes in interest rates, based upon an immediate 50 basis point increase in the applicable interest rates at June 30, 2012, the fair value of our sponsor’s fixed rate long-term debt would have decreased by approximately $1.2 million. Conversely, a 50 basis point decrease in that rate would increase the fair value of this indebtedness by $1.2 million.

On April 6, 2012, our sponsor entered into a $62.5 million senior secured credit facility with Amegy Bank, National Association and a syndicate of other financial institutions. Our sponsor’s senior secured credit facility consists of the following commitments on the part of the lending banks: (1) a four-year $25.0 million term loan, (2) a four-year $30.0 million advancing term loan commitment and (3) a four-year $7.5 million revolving loan commitment. In addition, the credit facility includes sub-facilities providing for letters of credit and swing line borrowings of up to $5.0 million and $2.5 million, respectively. Borrowings under our sponsor’s senior secured credit facility bear interest at a floating rate based upon our sponsor’s leverage ratio equal to, at our sponsor’s option, either (a) a base rate plus a range from 225 basis points and 325 basis points per annum or (b) a Eurodollar rate, plus a range of 325 basis points to 425 basis points per annum. The base rate is established as the highest of (i) the U.S. prime rate, (ii) the federal funds rate plus 50 basis points and (iii) daily one-month LIBOR plus 100 basis points. As of June 30, 2012, our sponsor had $38.8 million in outstanding borrowings under its senior secured credit facility at a weighted average interest rate of 3.6%. The carrying value of these borrowings approximates their fair value due to the applicable floating interest rate. See Note 6– Long-Term Debt to our condensed consolidated financial statements included in this registration statement for further discussion of this indebtedness.

We do not expect to have any liabilities or obligations under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes and senior secured credit facility following the completion of this offering. We expect to have no indebtedness outstanding as of the closing of this offering.

Credit Risk

Substantially all of our revenue for the year ended December 31, 2011 was generated through long-term, take-or-pay contracts with two customers. We also signed a long-term, take-or-pay contract in October 2011 with a third customer and a one year take-or-pay contract in May 2012 with a fourth customer, for which shipments commenced in May 2012. One of these customers is not investment grade. Sales to these new customers accounted for 16.1% of revenue in the six months ended June 30, 2012. All of our customers are pressure pumping service providers. This concentration of counterparties operating in a single industry may increase our overall exposure to credit risk, in that the counterparties may be similarly affected by changes in economic, regulatory or other conditions. If a customer defaults or if any of our contracts expires in accordance with its terms, and we are unable to renew or replace these contracts, our gross profit and cash flows, and our ability to make cash distributions to our unitholders may be adversely affected.

Internal Controls and Procedures

Prior to the completion of this offering, our sponsor has been a private company with limited accounting personnel to adequately execute our accounting processes and limited other supervisory resources with which to address our internal control over financial reporting. As such, we have not maintained an effective control environment in that the design and execution of our controls has not consistently resulted in effective review and supervision by individuals with financial reporting oversight roles. In connection with our sponsor’s audit for the year ended December 31, 2011, our sponsor’s independent registered public accounting firm identified and

 

101


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

communicated a material weakness related to the failure to maintain a sufficient complement of qualified accounting personnel, which contributed to our sponsor’s inability to maintain appropriate segregation of duties within the organization and effective review and supervision over the financial reporting process. A “material weakness” is a deficiency, or combination of deficiencies, in internal controls such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of our sponsor’s financial statements will not be prevented, or detected in a timely basis. This material weakness resulted in audit adjustments to our financial statements which were identified by our independent registered public accounting firm.

At the closing of this offering, our management team and financial reporting oversight personnel will be the same as those of our sponsor and thus, we may face the same material weakness described above.

Since March 2012, we have added several experienced accounting personnel, both full-time employees and contractors, in response to our identification of gaps in our skills base and expertise of the staff required to meet the financial reporting requirements of a public company. However, our evaluation of internal control over financial reporting is not complete and we expect remediation to continue.

While we have begun the process of evaluating our internal control over financial reporting, we are in the early phases of our review and will not complete our review until after this offering is completed. We cannot predict the outcome of our review at this time. During the course of the review, we may identify additional control deficiencies, which represent significant deficiencies and other material weaknesses, in addition to the material weakness previously identified, that require remediation by us. Our remediation efforts may not enable us to remedy or avoid material weaknesses or significant deficiencies in the future.

We are not currently required to comply with the SEC’s rules implementing Section 404 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, and are therefore not required to make a formal assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting for that purpose. Upon becoming a public company, we will be required to comply with the SEC’s rules implementing Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, which will require our management to certify financial and other information in our quarterly and annual reports and provide an annual management report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. We will not be required to make our first assessment of our internal control over financial reporting until the year following our first annual report required to be filed with the SEC. To comply with the requirements of being a public company, we will need to implement additional financial and management controls, reporting systems and procedures and hire additional accounting, finance and legal staff.

Further, our independent registered public accounting firm is not yet required to formally attest to the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting, and will not be required to do so for as long as we are an “emerging growth company” pursuant to the provisions of the JOBS Act. Please read “Summary—Emerging Growth Company Status.”

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In May 2011, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820): Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in US GAAP and IFRS, which clarifies Topic 820 and provides guidance on changes to certain principles or requirements for measuring fair value. The amendment is effective during interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. We adopted this guidance as of and for the three months ended March 31, 2012. The adoption of this guidance did not have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements.

New and Revised Financial Accounting Standards

We qualify as an “emerging growth company” pursuant to the provisions of the JOBS Act, enacted on April 5, 2012. Section 102 of the JOBS Act provides that an “emerging growth company” can take advantage of

 

102


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

the extended transition period provided in Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act for complying with new or revised accounting standards. However, we are choosing to “opt out” of such extended transition period, and as a result, we will comply with new or revised accounting standards on the relevant dates on which adoption of such standards is required for non-emerging growth companies. Our election to “opt-out” of the extended transition period is irrevocable.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

The discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations is based on our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally acceptable in the United States of America. The preparation of these financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the dates of the financial statements and the reported revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. We evaluate these estimates and assumptions on an ongoing basis and base our estimates on historical experience, current conditions and various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances. The results of these estimates form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities as well as identifying and assessing the accounting treatment with respect to commitments and contingencies. Our actual results may materially differ from these estimates.

Listed below are the accounting policies we believe are critical to our financial statements due to the degree of uncertainty regarding the estimates or assumptions involved, and that we believe are critical to the understanding of our operations.

Asset Retirement Obligation

We estimate the future cost of dismantling, restoring and reclaiming operating excavation sites and related facilities in accordance with federal, state and local regulatory requirements. We record the initial estimated present value of reclamation costs as an asset retirement obligation and increase the carrying amount of the related asset by a corresponding amount. We allocate reclamation costs to expense over the life of the related assets and adjust the related liability for changes resulting from the passage of time and revisions to either the timing or amount of the original present value estimate. If the asset retirement obligation is settled for more or less than the carrying amount of the liability, a loss or gain will be recognized, respectively.

Inventory Valuation

Sand inventory is stated at the lower of cost or market using the average cost method. Costs applied to inventory include direct excavation costs, processing costs, overhead allocation, depreciation and depletion. Stockpile tonnages are calculated by measuring the number of tons added and removed from the stockpile. Tonnages are verified periodically by an independent surveyor. Costs are calculated on a per ton basis and are applied to the stockpiles based on the number of tons in the stockpile.

Spare parts inventory includes critical spares, materials and supplies. We account for spare parts on a first in first out basis, and value the inventory at the lower of cost or market.

Depletion

We amortize the cost to acquire land and mineral rights using a units of production method, based on the total estimated reserves and tonnage extracted each period.

 

103


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

We periodically evaluate whether current events or circumstances indicate that the carrying value of our property, plant and equipment and mineral rights may not be recoverable. If circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable, we estimate future undiscounted net cash flows using estimates of proven sand reserves, estimated future sales prices (considering historical and current prices, price trends and related factors) and operating costs and anticipated capital expenditures. We record a reduction in the carrying value of our long lived assets if the undiscounted cash flows are less than the carrying value of the assets.

Our estimates of prices, recoverable proven reserves and operating and capital costs are subject to certain risks and uncertainties which may affect the recoverability of our long lived assets. Although we have made our best estimate of these factors based on current conditions, it is reasonably possible that changes could occur, which could adversely affect our estimate of the net cash flows expected to be generated from our operating property. No impairment charges were recorded during the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2011 or the six-month period ended June 30, 2012.

Environmental Matters

We are subject to various federal, state and local laws and regulations governing, among other things, hazardous materials, air and water emissions, environmental contamination and reclamation and the protection of the environment and natural resources. We have made, and expect to make in the future, expenditures to comply with such laws and regulations, but cannot predict the full amount of such future expenditures.

 

104


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

PROPPANT INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

Our Industry

The oil and natural gas proppant industry is comprised of businesses involved in the mining or manufacturing of the propping agents used in the drilling and completion of oil and natural gas wells. Hydraulic fracturing is the most widely used method for stimulating increased production from wells. The process consists of pumping fluids, mixed with granular proppants, into the geologic formation at pressures sufficient to create fractures in the hydrocarbon-bearing rock. Proppant-filled fractures create conductive channels through which the hydrocarbons can flow more freely from the formation into the wellbore and then to the surface.

Types of Proppant

There are three primary types of proppant that are commonly utilized in the hydraulic fracturing process: raw frac sand, which is the product we produce, resin-coated sand and manufactured ceramic beads. The following chart illustrates the composition of the North American market for proppant by type.

2011 Proppant Consumed by Weight

 

LOGO

Source: The Freedonia Group

Raw Frac Sand

Of the three primary types of proppant, raw frac sand is the most widely used due to its broad applicability in oil and natural gas wells and its cost advantage relative to other proppants. Raw frac sand may be used as a proppant in all but the highest pressure and temperature drilling environments, such as in the Haynesville shale, and has been employed in nearly all major U.S. oil and natural gas producing basins, including the Barnett, Eagle Ford, Fayetteville, Granite Wash, Marcellus, Niobara, Permian, Utica, Williston and Woodford basins.

Raw frac sand is generally mined from the surface or underground, and in some cases crushed, and then cleaned and sorted into consistent mesh sizes. The API has a range of guidelines it uses to evaluate frac sand grades and mesh sizes. In order to meet API specifications, frac sand must meet certain thresholds related to crush strength (ability to withstand high pressures), roundness and sphericity (facilitates hydrocarbon flow, or conductivity), particle size distribution, and turbidity (low levels of contaminants). Oil and gas producers generally require that frac sand used in their drilling and completion processes meet API specifications.

Raw frac sand can be further delineated into two main types: Northern White and Brady Brown. Northern White, which is the type of frac sand we produce, is considered to be of higher quality than Brady Brown and is known for its high crush strength, turbidity, roundness and sphericity and monocrystalline grain structure. Brady Brown has historically been considered the lower quality raw frac sand, as it is less monocrystalline in nature,

 

105


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

more angular, has a lower crush strength and often contains greater impurities, including feldspars and clays. Due to its quality, Northern White frac sand commands premium prices relative to Brady Brown. Northern White has historically experienced the greatest market demand relative to supply, due both to its superior physical characteristics and the fact that it is a limited resource that exists predominately in Wisconsin and other limited parts of the upper Midwest region of the United States. However, even within this superior class of Northern White sand, the quality of Northern White can vary significantly across deposits due to the differing geological processes that formed the various Northern White reserves.

The term “Northern White” is a commonly-used designation for premium white sand produced in Wisconsin and other limited parts of the upper Midwest region of the United States. Within the industry, a common alternative term for “Northern White” sand is “Ottawa” sand, a term that originated due to the high percentage of operating sand plants in or near Ottawa, Illinois, but is now often used interchangeably with the term “Northern White” sand to encompass all of the premium white sands produced throughout the upper Midwest region of the United States.

Resin-Coated Frac Sand

Resin-coated frac sand consists of raw frac sand that is coated with a flexible resin that increases the sand’s crush strength and prevents crushed sand from dispersing throughout the fracture. The strength and shape of the end product are largely determined by the quality of the underlying raw frac sand. Pressured (or tempered) resin-coated sand primarily enhances crush strength, thermal stability and chemical resistance, allowing the sand to perform under harsh downhole conditions. Curable (or bonding) resin-coated frac sand uses a resin that is designed to bond together under closure stress and high temperatures, preventing proppant flowback. In general, resin-coated frac sand is better suited for higher pressure, higher temperature drilling operations commonly associated with deep wells and natural gas wells. In 2011, pricing for resin-coated frac sand was $300 to $800 per ton.

Ceramics

Ceramic proppant is a manufactured product of comparatively consistent size and spherical shape that typically offers the highest crush strength relative to other types of proppants. As a result, ceramic proppant use is most applicable in the highest pressure and temperature drilling environments. Ceramic proppant derives its product strength from the molecular structure of its underlying raw material and is designed to withstand extreme heat, depth and pressure environments. The deepest, highest temperature and highest pressure wells typically require heavy weight ceramics with high alumina/bauxite content and coarser mesh sizes. The lower crush resistant ceramic proppants are lighter weight and derived from kaolin clay, with densities closer to raw frac sand. In 2011, pricing for ceramic proppants was $500 to $1,200 per ton, with bauxite-based, heavy grade ceramics commanding the highest prices.

 

106


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Comparison of Key Proppant Characteristics

The following table sets forth what we believe to be the key comparative characteristics of our frac sand and the three primary types of proppant.

 

     Hi-Crush Wyeville   Raw Frac Sand   Resin-Coated   Ceramics
Product and Characteristics   • Natural resource –

   Northern White sand

 

• Considered highest

   quality raw frac sand

 

• Monocrystalline

   in nature,

   exhibiting crush

   strength, turbidity

   and roundness

   and sphericity in

   excess of API

   specifications

  •   Natural resource

 

•   Primary types include

   Northern White,

   Brady Brown

 

•   Quality of sand varies

   widely depending

   on source

  • Raw frac sand

   substrate with resin

   coating

 

• Coating increases

   crush strength

 

• Bond together to

   prevent proppant

   flowback

  •   Manufactured

   product

 

•   Typically highest

   crush strength

2012 Pricing(1)

  $65/ton(2)   $35 to $140/ton   $390 to $620/ton   $640 to $980/ton

Crush Strength

  9,000 to 12,000 psi   5,000 to 12,000 psi   10,000 to 15,000 psi   10,000 to 18,000 psi

 

(1) Pricing through the first quarter of 2012 for raw frac sand, resin-coated and ceramics per independent industry report.
(2) Represents 2012 average price per ton for Wyeville freight on board at the mine site under our long-term, take-or-pay contracts.

Proppant Mesh Sizes

Mesh size is used to describe the size of the proppant and is determined by sieving the proppant through screens with uniform openings corresponding to the desired size of the proppant. Each type of proppant comes in various sizes, categorized as mesh sizes, and the various mesh sizes are used in different applications in the oil and natural gas industry. Generally, larger mesh sizes are used in wells targeting oil and liquids-rich formations, and smaller mesh sizes are used in wells targeting primarily gas bearing formations. The mesh number system is a measure of the number of equally sized openings there are per square inch of screen through which the proppant is sieved. For example, a 30 mesh screen has 30 equally sized openings per linear inch. Therefore, as the mesh size increases, the granule size decreases. In order to meet API specifications, 90% of the proppant described as 30/50 mesh size proppant must consist of granules that will pass through a 30 mesh screen but not through a 50 mesh screen.

Frac Sand Extraction, Processing and Distribution

Raw frac sand is a naturally occurring mineral that is mined and processed. While the specific extraction method utilized depends primarily on the geologic setting, most raw frac sand is mined using conventional open-pit bench extraction methods. The composition, depth and chemical purity of the sand also dictate the processing method and equipment utilized. For example, broken rock from a sandstone deposit may require one, two or three stages of crushing to produce sand grains required to meet API specifications. In contrast, unconsolidated deposits, like those found at our Wyeville facility, may require little or no crushing during the excavation process. After extraction, the raw frac sand is washed with water to remove fine impurities such as clay and organic particles, with additional procedures used when contaminants are not easily removable. The final steps in the production process involve the drying and sorting of the raw frac sand according to mesh size.

Most frac sand is shipped in bulk from the processing facility to customers by truck, rail or barge. For bulk raw frac sand, transportation costs often represent a significant portion of the customer’s overall product cost. Consequently, shipping in large quantities, particularly when shipping over long distances, provides a significant

 

107


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

cost advantage to the customer, which highlights the importance of rail or barge access for low cost delivery. As a result, facility location and logistics capabilities are among the most important considerations for producers and customers.

Demand Trends

The North American proppant market, including raw frac sand, ceramic and resin-coated proppants, was approximately 22 million tons in 2011. Industry estimates for 2011 indicate that the raw frac sand market represented approximately 17 million tons, or 77.2% of the total proppant market by weight. Over the past five years, proppant demand by weight has increased by 28.0% annually, and the market is projected to continue growing by 7.2% per year through 2016, representing an increase of approximately nine million tons in annual proppant demand over that time period. The total North American proppant market size in dollars was $3.7 billion in 2011 and is projected to grow 10.5% annually through 2016, according to The Freedonia Group. The following chart illustrates historical and forecasted proppant demand for certain years from 2001 to 2021.

Historical and Projected Proppant Demand

 

LOGO

Source: The Freedonia Group

Demand growth for frac sand and other proppants is primarily due to advancements in oil and natural gas drilling and well completion technology and techniques, such as horizontal drilling and hydraulic fracturing. These advancements have made the extraction of oil and natural gas increasingly cost-effective in formations that historically would have been uneconomic to develop. Proppant is an essential component in the exploitation of unconventional oil and gas reservoirs, and the demand for proppant has increased as more of these reservoirs have been developed. Over the past five years, North American rig count has increased by 2.6% annually and is expected to continue growing by 3.5% annually through 2016. In addition to an increase in rig count, the percentage of active drilling rigs used to drill horizontal wells, which require greater volumes of proppant than vertical wells, has increased from 17.3% in 2006 to 57.4% in 2011. While the aggregate rig count has exhibited consistent growth, the number of rigs drilling for natural gas has recently declined to its lowest level in 13 years as a result of low natural gas prices, while the number of rigs drilling for oil has more than offset this decline as a result of relatively high prices for oil. To the extent that the recent fluctuations in global crude oil prices develop into a prolonged decline, this drop could result in a reduction in the growth rate of active oil rigs and a decline in the number of active oil rigs from current levels. The following chart identifies growth in North American rig count since 2001 and projected growth through 2021.

 

108


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Historical and Projected North American Rig Count

LOGO

Source: The Freedonia Group and Baker Hughes.

As indicated above, over the past five years, North American rig count has increased by 2.6% annually, while the demand for proppant by weight has grown at a rate of 28.0% annually. We believe that demand for proppant has and will continue to increase at a rate greater than rig count as a result of the following additional demand drivers:

 

   

improved drilling rig productivity, resulting in more wells drilled per rig per year;

 

   

increases in the percentage of rigs that are drilling horizontal wells;

 

   

increases in the length of the typical horizontal wellbore;

 

   

increases in the number of fracture stages per foot in the typical completed horizontal wellbore;

 

   

increases in the volume of proppant used per fracturing stage; and

 

   

recurring efforts to offset steep production declines in unconventional oil and natural gas reservoirs, including the drilling of new wells and secondary hydraulic fracturing of existing wells.

The following table illustrates the historical and projected growth in North American wells drilled and the intensity of proppant use in those wells.

Historical and Projected North American Wells and Proppant Intensity

LOGO

Source: The Freedonia Group

Wells in unconventional reservoirs are characterized by high initial production rates followed by a steep decline in production rates during the first several years of the well’s life. Producers must continually drill new wells to offset production declines and maintain overall production levels. Additionally, operators are beginning to perform secondary hydraulic fracturing of existing wells in order to maintain overall production levels. We believe these efforts to offset steep production declines in unconventional oil and gas reservoirs will be a strong driver of future proppant demand growth.

 

109


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Recent growth in demand for raw frac sand has outpaced growth in demand for other proppants, and industry analysts predict that this trend will continue. According to The Freedonia Group, North American demand for all types of proppants, in dollar terms, is projected to increase 10.5% annually from 2011 through 2016, while demand for raw frac sand is projected to increase 12.1% annually over that time period. As well completion costs have increased as a proportion of total well costs, operators have increasingly looked for ways to improve per well economics by lowering costs without sacrificing production performance. To this end, the oil and natural gas industry is shifting away from the use of higher-cost proppants towards more cost-effective proppants, such as raw frac sand. The substantial increase in activity in North American oil and liquids-rich resource plays has further accelerated the demand growth for raw frac sand. Within these oil and liquids-rich basins, Northern White sand with coarser mesh sizes is often preferred due to its performance characteristics.

Supply Trends

As demand for raw frac sand has increased dramatically in recent years, the supply of raw frac sand has failed to keep pace, resulting in a supply-demand disparity. While a number of existing and new competitors have announced supply expansions and greenfield projects, we do not expect the magnitude of these expansions to meet expected demand. There are several key constraints to increasing raw frac sand production on an industry-wide basis, including:

 

   

the difficulty of finding frac sand reserves that meet API specifications;

 

   

the difficulty of securing contiguous frac sand reserves large enough to justify the capital investment required to develop a processing facility;

 

   

the challenges of identifying reserves with the above characteristics that either are located in close proximity to oil and natural gas reservoirs or have rail access needed for low-cost transportation to major shale basins;

 

   

the hurdles to securing mining, production, water, air, refuse and other federal, state and local operating permits from the proper authorities;

 

   

local opposition to development of facilities, especially those that require the use of on-road transportation, including moratoria on raw frac sand facilities in multiple counties in Wisconsin which hold potential sand reserves; and

 

   

the long lead time required to design and construct sand processing facilities that can efficiently process large quantities of high quality frac sand.

Furthermore, supplies of premium quality Northern White sands are limited to select areas, predominantly in western Wisconsin and selected areas of Minnesota and Illinois. The ability to obtain large contiguous reserves in these areas is a key constraint and can be particularly important for enabling the permitting and economic viability of a raw frac sand facility. At our Wyeville facility, we have been able to secure 561 acres and can excavate and process all sand on site, with no need to employ costly trucking transportation on local roads.

In part due to the community opposition and factors referenced above, permitting has recently become more challenging in Wisconsin. Several counties in the state have instituted moratoria on the permitting of new frac sand mining sites. While these moratoria have the potential to hinder the permitting of new facilities and slow increases in supply of frac sand, our Wyeville facility is fully permitted and complies with all current regulatory requirements. In addition, our sponsor has been successful in permitting and building the Augusta facility, which required obtaining an exemption to an in-place county moratorium. Our success in obtaining this exemption was a result of our management team’s experience in excavation and processing facility development, siting and permitting as well as our on-site approach to excavation and logistics, which minimizes community impact during the production process.

 

110


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Pricing

Raw frac sand has exhibited steady pricing increases over the past decade. While there are numerous grades and sizes of proppant which sell at varying prices, the overall pricing trend tends to be consistent across the various sizes. If demand for frac sand continues to grow faster than supply, then we expect that prices for frac sand will remain strong.

 

111


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

BUSINESS

Overview

We are a pure play, low-cost, domestic producer of premium monocrystalline sand, a specialized mineral that is used as a proppant to enhance the recovery rates of hydrocarbons from oil and natural gas wells. Our reserves consist of Northern White sand, a resource existing predominately in Wisconsin and limited portions of the upper Midwest region of the United States, which is highly valued as a preferred proppant because it exceeds all API specifications. We own, operate and develop sand reserves and related excavation and processing facilities and will seek to acquire or develop additional facilities. Our 561-acre facility with integrated rail infrastructure, located near Wyeville, Wisconsin, enables us to process and cost-effectively deliver approximately 1,600,000 tons of frac sand per year. Substantially all of our frac sand production is sold to leading investment grade-rated pressure pumping service providers under long-term, take-or-pay contracts that require our customers to pay a specified price for a specified volume of frac sand each month.

Over the past decade, exploration and production companies have increasingly focused on exploiting the vast hydrocarbon reserves contained in North America’s unconventional oil and natural gas reservoirs through advanced techniques, such as horizontal drilling and hydraulic fracturing. In recent years, this focus has resulted in exploration and production companies drilling more and longer horizontal wells, completing more hydraulic fracturing stages per well, and utilizing more proppant per stage in an attempt to maximize the volume of hydrocarbon recoveries per wellbore. As a result, North American demand for proppant has increased rapidly, growing at an average annual rate of 28.0% from 2006 to 2011, with total annual sales of $3.7 billion in 2011, according to The Freedonia Group. We believe that the market for raw frac sand will continue to grow based on the expected long-term development of North America’s unconventional oil and natural gas reservoirs.

Our Northern White sand, a type of silica, is highly valued by oil and natural gas producers as a preferred proppant due to its favorable physical characteristics, including its crush strength (ability to withstand high pressures), turbidity (low levels of contaminants) and roundness and sphericity (facilitates hydrocarbon flow, or conductivity), and its lower cost as compared to other proppants such as resin-coated sand and manufactured ceramics. In addition, Northern White sand is a limited resource that exists predominately in Wisconsin and limited portions of the upper Midwest region of the United States. We believe the supply of frac sand has failed to keep pace with the significant recent increase in demand due to several industry-wide production constraints, including limited availability of API spec sand reserves globally as well as the difficulty of obtaining the myriad of construction, environmental, mining and other permits required by local, state and federal regulators.

We intend to utilize the significant oil and natural gas industry experience of our management team to take advantage of what we believe are favorable, long-term market dynamics as we execute our growth strategy, which includes both the acquisition of additional frac sand reserves and the development of new excavation and processing facilities. We expect to have the opportunity to acquire significant additional acreage and reserves currently owned or under an agreement to be acquired by our sponsor, including approximately 1,700 acres of additional land in western Wisconsin to which we have a right of first offer, in addition to potential acquisitions from third parties. Our sponsor will not, however, be required to accept any offer we make, and may, under certain circumstances, sell such assets to third parties that may compete with us. Our sponsor may also elect to develop, retain and operate properties in competition with us or develop new assets that are not subject to our right of first offer.

We intend to remain solely focused on the frac sand market as we believe it offers attractive long-term growth fundamentals.

 

112


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Business Strategies

Our primary business objective is to increase our cash distributions per unit over time. We intend to accomplish this objective by executing the following strategies:

 

   

Focusing on stable, long-term, take-or-pay contracts with key customers. A key component of our business model is our contracting strategy, which seeks to secure a high percentage of our cash flows under long-term, fixed price contracts with take-or-pay provisions, while also staggering the tenors of our contracts so that they expire at different times. We believe this contracting strategy significantly mitigates our exposure to the potential price volatility of the spot market for frac sand in the short-term, allows us to take advantage of any increase in frac sand prices over the medium-term and provides us with long-term cash flow stability. As current contracts expire or as we add new processing capacity, we intend to pursue similar long-term contracts with our current customers and with other leading pressure pumping service providers. We intend to utilize nearly all of our processing capacity to fulfill these contracts, with any excess processed frac sand first offered to existing customers and the remaining amount sold opportunistically in the spot market.

 

   

Pursuing accretive acquisitions from our sponsor and third parties. We expect to pursue accretive acquisitions of frac sand facilities from our sponsor, including through our right of first offer to acquire an aggregate of 1,700 acres of additional land in western Wisconsin with approximately 79.2 million tons of proven recoverable reserves of frac sand according to John T. Boyd, as well as from third-party frac sand producers. As we evaluate acquisition opportunities, we intend to remain focused on operations that complement our reserves of premium frac sand and that provide or would accommodate the development and construction of rail or other advantaged logistics capabilities. We believe these factors are critical to our business model and are important characteristics for any potential acquisitions.

 

   

Expanding our proved reserve base and processing capacity. We seek to identify and evaluate economically attractive expansion and facility enhancement opportunities to increase our proved reserves and processing capacity. At Wyeville and any future sites, we expect to pursue add-on acreage acquisitions near our facilities to expand our reserve base and increase our reserve life. In March 2012, we completed an expansion of our Wyeville facility, increasing annual processing capacity from 950,000 tons per year to approximately 1,600,000 tons per year by adding wet and dry plant capacity and additional sand storage silos. We will continue to analyze and pursue other organic expansion efforts that will similarly allow us to cost-effectively optimize our existing assets and meet customer demand for our high quality frac sand.

 

   

Capitalizing on compelling industry fundamentals. We intend to continue to position ourselves as a pure play producer of high quality frac sand, as we believe the frac sand market offers attractive long-term growth fundamentals. The growth of horizontal drilling in shale and other unconventional oil and natural gas plays has resulted in greater demand for frac sand. This demand growth is underpinned by increased horizontal drilling, higher proppant use per well and cost advantages over resin-coated sand and manufactured ceramics. We believe frac sand supply will continue to be constrained by the difficulty in finding reserves that meet the technical specifications of the API in contiguous quantities large enough to justify the capital investment required and the challenges associated with successfully obtaining the necessary local, state and federal permits required for operations.

 

   

Maintaining financial flexibility and conservative leverage. We plan to pursue a disciplined financial policy and maintain a conservative capital structure. We expect to have no indebtedness at the closing of this offering and $104.7 million of liquidity in the form of $6.2 million of cash on hand and undrawn borrowing capacity under our new $100.0 million revolving credit facility, taking into account $1.5 million of letters of credit expected to be in place at closing. We believe that our borrowing capacity and ability to access debt and equity capital markets after this offering will provide us with the financial flexibility necessary to achieve our organic expansion and acquisition strategy.

 

113


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Competitive Strengths

We believe that we are well positioned to successfully execute our strategy and achieve our primary business objective because of the following competitive strengths:

 

   

Long-term contracted cash flow stability. We will generate substantially all of our revenues from the sale of frac sand under long-term contracts that require subsidiaries of Baker Hughes, FTS International, Halliburton and Weatherford to pay specified prices for specified volumes of product each month. We believe that the take-or-pay volume and pricing provisions and the long-term nature of our contracts will provide us with a stable base of cash flows and limit the risks associated with price movements in the spot market and any changes in product demand during the contract period. We are currently contracted to sell 1,460,000 tons of frac sand annually from our Wyeville facility, and as of June 30, 2012, our contracts had a weighted average remaining life of approximately 4.6 years.

 

   

Long-lived, high quality reserve base. Our Wyeville facility contains approximately 48.4 million tons of proven recoverable coarse grade reserves as of December 31, 2011, based on a third-party reserve report by John T. Boyd, and has an implied 33-year reserve life at currently contracted production rates. These reserves consist of high quality Northern White frac sand. Analysis by independent third-party testing companies indicates that our sand demonstrates characteristics in excess of API specifications with regard to crush strength, turbidity and roundness and sphericity. As a result, our raw frac sand is particularly well suited for and is experiencing significant demand from customers for use in the hydraulic fracturing of unconventional oil and natural gas wells.

 

   

Intrinsic logistics and infrastructure advantage. The strategic location and logistics capabilities of our Wyeville facility enable us to serve all major U.S. oil and natural gas producing basins. Our on-site transportation assets include three 5,000-foot rail spurs off a Union Pacific Railroad mainline that are capable of accommodating unit trains, allowing our customers to receive priority scheduling, expedited delivery and a more cost-effective shipping alternative. Our logistics capabilities enable efficient loading of sand and minimize rail car turnaround times at the facility, and we expect to acquire or develop similar logistics capabilities at any facilities we own in the future. We believe we are one of the few frac sand producers with a facility initially designed to deliver frac sand meeting API specifications to all of the major U.S. oil and natural gas producing basins by on-site rail facilities, including on-site storage capacity accommodating unit trains.

 

   

Competitive operating cost structure. Our operations have been strategically designed to provide low per-unit production costs with a significant variable component for the excavation and processing of our sand. Our sand reserves do not require blasting or crushing to be processed and, due to the shallow overburden at our Wyeville facility, we are able to use surface mining equipment in our operations, which provides for a lower cost structure than underground mining operations. Our mining operations are subcontracted to Gerke Excavating, Inc. at a fixed cost of $2.09 per ton excavated, subject to a diesel fuel surcharge, under a three-year contract. Unlike some competitors, our processing and rail loading facilities are located on-site, which eliminates the requirement for on-road transportation, lowers product movement costs and minimizes the reduction in sand quality due to handling.

 

   

Experienced and incentivized management team. Our management team has extensive experience investing and operating in the oil and natural gas industry and will be focused on optimizing our current business and expanding our operations through disciplined development and accretive acquisitions. We believe our management team’s substantial experience and relationships with participants in the oilfield services and exploration and production industries provide us with an extensive operational and commercial understanding of the markets in which our customers operate. The expertise of our management and operations teams covers a wide range of disciplines, with an emphasis on development, construction and operation of frac sand processing facilities, frac sand supply chain management and consulting and bulk solids material handling. Members of our management team are strongly incentivized to profitably grow our business and cash flows through their 39% interest in our sponsor, which will own          of our common units and all of our subordinated units and incentive distribution rights following this offering.

 

114


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Assets and Business Operations

We own and operate the Wyeville facility, which is located in Monroe County, Wisconsin and, as of December 31, 2011, contained 48.4 million tons of proven recoverable sand reserves of mesh sizes we currently have contracted to sell. According to John T. Boyd, our proven reserves consist entirely of coarse grade Northern White sand (which is also referred to as “Ottawa” sand) exceeding API specifications. Analysis of our sand by independent third-party testing companies indicates that it demonstrates characteristics in excess of API specifications with regard to crush strength, turbidity and roundness and sphericity.

We acquired the Wyeville acreage and commenced construction of the Wyeville facility in January 2011. We completed construction of the Wyeville facility and commenced sand excavation and processing in June 2011 with an initial plant processing capacity of 950,000 tons per year, and customer shipments were initiated in July 2011. From the Wyeville in-service date to March 31, 2012, we have processed and sold 555,250 tons of frac sand. We completed an expansion in March 2012 that increased our annual expected processing capacity to approximately 1,600,000 tons per year (or approximately 133,333 tons per month). We have contracted approximately 91% of this capacity for the remainder of 2012 and through the second quarter of 2014, and approximately 71% of this capacity for the remainder of 2014 and through the second quarter of 2016. Based on currently contracted production rates and a reserve report prepared by John T. Boyd, our Wyeville facility has an implied 33-year reserve life as of December 31, 2011.

We operate two dryer facilities at Wyeville with a combined nameplate input capacity, based on manufacturer specifications, of 250 tons per hour. Unless processing operations are suspended to conduct maintenance, our dryer facilities are run on a 24-hour basis. Our estimate of annual expected processing capacity assumes a 15% loss of capacity due to waste and an uptime efficiency of 85% of nameplate capacity, which allows approximately 55 days for downtime and maintenance. We processed and sold 92,282 (1,107,384 on an annualized basis), 118,464 (1,421,568 on an annualized basis) and 119,836 (1,438,037 on an annualized basis) tons of sand in April, May and June of 2012, respectively. Our actual production in April 2012 is significantly lower than our expected monthly processing capacity because deliveries pursuant to the contract volume increases we entered into in connection with the Wyeville expansion did not commence until May 2012.

The following table summarizes certain of the key characteristics of our Wyeville facility we believe allow us to provide our customers with high quality frac sand efficiently at competitive prices.

Key Characteristics of Wyeville Facility and its Reserves

 

Facility Characteristics

  

Description

Site Geography

   Situated on 561 contiguous acres, with on-site processing and rail loading facilities.

Deposits

   Sand pay zones of up to 80 feet; coarse grade mesh sizes from 20 to 70; few impurities such as clay or other contaminants.

Excavation Technique

   Shallow overburden allowing for surface excavation.

Sand Processing

   Sands are unconsolidated; do not require crushing.

Logistics Capabilities

   On-site transportation infrastructure capable of accommodating unit trains connected to Union Pacific Railroad mainline.

Sand Reserves

As of December 31, 2011, we had a total of 48.4 million tons of proven recoverable mineral reserves at our Wyeville facility. We own all 561 acres of land surrounding our Wyeville facility, which secures our mineral rights and access to reserves.

 

115


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

“Reserves” consist of sand that can be economically extracted or produced at the time of determination based on relevant legal, economic and technical considerations. The reserve estimates referenced herein represent proven reserves, which we define in the glossary. The quantity and nature of the mineral reserves at our Wyeville facility are estimated by our internal geologists and mining engineers and updated periodically, with necessary adjustments for operations during the year and additions or reductions due to property acquisitions and dispositions, quality adjustments and mine plan updates. John T. Boyd has estimated our reserves as of December 31, 2011, and we intend to continue retaining third-party engineers to review our reserves on an annual basis.

To opine as to the economic viability of our reserves, John T. Boyd reviewed our financial cost and revenue per ton data at the time of the proven reserve determination. Based on its review of our cost structure and its extensive experience with similar operations, John T. Boyd concluded that it is reasonable to assume that we will operate under a similar cost structure over the remaining life of our reserves. John T. Boyd further assumed that our revenue per ton, which was $62.90 on a weighted average basis at the time of the proven reserves determination, will remain relatively constant over the life of the reserve. Based on these assumptions, and taking into account possible cost increases associated with a maturing mine, John T. Boyd concluded that our current operating margins are sufficient to expect continued profitability throughout the life of our reserves.

The cutoff grade used by John T. Boyd in estimating our reserves considers only sand that will pass through a 20x70 mesh screen as proven reserves, meaning only sands with mesh sizes greater than 20 and less than 70 are included in John T. Boyd’s estimate of our proven reserves. In addition, John T. Boyd’s estimate of our reserves adjusts for mining losses of 10% and processing losses of material delivered to the wet plant feed hopper of 22%, for a total yield of 70% of the in-place sand resource.

Our Wyeville reserves are a mineral resource created over millions of years. Approximately 500 million years ago, the quartz rich Cambrian sheet sands were deposited in the upper Midwest region of the United States. During the Pleistocene era, which occurred approximately two million years ago, erosion caused by the melting of glaciers cut channels into the Mt. Simon Formation, forming rivers. Loose grains of sand resulting from this same erosion settled in these river beds where they were washed by the consistent current of the river. The washing action of the river removed debris, known as fines, from the sand, rounded the sand grains and helped it to remain unconsolidated. The Wyeville deposit is located in one of these ancient river beds. The high quartz content of the Cambrian sands and the monocrystalline structure of the Wyeville deposit is responsible for the extremely high crush strength relative to other types of sand.

 

116


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Although crush strength is one of a number of characteristics that define the quality of raw frac sand, it is a key characteristic for our customers and other purchasers of frac sand in determining whether the product will be suitable for its desired application. For example, raw frac sand with exceptionally high crush strength is suitable for use in high pressure downhole conditions that would otherwise require the use of more expensive resin-coated or ceramic proppants. The following charts illustrate the high crush strength of our sand reserves relative to that of our competitors.

Industry Crush Strength Benchmarking

30/50 Raw Frac Sand

 

LOGO

 

 

Note: Information based on publicly available competitor crush strength data.

(1) Based on results of crush strength testing performed on Hi-Crush Wyeville sand by PropTester.
(2) Based on results of crush strength testing performed on Hi-Crush Wyeville sand by Stim-Lab.
(3) Based on the average of Competitor C’s published crush strength for its 30/50 mesh size sand.
(4) Based on representative examples from publicly available sources.

40/70 Raw Frac Sand

 

LOGO

 

 

Note: Information based on publicly available competitor crush strength data.

(1) Based on results of crush strength testing performed on Hi-Crush Wyeville sand by PropTester.
(2) Based on results of crush strength testing performed on Hi-Crush Wyeville sand by Stim-Lab.
(3) Based on the average of Competitor A’s published crush strength for its 40/70 mesh size sand.
(4) Based on the average of Competitor C’s published crush strength for its 40/70 mesh size sand.
(5) Based on representative examples from publicly available sources.

 

117


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our sands are unconsolidated, extremely clean and well-rounded, and as a result do not require crushing or extensive processing to eliminate clays or other contaminants, enabling us to cost-effectively produce high quality, frac sand meeting API specifications. In addition, the sand deposits are present to a depth of approximately 80 feet, with a shallow overburden of approximately five feet. The shallow depth of the sand deposits allows us to conduct surface mining rather than underground mining, which lowers our production costs and decreases safety risks as compared to underground mining. The following map indicates the layout and location of our Wyeville facility.

Wyeville Facility

LOGO

Before acquiring new reserves, we perform extensive drilling of cores and analysis and other testing of the cores to confirm the quantity and quality of the acquired reserves. We have undertaken a comprehensive exploration drilling program at the Wyeville facility. In total, we have reviewed 52 core holes that were drilled utilizing mud rotary and sonic core drilling techniques with holes spaced between 500 feet and 800 feet to delineate the resource. The holes were drilled into the underlying Mount Simon sandstone formation through the unconsolidated sand, with depths generally ranging from 55 feet to 80 feet. The holes were sampled in 10-foot

 

118


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

depth increments with each 10-foot depth increment yielding a corresponding lab gradation. Core samples were sent to leading proppant sand-testing laboratories, each of which adhered to procedures and testing methods in accordance with the American Society for Testing and Materials’ standards for testing materials. During the course of the drilling, John T. Boyd assisted in determining the number and location of drill holes. The results of this program were taken into account in determining the quality and volume of our reserves.

We acquired the Wyeville acreage in fee in January 2011 from three separate land owners, one of which had previously conducted limited surface excavation on-site. In each transaction, we acquired surface and mineral rights, all of which were initially subject to an aggregate non-participating royalty interest of $6.15 per ton of frac sand sold. These royalties were negotiated by us in connection with our acquisition of the Wyeville acreage. Effective July 2012, we terminated certain royalty agreements for a one time cash payment of $14.0 million, reducing our ongoing royalty costs from $6.15 to $2.50 per ton of sand excavated, delivered and paid for. In some instances in the future, we may acquire the mineral rights to reserves without actually taking ownership of the properties. A 40-acre portion of the Wyeville acreage is encumbered by a mortgage in favor of Weatherford Lift Systems. The mortgage secures our obligation to deliver 100% of our minimum delivery requirement for the first year of the contract and 50% of our minimum delivery requirement for the second year of the contract. The mortgage terminates upon our satisfaction of these delivery requirements.

An approximately 300 acre portion of the Wyeville acreage is subject to an agreement whereby we agreed to sell such acreage back to the individuals from whom the land was purchased in the event that the applicable minimum royalty payments have not been satisfied. If such minimum royalty payments for the three year period commencing on September 15, 2011 (the “Initial Operations Period”) have not been satisfied before September 15, 2014, we agreed to sell the property to the original landowner for one dollar, subject to certain terms. Additionally, at the end of each 12 month period following the conclusion of the Initial Operations Period, if such minimum royalties have not been satisfied for the rolling three previous years (the “Subsequent Operations Periods”), we agreed to sell the property to the original landowner for one dollar, subject to certain terms.

During the Initial Operations Period, the required royalty payments amount to an aggregate of $825,000 over the three year period. During any Subsequent Operations Period, the required royalty payments amount to an aggregate of $1,050,000 over each three year period. If we have not made the minimum required royalty payments associated with ongoing sand sales by the end of any Initial Operations Period or Subsequent Operations Period, we may satisfy our obligation by making a lump-sum cash make-whole payment. Accordingly, we believe there is no material risk that we will be required to sell back the subject property pursuant to this agreement.

Excavation Operations

The surface excavation operations at our Wyeville site are conducted by a third-party contractor, Gerke Excavating, Inc. The mining technique at our Wyeville site is open-pit excavation of approximately 20-acre panels of unconsolidated silica deposits. The excavation process involves clearing and grubbing vegetation and trees overlying the proposed mining area. The initial two to five feet of overburden is removed and utilized to construct perimeter berms around the pit and property boundary. No underground mines are operated at our Wyeville site.

A track excavator and articulated trucks are utilized for excavating the sand at several different elevation levels of the active pit. The pit is dry mined, and the water elevation is maintained below working level through a dewatering and pumping process. The mined material is loaded and hauled from different areas of the pit and different elevations within the pit to the primary loading facility at our mine’s on-site wet processing facility. Gerke Excavating, Inc. is paid a fixed fee of $2.09 per ton of sand excavated, subject to a diesel fuel surcharge.

 

119


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Processing Facilities

Our processing facilities are designed to wash, sort and store our raw frac sand. The Wyeville processing plant started operations in June 2011 and employs modern and efficient wet and dry processing technology. Following the completion of this offering, our processing operations will be conducted by employees of our sponsor or one of its subsidiaries pursuant to the terms of the omnibus agreement, under the oversight of our management team. See “—Our Management and Employees.”

Our mined raw frac sand is initially stockpiled before processing. The material is recovered by a mounted belt feeder, which extends beneath a surge pile, and is fed onto a conveyor. The sand exits the tunnel on the conveyor belt and is fed into the 600-ton per hour wet plant where impurities and unusable fine grain sand are removed from the raw feed. The wet processed sand is then stockpiled in advance of being fed into the dry plant for further processing. The wet plant operates for seven to eight months per year due to the limitations arising from sustained freezing temperatures during winter months. When the wet plant is operating, however, it processes more sand per day than the dry plant to build-up stockpiles of frac sand to be processed by the dry plant during the winter months.

The dry plant, which operates throughout the entire year, has a rated capacity of 250 tons per hour. The wet processed sand stockpile is fed into the dry plant hopper using a front end loader. The material is processed in a natural gas fired vibratory fluid bed dryer contained in an enclosed building. After drying, the sand is screened through gyratory screens and separated into industry standard product sizes. The finished product is then conveyed to multiple on-site storage silos for each size specification.

Logistics Capabilities

All of our product is shipped by rail from our three 5,000-foot rail spurs that connect our processing and storage facilities to a Union Pacific Railroad mainline. The length of these rail spurs and the capacity of the associated product storage silos allow us to accommodate a large number of rail cars. It also enables us to accommodate unit trains, which significantly increases our efficiency in meeting our customers’ frac sand transportation needs. Unit trains, typically 80 rail cars in length or longer, are dedicated trains chartered for a single delivery destination. Generally, unit trains receive priority scheduling and do not switch cars at various intermediate junctions, which results in a more cost-effective and efficient method of shipping than the standard method of rail shipment. We believe the Wyeville facility is one of the first frac sand facilities in the industry initially designed to accommodate large scale rail and unit train logistics, which require sufficient acreage, loading facilities and rail spurs to accommodate a unit train on site. Following the completion of this offering, our loading and logistics operations will be conducted by employees of our sponsor or one of its subsidiaries pursuant to the terms of the omnibus agreement, under the oversight of our management team. See “—Our Management and Employees.”

Logistics capabilities of frac sand producers are important to our customers, who focus on both the reliability and flexibility of product delivery. Because our customers generally find it impractical to store frac sand in large quantities near their job sites, they seek to arrange for product to be delivered where and as needed, which requires predictable and efficient loading and shipping of product. The integrated nature of our logistics operations and our three 5,000 foot rail spurs enable us to handle railcars for multiple customers simultaneously, minimizing the number of days required to successfully load shipments, even at times of peak activity, avoid the use of trucks and minimize transloading within the facility. At the same time, we believe our ability to ship using unit trains differentiates us from most other frac sand producers that ship using manifest, or mixed freight, trains, which may make multiple stops to switch cars before delivering cargoes, or transport their products by truck or barge. In addition, unlike some competitors, our processing and rail loading facilities are located on-site, which eliminates the requirement for on-road transportation, lowers product movement costs and minimizes the reduction in sand quality due to handling. Together, these advantages provide our customers with a reliable and efficient delivery method from our facility to each of the major U.S. oil and natural gas producing basins, and allow us to take advantage of the increasing demand for such a delivery method.

 

120


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Geographic Breakdown of Deliveries

 

Percentage Delivered by Destination

 

LOGO

Destination    Associated Basins (1)
Texas   

Permian

Eagle Ford

Pennsylvania    Marcellus
Colorado   

Niobrara

Piceance

Arkansas    Fayetteville
Oklahoma    Mid-Continent
Ohio    Utica
North Dakota    Bakken

 

 

 

Note: Deliveries include total frac sand delivered by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC from July 2011 through June 30, 2012.

(1) Basins where we believe our frac sand is used after shipment to transload facilities in the destination states.

We sell frac sand freight on board, or “FOB,” to our customers, meaning that they take title to the product once it is loaded into their owned or leased railcars, which are generally specifically dedicated to support their contracts with us, and they incur all transportation costs. Accordingly, we have no direct exposure to fluctuations in rail transportation costs.

Quality Control

We employ an automated process control system that efficiently manages our mining, loading, shipping, storage, processing and preventative maintenance functions. Furthermore, our co-located storage and loading facilities and shipment via unit trains reduce the incidence of contamination during the delivery process and result in higher quality sand being delivered to our customers. We monitor the quality and consistency of our products by conducting hourly tests throughout the production process to detect variances, using each of three unique testing technologies. We take product samples from every rail car that is loaded at the facility and test every fourth car in our on-site laboratory. Samples are retained for three months for testing upon customer request. We have a third-party calibration company certify all measurement devices at our facility on a monthly basis. We also provide customers with documentation verifying that all products shipped meet customer specifications. We continually refine our processes to ensure repeatable results in our processing plant and product quality accountability for our customers.

Customers

Our current customer base is comprised of subsidiaries of four of North America’s largest providers of pressure pumping services, Baker Hughes, FTS International, Halliburton and Weatherford. Our largest customers based on current contracts, Baker Hughes and Halliburton, are each rated A2 / A by Moody’s and Standard & Poor’s, respectively, and Weatherford is rated Baa2 / BBB by these agencies. FTS International Services LLC, the subsidiary of FTS International that is the counterparty to our customer contract, is rated Ba3 / B by these agencies. Spears and Associates estimates that these four companies controlled 47% of North American pressure pumping fleet in 2011 and accounted for greater than 50% of the North American pressure pumping market, based on 2011 revenue. For the year ended December 31, 2011, sales to Halliburton and Weatherford accounted for 64% and 36% of our total revenues, respectively. Sales under our contracts with Baker Hughes and FTS International commenced in May 2012.

 

121


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Contracts

We sell substantially all of the sand we produce under long-term, take-or-pay contracts that significantly reduce our exposure to short-term fluctuations in the price of and demand for frac sand. For the year ended December 31, 2011 and the first quarter of 2012, we generated 99% of our revenues from sand delivered under our long-term sand sales contracts, and we expect to continue selling a significant majority of our sand under long-term contracts. As of June 30, 2012, we had four long-term sand sale contracts with a weighted average remaining life of approximately 4.6 years. The following table presents a summary of our contracted volumes and revenues from 2011 through 2015, as well as the average contract sales price and make-whole price our customers are obligated to pay in the event they decline to accept delivery of the required product volumes under their respective contracts.

 

    Year Ended December 31,  
    2011     2012     2013     2014     2015  

Contracted Volumes (tons)

    331,667        1,216,667        1,460,000        1,295,000        1,130,000   

% of Processing Capacity (1)

    79     85     91     81     71

Contracted Revenue

  $ 19,916,667      $ 78,966,667      $ 96,466,667      $ 88,350,000      $ 80,100,000   

Average Sales Price per ton

    $60        $65        $66        $68        $71   

Average Make-Whole Price per ton

    $60        $49        $49        $51        $51   

 

(1) Percentage of processing capacity for 2011 and 2012 based on weighted average processing capacity for such periods.

As the above table illustrates, when one of our contracts expires in 2014, the average contracted price per ton will increase. The expiring contract provides for sales prices lower than current market prices. Prior to this contract’s expiration, we will seek to renew or replace this contract on pricing terms more comparable to market prices at the time. Occasionally, if we have excess production and market conditions are favorable, we may elect to sell frac sand in spot market transactions.

The terms of our customer contracts, including sand quality requirements, quantity parameters, permitted sources of supply, effects of future regulatory changes, force majeure and termination and assignment provisions, vary by customer. As indicated in the above table, our customer contracts contain penalties for non-performance by our customers, with make-whole prices averaging approximately $49 per ton in 2012. If one of our customers fails to meet its minimum obligations to us, we would expect that the make-whole payment, combined with a decrease in our variable costs (such as royalty payments and excavation costs), would substantially mitigate any adverse impact on our cash flow from such failure. We would also have the ability to sell the sand volumes for which we receive make-whole payments to third parties. Our customer contracts also contain penalties for our non-performance. If we are unable to deliver contracted volumes within three months of contract year end, or otherwise arrange for delivery from a third party, we are required to pay make-whole payments averaging approximately $49 per ton in 2012. We believe our new facilities, substantial reserves and our on-site processing and logistics capabilities mitigate our risk of non-performance. In addition, we intentionally maintain long-term contracted volume commitments to our customers at less than 100% of our processing capacity to provide excess capacity to reduce the likelihood of failing to meet the requirements of our contracts. We believe our levels of inventory combined with our three month cure period starting at contract year end should be more than sufficient to prevent us from paying make-whole payments as a result of plant shutdowns due to repairs to our facilities necessitated by reasonably foreseeable mechanical interruptions.

Quality and volumes of sand are stipulated in our sales contracts, which require us to deliver frac sand meeting or exceeding the standards of ISO 13503-2. Our sand is sold FOB plant site, with title and risk of loss transferring to the customer when we load the sand onto the customer’s rail cars at our facility.

Pursuant to the terms of the omnibus agreement, we will be obligated to assign to our sponsor all of our rights and obligations under our customer contract with FTS International effective as of May 1, 2013, and our

 

122


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

sponsor will be obligated to accept such assignment, assume our obligations under such contract and indemnify us for any losses we may incur following such assignment. Please see “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement—Assignment of FTS International Contract.” Accordingly, we have assumed when describing our customer contracts in this prospectus that we will have no contractual rights, obligations or liabilities with respect to our customer contract with FTS International after May 1, 2013.

Competition

There are numerous large and small producers in all sand producing regions of the United States with whom we compete. Our main competitors include Badger Mining Corporation, Fairmount Minerals, Ltd., Preferred Proppants LLC, Unimin Corporation and U.S. Silica Holdings, Inc. The most important factors on which we compete are product quality, performance and sand characteristics, transportation capabilities, reliability of supply and price. Demand for frac sand and the prices that we will be able to obtain for our products, to the extent not subject to a fixed price contract, are closely linked to proppant consumption patterns for the completion of oil and natural gas wells in North America. These consumption patterns are influenced by numerous factors, including the price for hydrocarbons, the drilling rig count and hydraulic fracturing activity, including the number of stages completed and the amount of proppant used per stage. Further, these consumption patterns are also influenced by the location, quality, price and availability of raw frac sand and other types of proppants such as resin-coated sand and ceramic proppant.

Our History and Relationship with Our Sponsor

Overview and History

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, our sponsor, was formed in 2010 in Houston, Texas. Members of our sponsor’s management team have, on average, more than 20 years of experience investing in and operating businesses in the oil and natural gas and sand mining industries. Members of our management team have partnered with major oilfield services companies and exploration and production companies in the development of oil and natural gas reservoirs. In this capacity, members of our management team gained valuable expertise and developed strong relationships in the oilfield services industry. Recognizing the increasing demand for proppants as a result of rapidly evolving hydraulic fracturing techniques, members of our management team chose to leverage their expertise and relationships to capitalize on this increasing demand by developing raw frac sand reserves and facilities. In addition, our Chief Operating Officer has overseen the design, construction and staffing for multiple sand mining and processing facilities. The expertise of our management and operations teams covers a wide range of disciplines, with an emphasis on development, construction and operation of frac sand processing facilities, frac sand supply chain management and consulting and bulk solids material handling.

Our sponsor’s lead investor is Avista Capital Partners, a leading private equity firm with significant investing and operating expertise in the energy industry. Founded in 2005 by senior investment professionals who worked together at DLJMB, then one of the world’s largest and most successful private equity franchises, Avista makes controlling or influential minority investments in connection with various transaction structures. The energy team at Avista is comprised of experienced professionals and industry executives with relevant expertise in the energy sector. Avista principals have led over $2.7 billion in equity investments in energy companies while at Avista and DLJMB, including Basic Energy Services, Inc., Brigham Exploration Company, Copano Energy, L.L.C., Seabulk International, Inc., and joint-ventures with Carrizo Oil & Gas, Inc.

Our Sponsor’s Assets and Our Right of First Offer

In connection with this offering, our sponsor is contributing to us its sand reserves and related excavation and processing facilities located in Wyeville, Wisconsin, which are being contributed to us because of Wyeville’s established operating history and the fact that Wyeville is our sponsor’s most fully-contracted facility. In addition

 

123


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

to the Wyeville facility, our sponsor owns or has options to acquire several other sand mining locations where it could develop similar logistics capabilities as the Wyeville facility, and it will retain these assets following this offering. Pursuant to the terms of an omnibus agreement we expect to enter into with our sponsor, we will have a right of first offer with respect to certain of our sponsor’s assets, which are located in Augusta, Wisconsin and Tomah, Wisconsin. The Augusta excavation and processing facility in Eau Claire County, Wisconsin is currently operational, and our sponsor expects to commence shipments from Augusta in the third quarter of 2012. John T. Boyd estimated that, as of December 31, 2011, the Augusta site had 46.2 million tons of proven recoverable coarse grade sand reserves located on approximately 1,000 acres. Our sponsor recently completed construction of a 1,600,000 ton per year processing facility at Augusta, and John T. Boyd estimates that the site has a reserve life of approximately 39 years based on currently contracted production levels. After taking into account our sponsor’s agreement to assume one of our customer contracts, our sponsor has contracted for the sale of 1,200,000 tons of sand per year from the Augusta facility with two of our existing customers under take-or-pay contracts with a weighted average life of approximately 4.8 years that specify both volumes and price. The customers will take delivery of the sand at on-site rail facilities that, like the Wyeville facility, can accommodate unit trains.

Our sponsor has also agreed to acquire approximately 700 acres in Tomah, Wisconsin, which is six miles south of the Wyeville facility in Monroe County. The Tomah site has access to the same Union Pacific Railroad mainline as the Wyeville facility, which runs adjacent to the property, and could accommodate similar rail logistics as the Wyeville facility. Extensive core samples have been taken at Tomah and independently tested with results indicating a high quality sand reserve similar to the Wyeville site. According to a John T. Boyd reserve report, the Tomah site had proven recoverable sand reserves of 33 million tons as of December 31, 2011, which represents a 51 year reserve life assuming construction of a 650,000 ton per year processing facility.

In addition, our sponsor is evaluating a number of additional development locations and adds potential projects to its development backlog regularly.

Our sponsor’s retained sand facilities represent a significant potential growth opportunity for us. Our sponsor continually evaluates acquisitions and may elect to acquire, construct or dispose of assets in the future, including in sales of assets to us. As the owner of our general partner,          of our common units, all          of our subordinated units and all of our incentive distribution rights following this offering, our sponsor is well aligned and highly motivated to promote and support the successful execution of our business strategies, including utilizing our partnership as a growth vehicle for its sand mining operations. Although we expect to have the opportunity to make additional acquisitions directly from our sponsor in the future, including the sand excavation and processing facilities described above that are subject to our right of first offer, our sponsor is under no obligation to accept any offer we make, and may, following good faith negotiations with us, sell the assets subject to our right of first offer to third parties that may compete with us. Our sponsor may also elect to develop, retain and operate properties in competition with us or develop new assets that are not subject to our right of first offer.

In addition, while we believe our relationship with our sponsor is a significant positive attribute, it may also be a source of conflict. For example, our sponsor is not restricted in its ability to compete with us, and since the commencement of operations at its Augusta facility in August of 2012 our sponsor has been competing directly with us for new and existing customers. In addition, we expect that our sponsor will develop additional frac sand excavation and processing facilities in the future, which may also compete with us. While we expect that our management team, which also manages our sponsor’s retained assets, and our sponsor will allocate new and replacement customer contracts between us and our sponsor in a manner that balances the interests of both parties, they are under no obligation to do so. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.”

 

124


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our Management and Employees

We are managed and operated by the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner, Hi-Crush GP LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary of our sponsor. As a result of owning our general partner, our sponsor will have the right to appoint all members of the board of directors of our general partner, including at least three independent directors meeting the independence standards established by the NYSE. At least one of our independent directors will be appointed prior to the date our common units are listed for trading on the NYSE. For more information about the executive officers and directors of our general partner, please read “Management.” Our unitholders will not be entitled to elect our general partner or its directors or otherwise directly participate in our management or operations. Even if our unitholders are dissatisfied with the performance of our general partner, they will have limited ability to remove the general partner without its consent, and will not be able to do so initially, because our general partner and its affiliates will own a sufficient number of units upon completion of this offering to prevent its removal. Our unitholders will be able to indirectly participate in our management and operations only to the limited extent actions taken by our general partner require the approval of a percentage of our unitholders and our general partner and its affiliates do not own sufficient units to guarantee such approval. Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Voting Rights.”

Following the consummation of this offering, we will enter into an omnibus agreement with our sponsor and our general partner that will govern our relationship with them regarding the provisions of certain administrative services to us. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement.” In addition, under our partnership agreement, we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates, including our sponsor, for all expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf, to the extent such expenses are not contemplated by the omnibus agreement. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us.

Hi-Crush Partners LP does not have any employees. All of the employees that will conduct our business pursuant to the omnibus agreement will be employed by Hi-Crush Proppants LLC or a wholly owned subsidiary of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. As of June 30, 2012, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC had 74 employees. In addition, we contract out our excavation operations to a third party, Gerke Excavating, Inc., and accordingly have no employees involved in those operations.

Environmental and Occupational Safety and Health Regulation

Mining and Workplace Safety

Federal Regulation

The U.S. Mine Safety and Health Administration (“MSHA”) is the primary regulatory agency with jurisdiction over the commercial silica industry. Accordingly, MSHA regulates quarries, surface mines, underground mines, and the industrial mineral processing facilities associated with quarries and mines. The mission of MSHA is to administer the provisions of the Federal Mine Safety and Health Act of 1977 and to enforce compliance with mandatory safety and health standards. As part of MSHA’s oversight, its representatives must perform at least two unannounced inspections annually for each surface mining facility in its jurisdiction. To date, these inspections have not resulted in any citations for material violations of MSHA standards.

We also are subject to the requirements of the U.S. Occupational Safety and Health Act (“OSHA”) and comparable state statutes that regulate the protection of the health and safety of workers. In addition, the OSHA Hazard Communication Standard requires that information be maintained about hazardous materials used or produced in operations and that this information be provided to employees, state and local government authorities, and the public. OSHA regulates the users of commercial silica and provides detailed regulations requiring employers to protect employees from overexposure to silica through the enforcement of permissible exposure limits and the OSHA Hazard Communication Standard.

 

125


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Internal Controls

We adhere to a strict occupational health program aimed at controlling employee exposure to silica dust, which includes dust sampling, a respiratory protection program, medical surveillance, training, and other components. Our safety program is designed to ensure compliance with MSHA regulations. For both health and safety issues, extensive training is provided to employees. We have a safety committee at our plant made up of salaried and hourly employees that are involved in establishing, implementing, and improving safety standards. We perform annual internal health and safety audits and conduct semi-annual crisis management drills to test our plants’ abilities to respond to various situations.

Environmental Matters

We and the commercial silica industry are subject to extensive governmental regulation pertaining to matters such as permitting and licensing requirements, plant and wildlife protection, hazardous materials, air and water emissions, and environmental contamination and reclamation. A variety of federal, state and local agencies have established, implement and enforce these regulations.

Federal Regulation

At the federal level, we may be required to obtain permits under Section 404 of the Clean Water Act from the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers for the discharge of dredged or fill material into waters of the United States, including wetlands and streams, in connection with our operations. We also may be required to obtain permits under Section 402 of the Clean Water Act from the EPA or the Wisconsin Department of Natural Resources, to whom the EPA has delegated local implementation of the permit program, for discharges of pollutants into waters of the United States, including discharges of wastewater or stormwater runoff associated with construction activities. Failure to obtain these required permits or to comply with their terms could subject us to administrative, civil, and criminal penalties as well as injunctive relief.

The U.S. Clean Air Act and comparable state laws regulate emissions of various air pollutants through air emissions permitting programs and the imposition of other requirements. These regulatory programs may require us to install expensive emissions abatement equipment, modify operational practices, and obtain permits for existing or new operations. Before commencing construction on a new or modified source of air emissions, such laws may require us to reduce emissions at existing facilities. As a result, we may be required to incur increased capital and operating costs to comply with these regulations. We could be subject to administrative, civil, and criminal penalties as well as injunctive relief for noncompliance with air permits or other requirements of the U.S. Clean Air Act and comparable state laws and regulations.

As part of our operations, we utilize or store petroleum products and other substances such as diesel fuel, lubricating oils, and hydraulic fluid. We are subject to regulatory programs pertaining to the storage, use, transportation, and disposal of these substances. Spills or releases may occur in the course of our operations, and we could incur substantial costs and liabilities as a result of such spills or releases, including claims for damage or injury to property and persons. The Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act (“CERCLA,” also known as the Superfund law) and comparable state laws impose joint and several liability, without regard to fault or legality of conduct, on classes of persons who are considered to be responsible for the release of hazardous substances into the environment. These persons include the owner or operator of the site where the release occurred and anyone who disposed of or arranged for disposal, including offsite disposal, of a hazardous substance generated or released at the site. Under CERCLA, such persons may be subject to liability for the costs of cleaning up the hazardous substances, for damages to natural resources, and for the costs of certain health studies. In addition, it is not uncommon for neighboring landowners and other third parties to file claims for personal injury and property damage allegedly caused by the hazardous substances released into the environment.

 

126


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

In addition, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act (“RCRA”) and comparable state statutes regulate the generation, transportation, treatment, storage, disposal, and cleanup of hazardous and non-hazardous wastes. The EPA and Wisconsin Department of Natural Resources, to whom the EPA has delegated portions of the RCRA program for local implementation, administer the RCRA program.

Our operations may also be subject to broad environmental review under the National Environmental Policy Act (“NEPA”). NEPA requires federal agencies to evaluate the environmental impact of all “major federal actions” significantly affecting the quality of the human environment. The granting of a federal permit for a major development project, such as a mining operation, may be considered a “major federal action” that requires review under NEPA. Therefore, our projects may require review and evaluation under NEPA. As part of this evaluation, the federal agency considers a broad array of environmental impacts, including, among other things, impacts on air quality, water quality, wildlife (including threatened and endangered species), historic and archeological resources, geology, socioeconomics, and aesthetics. NEPA also requires the consideration of alternatives to the project. The NEPA review process, especially the preparation of a full environmental impact statement, can be time consuming and expensive. The purpose of the NEPA review process is to inform federal agencies’ decision-making on whether federal approval should be granted for a project and to provide the public with an opportunity to comment on the environmental impacts of a proposed project. Though NEPA requires only that an environmental evaluation be conducted and does not mandate a particular result, a federal agency could decide to deny a permit or impose certain conditions on its approval, based on its environmental review under NEPA, or a third party could challenge the adequacy of a NEPA review and thereby delay the issuance of a federal permit or approval.

Federal agencies granting permits for our operations also must consider impacts to endangered and threatened species and their habitat under the Endangered Species Act. We also must comply with and are subject to liability under the Endangered Species Act, which prohibits and imposes stringent penalties for the harming of endangered or threatened species and their habitat. Federal agencies also must consider a project’s impacts on historic or archeological resources under the National Historic Preservation Act, and we may be required to conduct archeological surveys of project sites and to avoid or preserve historical areas or artifacts.

State and Local Regulation

We are also subject to a variety of state and local environmental review and permitting requirements. Some states, including Wisconsin where our current projects are located, have state laws similar to NEPA; thus our development of a new site or the expansion of an existing site may be subject to comprehensive state environmental reviews even if it is not subject to NEPA. In some cases, the state environmental review may be more stringent than the federal review. Our operations may require state-law based permits in addition to federal permits, requiring state agencies to consider a range of issues, many the same as federal agencies, including, among other things, a project’s impact on wildlife and their habitats, historic and archaeological sites, aesthetics, agricultural operations, and scenic areas. Wisconsin and some other states also have specific permitting and review processes for commercial silica mining operations, and state agencies may impose different or additional monitoring or mitigation requirements than federal agencies. The development of new sites and our existing operations also are subject to a variety of local environmental and regulatory requirements, including land use, zoning, building, and transportation requirements.

As demand for frac sand in the oil and natural gas industry has driven a significant increase in current and expected future production of commercial silica, some local communities have expressed concern regarding silica sand mining operations. These concerns have generally included exposure to ambient silica sand dust, truck traffic, water usage, and blasting. In response, certain state and local communities have developed or are in the process of developing regulations or zoning restrictions intended to minimize the potential for dust to become airborne, control the flow of truck traffic, significantly curtail the area available for mining activities, require compensation to local residents for potential impacts of mining activities and, in some cases, ban issuance of new permits for mining activities. To date, we have not experienced any material impact to our existing mining

 

127


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

operations or planned capacity expansions as a result of these types of concerns. We are not aware of any proposals for significant increased scrutiny on the part of state or local regulators in the jurisdictions in which we operate or community concerns with respect to our operations that would reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, or results of operations going forward.

Planned expansion of our mining and production capacity in new communities could be more significantly impacted by increased regulatory activity. Difficulty or delays in obtaining or inability to obtain new mining permits or increased costs of compliance with future state and local regulatory requirements could have a material negative impact on our ability to grow our business. In an effort to minimize these risks, we continue to be engaged with local communities in order to grow and maintain strong relationships with residents and regulators.

Costs of Compliance

We may incur significant costs and liabilities as a result of environmental, health, and safety requirements applicable to our activities. Failure to comply with environmental laws and regulations may result in the assessment of administrative, civil, and criminal penalties; imposition of investigatory, cleanup, and site restoration costs and liens; the denial or revocation of permits or other authorizations; and the issuance of injunctions to limit or cease operations. Compliance with these laws and regulations may also increase the cost of the development, construction, and operation of our projects and may prevent or delay the commencement or continuance of a given project. In addition, claims for damages to persons or property may result from environmental and other impacts of our activities.

The process for performing environmental impact studies and reviews for federal, state, and local permits required for our operations involves a significant investment of time and monetary resources. We cannot control the permit approval process. We cannot predict whether all permits required for a given project will be granted or whether such permits will be the subject of significant opposition. The denial of a permit essential to a project or the imposition of conditions with which it is not practicable or feasible to comply could impair or prevent our ability to develop a project. Significant opposition and delay in the environmental review and permitting process also could impair or delay our ability to develop a project. Additionally, the passage of more stringent environmental laws could impair our ability to develop new operations and have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Permits

We operate the Wyeville facility under a number of federal, state and local authorizations.

The Wyeville facility currently operates under a construction air permit from the Wisconsin Department of Natural Resources (“Wisconsin DNR”). We must demonstrate our compliance with the construction air permit over an 18-month period, which began on March 12, 2012, after which the Wisconsin DNR will issue an operation air permit. We developed and comply with a Fugitive Dust Control Plan and a Malfunction Prevention and Abatement Plan.

Stormwater discharges from the Wyeville facility are permitted under the Wisconsin Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (“WPDES”). An updated Notice of Intent for the WPDES general permit, which will include the new mine areas, is in progress. Placement of all permanent erosion control structures at the Wyeville facility is now complete.

The Wyeville facility has a U.S. Army Corps of Engineers Section 404 permit and a Wisconsin DNR Section 401 Water Quality Certification for filling of wetlands associated with the rail spur construction. The Section 404 permit includes the requirement that we restore and monitor 2.1 acres of wetlands at an on-site location per our Compensatory Wetland Mitigation Site Plan. We also obtained a Land Use Permit from Monroe County to fill in and grade a floodplain associated with the rail spur construction.

 

128


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

We conduct mining operations at the Wyeville facility pursuant to a Monroe County Nonmetallic Mining Reclamation Permit. We have submitted an updated Nonmetallic Mining Reclamation Plan to Monroe County and have applied for an amendment to the existing permit to address our proposed mine extension.

Safety and Maintenance

We adhere to a strict occupational health program aimed at controlling exposure to silica dust, which includes dust sampling, a respiratory protection program, medical surveillance, training and other components. Our safety program is designed to ensure compliance with the standards of our Occupational Health and Safety Manual and MSHA regulations. For both health and safety issues, extensive training is provided to employees. We have safety committees at our plants made up of salaried and hourly employees. We perform annual internal health and safety audits and conduct semi-annual crisis management drills to test our abilities to respond to various situations. Health and safety programs are administered by our corporate health and safety department with the assistance of plant Environmental, Health and Safety Coordinators.

Seasonality

Our business is affected to some extent by seasonal fluctuations in weather that impact the production levels at our wet processing plant. While our sales and finished product production levels are contracted evenly throughout the year, our excavation and wet sand processing activities are limited to non-winter months. As a consequence, we experience lower cash operating costs in the first and fourth quarter of each calendar year. For additional information, please read “—Assets and Business Operations—Processing Facilities.”

Principal Executive Offices

We lease office space for our principal executive offices in Houston, Texas. The lease expires in October 2012.

Legal Proceedings

Although we may, from time to time, be involved in litigation and claims arising out of our operations in the normal course of business, we do not believe that we are a party to any litigation that will have a material adverse impact on our financial condition or results of operations.

 

129


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

MANAGEMENT

Management of Hi-Crush Partners LP

We are managed and operated by the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner. Following this offering,     % of our outstanding common units and all of our outstanding subordinated units and incentive distribution rights will be owned by our sponsor. As a result of owning our general partner, our sponsor will have the right to appoint all members of the board of directors of our general partner, including the independent directors. Our unitholders will not be entitled to elect our general partner or its directors or otherwise directly participate in our management or operation. Our general partner owes certain duties to our unitholders as well as a fiduciary duty to its owners.

Upon the closing of this offering, we expect that our general partner will have eight directors, one of whom will be independent as defined under the independence standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act. The NYSE does not require a listed publicly-traded partnership, such as ours, to have a majority of independent directors on the board of directors of our general partner or to establish a compensation committee or a nominating committee. However, our general partner is required to have an audit committee of at least three members, and all its members are required to meet the independence and experience standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act, subject to certain transitional relief during the one-year period following consummation of this offering. Our sponsor will appoint at least one member of the audit committee to the board of directors of our general partner by the date our common units first trade on the NYSE.

All of the executive officers of our general partner listed below will allocate their time between managing our business and affairs and the business and affairs of our sponsor. While the amount of time that our executive officers will devote to our business and the business of our sponsor will vary in any given year based on a variety of factors, we currently estimate that each of our executive officers will initially spend approximately 50% of their time on the management of our business following the completion of this offering. Our executive officers intend, however, to devote as much time to the management of our business and affairs as is necessary for the proper conduct of our business and affairs.

Following the consummation of this offering, neither our general partner nor our sponsor will receive any management fee or other compensation in connection with our general partner’s management of our business, but we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates, including our sponsor, for all expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. These expenses include salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf and expenses allocated to our general partner by its affiliates. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions.”

In evaluating director candidates, our sponsor will assess whether a candidate possesses the integrity, judgment, knowledge, experience, skill and expertise that are likely to enhance the board’s ability to manage and direct our affairs and business, including, when applicable, to enhance the ability of committees of the board to fulfill their duties.

 

130


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Executive Officers and Directors of Our General Partner

The following table shows information for the executive officers and directors of our general partner upon the consummation of this offering. Directors are appointed for a one-year term and hold office until their successors have been elected or qualified or until the earlier of their death, resignation, removal or disqualification. Executive officers serve at the discretion of the board. There are no family relationships among any of our directors or executive officers. Some of our directors and all of our executive officers also serve as executive officers of our sponsor.

 

Name

   Age     

Position With Our General Partner

Robert E. Rasmus

     55       Co-Chief Executive Officer and Director

James M. Whipkey

     54       Co-Chief Executive Officer and Director

Jefferies V. Alston, III

     34       Chief Operating Officer and Director

Laura C. Fulton

     48       Chief Financial Officer

Mark C. Skolos

     52       General Counsel and Secretary

Chad M. McEver

     39       Vice President

Robert L. Cabes, Jr.

     42       Director

John R. Huff

     66       Director

Trevor T. Turbidy

     43       Director

Steven A. Webster

     60       Director

Joseph C. Winkler III

     60       Director

Robert E. Rasmus—Co-Chief Executive Officer. Mr. Rasmus is a co-founder of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and has served as its Co-Chief Executive Officer since its formation in October 2010. Mr. Rasmus was named Co-Chief Executive Officer and appointed to the board of directors of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. Rasmus was a founding member of Red Oak Capital Management LLC (“ROCM”) in June 2002 and has served as Managing Director since inception. ROCM’s business model centered on partnering with the largest oil services companies in unconventional basins in the United States. Prior to the founding of ROCM, Mr. Rasmus was the President of Thunderbolt Capital Corp., a venture firm focused on start-up and early stage private equity investments. Previously, Mr. Rasmus started, built and expanded a variety of domestic and international capital markets and corporate finance businesses. Mr. Rasmus was the Senior Managing Director of Banc One Capital Markets, Inc. (formerly First Chicago Capital Markets, Inc.) where he was responsible for the high yield and private placement businesses while functioning as a member of the management committee. Prior thereto, Mr. Rasmus was the Managing Director and Head of Investment Banking in London for First Chicago Ltd. Mr. Rasmus holds a B.A. degree in Government and International Relations from the University of Notre Dame. We believe that Mr. Rasmus’ industry experience and deep knowledge of our business makes him well-suited to serve on the board of directors of our general partner.

James M. Whipkey—Co-Chief Executive Officer. Mr. Whipkey has a 32 year background in the oil and natural gas industry with broad experience in both technical and financial areas. Mr. Whipkey is a co-founder of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and has served as its Co-Chief Executive Officer since its formation in October 2010. Mr. Whipkey was named Co-Chief Executive Officer and appointed to the board of directors of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. Whipkey was a founding member of ROCM in June 2002 and has served as Managing Director since inception. Prior to the founding of ROCM, Mr. Whipkey was an equity analyst covering the exploration and production sector, most recently as a Managing Director at ABN Amro Bank N.V. From 1997 to 2000, Mr. Whipkey was the Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer for NYSE-listed Benton Oil and Gas Company. Prior thereto, Mr. Whipkey worked in a number of investment banking positions managing a wide range of relationships and responsibilities in the energy sector. His various roles included energy derivatives trading at Phibro Energy Inc., investment banking at Kidder, Peabody & Co., and stock analysis at Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc., where he won “All-Star” recognition from the Wall Street Journal in both the E&P and oil service sectors. Mr. Whipkey began his career as a petroleum engineer with Amoco Corporation where he spent five years in operations, drilling and reservoir simulation roles. Mr. Whipkey holds a B.S. degree in Petroleum and Natural Gas Engineering from The Pennsylvania State University and an M.B.A. in Finance from the University of Chicago. We believe that Mr. Whipkey’s experience in senior financial management and knowledge of our business will serve him well as a member of the board of directors of our general partner.

 

131


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Jefferies V. Alston, III—Chief Operating Officer. Mr. Alston has served as Chief Operating Officer of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC since May 2011 and was appointed Chief Operating Officer and appointed to the board of directors of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. Alston founded Trinity Consulting, LLC (“Trinity”) in December 2009, where he designed and managed construction of numerous frac sand processing facilities and became one of the leading consultants in the industry, until dissolving Trinity to join Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. Mr. Alston worked for Alston Equipment Company, Inc. (“Alston Equipment”) from February 1999 until he founded Trinity in December 2009. While at Alston Equipment, Mr. Alston was responsible for sales, growth initiatives and customer relations. Mr. Alston attended The University of Southern Mississippi and Southeastern Louisiana University. With his extensive knowledge of the frac sand industry, we believe Mr. Alston will bring substantial experience and leadership skills to the board of directors of our general partner.

Laura C. Fulton—Chief Financial Officer. Ms. Fulton has served as Chief Financial Officer of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC since April 2012. In May 2012, Ms. Fulton was appointed to Chief Financial Officer of our general partner. From March 2008 to October 2011, Ms. Fulton served as the Executive Vice President, Accounting and then Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer of AEI Services, LLC (“AEI”), an owner and operator of essential energy infrastructure assets in emerging markets. Prior to AEI, Ms. Fulton spent 12 years with Lyondell Chemical Company in various capacities, including as general auditor responsible for internal audit and the Sarbanes-Oxley certification process, and as the assistant controller. Previously, Ms. Fulton worked for Deloitte & Touche in its audit and assurance practice for 11 years. Ms. Fulton is a CPA and graduated cum laude from Texas A&M University with a B.B.A. in Accounting. Ms. Fulton is a member of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and serves on the Accounting Department Advisory Board at Texas A&M University.

Mark C. Skolos—General Counsel and Secretary. Mr. Skolos was appointed General Counsel of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC in April 2012 and named General Counsel and Secretary of our general partner in May 2012. Prior to joining Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, Mr. Skolos was a shareholder at the law firm of Weld, Riley, Prenn and Ricci S.C. (“Weld Riley”) from September 2011 to April 2012. Mr. Skolos worked as an attorney for Skolos, Millis and Matousek, S.C., or its predecessor firms (“Skolos Millis”), for 26 years prior to its merger with Weld Riley in April 2012. Mr. Skolos was made a shareholder at Skolos Millis in 1990. In his private practice, Mr. Skolos represented developers, businesses and local units of government on issues of government regulation, land use and real estate. Mr. Skolos has extensive experience representing companies in the non-metallic mining and processing industry on a wide spectrum of issues, including permitting, land acquisition and government relations. He graduated from the University of Wisconsin Law School in 1985 with a Juris Doctorate degree. Mr. Skolos has served as President of the Tri-County Bar Association of Wisconsin and acted as both Circuit Court and Family Court Commissioner in the State of Wisconsin.

Chad M. McEver—Vice President. Mr. McEver has served as Vice President of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC since its inception in October 2010. Mr. McEver was named Vice President of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. McEver joined ROCM as an Associate in 2004 and has served as Vice President since 2010. In executing the business model of ROCM, Mr. McEver has been responsible for analysis, execution and origination of projects with exploration and production and oilfield services companies and ROCM’s co-investors. From 2001 to 2004, Mr. McEver was a Director at EnerCom, Inc., an investor relations consulting firm exclusively serving the energy industry. From 1999 to 2001, Mr. McEver was an analyst in the investment banking energy group at Raymond James & Associates. Mr. McEver holds a Bachelor of Business Administration from Stephen F. Austin State University and an M.B.A in Finance from the University of Denver.

Robert L. Cabes, Jr.—Director. Mr. Cabes has served as a director of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC since May 2011 and was appointed to the board of directors of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. Cabes has been a Partner of Avista Capital Partners, a private equity firm focused on investments in the energy, healthcare and media sectors, since June 2005. From April 2001 to June 2005, Mr. Cabes served as Principal of Global Energy Partners, Ltd. (“GEP”) a specialty group within Credit Suisse’s asset management business that made investments in energy companies. Prior to joining GEP, Mr. Cabes was with Credit Suisse’s and Donaldson, Lufkin and Jenrette’s Investment Banking Divisions (prior to its acquisition by Credit Suisse in

 

132


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

2000) where he worked on debt and equity securities underwriting and mergers and acquisitions for energy companies. Mr. Cabes has served as a member of the board of directors of Geokinetics, Inc. since November 2006 and serves as a director of numerous private companies, including ACP II Marcellus, LLC, ACP III Utica, LLC, Celtique Energie Holdings Ltd., Hansa Hydrocarbons Ltd., Laramie Energy II, LLC, Laredo Energy IV GP, LLC, Manti Exploration GP LLC, Royal Offshore, LLC and Spartan Offshore Drilling, LLC. Mr. Cabes holds a B.B.A. from Southern Methodist University and is a CFA charterholder. Mr. Cabes brings financial and analytical expertise in the energy sector, including experience as a director of numerous energy-related companies, to the board of directors of our general partner.

John R. Huff—Director. Mr. Huff has served as a director of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC since May 2011 and was appointed to the board of directors of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. Huff has served as Chairman of the board of directors of Oceaneering International, Inc. (“Oceaneering”) since 1990 and served as its Chief Executive Officer from 1986 to 2006. Prior to joining Oceaneering, Mr. Huff served as Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Western Oceanic, Inc. from 1972 to 1986. In addition to his service as chairman of the board of directors of Oceaneering, Mr. Huff has served as a member of the board of directors of KBR, Inc. since April 2007 and of Suncor Energy, Inc. since 1998. Mr. Huff also served as a member of the board of directors of Rowan Companies, Inc. from April 2006 to May 2009 and of BJ Services Company from 1992 to April 2010. Mr. Huff received a Bachelor’s degree in civil engineering from Georgia Tech University and attended the Harvard Business School’s Program for Management Development. Mr. Huff is a Registered Professional Engineer in the State of Texas. We believe that Mr. Huff’s substantial knowledge of energy-related businesses, as well as his considerable experience as a director of public companies, has prepared him well to serve on the board of directors of our general partner.

Trevor T. Turbidy—Director. Mr. Turbidy has served as a director of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC since May 2011 and was appointed to the board of directors of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. Turbidy has served as an energy industry advisor for Avista Capital Partners since 2007. Prior to joining Avista Capital Partners, Mr. Turbidy served as Chief Executive Officer of Trico Marine Services (“Trico”), an international provider of marine support vessel services to the offshore oil and gas industry from 2005 to 2007. Prior to that, Mr. Turbidy was Chief Financial Officer of Trico from 2003 to 2005, functioned as the Chief Restructuring Officer during the company’s restructuring and subsequently was promoted to Chief Executive Officer after its successful completion. Prior to his service at Trico, Mr. Turbidy spent more than a decade with Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrete Inc. (“DLJ”) and Credit Suisse First Boston in their investment banking divisions. During his tenure with DLJ and Credit Suisse First Boston, Mr. Turbidy focused on the energy sector, principally offshore and land drilling contractors, seismic service providers, oilfield equipment manufacturers, offshore support vessel providers and exploration and production companies, as well as regional opportunities in the Southwest. Mr. Turbidy previously served as a director of Grey Wolf, Inc., Precision Drilling Corporation and Trico Marine Services Inc., as well as a number of private companies in the energy industry. Mr. Turbidy holds an A.B. in Economics from Duke University. We believe that Mr. Turbidy’s substantial management-level experience with public and private companies, together with his considerable knowledge of the energy industry as a whole, will be of great value to the board of directors of our general partner.

Steven A. Webster—Director. Mr. Webster has served as a director of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC since May 2011 and was appointed to the board of directors of our general partner in May 2012. Mr. Webster has served as Co-Managing Partner of Avista Capital Partners since he co-founded the firm in July 2005. From January 2000 until June 2005, Mr. Webster served as the Chairman of GEP, which made private equity investments in energy businesses. From December 1997 to May 1999, Mr. Webster was the Chief Executive Officer and President of R&B Falcon Corporation, an offshore drilling contractor, and prior to that, was Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Falcon Drilling Company, which he founded in 1988. Mr. Webster currently serves as a director of Carrizo Oil & Gas, Inc., SEACOR Holdings, Inc., Geokinetics, Inc., Basic Energy Services, Inc. and Hercules Offshore, Inc. Mr. Webster also serves as a trust manager of Camden Property Trust and as a director of several private companies. Mr. Webster previously served as a director of Pinnacle Gas Resources, Inc. from 2003 to June 2009, Encore Bancshares from 2000 to May 2009, Solitario Exploration & Royalty Corp. (formerly

 

133


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Solitario Resources Corp.) from 2006 to March 2009, Brigham Exploration Company from 2000 to April 2007, Goodrich Petroleum Corporation from 2004 to March 2007, Seabulk International, Inc. from 2002 to March 2006, Grey Wolf, Inc. from 1996 to December 2008 and Crown Resources Corporation from 1988 to August 2006. Mr. Webster holds a B.S.I.M. from Purdue University, an MBA from Harvard Business School and an honorary doctorate in management from Purdue University. We believe Mr. Webster’s experience in, and knowledge of, the energy industry, business leadership skills and experience as a director of numerous other public companies make him well-qualified to serve on the board of directors of our general partner.

Joseph C. Winkler III—Director. Mr. Winkler has agreed to join the board of directors of our general partner prior to or upon the listing date and will serve as the Chairman of the Audit Committee and Conflicts Committee. Mr. Winkler served as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Complete Production Services, Inc. (“Complete”), a provider of specialized oil and gas services and equipment in North America, from March 2007 until February 2012, at which time Complete was acquired by Superior Energy Services, Inc. From June 2005 to March 2007, Mr. Winkler served as Complete’s President and Chief Executive Officer. Prior to that, from March 2005 until June 2005, Mr. Winkler served as the Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of National Oilwell Varco, Inc., an oilfield capital equipment and services company, and from May 2003 until March 2005 as the President and Chief Operating Officer of the company’s predecessor, Varco International, Inc. (“Varco”). From April 1996 until May 2003, Mr. Winkler served in various other capacities with Varco and its predecessor, including Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer. From 1993 to April 1996, Mr. Winkler served as the Chief Financial Officer of D.O.S., Ltd., a privately held provider of solids control equipment and services and coil tubing equipment to the oil and gas industry, which was acquired by Varco in April 1996. Prior to joining D.O.S., Ltd., Mr. Winkler served as Chief Financial Officer of Baker Hughes INTEQ, and served in a similar role for various companies owned by Baker Hughes Incorporated including Eastman/Telco and Milpark Drilling Fluids. Mr. Winkler is a member of the board of directors of Dresser-Rand Group, Inc., a NYSE-listed provider of rating equipment solutions, and serves on the Compensation and Nominating and Governance Committees. Mr. Winkler has been a member of the board of directors of Commercial Metals Company, a vertically integrated Fortune 500 steel company, since June 2012 and serves on its Finance Committee. Mr. Winkler is a Gulf Coast District Director of the Petroleum Equipment Suppliers Association (PESA), an oilfield service and supply industry trade association. Mr. Winkler received a B.S. degree in Accounting from Louisiana State University. We believe that Mr. Winkler’s many years of operational, financial, international and capital markets experience, a significant portion of which was with publicly traded companies in the oil and gas services, manufacturing and exploration and production industries, make him particularly well-suited to serve on the board of directors of our general partner.

Involvement in Certain Legal Proceedings

Mr. Turbidy served as an officer of Trico from 2003 to 2007. In December 2003, while Mr. Turbidy was serving as its Chief Financial Officer, Trico and certain of its subsidiaries filed for protection under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. Mr. Turbidy functioned as the Chief Restructuring Officer during the company’s restructuring and subsequently was promoted to Chief Executive Officer after its successful completion.

Director Independence

In accordance with the rules of the NYSE, our sponsor must appoint at least one independent director prior to the listing of our common units on the NYSE, one additional member within three months of that listing, and one additional independent member within 12 months of that listing.

Committees of the Board of Directors

The board of directors of our general partner will have an audit committee and a conflicts committee. We do not expect that we will have a compensation committee, but rather that our board of directors will approve equity grants to directors and employees.

 

134


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Audit Committee

We are required to have an audit committee of at least three members, and all its members are required to meet the independence and experience standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act, subject to certain transitional relief during the one-year period following consummation of this offering as described above. The audit committee will assist the board of directors in its oversight of the integrity of our financial statements and our compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and partnership policies and controls. The audit committee will have the sole authority to (1) retain and terminate our independent registered public accounting firm, (2) approve all auditing services and related fees and the terms thereof performed by our independent registered public accounting firm, and (3) pre-approve any non-audit services and tax services to be rendered by our independent registered public accounting firm. The audit committee will also be responsible for confirming the independence and objectivity of our independent registered public accounting firm. Our independent registered public accounting firm will be given unrestricted access to the audit committee and our management, as necessary.

Conflicts Committee

We expect that at least two independent members of the board of directors of our general partner will serve on a conflicts committee to review specific matters that the board believes may involve conflicts of interest and determines to submit to the conflicts committee for review. The conflicts committee will determine if the resolution of the conflict of interest is in our best interest. The members of the conflicts committee may not be officers or employees of our general partner or directors, officers or employees of its affiliates, including our sponsor, and must meet the independence standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act to serve on an audit committee of a board of directors, along with other requirements in our partnership agreement. Any matters approved by the conflicts committee will be conclusively deemed to be in our best interest, approved by all of our partners and not a breach by our general partner of any duties it may owe us or our unitholders.

 

135


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION AND OTHER INFORMATION

We are providing compensation disclosure that satisfies the requirements applicable to emerging growth companies, as defined in the JOBS Act.

Summary Compensation Table

The table below sets forth the annual compensation earned during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011 by our principal executive officer and our next two most highly-compensated executive officers (our “Named Executive Officers” or “NEOs”).

 

Name and Principal Position

   Year      Salary
($) (1)
     All Other
Compensation
($) (2)
     Total
($)
 

Robert E. Rasmus, Co-Chief Executive Officer

     2011         42,692         16,622         59,314   

James M. Whipkey, Co-Chief Executive Officer

     2011         42,692         14,177         56,869   

Jefferies V. Alston, III, Chief Operating Officer

     2011         42,692                 42,692   

 

(1) Represents the actual amount of salary paid to each NEO during 2011 based upon the annualized base salary of $75,000 defined under each NEO’s employment agreement with us, which became effective on May 25, 2011.
(2) Pursuant to a management services agreement entered into between Red Oak Capital Management LLC and our sponsor, our sponsor reimburses Red Oak Capital Management LLC for the health and welfare benefits and coverage paid for Messrs. Rasmus and Whipkey. Amounts in this column reflect the amount paid by our sponsor for the health and welfare benefits and coverage of Messrs. Rasmus and Whipkey during 2011. Please see “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Other Transactions with Related Persons” for additional information on the management services agreement.

Narrative Disclosure to the Summary Compensation Table

Employment Agreements

Each of our NEOs has entered into an employment agreement with our sponsor (collectively, the “Employment Agreements”). The Employment Agreements were each entered into on May 25, 2011. The initial term of the Employment Agreements is one year for each NEO, with automatic extensions for additional one-year periods unless either party provides at least sixty days advance written notice of the intent to terminate the Employment Agreement.

Under the Employment Agreements, each NEO is entitled to an annualized base salary and is eligible for discretionary bonuses awarded by us from time to time, each of which is described in greater detail below.

The Employment Agreements also contain severance provisions, which are discussed in detail below under “Additional Narrative Disclosure—Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change in Control.”

In addition, the Employment Agreements contain a confidentiality obligation on the part of the NEO of indefinite duration and a non-competition and non-solicitation obligation on the part of the executive for a period of one-year following his termination of employment with us for any reason. We do not currently provide any additional or enhanced payments or benefits to our NEOs in connection with any change in control transactions.

On July 13, 2012, our sponsor entered into a side letter agreement with each of our NEOs (collectively, the “Side Letter Agreements”). The Side Letter Agreements modify each NEO’s base salary and severance provisions as described in further detail below, provided that certain conditions are met.

 

136


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Base Salary

Each NEO’s base salary is a fixed component of compensation and is specified in the Employment Agreements. Each NEO receives an annualized base salary of $75,000. Our NEO’s base salaries were originally set pursuant to discussions between our sponsor and the NEOs.

As provided in the Side Letter Agreements, upon the occurrence of (i) the consummation of this offering and (ii) each NEO’s entry into a written agreement with our sponsor that provides for incentive compensation as consideration for services to be provided to us following the consummation of this offering, each NEO’s base salary as set forth in the Employment Agreements will be reduced to an annualized amount of $1.

Bonuses

Under the Employment Agreements, our NEOs are eligible for discretionary bonuses that may be awarded from time to time; provided that, our board of directors has sole discretion as to whether a bonus is awarded, the criteria for any bonus, and the amount of any bonus. In 2011, no NEOs received such a discretionary bonus.

Our sponsor is currently considering the type, amount, and terms of incentive compensation to be awarded to our NEOs as consideration for services to be provided to us following the consummation of this offering. Our sponsor anticipates reaching a conclusion and entering into a written agreement with each NEO regarding incentive compensation shortly following the consummation of this offering. In any event, whether any of our NEOs will receive incentive compensation for services provided to us is contingent upon the consummation of this offering.

Other Compensation Elements

Each NEO is entitled to 20 days of paid vacation each calendar year during the term of the Employment Agreement.

Outstanding Equity Awards at 2011 Fiscal Year-End

We have not previously granted any equity awards to our NEOs. As a result, none of our NEOs had outstanding equity awards as of December 31, 2011.

Additional Narrative Disclosure

Retirement Benefits

Our sponsor has not maintained and we do not currently maintain a defined benefit pension plan, defined contribution plan or nonqualified deferred compensation plan. As a result, there are no retirement benefits that are currently provided to our NEOs.

Potential Payments Upon Termination or a Change in Control

The Employment Agreements contain severance provisions. Under the terms of the Employment Agreements, the employment of each NEO may be terminated by us with or without Cause, by the NEO for or without Good Reason, due to the NEO’s disability or death, or due to expiration of the term of the Employment Agreement.

Upon a termination by us for Cause, by the NEO without Good Reason, due to the NEO’s disability or death, or due to expiration of the term of the Employment Agreement, the NEO is entitled to the following severance benefits: (i) payment of all accrued and unpaid base salary through the date of termination, (ii) reimbursement for all incurred but unreimbursed expenses entitled to reimbursement, and (iii) provision of any benefits to which the NEO is entitled pursuant to the terms of any applicable benefit plan or program (collectively, the “Accrued Obligations”).

 

137


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Upon a termination by us without Cause or by the NEO for Good Reason, the NEO is entitled to the following severance benefits: (i) payment of the Accrued Obligations and (ii) payment of an additional amount equal to 12 times the monthly rate of the NEO’s base salary as of the date of termination paid in a lump sum payment on the date that is 30 days after the date of termination. Payment of the additional lump sum payment is contingent upon the NEO’s execution and non-revocation of a general release of claims in favor of us.

The Side Letter Agreements provide that upon the consummation of this offering, the severance provisions of the Employment Agreements shall be deemed amended immediately after the closing date of this offering such that upon a termination by us without Cause or by the NEO for Good Reason, the NEO is entitled to the following severance benefits: (i) payment of the Accrued Obligations and (ii) payment of an amount equal to $750,000 paid in a lump sum payment on the date that is 30 days after the date of termination. Payment of the additional lump sum payment is contingent upon the NEO’s execution and non-revocation of a general release of claims in favor of us.

Under the Employment Agreements, “Cause” means an NEO’s: (i) conviction of, or entry of a guilty plea or plea of no contest with respect to, a felony or any other crime directly or indirectly involving the NEO’s lack of honesty or moral turpitude, (ii) drug or alcohol abuse for which the NEO fails to undertake and maintain treatment within five calendar days after requested by the Company, (iii) acts of fraud, embezzlement, theft, dishonesty or gross misconduct, (iv) material misappropriation (or attempted misappropriation) of any of our funds or property, or (v) a breach of the NEO’s obligations described under the Employment Agreement, as determined by a majority of our board of directors. Under the Employment Agreements, “Good Reason” means, without the NEO’s consent: (i) a material breach by us of our obligations under the Employment Agreement, (ii) any material diminution of the duties of the NEO, (iii) a reduction in the NEO’s base salary, other than pursuant to a proportionate reduction applicable to all senior executives or employees generally and the members of our board of directors, to the extent such board members receive board fees, or (iv) the relocation of the geographic location of the NEO’s principal place of employment by more than 50 miles.

No NEO has any right to receive a “gross up” for any excise tax imposed by Section 4999 of the Code, or any federal, state or local income tax.

Director Compensation

Our sponsor paid an annualized fee of $50,000 per year to two non-employee directors as compensation for services as directors of our sponsor. In connection with Avista Capital Partners’ investment in our sponsor, our sponsor paid a fee of $500,000 to non-employee director Trevor Turbidy, who also serves as an Energy Industry Advisor for Avista Capital Partners, for consulting services rendered during 2011.

Following the consummation of this offering, each independent director of our general partner will receive an annual retainer of $50,000. Each independent director will additionally receive an initial grant of the number of common units having a grant date fair value of approximately $50,000 following the closing of this offering. Each independent director will also receive an annual grant, effective on January 1st of each year, of the number of common units having a grant date fair value of approximately $50,000 as of such date. Further, each independent director serving as a chairman or a member of a committee of the board of directors of our general partner will receive an annual retainer of $25,000 or $10,000, respectively.

 

138


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

The following table sets forth the beneficial ownership of common units and subordinated units of Hi-Crush Partners LP that will be issued and outstanding upon the consummation of this offering and the related transactions and held by:

 

   

our general partner;

 

   

beneficial owners of 5% or more of our common units;

 

   

each director, director nominee and named executive officer; and

 

   

all of our directors, director nominees and named executive officers as a group.

The table does not reflect any common units that directors and executive officers may purchase in this offering through the directed unit program described under “Underwriting.”

 

Name of Beneficial Owner

  Common Units
Beneficially
Owned
    Percentage of
Common Units
Beneficially
Owned
    Subordinated
Units Beneficially
Owned
    Percentage of
Subordinated
Units Beneficially
Owned
    Percentage of
Common and
Subordinated
Units Beneficially
Owned
 

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC (1)(2)

      %          100%        %   

Hi-Crush GP LLC (2)

      %          %        %   

Robert E. Rasmus (2)

      %          %        %   

James M. Whipkey (2)

      %          %        %   

Jefferies V. Alston, III (2)

      %          %        %   

Martha M. Romig (2)

      %          %        %   

Robert L. Cabes, Jr. (3)

      %          %        %   

John R. Huff (4)

      %          %        %   

Trevor T. Turbidy (3)

      %          %        %   

Steven A. Webster (3)

      %          %        %   

Joseph C. Winkler III (2)

      %          %        %   

All named executive officers and directors as a group (9 persons)

    —          —  %        —          —  %        —  %   

 

(1)

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC is the selling unitholder in this offering. The table assumes the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase additional common units from the selling unitholder. Avista Capital Partners II, LP, Avista Capital Partners (Offshore) II-A, LP and Avista Capital Partners (Offshore) II, LP indirectly own 58% of the membership interests of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, through two investment vehicles, ACP HIP Splitter, LP and ACP HIP Splitter (Offshore), LP. Each of Avista Capital Partners II, LP, Avista Capital Partners (Offshore) II-A, LP and Avista Capital Partners (Offshore) II, LP is controlled by its general partner, Avista Capital Partners II GP, LLC (“Avista GP”). Voting and investment determinations are made by an investment committee of Avista GP, comprised of the following members: Thompson Dean, Steven Webster, David Burgstahler, Newton Aguiar, Robert Cabes, David Durkin and OhSang Kwon. As a result, and by virtue of the relationships described above, each of Thompson Dean, Steven Webster, David Burgstahler, Newton Aguiar, Robert Cabes, David Durkin and OhSang Kwon may be deemed to exercise voting and dispositive power with respect to securities held by ACP HIP Splitter, LP and ACP HIP Splitter (Offshore), LP. The address for Avista Capital Partners is 65 East 55th Street, 18th Floor, New York, NY 10022.

 

(2) The address for each of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, Hi-Crush GP LLC, Robert E. Rasmus, James M. Whipkey, Jefferies V. Alston, III, Martha M. Romig and Joseph C. Winkler III is Three Riverway, Suite 1550, Houston, Texas 77056.

 

(3) The address for each of Robert L. Cabes, Jr., Trevor T. Turbidy and Steven A. Webster is 1000 Louisiana St., Suite 3700, Houston, Texas 77002.

 

(4) The address for John R. Huff is 11911 FM 529, Houston, Texas 77041.

 

139


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Pursuant to a pledge and security agreement between our sponsor and Amegy Bank, National Association, as administrative agent under our sponsor’s senior secured credit facility, all of our sponsor’s interest in (i) our general partner, (ii) the              common units our sponsor owns in us which are not being sold in this offering (or up to              common units if the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full), (iii) the              subordinated units our sponsor owns in us and (iv) the incentive distribution rights, are pledged as collateral for the benefit of the lenders under such credit facility. In the event the underwriters do not exercise in full their option to acquire an additional              common units from our sponsor, our sponsor will also pledge any additional common units not purchased by the underwriters.

 

140


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

After this offering, assuming that the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase additional common units, our sponsor will own              common units and              subordinated units representing an aggregate approximately     % limited partner interest in us, will own the incentive distribution rights and will own and control our general partner. Our sponsor will also appoint all of the directors of our general partner, which will maintain a non-economic general partner interest in us.

The terms of the transactions and agreements disclosed in this section were determined by and among affiliated entities and, consequently, are not the result of arm’s length negotiations. These terms are not necessarily at least as favorable to the parties to these transactions and agreements as the terms that could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties.

Distributions and Payments to Affiliates of Our General Partner

The following table summarizes the distributions and payments to be made by us to our general partner and its affiliates in connection with the formation, ongoing operation and any liquidation of Hi-Crush Partners LP.

Formation Stage

The aggregate consideration received by

affiliates of our general partner for the

contribution of their interests

              common units including              common units the selling unitholder is selling to the public in this offering;

 

                subordinated units; and

 

    our incentive distribution rights.

 

  To the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units, the selling unitholder will sell such units to the public.

Operational Stage

Distributions of cash available for

distribution to our general partner and its

affiliates

We will generally make cash distributions 100% to our unitholders, including affiliates of our general partner. In addition, if distributions exceed the minimum quarterly distribution and other higher target distribution levels, our sponsor (as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) will be entitled to increasing percentages of the distributions, up to 50.0% of the distributions above the highest target distribution level.

 

  Assuming we have sufficient cash available for distribution to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our outstanding common units and subordinated units for four quarters, affiliates of our general partner would receive an annual distribution of approximately $         million on their units.

 

141


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Payments to our general partner and its affiliates

Our general partner will not receive a management fee or other compensation for its management of our partnership, but we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for all direct and indirect expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. These expenses include salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf and expenses allocated to our general partner by its affiliates. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us.

 

Withdrawal or removal of our general partner

If our general partner withdraws or is removed, its non-economic general partner interest and our sponsor’s incentive distribution rights will either be sold to the new general partner for cash or converted into common units, in each case for an amount equal to the fair market value of those interests. Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner.”

Liquidation Stage

 

Liquidation

Upon our liquidation, the partners will be entitled to receive liquidating distributions according to their particular capital account balances.

Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions

In connection with this offering, we will enter into certain agreements with our sponsor, as described in more detail below.

Contribution Agreement

In connection with the closing of this offering, we will enter into a contribution agreement that will effect the transactions, including the transfer of the ownership interests in Hi-Crush Chambers LLC, Hi-Crush Railroad LLC, Hi-Crush Wyeville LLC and Hi-Crush Operating LLC and the issuance by us to our sponsor of common units, subordinated units and incentive distribution rights. While we believe this agreement is on terms no less favorable to any party than those that could have been negotiated with an unaffiliated third party, it will not be the result of arm’s-length negotiations. All of the transaction expenses incurred in connection with these transactions will be paid from the proceeds of this offering.

Omnibus Agreement

In connection with the closing of this offering, we will enter into an omnibus agreement with affiliates of our general partner, including our sponsor, that will address certain aspects of our relationship with them, including:

 

   

our use of the name “Hi-Crush” and related marks;

 

   

our payment of administrative services fees to our sponsor for general and administrative services;

 

   

the assumption by our sponsor of one of our customer contracts beginning on May 1, 2013;

 

   

our right of first offer with respect to our sponsor’s Augusta and Tomah acreage and related assets, which are being retained by our sponsor in connection with this offering; and

 

   

certain indemnification obligations.

 

142


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The omnibus agreement can be amended by written agreement of all parties to the agreement. However, the partnership may not agree to any amendment or modification that would, in the reasonable discretion of our general partner, be adverse in any material respect to the holders of our common units without prior approval of the conflicts committee. So long as our sponsor controls our general partner, the omnibus agreement will remain in full force and effect unless mutually terminated by the parties. If our sponsor ceases to control our general partner, the omnibus agreement will terminate, provided the indemnification obligations and obligations with respect to the FTS International contract described below will remain in full force and effect in accordance with their terms.

Indemnification Obligations

Our sponsor’s indemnification obligations will include certain liabilities relating to:

 

   

for a period of three years after the closing of this offering, environmental liabilities, including (i) any violation or correction of violation of environmental laws associated with our assets, where a correction of violation would include assessment, investigation, monitoring, remediation, or other similar action and (ii) any event, omission or condition associated with the ownership of our assets (including the presence of hazardous materials), including (A) the cost and expense of any assessment, investigation, monitoring, remediation or other similar action and (B) the cost and expense of any environmental or toxic tort litigation, provided that the aggregate amount payable to us pursuant to this bullet point does not exceed $7.5 million;

 

   

until 60 days after the applicable statute of limitations, any of our federal, state and local income tax liabilities attributable to the ownership and operation of our assets and the assets of our subsidiaries prior to the closing of this offering;

 

   

for a period of three years after the closing of this offering, the failure to have all necessary consents and governmental permits where such failure renders us unable to use and operate our assets in substantially the same manner in which they were used and operated immediately prior to the closing of this offering (subject to certain exceptions for the revocation or non-renewal of consents and governmental permits due to changes in laws, governmental regulations or certain other events outside of the control of our sponsor and our general partner);

 

   

for a period of three years after the closing of this offering, our failure to have valid and indefeasible easement rights, rights-of-way, leasehold and/or fee ownership interest in the lands where our assets are located and such failure prevents us from using or operating our assets in substantially the same manner as operated immediately prior to the closing of this offering;

 

   

any losses, costs or damages incurred by us that are attributable to the ownership and operation of the assets our sponsor is contributing to us prior to the closing of this offering; and

 

   

any losses arising out of or associated with our customer contract with FTS International, which we refer to as the “FTS International contract,” after we assign it to our sponsor effective May 1, 2013 as contemplated by the omnibus agreement.

In no event will our sponsor be obligated to indemnify us for any claims, losses or expenses or income taxes referred to above to the extent either (i) reserved for in our financial statements as of December 31, 2011, or (ii) we recover any such amounts under available insurance coverage, from contractual rights or other recoveries against any third party.

In addition, we will also agree to indemnify our sponsor from any losses, costs or damages incurred by our sponsor that are attributable to the ownership and operation of our assets and the assets of our subsidiaries following the closing of this offering, subject to the same limitations on our sponsor’s indemnity to us.

 

143


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Assignment of FTS International Customer Contract

We will be obligated to assign to our sponsor or a designated subsidiary of our sponsor all of our rights and obligations under our FTS International contract effective as of May 1, 2013, and our sponsor will be obligated to accept such assignment and assume our obligations under such contract. Pursuant to the terms of the FTS International contract, such assignment will not relieve us of any liability under the FTS International contract, but our sponsor has agreed to fully and unconditionally indemnify us in connection with any losses we incur with regard to the FTS International contract from and after the date of the assignment.

Following our assignment of the FTS International contract as described above, because of our indemnification rights, we will effectively have no rights, obligations or liability under the contract.

Right of First Offer With Respect to Augusta and Tomah Assets

Our sponsor will grant us, for a period of 3 years following this offering, a right of first offer on its sand reserves and any related assets that have been or will be constructed on its current acreage in Augusta and Tomah, Wisconsin (the “ROFO assets”) to the extent that our sponsor proposes to transfer a ROFO asset to a third party other than in connection with a sale of all or substantially all of its assets.

In the event our sponsor proposes to transfer any ROFO asset, it will first give notice to us of its intention to transfer such asset (a “ROFO notice”), and the ROFO notice will include any material terms and conditions as would be reasonably necessary for us to make a responsive offer to enter into the proposed transaction. We will have 15 days following the receipt of the ROFO notice to propose an offer to acquire the ROFO asset from our sponsor (a “ROFO response”), which proposal will include the terms on which we would be willing to enter into a binding agreement to acquire the assets. If we do not deliver a ROFO response within such 15-day period, then we will be deemed to have waived our right of first offer with respect to the ROFO asset in question, and our sponsor will be free to transfer the ROFO asset to any third party on terms and conditions determined in the sole discretion of our sponsor.

If we do submit a ROFO response, then we and our sponsor will be obligated to negotiate, in good faith, the terms of the purchase and sale of the ROFO asset for 10 days following our delivery of the ROFO response. If we are unable to reach a definitive agreement during such 10-day period, then our sponsor may transfer the ROFO asset to any third party on terms and conditions determined in the sole discretion of our sponsor.

Our sponsor and its affiliates will not be restricted, under either our partnership agreement or the omnibus agreement, from competing with us. In particular, our sponsor’s Augusta facility competes with us for new and existing frac sand customers. Our sponsor may, except with respect to the right of first offer described above, acquire or dispose of frac sand reserves and processing facilities or other assets in the future without any obligation to offer us the opportunity to purchase those assets.

Registration Rights Agreement

In connection with this offering, we will enter into a registration rights agreement with our sponsor, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, pursuant to which we may be required to register the sale of the (i) common units issued (or issuable) to our sponsor pursuant to the contribution agreement, (ii) subordinated units and (iii) common units issuable upon conversion of the subordinated units or the Combined Interests (as defined in our partnership agreement) pursuant to the terms of the Partnership Agreement (together, the “Registrable Securities”) it holds. Under the registration rights agreement, our sponsor will have the right to request that we register the sale of Registrable Securities held by it, and our sponsor will have the right to require us to make available shelf registration statements permitting sales of Registrable Securities into the market from time to time over an extended period, subject to certain limitations. The registration rights agreement also includes provisions dealing with indemnification and contribution and allocation of expenses. All of our Registrable Securities held by our sponsor and any permitted transferee will be entitled to these registration rights.

 

144


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Other Transactions with Related Persons

On May 25, 2011, our sponsor entered into a Management Services Agreement (“Services Agreement”) with ROCM. Messrs. Rasmus and Whipkey, our co-chief executive officers, each hold 50% interests in ROCM. The Services Agreement requires ROCM to provide our sponsor with certain management and administrative support services, including, without limitation (i) general management oversight and administration of the sponsor’s business, (ii) services of ROCM’s corporate accounting and internal controls personnel, (iii) use of ROCM’s office space, (iv) all necessary business supplies for use at ROCM’s office space, (v) use of ROCM’s communication systems and telephone equipment and (vi) use of ROCM’s information systems services, along with all other management and administrative services that our sponsor and ROCM agree are necessary for the efficient operation of our sponsor’s business and affairs. Neither we nor any of our subsidiaries are parties to the Services Agreement, and neither we nor any of our subsidiaries intend to assume any obligations under the Services Agreement.

The initial term of the Services Agreement was one year, but it remains in place pursuant to its terms, subject to termination. Either party may terminate the agreement by delivering written notice within 90 days prior to the date of expiration of the initial term or any time after the expiration of the initial term, by delivering written notice 90 days prior to the desired date of termination. Under the terms of the Services Agreement, our sponsor does not pay any stand-alone management fee, but instead reimburses ROCM for 95% of the costs actually incurred by ROCM in providing the services described above, up to an aggregate of $850,000 per year. These costs include the salary and benefits paid to the employees providing accounting and internal control services, the rent of ROCM’s office space, the costs of business supplies, communication and telephone systems and other similar expenses. After two years from the date of signing, our sponsor will be obligated to reimburse ROCM for 100% of such costs. Total management services fees for 2011 and 2010 were $370,000 and $0, respectively. Based on their interests in ROCM, the approximate value of the interests of Messrs. Rasmus and Whipkey in the Services Agreement were $185,000 and $0 each for 2011 and 2010, respectively.

On July 20, 2011, our sponsor entered into various subordinated promissory notes with certain equity investors, including Avista Capital Partners, and their affiliates in an aggregate original principal amount of approximately $52.2 million. Borrowings under the subordinated promissory notes bear interest, at our sponsor’s option, at a rate of 10.0% for cash interest and 12.0% for paid-in-kind interest (“PIK interest”). As of December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012, there was $46.1 million and $57.7 million of outstanding indebtedness under our sponsor’s subordinated promissory notes, respectively. The outstanding balance includes $2.4 million and $5.5 million of PIK interest as of December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012, respectively. The subordinated promissory notes mature in July 2016.

Our sponsor pays quarterly director fees to directors that may be members and/or holders of debt of our sponsor. Total director fees incurred in 2011 and 2010 were approximately $60,000 and $0, respectively, and are included in general and administrative costs.

Procedures for Review, Approval and Ratification of Transactions with Related Persons

We expect that the board of directors of our general partner will adopt policies for the review, approval and ratification of transactions with related persons and a written code of business conduct and ethics. We expect that, under our code of business conduct and ethics, a director will be required to bring to the attention of the chief executive officer or the board any conflict or potential conflict of interest that may arise between the director or any affiliate of the director, on the one hand, and us or our general partner on the other. The resolution of any such conflict or potential conflict should, at the discretion of the board in light of the circumstances, be determined by a majority of the disinterested directors. In determining whether to approve or ratify a transaction with a related party, we expect that the board of directors of our general partner will take into account, among other factors it deems appropriate, (1) whether the transaction is on terms no less favorable than terms generally available to an unaffiliated third party under the same or similar circumstances, (2) the extent of the related person’s interest in the transaction and (3) whether the interested transaction is material to the Partnership. As

 

145


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

described in “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties,” our partnership agreement contains detailed provisions regarding the resolution of conflicts of interest, as well as the standard of care the board of directors of our general partner must satisfy in doing so.

If a conflict or potential conflict of interest arises between our general partner or its affiliates, on the one hand, and us or our unitholders, on the other hand, the resolution of any such conflict or potential conflict should be addressed by the board of directors of our general partner in accordance with the provisions of our partnership agreement. Such a conflict of interest may arise, for example, in connection with negotiating and approving the acquisition of any assets from our sponsor, including in connection with our right of first offer under the omnibus agreement. At the discretion of the board in light of the circumstances, the resolution may be determined by the board in its entirety or by a conflicts committee meeting the definitional requirements for such a committee under our partnership agreement. We do not expect that our code of business conduct and ethics or any policies that the board of directors of our general partner will adopt will require the approval of any transactions with related persons, including our sponsor, by our unitholders.

As described elsewhere in this prospectus, we expect to have the opportunity to acquire additional assets from our sponsor in the future, including in connection with our right of first offer provided in the omnibus agreement. Our sponsor or other affiliates of our general partner are free to offer properties to us on terms they deem acceptable. We expect that, under our code of business conduct and ethics, the board of directors of our general partner (or the conflicts committee, if the board of directors delegates the necessary authority to the conflicts committee) will be free to accept or reject any such offers and to negotiate any terms it deems acceptable to us and that the board of directors of our general partner or the conflicts committee will decide the appropriate value of any assets offered to us by affiliates of our general partner. In making such determination of value, the board of directors of our general partner or the conflicts committee will be permitted to consider any factors they determine in good faith to consider. We expect the board of directors or the conflicts committee will consider a number of factors in its determination of value, including, without limitation, operating data, reserve information, operating cost structure, current and projected cash flow, financing costs, the anticipated impact on distributions to our unitholders, the price outlook for frac sand, reserve life and the location and quality of the reserves.

Upon our adoption of our code of business conduct, we would expect that any executive officer will be required to avoid conflicts of interest unless approved by the board of directors of our general partner.

In the case of any sale of equity by us in which an owner or affiliate of an owner of our general partner participates, we anticipate that our practice will be to obtain approval of the board for the transaction. We anticipate that the board will typically delegate authority to set the specific terms to a pricing committee, consisting of one of the co-chief executive officers and one independent director. Actions by the pricing committee will require unanimous approval. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties—Conflicts of Interest” for additional information regarding the relevant provisions of our partnership agreement.

The code of business conduct and ethics described above will be adopted in connection with the closing of this offering, and as a result, the transactions described above were not reviewed according to such procedures.

 

146


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST AND FIDUCIARY DUTIES

Conflicts of Interest

Conflicts of interest exist and may arise in the future as a result of the relationships between our general partner and its affiliates, including our sponsor, on the one hand, and our partnership and our limited partners, on the other hand. The directors and officers of our general partner have fiduciary duties to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to our sponsor. At the same time, our general partner has a duty to manage our partnership in a manner it believes is in our best interests. Our partnership agreement specifically defines the remedies available to unitholders for actions taken that, without these defined liability standards, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty under applicable Delaware law. The Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act, which we refer to as the Delaware Act, provides that Delaware limited partnerships may, in their partnership agreements, expand, restrict or eliminate the fiduciary duties otherwise owed by the general partner to the limited partners and the partnership.

Whenever a conflict arises between our general partner or its affiliates, on the one hand, and us or our limited partners, on the other hand, the resolution or course of action in respect of such conflict of interest shall be permitted and deemed approved by all our limited partners and shall not constitute a breach of our partnership agreement, of any agreement contemplated thereby or of any duty, if the resolution or course of action in respect of such conflict of interest is:

 

   

approved by the conflicts committee of our general partner, although our general partner is not obligated to seek such approval; or

 

   

approved by the holders of a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding any such units owned by our general partner or any of its affiliates.

Our general partner may, but is not required to, seek the approval of such resolutions or courses of action from the conflicts committee of its board of directors or from the holders of a majority of the outstanding common units as described above. If our general partner does not seek approval from the conflicts committee or from holders of common units as described above and the board of directors of our general partner approves the resolution or course of action taken with respect to the conflict of interest, then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, the board of directors of our general partner acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of us or any of our unitholders, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. Unless the resolution of a conflict is specifically provided for in our partnership agreement, the board of directors of our general partner or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner may consider any factors they determine in good faith to consider when resolving a conflict. An independent third party is not required to evaluate the resolution. Under our partnership agreement, a determination, other action or failure to act by our general partner, the board of directors of our general partner or any committee thereof (including the conflicts committee) will be deemed to be “in good faith” unless our general partner, the board of directors of our general partner or any committee thereof (including the conflicts committee) believed such determination, other action or failure to act was adverse to the interests of the partnership. Please read “Management—Committees of the Board of Directors—Conflicts Committee” for information about the conflicts committee of our general partner’s board of directors.

Conflicts of interest could arise in the situations described below, among others:

Actions taken by our general partner may affect the amount of cash available to pay distributions to unitholders or accelerate the right to convert subordinated units.

The amount of cash that is available for distribution to unitholders is affected by decisions of our general partner regarding such matters as:

 

   

amount and timing of asset purchases and sales;

 

147


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

cash expenditures;

 

   

borrowings;

 

   

entry into and repayment of current and future indebtedness;

 

   

issuance of additional units; and

 

   

the creation, reduction or increase of reserves in any quarter.

In addition, borrowings by us and our affiliates do not constitute a breach of any duty owed by our general partner to our unitholders, including borrowings that have the purpose or effect of:

 

   

enabling affiliates of our general partner to receive distributions on any subordinated units held by them or the incentive distribution rights; or

 

   

hastening the expiration of the subordination period.

In addition, our general partner may use an amount, initially equal to $         million, which would not otherwise constitute operating surplus, in order to permit the payment of distributions on subordinated units and the incentive distribution rights. All of these actions may affect the amount of cash or equity distributed to our unitholders and our general partner and may facilitate the conversion of subordinated units into common units. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners.”

For example, in the event we have not generated sufficient cash from our operations to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our common units and our subordinated units, our partnership agreement permits us to borrow funds, which would enable us to make such distribution on all outstanding units. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus—Operating Surplus.”

The directors and officers of our sponsor have a fiduciary duty to make decisions in the best interests of the owners of our sponsor, which may be contrary to our interests.

Because certain officers and certain directors of our general partner are also directors and/or officers of affiliates of our general partner, including our sponsor, they have fiduciary duties to our sponsor that may cause them to pursue business strategies that disproportionately benefit our sponsor or which otherwise are not in our best interests.

Our general partner is allowed to take into account the interests of parties other than us, such as our sponsor, in exercising certain rights under our partnership agreement.

Our partnership agreement contains provisions that permissibly reduce the standards to which our general partner would otherwise be held by state fiduciary duty law. For example, our partnership agreement permits our general partner to make a number of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner. This entitles our general partner to consider only the interests and factors that it desires, and it has no duty or obligation to give any consideration to any interest of, or factors affecting, us, our affiliates or any limited partner. Examples include the exercise of its call right, its voting rights with respect to any units it owns, its registration rights and its determination whether or not to consent to any merger or consolidation.

Our sponsor competes with us, and our general partner’s affiliates will have the ability to compete with us, and neither our general partner nor its affiliates have any obligation to present business opportunities to us.

Affiliates of our general partner are not prohibited from engaging in other businesses or activities, including those that might be in direct competition with us, and our sponsor or its affiliates, may acquire, construct or dispose of assets in the future without any obligation to offer us the opportunity to acquire those assets, other than our right of first offer on our sponsor’s sand reserves and any related assets that have been or will be

 

148


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

constructed on its acreage in Augusta, Wisconsin and Tomah, Wisconsin. In addition, our sponsor owns an entity that competes with us and we expect that it will acquire interests in additional entities that will directly compete with us following this offering. For example, our sponsor recently completed construction of the Augusta excavation and processing facility in Eau Claire County, Wisconsin. Our sponsor has contracted for the sale of 1,200,000 tons per year of coarse grand Northern White sand from the Augusta facility with two of our existing customers and may seek additional contracts from other of our current and potential customers in direct competition with us as we seek to renew or replace our existing contracts. We share our management team with our sponsor, and the shared management team is under no obligation to offer new and replacement customer contracts to us before offering them to our sponsor, which could have a material adverse impact on our ability to renew or replace existing customer contracts on favorable terms or at all.

Under our partnership agreement, the doctrine of corporate opportunity, or any analogous doctrine, will not apply to our general partner and its affiliates. As a result, neither our general partner nor any of its affiliates have any obligation to present business opportunities to us.

Our partnership agreement limits the liability of, and replaces the duties owed by, our general partner and also restricts the remedies available to our unitholders for actions that, without the limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty.

In addition to the provisions described above, our partnership agreement contains provisions that restrict the remedies available to our unitholders for actions that might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty. For example, our partnership agreement provides that:

 

   

our general partner shall not have any liability to us or our unitholders for decisions made in its capacity as a general partner so long as it acted in good faith, meaning it believed that the decision was not adverse to the interests of our partnership;

 

   

our general partner and its officers and directors will not be liable for monetary damages to us or our limited partners for any acts or omissions unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that our general partner or those other persons acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that its conduct was unlawful; and

 

   

in resolving conflicts of interest, it will be presumed that in making its decision the general partner, the board of directors of the general partner or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or us, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption.

By purchasing a common unit, a common unitholder will agree to become bound by the provisions in our partnership agreement, including the provisions discussed above. Please read “—Fiduciary Duties.”

Common unitholders have no right to enforce obligations of our general partner and its affiliates under agreements with us.

Any agreements between us, on the one hand, and our general partner and its affiliates, on the other, will not grant to the unitholders, separate and apart from us, the right to enforce the obligations of our general partner and its affiliates in our favor.

Contracts between us, on the one hand, and our general partner and its affiliates, on the other, are not and will not be the result of arm’s-length negotiations.

Neither our partnership agreement nor any of the other agreements, contracts and arrangements between us and our general partner and its affiliates are or will be the result of arm’s-length negotiations. Our general partner will determine, in good faith, the terms of any of such future transactions.

 

149


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Except in limited circumstances, our general partner has the power and authority to conduct our business without unitholder approval.

Under our partnership agreement, our general partner has full power and authority to do all things, other than those items that require unitholder approval, necessary or appropriate to conduct our business including, but not limited to, the following actions:

 

   

expending, lending, or borrowing money, assuming, guaranteeing, or otherwise contracting for, indebtedness and other liabilities, issuing evidences of indebtedness, including indebtedness that is convertible into our securities, and incurring any other obligations;

 

   

preparing and transmitting tax, regulatory and other filings, periodic or other reports to governmental or other agencies having jurisdiction over our business or assets;

 

   

acquiring, disposing, mortgaging, pledging, encumbering, hypothecating, or exchanging our assets or merging or otherwise combining us with or into another person;

 

   

negotiating, executing and performing contracts, conveyance or other instruments;

 

   

distributing cash;

 

   

selecting or dismissing employees and agents, outside attorneys, accountants, consultants and contractors and determining their compensation and other terms of employment or hiring;

 

   

maintaining insurance for our benefit;

 

   

forming, acquiring an interest in, and contributing property and loaning money to, any further limited partnerships, joint ventures, corporations, limited liability companies or other relationships;

 

   

controlling all matters affecting our rights and obligations, including bringing and defending actions at law or in equity or otherwise litigating, arbitrating or mediating, and incurring legal expense and settling claims and litigation;

 

   

indemnifying any person against liabilities and contingencies to the extent permitted by law;

 

   

purchasing, selling or otherwise acquiring or disposing of our partnership interests, or issuing additional options, rights, warrants, appreciation rights, phantom or tracking interests relating to our partnership interests; and

 

   

entering into agreements with any of its affiliates to render services to us or to itself in the discharge of its duties as our general partner.

Please read “The Partnership Agreement” for information regarding the voting rights of unitholders.

Common units are subject to our general partner’s call right.

If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the common units, our general partner will have the right, which it may assign to any of its affiliates or to us, but not the obligation, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the common units held by unaffiliated persons at the market price calculated in accordance with the terms of our partnership agreement. As a result, you may be required to sell your common units at an undesirable time or price and may not receive any return on your investment. You may also incur a tax liability upon a sale of your units. Our general partner is not obligated to obtain a fairness opinion regarding the value of the common units to be repurchased by it upon exercise of the call right. There is no restriction in our partnership agreement that prevents our general partner from issuing additional common units and exercising its call right. Our general partner may use its own discretion, free of fiduciary duty restrictions, in determining whether to exercise this right. As a result, a common unitholder may have his common units purchased from him at an undesirable time or price. Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Limited Call Right.”

 

150


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

We may not choose to retain separate counsel for ourselves or for the holders of common units.

The attorneys, independent accountants and others who perform services for us have been retained by our general partner. Attorneys, independent accountants and others who perform services for us are selected by our general partner or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner and may perform services for our general partner and its affiliates. We may retain separate counsel for ourselves or the conflict committee in the event of a conflict of interest between our general partner and its affiliates, on the one hand, and us or the holders of common units, on the other, depending on the nature of the conflict, although we may choose not to do so.

The holder or holders of our incentive distribution rights may elect to cause us to issue common units to it in connection with a resetting of incentive distribution levels without the approval of our unitholders. This election may result in lower distributions to our common unitholders in certain situations.

The holder or holders of a majority of our incentive distribution rights (initially our sponsor) have the right, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and they have received incentive distributions at the highest level to which they are entitled (50.0%) for each of the prior four consecutive fiscal quarters, to reset the initial target distribution levels at higher levels based on our cash distribution levels at the time of the exercise of the reset election. Following a reset election, a baseline distribution amount will be calculated equal to an amount equal to the prior cash distribution per common unit for the fiscal quarter immediately preceding the reset election (such amount is referred to as the “reset minimum quarterly distribution”), and the target distribution levels will be reset to correspondingly higher levels based on percentage increases above the reset minimum quarterly distribution.

We anticipate that our sponsor would exercise this reset right in order to facilitate acquisitions or internal growth projects that would not be sufficiently accretive to cash distributions per unit without such conversion. However, our sponsor may transfer the incentive distribution rights at any time. It is possible that our sponsor or a transferee could exercise this reset election at a time when we are experiencing declines in our aggregate cash distributions or at a time when the holders of the incentive distribution rights expect that we will experience declines in our aggregate cash distributions in the foreseeable future. In such situations, the holders of the incentive distribution rights may be experiencing, or may expect to experience, declines in the cash distributions it receives related to the incentive distribution rights and may therefore desire to be issued our common units, which are entitled to specified priorities with respect to our distributions and which therefore may be more advantageous for them to own in lieu of the right to receive incentive distribution payments based on target distribution levels that are less certain to be achieved. As a result, a reset election may cause our common unitholders to experience dilution in the amount of cash distributions that they would have otherwise received had we not issued new common units to the holders of the incentive distribution rights in connection with resetting the target distribution levels. Please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Our Sponsor’s Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Rights.”

Fiduciary Duties

Duties owed to unitholders by our general partner are prescribed by law and in our partnership agreement. The Delaware Act provides that Delaware limited partnerships may, in their partnership agreements, expand, restrict or eliminate the fiduciary duties otherwise owed by the general partner to limited partners and the partnership.

Our partnership agreement contains various provisions that eliminate and replace the fiduciary duties that might otherwise be owed by our general partner. We have adopted these provisions to allow our general partner or its affiliates to engage in transactions with us that otherwise might be prohibited by state law fiduciary standards and to take into account the interests of other parties in addition to our interests when resolving conflicts of interest. We believe this is appropriate and necessary because the board of directors of our general partner has a duty to manage our partnership in good faith and a duty to manage our general partner in a manner

 

151


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

beneficial to its owner. Without these modifications, our general partner’s ability to make decisions involving conflicts of interest would be restricted. Replacing the fiduciary duty standards in this manner benefits our general partner by enabling it to take into consideration all parties involved in the proposed action. Replacing the fiduciary duty standards also strengthens the ability of our general partner to attract and retain experienced and capable directors. Replacing the fiduciary duty standards represents a detriment to our public unitholders because it restricts the remedies available to our public unitholders for actions that, without those limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty, as described below, and permits our general partner to take into account the interests of third parties in addition to our interests when resolving conflicts of interests.

The following is a summary of the material restrictions of the fiduciary duties owed by our general partner to the limited partners:

 

State law fiduciary duty standards

Fiduciary duties are generally considered to include an obligation to act in good faith and with due care and loyalty. The duty of care, in the absence of a provision in a partnership agreement providing otherwise, would generally require a general partner to act for the partnership in the same manner as a prudent person would act on his own behalf. The duty of loyalty, in the absence of a provision in a partnership agreement providing otherwise, would generally require that any action taken or transaction engaged in be entirely fair to the partnership.

 

Partnership agreement modified standards

Our partnership agreement contains provisions that waive or consent to conduct by our general partner and its affiliates that might otherwise raise issues as to compliance with fiduciary duties or applicable law. For example, our partnership agreement provides that when our general partner is acting in its capacity as our general partner, as opposed to in its individual capacity, it must act in “good faith” and will not be subject to any other standard under applicable law. In addition, when our general partner is acting in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner, it may act without any fiduciary obligation to us or the unitholders whatsoever. These standards replace the obligations to which our general partner would otherwise be held.

 

  If our general partner does not obtain approval from the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner or our common unitholders, excluding any such units owned by our general partner or its affiliates, and the board of directors of our general partner approves the resolution or course of action taken with respect to the conflict of interest, then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, its board, which may include board members affected by the conflict of interest, acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. These standards replace the obligations to which our general partner would otherwise be held.

 

152


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Rights and remedies of unitholders

The Delaware Act generally provides that a limited partner may institute legal action on behalf of the partnership to recover damages from a third party where a general partner has refused to institute the action or where an effort to cause a general partner to do so is not likely to succeed. These actions include actions against a general partner for breach of its duties or of our partnership agreement. In addition, the statutory or case law of some jurisdictions may permit a limited partner to institute legal action on behalf of himself and all other similarly situated limited partners to recover damages from a general partner for violations of its fiduciary duties to the limited partners.

 

Partnership agreement modified standards

The Delaware Act provides that, unless otherwise provided in a partnership agreement, a partner or other person shall not be liable to a limited partnership or to another partner or to another person that is a party to or is otherwise bound by a partnership agreement for breach of fiduciary duty for the partner’s or other person’s good faith reliance on the provisions of the partnership agreement. Under our partnership agreement, to the extent that, at law or in equity an indemnitee has duties (including fiduciary duties) and liabilities relating thereto to us or to our partners, our general partner and any other indemnitee acting in connection with our business or affairs shall not be liable to us or to any partner for its good faith reliance on the provisions of our partnership agreement.

By purchasing our common units, each common unitholder automatically agrees to be bound by the provisions in our partnership agreement, including the provisions discussed above. This is in accordance with the policy of the Delaware Act favoring the principle of freedom of contract and the enforceability of partnership agreements. The failure of a limited partner to sign a partnership agreement does not render the partnership agreement unenforceable against that person.

Under our partnership agreement, we must indemnify our general partner and its officers, directors, managers and certain other specified persons, to the fullest extent permitted by law, against liabilities, costs and expenses incurred by our general partner or these other persons. We must provide this indemnification unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that these persons acted in bad faith. We must also provide this indemnification for criminal proceedings unless our general partner or these other persons acted with knowledge that their conduct was unlawful. Thus, our general partner could be indemnified for its negligent acts if it meets the requirements set forth above. To the extent these provisions purport to include indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act in the opinion of the SEC, such indemnification is contrary to public policy and, therefore, unenforceable. Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Indemnification.”

 

153


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

DESCRIPTION OF THE COMMON UNITS

The Units

The common units and the subordinated units are separate classes of limited partner interests in us. The holders of units are entitled to participate in partnership distributions and exercise the rights or privileges available to limited partners under our partnership agreement. For a description of the relative rights and preferences of holders of common units and subordinated units in and to partnership distributions, please read this section and “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners.” For a description of other rights and privileges of limited partners under our partnership agreement, including voting rights, please read “The Partnership Agreement.”

Transfer Agent and Registrar

Duties

American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, LLC will serve as the registrar and transfer agent for the common units. We will pay all fees charged by the transfer agent for transfers of common units except the following, which must be paid by unitholders:

 

   

surety bond premiums to replace lost or stolen certificates, taxes and other governmental charges;

 

   

special charges for services requested by a holder of a common unit; and

 

   

other similar fees or charges.

There will be no charge to unitholders for disbursements of our cash distributions. We will indemnify the transfer agent, its agents and each of their stockholders, directors, officers and employees against all claims and losses that may arise out of acts performed or omitted for its activities in that capacity, except for any liability due to any gross negligence or intentional misconduct of the indemnified person or entity.

Resignation or Removal

The transfer agent may resign, by notice to us, or be removed by us. The resignation or removal of the transfer agent will become effective upon our appointment of a successor transfer agent and registrar and its acceptance of the appointment. If no successor is appointed or has not accepted its appointment within 30 days of the resignation or removal, our general partner may act as the transfer agent and registrar until a successor is appointed.

Transfer of Common Units

Upon the transfer of a common unit in accordance with our partnership agreement, the transferee of the common unit shall be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the common units transferred when such transfer and admission are reflected in our books and records. Each transferee:

 

   

represents that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to become bound by our partnership agreement;

 

   

automatically becomes bound by the terms and conditions of our partnership agreement; and

 

   

gives the consents, waivers and approvals contained in our partnership agreement, such as the approval of all transactions and agreements that we are entering into in connection with our formation and this offering.

Our general partner will cause any transfers to be recorded on our books and records no less frequently than quarterly.

 

154


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

We may, at our discretion, treat the nominee holder of a common unit as the absolute owner. In that case, the beneficial holder’s rights are limited solely to those that it has against the nominee holder as a result of any agreement between the beneficial owner and the nominee holder.

Common units are securities and any transfers are subject to the laws governing the transfer of securities. In addition to other rights acquired upon transfer, the transferor gives the transferee the right to become a substituted limited partner in our partnership for the transferred common units.

Until a common unit has been transferred on our books, we and the transfer agent may treat the record holder of the common unit as the absolute owner for all purposes, except as otherwise required by law or stock exchange regulations.

 

155


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

THE PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT

The following is a summary of the material provisions of our partnership agreement. The form of our partnership agreement is included in this prospectus as Appendix A. We will provide prospective investors with a copy of our partnership agreement upon request at no charge.

We summarize the following provisions of our partnership agreement elsewhere in this prospectus:

 

   

with regard to distributions of cash available for distribution, please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners”;

 

   

with regard to the duties of, and standard of care applicable to, our general partner, please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties”;

 

   

with regard to the transfer of common units, please read “Description of the Common Units—Transfer of Common Units”; and

 

   

with regard to allocations of taxable income and taxable loss, please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences.”

Organization and Duration

Hi-Crush Partners LP was organized in May 2012 and will have a perpetual existence unless terminated pursuant to the terms of our partnership agreement.

Purpose

Our purpose, as set forth in our partnership agreement, is limited to any business activity that is approved by our general partner and that lawfully may be conducted by a limited partnership organized under Delaware law; provided that our general partner shall not cause us to take any action that the general partner determines would be reasonably likely to cause us to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise taxable as an entity for federal income tax purposes.

Although our general partner has the ability to cause us and our subsidiaries to engage in activities other than the business of excavating, processing and selling frac sand, our general partner may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or the limited partners. Our general partner is generally authorized to perform all acts it determines to be necessary or appropriate to carry out our purposes and to conduct our business.

Cash Distributions

Our partnership agreement specifies the manner in which we will make cash distributions to holders of our common units and other partnership securities as well as to our sponsor in respect of its incentive distribution rights. For a description of these cash distribution provisions, please read “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners.”

Capital Contributions

Unitholders are not obligated to make additional capital contributions, except as described below under “—Limited Liability.”

 

156


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Voting Rights

The following is a summary of the unitholder vote required for approval of the matters specified below. Matters that require the approval of a “unit majority” require:

 

   

during the subordination period, the approval of a majority of the common units, excluding those common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, and a majority of the subordinated units, voting as separate classes; and

 

   

after the subordination period, the approval of a majority of the common units, voting as a single class.

In voting their common and subordinated units, affiliates of our general partner will have no fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or the limited partners.

The incentive distribution rights may be entitled to vote in certain circumstances.

 

Issuance of additional units

No approval right.

 

Amendment of the partnership agreement

Certain amendments may be made by our general partner without the approval of the unitholders. Other amendments generally require the approval of a unit majority. Please read “—Amendment of the Partnership Agreement.”

 

Merger of our partnership or the sale of all or substantially all of our assets


Unit majority in certain circumstances. Please read “—Merger, Consolidation, Conversion, Sale or Other Disposition of Assets.”

 

Dissolution of our partnership

Unit majority. Please read “—Dissolution.”

 

Continuation of our business upon dissolution

Unit majority. Please read “—Dissolution.”

 

Withdrawal of our general partner

Under most circumstances, the approval of a majority of the common units, excluding common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, is required for the withdrawal of our general partner prior to June 30, 2022 in a manner that would cause a dissolution of our partnership. Please read “—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner.”

 

Removal of our general partner

Not less than 66 2/3% of the outstanding units, voting as a single class, including units held by our general partner and its affiliates. Please read “—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner.”

 

Transfer of our general partner interest

No approval right. Please read “—Transfer of General Partner Interest.”

 

Transfer of incentive distribution rights

No approval right. Please read “—Transfer of Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights.”

 

Transfer of ownership interests in our general partner

No approval right. Please read “—Transfer of Ownership Interests in the General Partner.”

 

157


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

If any person or group other than our general partner and its affiliates acquires beneficial ownership of 20% or more of any class of units, that person or group loses voting rights on all of its units. This loss of voting rights does not apply to any person or group that acquires the units from our general partner or its affiliates and any transferees of that person or group approved by our general partner or to any person or group who acquires the units with the specific prior approval of our general partner.

Applicable Law; Forum, Venue and Jurisdiction

Our partnership agreement is governed by Delaware law. Our partnership agreement requires that any claims, suits, actions or proceedings:

 

   

arising out of or relating in any way to the partnership agreement (including any claims, suits or actions to interpret, apply or enforce the provisions of the partnership agreement or the duties, obligations or liabilities among limited partners or of limited partners to us, or the rights or powers of, or restrictions on, the limited partners or us);

 

   

brought in a derivative manner on our behalf;

 

   

asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any director, officer or other employee of us or our general partner, or owed by our general partner, to us or the limited partners;

 

   

asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the Delaware Act; or

 

   

asserting a claim governed by the internal affairs doctrine

shall be exclusively brought in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or, if such court does not have subject matter jurisdiction thereof, any other court located in the State of Delaware with subject matter jurisdiction), regardless of whether such claims, suits, actions or proceedings sound in contract, tort, fraud or otherwise, are based on common law, statutory, equitable, legal or other grounds, or are derivative or direct claims. By purchasing a common unit, a limited partner is irrevocably consenting to these limitations and provisions regarding claims, suits, actions or proceedings and submitting to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or such other Delaware courts) in connection with any such claims, suits, actions or proceedings.

Limited Liability

Assuming that a limited partner does not participate in the control of our business within the meaning of the Delaware Act and that he otherwise acts in conformity with the provisions of the partnership agreement, his liability under the Delaware Act will be limited, subject to possible exceptions, to the amount of capital he is obligated to contribute to us for his common units plus his share of any undistributed profits and assets. However, if it were determined that the right, or exercise of the right, by the limited partners as a group:

 

   

to remove or replace our general partner;

 

   

to approve some amendments to our partnership agreement; or

 

   

to take other action under our partnership agreement;

constituted “participation in the control” of our business for the purposes of the Delaware Act, then the limited partners could be held personally liable for our obligations under the laws of Delaware, to the same extent as our general partner. This liability would extend to persons who transact business with us under the reasonable belief that the limited partner is a general partner. Neither our partnership agreement nor the Delaware Act specifically provides for legal recourse against our general partner if a limited partner were to lose limited liability through any fault of our general partner. While this does not mean that a limited partner could not seek legal recourse, we know of no precedent for this type of a claim in Delaware case law.

Under the Delaware Act, a limited partnership may not make a distribution to a partner if, after the distribution, all liabilities of the limited partnership, other than liabilities to partners on account of their

 

158


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

partnership interests and liabilities for which the recourse of creditors is limited to specific property of the partnership, would exceed the fair value of the assets of the limited partnership. For the purpose of determining the fair value of the assets of a limited partnership, the Delaware Act provides that the fair value of property subject to liability for which recourse of creditors is limited shall be included in the assets of the limited partnership only to the extent that the fair value of that property exceeds the nonrecourse liability. The Delaware Act provides that a limited partner who receives a distribution and knew at the time of the distribution that the distribution was in violation of the Delaware Act shall be liable to the limited partnership for the amount of the distribution for three years.

Following the completion of this offering, we expect that our subsidiaries will conduct business in one state and we may have subsidiaries that conduct business in other states or countries in the future. Maintenance of our limited liability as owner of our operating subsidiaries may require compliance with legal requirements in the jurisdictions in which the operating subsidiaries conduct business, including qualifying our subsidiaries to do business there.

Limitations on the liability of members or limited partners for the obligations of a limited liability company or limited partnership have not been clearly established in many jurisdictions. If, by virtue of our ownership interest in our subsidiaries or otherwise, it were determined that we were conducting business in any jurisdiction without compliance with the applicable limited partnership or limited liability company statute, or that the right or exercise of the right by the limited partners as a group to remove or replace our general partner, to approve some amendments to our partnership agreement, or to take other action under our partnership agreement constituted “participation in the control” of our business for purposes of the statutes of any relevant jurisdiction, then the limited partners could be held personally liable for our obligations under the law of that jurisdiction to the same extent as our general partner under the circumstances. We will operate in a manner that our general partner considers reasonable and necessary or appropriate to preserve the limited liability of the limited partners.

Issuance of Additional Interests

Our partnership agreement authorizes us to issue an unlimited number of additional partnership interests for the consideration and on the terms and conditions determined by our general partner without the approval of the unitholders.

It is possible that we will fund acquisitions through the issuance of additional common units, subordinated units or other partnership interests. Holders of any additional common units we issue will be entitled to share equally with the then-existing common unitholders in our distributions of cash available for distribution. In addition, the issuance of additional common units or other partnership interests may dilute the value of the interests of the then-existing common unitholders in our net assets.

In accordance with Delaware law and the provisions of our partnership agreement, we may also issue additional partnership interests that, as determined by our general partner, may have rights to distributions or special voting rights to which the common units are not entitled. In addition, our partnership agreement does not prohibit our subsidiaries from issuing equity interests, which may effectively rank senior to the common units.

Our general partner will have the right, which it may from time to time assign in whole or in part to any of its affiliates, to purchase common units, subordinated units or other partnership interests whenever, and on the same terms that, we issue partnership interests to persons other than our general partner and its affiliates, to the extent necessary to maintain the percentage interest of our general partner and its affiliates, including such interest represented by common and subordinated units, that existed immediately prior to each issuance. The common unitholders will not have preemptive rights under our partnership agreement to acquire additional common units or other partnership interests.

 

159


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Amendment of the Partnership Agreement

General

Amendments to our partnership agreement may be proposed only by our general partner. However, our general partner will have no duty or obligation to propose any amendment and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or the limited partners. In order to adopt a proposed amendment, other than the amendments discussed below, our general partner is required to seek written approval of the holders of the number of units required to approve the amendment or to call a meeting of the limited partners to consider and vote upon the proposed amendment. Except as described below, an amendment must be approved by a unit majority.

Prohibited Amendments

No amendment may be made that would:

 

   

enlarge the obligations of any limited partner without his consent, unless approved by at least a majority of the type or class of limited partner interests so affected; or

 

   

enlarge the obligations of, restrict in any way any action by or rights of, or reduce in any way the amounts distributable, reimbursable or otherwise payable by us to our general partner or any of its affiliates without the consent of our general partner, which consent may be given or withheld in its sole discretion.

The provision of our partnership agreement preventing the amendments having the effects described in the clauses above can be amended upon the approval of the holders of at least 90.0% of the outstanding units, voting as a single class (including units owned by our general partner and its affiliates). Upon completion of the offering, an affiliate of our general partner will own approximately     % of our outstanding common and subordinated units.

No Unitholder Approval

Our general partner may generally make amendments to our partnership agreement without the approval of any limited partner to reflect:

 

   

a change in our name, the location of our principal place of business, our registered agent or our registered office;

 

   

the admission, substitution, withdrawal or removal of partners in accordance with our partnership agreement;

 

   

a change that our general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to qualify or continue our qualification as a limited partnership or other entity in which the limited partners have limited liability under the laws of any state or to ensure that neither we nor any of our subsidiaries will be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise taxed as an entity for federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed);

 

   

an amendment that is necessary, in the opinion of our counsel, to prevent us or our general partner or its directors, officers, agents or trustees from in any manner being subjected to the provisions of the Investment Company Act of 1940, the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 or “plan asset” regulations adopted under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, or ERISA, whether or not substantially similar to plan asset regulations currently applied or proposed;

 

   

an amendment that our general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with the creation, authorization or issuance of additional partnership interests or the right to acquire partnership interests;

 

160


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

any amendment expressly permitted in our partnership agreement to be made by our general partner acting alone;

 

   

an amendment effected, necessitated or contemplated by a merger agreement that has been approved under the terms of our partnership agreement;

 

   

any amendment that our general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate for the formation by us of, or our investment in, any corporation, partnership or other entity, as otherwise permitted by our partnership agreement;

 

   

a change in our fiscal year or taxable year and related changes;

 

   

conversions into, mergers with or conveyances to another limited liability entity that is newly formed and has no assets, liabilities or operations at the time of the conversion, merger or conveyance other than those it receives by way of the conversion, merger or conveyance; or

 

   

any other amendments substantially similar to any of the matters described in the clauses above.

In addition, our general partner may make amendments to our partnership agreement, without the approval of any limited partner, if our general partner determines that those amendments:

 

   

do not adversely affect the limited partners, considered as a whole, or any particular class of limited partners, in any material respect;

 

   

are necessary or appropriate to satisfy any requirements, conditions or guidelines contained in any opinion, directive, order, ruling or regulation of any federal or state agency or judicial authority or contained in any federal or state statute;

 

   

are necessary or appropriate to facilitate the trading of limited partner interests or to comply with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any securities exchange on which the limited partner interests are or will be listed for trading;

 

   

are necessary or appropriate for any action taken by our general partner relating to splits or combinations of units under the provisions of our partnership agreement;

 

   

are necessary or appropriate in connection with the creation, authorization or issuance of any class or series of partnership securities; or

 

   

are required to effect the intent expressed in this prospectus or the intent of the provisions of our partnership agreement or are otherwise contemplated by our partnership agreement.

Opinion of Counsel and Unitholder Approval

Any amendment that our general partner determines adversely affects in any material respect one or more particular classes of limited partners will require the approval of at least a majority of the class or classes so affected, but no vote will be required by any class or classes of limited partners that our general partner determines are not adversely affected in any material respect. Any amendment that would have a material adverse effect on the rights or preferences of any type or class of outstanding units in relation to other classes of units will require the approval of at least a majority of the type or class of units so affected. Any amendment that would reduce or increase the voting percentage required to take any action other than to remove the general partner or call a meeting of unitholders is required to be approved by the affirmative vote of limited partners whose aggregate outstanding units constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced or increased. Any amendment that would increase the percentage of units required to remove the general partner or call a meeting of unitholders must be approved by the affirmative vote of limited partners whose aggregate outstanding units constitute not less than the percentage sought to be increased. For amendments of the type not requiring unitholder approval, our general partner will not be required to obtain an opinion of counsel that an amendment will neither result in a loss of limited liability to the limited partners nor result in our being treated as

 

161


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

a taxable entity for federal income tax purposes in connection with any of the amendments. No other amendments to our partnership agreement will become effective without the approval of holders of at least 90% of the outstanding units, voting as a single class, unless we first obtain an opinion of counsel to the effect that the amendment will not affect the limited liability under applicable law of any of our limited partners.

Merger, Consolidation, Conversion, Sale or Other Disposition of Assets

A merger, consolidation or conversion of us requires the prior consent of our general partner. However, our general partner will have no duty or obligation to consent to any merger, consolidation or conversion and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interest of us or the limited partners.

In addition, our partnership agreement generally prohibits our general partner, without the prior approval of the holders of a unit majority, from causing us to sell, exchange or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets in a single transaction or a series of related transactions, including by way of merger, consolidation or other combination. Our general partner may, however, mortgage, pledge, hypothecate or grant a security interest in all or substantially all of our assets without such approval. Our general partner may also sell all or substantially all of our assets under a foreclosure or other realization upon those encumbrances without such approval. Finally, our general partner may consummate any merger without the prior approval of our unitholders if we are the surviving entity in the transaction, our general partner has received an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters, the transaction would not result in a material amendment to the partnership agreement (other than an amendment that the general partner could adopt without the consent of other partners), each of our units will be an identical unit of our partnership following the transaction and the partnership securities to be issued do not exceed 20% of our outstanding partnership interests (other than incentive distribution rights) immediately prior to the transaction. If the conditions specified in our partnership agreement are satisfied, our general partner may convert us or any of our subsidiaries into a new limited liability entity or merge us or any of our subsidiaries into, or convey all of our assets to, a newly formed entity, if the sole purpose of that conversion, merger or conveyance is to effect a mere change in our legal form into another limited liability entity, we have received an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters and the governing instruments of the new entity provide the limited partners and our general partner with the same rights and obligations as contained in our partnership agreement. Our unitholders are not entitled to dissenters’ rights of appraisal under our partnership agreement or applicable Delaware law in the event of a conversion, merger or consolidation, a sale of substantially all of our assets or any other similar transaction or event.

Dissolution

We will continue as a limited partnership until dissolved under our partnership agreement. We will dissolve upon:

 

   

the election of our general partner to dissolve us, if approved by the holders of units representing a unit majority;

 

   

there being no limited partners, unless we are continued without dissolution in accordance with applicable Delaware law;

 

   

the entry of a decree of judicial dissolution of our partnership; or

 

   

the withdrawal or removal of our general partner or any other event that results in its ceasing to be our general partner other than by reason of a transfer of its general partner interest in accordance with our partnership agreement or its withdrawal or removal following the approval and admission of a successor.

Upon a dissolution under the last clause above, the holders of a unit majority may also elect, within specific time limitations, to continue our business on the same terms and conditions described in our partnership

 

162


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

agreement by appointing as a successor general partner an entity approved by the holders of units representing a unit majority, subject to our receipt of an opinion of counsel to the effect that:

 

   

the action would not result in the loss of limited liability under Delaware law of any limited partner; and

 

   

neither our partnership nor any of our subsidiaries would be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise be taxable as an entity for federal income tax purposes upon the exercise of that right to continue (to the extent not already so treated or taxed).

Liquidation and Distribution of Proceeds

Upon our dissolution, unless our business is continued, the liquidator authorized to wind up our affairs will, acting with all of the powers of our general partner that are necessary or appropriate, liquidate our assets and apply the proceeds of the liquidation as described in “How We Make Distributions To Our Partners—Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation.” The liquidator may defer liquidation or distribution of our assets for a reasonable period of time or distribute assets to partners in kind if it determines that a sale would be impractical or would cause undue loss to our partners.

Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner

Except as described below, our general partner has agreed not to withdraw voluntarily as our general partner prior to June 30, 2022 without obtaining the approval of the holders of at least a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, and furnishing an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters. On or after June 30, 2022, our general partner may withdraw as general partner without first obtaining approval of any unitholder by giving 90 days’ written notice, and that withdrawal will not constitute a violation of our partnership agreement. Notwithstanding the information above, our general partner may withdraw without unitholder approval upon 90 days’ notice to the limited partners if at least 50% of the outstanding common units are held or controlled by one person and its affiliates, other than our general partner and its affiliates. In addition, our partnership agreement permits our general partner, in some instances, to sell or otherwise transfer all of its general partner interest in us without the approval of the unitholders. Please read “—Transfer of General Partner Interest.”

Upon withdrawal of our general partner under any circumstances, other than as a result of a transfer by our general partner of all or a part of its general partner interest in us, the holders of a unit majority may select a successor to that withdrawing general partner. If a successor is not elected, or is elected but an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters cannot be obtained, we will be dissolved, wound up and liquidated, unless within a specified period after that withdrawal, the holders of a unit majority agree in writing to continue our business and to appoint a successor general partner. Please read “—Dissolution.”

Our general partner may not be removed unless that removal is approved by the vote of the holders of not less than 66 2/3% of the outstanding units, voting together as a single class, including units held by our general partner and its affiliates, and we receive an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters. Any removal of our general partner is also subject to the approval of a successor general partner by the vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding common units, voting as a class, and the outstanding subordinated units, voting as a class. The ownership of more than 33 1/3% of the outstanding units by our general partner and its affiliates gives them the ability to prevent our general partner’s removal. At the closing of this offering, an affiliate of our general partner will own     % of our outstanding limited partner units, including all of our subordinated units.

Our partnership agreement also provides that if our general partner is removed as our general partner under circumstances where cause does not exist:

 

   

all subordinated units held by any person who did not, and whose affiliates did not, vote any units in favor of the removal of the general partner, will immediately and automatically convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, provided such person is not an affiliate of the successor general partner; and

 

163


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

if all of the subordinated units convert pursuant to the foregoing, all cumulative common unit arrearages on the common units will be extinguished and the subordination period will end.

In the event of the removal of our general partner under circumstances where cause exists or withdrawal of our general partner where that withdrawal violates our partnership agreement, a successor general partner will have the option to purchase the general partner interest and incentive distribution rights of the departing general partner and its affiliates for a cash payment equal to the fair market value of those interests. Under all other circumstances where our general partner withdraws or is removed by the limited partners, the departing general partner will have the option to require the successor general partner to purchase the general partner interest and the incentive distribution rights of the departing general partner and its affiliates for fair market value. In each case, this fair market value will be determined by agreement between the departing general partner and the successor general partner. If no agreement is reached, an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert selected by the departing general partner and the successor general partner will determine the fair market value. Or, if the departing general partner and the successor general partner cannot agree upon an expert, then an expert chosen by agreement of the experts selected by each of them will determine the fair market value.

If the option described above is not exercised by either the departing general partner or the successor general partner, the departing general partner’s general partner interest and all its and its affiliates’ incentive distribution rights will automatically convert into common units equal to the fair market value of those interests as determined by an investment banking firm or other independent expert selected in the manner described in the preceding paragraph.

In addition, we will be required to reimburse the departing general partner for all amounts due the departing general partner, including, without limitation, all employee-related liabilities, including severance liabilities, incurred as a result of the termination of any employees employed for our benefit by the departing general partner or its affiliates.

Transfer of General Partner Interest

At any time, our general partner may transfer all or any of its general partner interest to another person without the approval of any other partner. As a condition of this transfer, the transferee must, among other things, assume the rights and duties of our general partner, agree to be bound by the provisions of our partnership agreement and furnish an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters.

Transfer of Ownership Interests in the General Partner

At any time, the owners of our general partner may sell or transfer all or part of its ownership interests in our general partner to an affiliate or third party without the approval of our unitholders.

Transfer of Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights

By transfer of subordinated units or incentive distribution rights in accordance with our partnership agreement, each transferee of subordinated units or incentive distribution rights will be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the subordinated units or incentive distribution rights transferred when such transfer and admission is reflected in our books and records. Each transferee:

 

   

represents that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to become bound by our partnership agreement;

 

   

automatically becomes bound by the terms and conditions of our partnership agreement; and

 

   

gives the consents, waivers and approvals contained in our partnership agreement, such as the approval of all transactions and agreements we are entering into in connection with our formation and this offering.

 

164


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Our general partner will cause any transfers to be recorded on our books and records no less frequently than quarterly.

We may, at our discretion, treat the nominee holder of subordinated units or incentive distribution rights as the absolute owner. In that case, the beneficial holder’s rights are limited solely to those that it has against the nominee holder as a result of any agreement between the beneficial owner and the nominee holder.

Subordinated units and incentive distribution rights are securities and any transfers are subject to the laws governing transfer of securities. In addition to other rights acquired upon transfer, the transferor gives the transferee the right to become a limited partner for the transferred subordinated units or incentive distribution rights.

Until a subordinated unit or incentive distribution right has been transferred on our books, we and the transfer agent may treat the record holder of the unit or right as the absolute owner for all purposes, except as otherwise required by law or stock exchange regulations.

Change of Management Provisions

Our partnership agreement contains specific provisions that are intended to discourage a person or group from attempting to remove Hi-Crush GP LLC as our general partner or from otherwise changing our management. Please read “—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner” for a discussion of certain consequences of the removal of our general partner. If any person or group, other than our general partner and its affiliates, acquires beneficial ownership of 20% or more of any class of units, that person or group loses voting rights on all of its units. This loss of voting rights does not apply in certain circumstances. Please read “—Meetings; Voting.”

Limited Call Right

If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the then-issued and outstanding limited partner interests of any class, our general partner will have the right, which it may assign in whole or in part to any of its affiliates or beneficial owners or to us, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the limited partner interests of the class held by unaffiliated persons, as of a record date to be selected by our general partner, on at least 10, but not more than 60, days notice. The purchase price in the event of this purchase is the greater of:

 

   

the highest price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for any limited partner interests of the class purchased within the 90 days preceding the date on which our general partner first mails notice of its election to purchase those limited partner interests; and

 

   

the average of the daily closing prices of the partnership securities of such class over the 20 trading days preceding the date that is three days before the date the notice is mailed.

As a result of our general partner’s right to purchase outstanding limited partner interests, a holder of limited partner interests may have his limited partner interests purchased at an undesirable time or at a price that may be lower than market prices at various times prior to such purchase or lower than a unitholder may anticipate the market price to be in the future. The tax consequences to a unitholder of the exercise of this call right are the same as a sale by that unitholder of his common units in the market. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Disposition of Units.”

Non-Taxpaying Holders; Redemption

To avoid any adverse effect on the maximum applicable rates chargeable to customers by us or any of our future subsidiaries, or in order to reverse an adverse determination that has occurred regarding such maximum rate, our partnership agreement provides our general partner the power to amend the agreement. If our general

 

165


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

partner, with the advice of counsel, determines that our not being treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise taxable as an entity for federal income tax purposes, coupled with the tax status (or lack of proof thereof) of one or more of our limited partners, has, or is reasonably likely to have, a material adverse effect on the maximum applicable rates chargeable to customers by our subsidiaries, then our general partner may adopt such amendments to our partnership agreement as it determines necessary or advisable to:

 

   

obtain proof of the federal income tax status of our limited partners (and their owners, to the extent relevant); and

 

   

permit us to redeem the units held by any person whose tax status has or is reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the maximum applicable rates or who fails to comply with the procedures instituted by our general partner to obtain proof of the federal income tax status. The redemption price in the case of such a redemption will be the average of the daily closing prices per unit for the 20 consecutive trading days immediately prior to the date set for redemption.

Non-Citizen Assignees; Redemption

If our general partner, with the advice of counsel, determines we are subject to federal, state or local laws or regulations that, in the reasonable determination of our general partner, create a substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any property that we have an interest in because of the nationality, citizenship or other related status of any limited partner, then our general partner may adopt such amendments to our partnership agreement as it determines necessary or advisable to:

 

   

obtain proof of the nationality, citizenship or other related status of our limited partners (and their owners, to the extent relevant); and

 

   

permit us to redeem the units held by any person whose nationality, citizenship or other related status creates substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any property or who fails to comply with the procedures instituted by the general partner to obtain proof of the nationality, citizenship or other related status. The redemption price in the case of such a redemption will be the average of the daily closing prices per unit for the 20 consecutive trading days immediately prior to the date set for redemption.

Meetings; Voting

Except as described below regarding a person or group owning 20% or more of any class of units then outstanding, record holders of units on the record date will be entitled to notice of, and to vote at, meetings of our limited partners and to act upon matters for which approvals may be solicited.

Our general partner does not anticipate that any meeting of our unitholders will be called in the foreseeable future. Any action that is required or permitted to be taken by the unitholders may be taken either at a meeting of the unitholders or without a meeting if consents in writing describing the action so taken are signed by holders of the number of units necessary to authorize or take that action at a meeting. Meetings of the unitholders may be called by our general partner or by unitholders owning at least 20% of the outstanding units of the class for which a meeting is proposed. Unitholders may vote either in person or by proxy at meetings. The holders of a majority of the outstanding units of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called, represented in person or by proxy, will constitute a quorum, unless any action by the unitholders requires approval by holders of a greater percentage of the units, in which case the quorum will be the greater percentage.

Each record holder of a unit has a vote according to his percentage interest in us, although additional limited partner interests having special voting rights could be issued. Please read “—Issuance of Additional Interests.” However, if at any time any person or group, other than our general partner and its affiliates, or a direct or subsequently approved transferee of our general partner or its affiliates and purchasers specifically approved by our general partner, acquires, in the aggregate, beneficial ownership of 20% or more of any class of units then outstanding, that person or group will lose voting rights on all of its units and the units may not be voted on any

 

166


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

matter and will not be considered to be outstanding when sending notices of a meeting of unitholders, calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes. Common units held in nominee or street name account will be voted by the broker or other nominee in accordance with the instruction of the beneficial owner unless the arrangement between the beneficial owner and his nominee provides otherwise. Except as our partnership agreement otherwise provides, subordinated units will vote together with common units, as a single class.

Any notice, demand, request, report or proxy material required or permitted to be given or made to record common unitholders under our partnership agreement will be delivered to the record holder by us or by the transfer agent.

Voting Rights of Incentive Distribution Rights

If a majority of the incentive distribution rights are held by our general partner and its affiliates, the holders of the incentive distribution rights will have no right to vote in respect of such rights on any matter, unless otherwise required by law, and the holders of the incentive distribution rights shall be deemed to have approved any matter approved by our general partner.

If less than a majority of the incentive distribution rights are held by our general partner and its affiliates, the incentive distribution rights will be entitled to vote on all matters submitted to a vote of unitholders, other than amendments and other matters that our general partner determines do not adversely affect the holders of the incentive distribution rights in any material respect. On any matter in which the holders of incentive distribution rights are entitled to vote, such holders will vote together with the subordinated units, prior to the end of the subordination period, or together with the common units, thereafter, in either case as a single class, and such incentive distribution rights shall be treated in all respects as subordinated units or common units, as applicable, when sending notices of a meeting of our limited partners to vote on any matter (unless otherwise required by law), calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes under our partnership agreement. The relative voting power of the holders of the incentive distribution rights and the subordinated units or common units, depending on which class the holders of incentive distribution rights are voting with, will be set in the same proportion as cumulative cash distributions, if any, in respect of the incentive distribution rights for the four consecutive quarters prior to the record date for the vote bears to the cumulative cash distributions in respect of such class of units for such four quarters.

Status as Limited Partner

By transfer of common units in accordance with our partnership agreement, each transferee of common units shall be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the common units transferred when such transfer and admission are reflected in our books and records. Except as described under “—Limited Liability,” the common units will be fully paid, and unitholders will not be required to make additional contributions.

Indemnification

Under our partnership agreement, in most circumstances, we will indemnify the following persons, to the fullest extent permitted by law, from and against all losses, claims, damages or similar events:

 

   

our general partner;

 

   

any departing general partner;

 

   

any person who is or was an affiliate of our general partner or any departing general partner;

 

   

any person who is or was a manager, managing member, general partner, director, officer, fiduciary or trustee of our partnership, our subsidiaries, our general partner, any departing general partner or any of their affiliates;

 

167


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

any person who is or was serving as a manager, managing member, general partners, director, officer, employee, agent, fiduciary or trustee of another person owing a fiduciary duty to us or our subsidiaries;

 

   

any person who controls our general partner or any departing general partner; and

 

   

any person designated by our general partner.

Any indemnification under these provisions will only be out of our assets. Unless our general partner otherwise agrees, it will not be personally liable for, or have any obligation to contribute or lend funds or assets to us to enable us to effectuate, indemnification. We may purchase insurance against liabilities asserted against and expenses incurred by persons for our activities, regardless of whether we would have the power to indemnify the person against liabilities under our partnership agreement.

Reimbursement of Expenses

Our partnership agreement requires us to reimburse our general partner for all direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on our behalf and all other expenses allocable to us or otherwise incurred by our general partner in connection with operating our business. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. These expenses include salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf and expenses allocated to our general partner by its affiliates. Our general partner is entitled to determine the expenses that are allocable to us.

Books and Reports

Our general partner is required to keep appropriate books of our business at our principal offices. These books will be maintained for both tax and financial reporting purposes on an accrual basis. For tax and fiscal reporting purposes, our fiscal year is the calendar year.

We will furnish or make available to record holders of our common units, within 105 days after the close of each fiscal year, an annual report containing audited consolidated financial statements and a report on those consolidated financial statements by our independent public accountants. Except for our fourth quarter, we will also furnish or make available summary financial information within 50 days after the close of each quarter. We will be deemed to have made any such report available if we file such report with the SEC on EDGAR or make the report available on a publicly available website which we maintain.

We will furnish each record holder with information reasonably required for federal and state tax reporting purposes within 90 days after the close of each calendar year. This information is expected to be furnished in summary form so that some complex calculations normally required of partners can be avoided. Our ability to furnish this summary information to our unitholders will depend on their cooperation in supplying us with specific information. Every unitholder will receive information to assist him in determining his federal and state tax liability and in filing his federal and state income tax returns, regardless of whether he supplies us with the necessary information.

Right to Inspect Our Books and Records

Our partnership agreement provides that a limited partner can, for a purpose reasonably related to his interest as a limited partner, upon reasonable written demand stating the purpose of such demand and at his own expense, have furnished to him:

 

   

a current list of the name and last known address of each record holder;

 

168


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

copies of our partnership agreement, our certificate of limited partnership, and all amendments thereto, together with copies of the executed copies of all powers of attorney pursuant to which our partnership agreement, our certificate of limited partnership and all amendments thereto have been executed;

 

   

information regarding the status of our business and financial condition (provided that obligation shall be satisfied to the extent the limited partner is furnished our most recent annual report and any subsequent quarterly or periodic reports required to be filed (or which would be required to be filed) with the SEC pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act); and

 

   

any other information regarding our affairs that our general partner determines is just and reasonable.

Under our partnership agreement, however, each of our limited partners and other persons who acquire interests in our partnership interests, do not have rights to receive information from us or any of the persons we indemnify as described above under “—Indemnification” for the purpose of determining whether to pursue litigation or assist in pending litigation against us or those indemnified persons relating to our affairs, except pursuant to the applicable rules of discovery relating to the litigation commenced by the person seeking information.

Our general partner may, and intends to, keep confidential from the limited partners trade secrets or other information the disclosure of which our general partner believes in good faith is not in our best interests or that we are required by law or by agreements with third parties to keep confidential.

Registration Rights

Under our partnership agreement, we have agreed to register for resale under the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws any common units, subordinated units or other limited partner interests proposed to be sold by our general partner or any of its affiliates or their assignees if an exemption from the registration requirements is not otherwise available. These registration rights continue for two years following any withdrawal or removal of our general partner. We are obligated to pay all expenses incidental to the registration, excluding underwriting discounts.

In addition, in connection with this offering, we expect to enter into a registration rights agreement with our sponsor. Pursuant to the registration rights agreement, we will be required to file a registration statement to register the common units and subordinated units issued to our sponsor and the common units issuable upon the conversion of the subordinated units upon request of our sponsor. In addition, the registration rights agreement gives our sponsor piggyback registration rights under certain circumstances. The registration rights agreement also includes provisions dealing with holdback agreements, indemnification and contribution and allocation of expenses. These registration rights are transferable to affiliates of our sponsor and, in certain circumstances, to third parties. Please read “Units Eligible for Future Sale.”

 

169


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

UNITS ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

After the sale of the common units offered by this prospectus, our sponsor will hold an aggregate of             common units and            subordinated units. All of the subordinated units will convert into common units at the end of the subordination period and some may convert earlier. For information regarding the conversion of subordinated units into common units prior to the end of the subordination period, please read “The Partnership Agreement—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner.” The sale of these common and subordinated units could have an adverse impact on the price of the common units or on any trading market that may develop.

Our common units sold in this offering will generally be freely transferable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act, except that any common units held by an “affiliate” of ours may not be resold publicly except in compliance with the registration requirements of the Securities Act or under an exemption under Rule 144 or otherwise. Rule 144 permits securities acquired by an affiliate of the issuer to be sold into the market in an amount that does not exceed, during any three-month period, the greater of:

 

   

1% of the total number of the securities outstanding; or

 

   

the average weekly reported trading volume of our common units for the four weeks prior to the sale.

Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to specific manner of sale provisions, holding period requirements, notice requirements and the availability of current public information about us. A person who is not deemed to have been an affiliate of ours at any time during the three months preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned our common units for at least six months (provided we are in compliance with the current public information requirement), or one year (regardless of whether we are in compliance with the current public information requirement), would be entitled to sell those common units under Rule 144, subject only to the current public information requirement. After beneficially owning Rule 144 restricted units for at least one year, a person who is not deemed to have been an affiliate of ours at any time during the 90 days preceding a sale would be entitled to freely sell those common units without regard to the public information requirements, volume limitations, manner of sale provisions and notice requirements of Rule 144.

Our partnership agreement provides that we may issue an unlimited number of limited partner interests of any type without a vote of the unitholders at any time. Any issuance of additional common units or other equity securities would result in a corresponding decrease in the proportionate ownership interest in us represented by, and could adversely affect the cash distributions to and market price of, common units then outstanding. Please read “The Partnership Agreement—Issuance of Additional Interests.”

Under our partnership agreement and the registration rights agreement that we expect to enter into, our general partner and its affiliates will have the right to cause us to register under the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws the offer and sale of any units that they hold. Subject to the terms and conditions of the partnership agreement and the registration rights agreement, these registration rights allow our general partner and its affiliates or their assignees holding any units to require registration of any of these units and to include any of these units in a registration by us of other units, including units offered by us or by any unitholder. Our general partner and its affiliates will continue to have these registration rights for two years following its withdrawal or removal as our general partner. In connection with any registration of this kind, we will indemnify each unitholder participating in the registration and its officers, directors, and controlling persons from and against any liabilities under the Securities Act or any applicable state securities laws arising from the registration statement or prospectus. We will bear all costs and expenses incidental to any registration, excluding any underwriting discount. Except as described below, our general partner and its affiliates may sell their units in private transactions at any time, subject to compliance with applicable laws.

The executive officers and directors of our general partner and our sponsor have agreed not to sell any common units they beneficially own for a period of 180 days from the date of this prospectus. Please read “Underwriting” for a description of these lock-up provisions.

 

170


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Prior to the completion of this offering, we expect to adopt a new long-term incentive plan (the “Long-Term Incentive Plan”). If adopted, we intend to file a registration statement on Form S-8 under the Securities Act to register common units issuable under the Long-Term Incentive Plan. This registration statement on Form S-8 is expected to be filed following the effective date of the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part and will be effective upon filing. Accordingly, common units issued under the Long-Term Incentive Plan will be eligible for resale in the public market without restriction after the effective date of the Form S-8 registration statement, subject to applicable vesting requirements, Rule 144 limitations applicable to affiliates and the lock-up restrictions described above.

 

171


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

This section summarizes the material federal income tax consequences that may be relevant to prospective unitholders and is based upon current provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), existing and proposed Treasury regulations thereunder (the “Treasury Regulations”), and current administrative rulings and court decisions, all of which are subject to change. Changes in these authorities may cause the federal income tax consequences to a prospective unitholder to vary substantially from those described below. Unless the context otherwise requires, references in this section to “we” or “us” are references to Hi-Crush Partners LP and its subsidiaries.

Legal conclusions contained in this section, unless otherwise noted, are the opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. and are based on the accuracy of representations made by us to them for this purpose. However, this section does not address all federal income tax matters that affect us or our unitholders. Furthermore, this section focuses on unitholders who are individual citizens or residents of the United States (for federal income tax purposes), who have the U.S. dollar as their functional currency and who hold units as capital assets (generally, property that is held for investment). This section has limited applicability to corporations, partnerships, (including entities treated as partnerships for federal income tax purposes), estates, trusts, non-resident aliens or other unitholders subject to specialized tax treatment, such as tax-exempt institutions, non-U.S. persons, individual retirement accounts (“IRAs”), employee benefit plans, real estate investment trusts or mutual funds. Accordingly, we encourage each unitholder to consult the unitholder’s own tax advisor in analyzing the federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax consequences particular to that unitholder resulting from ownership or disposition of units.

We are relying on opinions and advice of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. with respect to the matters described herein. An opinion of counsel represents only that counsel’s best legal judgment and does not bind the IRS or a court. Accordingly, the opinions and statements made herein may not be sustained by a court if contested by the IRS. Any such contest of the matters described herein may materially and adversely impact the market for units and the prices at which units trade. In addition, our costs of any contest with the IRS will be borne indirectly by our unitholders and our general partner because the costs will reduce our cash available for distribution. Furthermore, the tax consequences of an investment in us, may be significantly modified by future legislative or administrative changes or court decisions, which may be retroactively applied.

For the reasons described below, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has not rendered an opinion with respect to the following federal income tax issues: (1) the treatment of a unitholder whose units are the subject of a securities loan (e.g., a loan to a short seller to cover a short sale of units) (please read “—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Treatment of Securities Loans”); (2) whether our monthly convention for allocating taxable income and losses is permitted by existing Treasury Regulations (please read “—Disposition of Units—Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees”); and (3) whether our method for taking into account Section 743 adjustments is sustainable in certain cases (please read “—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election” and “—Uniformity of Units”).

Taxation of the Partnership

Partnership Status

We expect to be treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes and, therefore, generally will not be liable for such taxes. Instead, as described below, each of our unitholders will take into account its respective share of our items of income, gain, loss and deduction in computing its federal income tax liability as if the unitholder had earned such income directly, even if we make no cash distributions to the unitholder. Distributions we make to a unitholder generally will not give rise to income or gain taxable to such unitholder, unless the amount of cash distributed exceeds the unitholder’s adjusted tax basis in its units.

Section 7704 of the Code generally provides that publicly-traded partnerships will be treated as corporations for federal income tax purposes. However, if 90% or more of a partnership’s gross income for every taxable year

 

172


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

it is publicly-traded consists of “qualifying income,” the partnership may continue to be treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes (the “Qualifying Income Exception”). Qualifying income includes (i) income and gains derived from the exploration, development, mining or production, processing, refining, transportation, and marketing of any mineral or natural resource, including sand, (ii) interest (other than from a financial business), (iii) dividends, (iv) gains from the sale of real property and (v) gains from the sale or other disposition of capital assets held for the production of qualifying income. We estimate that approximately             % of our current gross income is not qualifying income; however, this estimate could change from time to time.

Based upon factual representations made by us and our general partner regarding the composition of our income and the other representations set forth below, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. is of the opinion that we will be treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes. In rendering its opinion, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has relied on factual representations made by us and our general partner. The representations made by us and our general partner upon which Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has relied include, without limitation:

(a) Neither we nor any of our partnership or limited liability company subsidiaries has elected to be treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes; and

(b) For each taxable year since and including the year of our initial public offering, more than 90% of our gross income has been and will be income of a character that Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has opined is “qualifying income” within the meaning of Section 7704(d) of the Code.

We believe that these representations are true and will be true in the future.

If we fail to meet the Qualifying Income Exception, other than a failure that is determined by the IRS to be inadvertent and that is cured within a reasonable time after discovery (in which case the IRS may also require us to make adjustments with respect to our unitholders or pay other amounts), we will be treated as transferring all of our assets, subject to liabilities, to a newly formed corporation, on the first day of the year in which we fail to meet the Qualifying Income Exception, in return for stock in that corporation and then as distributing that stock to our unitholders in liquidation. This deemed contribution and liquidation should not result in the recognition of taxable income by our unitholders or us so long as our liabilities do not exceed the tax basis of our assets. Thereafter, we would be treated as an association taxable as a corporation for federal income tax purposes.

If for any reason we are taxable as a corporation in any taxable year, our items of income, gain, loss and deduction would be taken into account by us in determining the amount of our liability for federal income tax, rather than being passed through to our unitholders. Our taxation as a corporation would materially reduce the cash available for distribution to unitholders and thus would likely substantially reduce the value of our units. Any distribution made to a unitholder at a time we are treated as a corporation would be (i) a taxable dividend to the extent of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, then (ii) a nontaxable return of capital to the extent of the unitholder’s tax basis in its units, and thereafter (iii) taxable capital gain.

The remainder of this discussion assumes that we will be treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes.

Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership

Limited Partner Status

Unitholders who are admitted as limited partners of the partnership, as well as unitholders whose units are held in street name or by a nominee and who have the right to direct the nominee in the exercise of all substantive rights attendant to the ownership of units, will be treated as partners of the partnership for federal income tax purposes. For a discussion related to the risks of losing partner status as a result of securities loans, please read “—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Treatment of Securities Loans.” Unitholders who are not treated as partners in us as described above are urged to consult their own tax advisors with respect to the tax consequences applicable to them under the circumstances.

 

173


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Flow-Through of Taxable Income

Subject to the discussion below under “—Entity-Level Collections of Unitholder Taxes” with respect to payments we may be required to make on behalf of our unitholders, we will not pay any federal income tax. Rather, each unitholder will be required to report on its federal income tax return each year its share of our income, gains, losses and deductions for our taxable year or years ending with or within its taxable year. Consequently, we may allocate income to a unitholder even if that unitholder has not received a cash distribution.

Basis of Units

A unitholder’s tax basis in its units initially will be the amount paid for those units plus the unitholder’s share of our liabilities. That basis generally will be (i) increased by the unitholder’s share of our income and any increases in such unitholder’s share of our liabilities, and (ii) decreased, but not below zero, by the amount of all distributions, the unitholder’s share of our losses, and any decreases in its share of our liabilities.

Ratio of Taxable Income to Distributions

We estimate that a purchaser of units in this offering who owns those units from the date of closing through the record date for distributions for the period ending December 31, 2014, will be allocated, on a cumulative basis, an amount of federal taxable income that will be     % or less of the cash distributed with respect to that period. Thereafter, we anticipate that the ratio of taxable income to cash distributions to the common unitholders will increase. These estimates are based upon the assumption that earnings from operations will approximate the amount required to make the minimum quarterly distribution on all units and other assumptions with respect to capital expenditures, cash flow, net working capital and anticipated cash distributions. These estimates and assumptions are subject to, among other things, numerous business, economic, regulatory, legislative, competitive and political uncertainties beyond our control. Further, the estimates are based on current tax law and tax reporting positions that we will adopt and with which the IRS could disagree. Accordingly, we cannot assure that these estimates will prove to be correct, and our counsel has not opined on the accuracy of such estimates. The actual ratio of taxable income to cash distributions could be higher or lower than expected, and any differences could be material and could affect the value of units. For example, the ratio of taxable income to cash distributions to a purchaser of units in this offering would be higher, and perhaps substantially higher, than our estimate with respect to the period described above if:

 

   

the earnings from operations exceeds the amount required to make minimum quarterly distributions on all common units, yet we only distribute the minimum quarterly distribution on all units; or

 

   

we make a future offering of common units and use the proceeds of the offering in a manner that does not produce additional deductions during the period described above, such as to repay indebtedness outstanding at the time of this offering or to acquire property that is not eligible for depreciation or amortization for federal income tax purposes or that is depreciable or amortizable at a rate significantly slower than the rate applicable to our assets at the time of this offering.

Treatment of Distributions

Distributions made by us to a unitholder generally will not be taxable to the unitholder, unless such distributions exceed the unitholder’s tax basis in its units, in which case the unitholder generally will recognize gain taxable in the manner described below under “—Disposition of Units.”

Any reduction in a unitholder’s share of our liabilities will be treated as a distribution by us of cash to that unitholder. A decrease in a unitholder’s percentage interest in us because of our issuance of additional units may decrease the unitholder’s share of our liabilities. For purposes of the foregoing, a unitholder’s share of our nonrecourse liabilities (liabilities for which no partner bears the economic risk of loss) generally will be based upon that unitholder’s share of the unrealized appreciation (or depreciation) in our assets, to the extent thereof, with any excess liabilities allocated based on the unitholder’s share of our profits. Please read “—Disposition of Units.”

 

174


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

A non-pro rata distribution of money or property (including a deemed distribution as a result of the reallocation of our liabilities described above) may cause a unitholder to recognize ordinary income, if the distribution reduces the unitholder’s share of our “unrealized receivables,” including depreciation and depletion recapture and substantially appreciated “inventory items,” both as defined in Section 751 of the Code (“Section 751 Assets”). To the extent of such reduction, the unitholder would be deemed to receive its proportionate share of the Section 751 Assets and exchange such assets with us in return for a portion of the non-pro rata distribution. This deemed exchange generally will result in the unitholder’s recognition of ordinary income in an amount equal to the excess of (1) the non-pro rata portion of that distribution over (2) the unitholder’s tax basis (generally zero) in the Section 751 Assets deemed to be relinquished in the exchange.

Limitations on Deductibility of Losses

A unitholder may not be entitled to deduct the full amount of loss we allocate to it because its share of our losses will be limited to the lesser of (i) the unitholder’s tax basis in its units, and (ii) in the case of a unitholder that is an individual, estate, trust or certain types of closely-held corporations, the amount for which the unitholder is considered to be “at risk” with respect to our activities. In general, a unitholder will be at risk to the extent of its tax basis in its units, reduced by (1) any portion of that basis attributable to the unitholder’s share of our liabilities, (2) any portion of that basis representing amounts otherwise protected against loss because of a guarantee, stop loss agreement or similar arrangement and (3) any amount of money the unitholder borrows to acquire or hold its units, if the lender of those borrowed funds owns an interest in us, is related to another unitholder or can look only to the units for repayment. A unitholder subject to the at risk limitation must recapture losses deducted in previous years to the extent that distributions (including distributions deemed to result from a reduction in a unitholder’s share of nonrecourse liabilities) cause the unitholder’s at risk amount to be less than zero at the end of any taxable year.

Losses disallowed to a unitholder or recaptured as a result of the basis or at risk limitations will carry forward and will be allowable as a deduction in a later year to the extent that the unitholder’s tax basis or at risk amount, whichever is the limiting factor, is subsequently increased. Upon a taxable disposition of units, any gain recognized by a unitholder can be offset by losses that were previously suspended by the at risk limitation but not losses suspended by the basis limitation. Any loss previously suspended by the at risk limitation in excess of that gain can no longer be used.

In addition to the basis and at risk limitations, a passive activity loss limitation generally limits the deductibility of losses incurred by individuals, estates, trusts, some closely-held corporations and personal service corporations from “passive activities” (generally, trade or business activities in which the taxpayer does not materially participate). The passive loss limitations are applied separately with respect to each publicly-traded partnership. Consequently, any passive losses we generate will be available to offset only passive income generated by us. Passive losses that exceed a unitholder’s share of passive income we generate may be deducted in full when the unitholder disposes of all of its units in a fully taxable transaction with an unrelated party. The passive loss rules generally are applied after other applicable limitations on deductions, including the at risk and basis limitations.

Limitations on Interest Deductions

The deductibility of a non-corporate taxpayer’s “investment interest expense” generally is limited to the amount of that taxpayer’s “net investment income.” Investment interest expense includes:

 

   

interest on indebtedness allocable to property held for investment;

 

   

interest expense allocated against portfolio income; and

 

   

the portion of interest expense incurred to purchase or carry an interest in a passive activity to the extent allocable against portfolio income.

 

175


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The computation of a unitholder’s investment interest expense will take into account interest on any margin account borrowing or other loan incurred to purchase or carry a unit. Net investment income includes gross income from property held for investment and amounts treated as portfolio income under the passive loss rules, less deductible expenses other than interest directly connected with the production of investment income. Net investment income generally does not include qualified dividend income or gains attributable to the disposition of property held for investment. A unitholder’s share of a publicly-traded partnership’s portfolio income and, according to the IRS, net passive income will be treated as investment income for purposes of the investment interest expense limitation.

Entity-Level Collections of Unitholder Taxes

If we are required or elect under applicable law to pay any federal, state, local or non-U.S. tax on behalf of any current or former unitholder or our general partner, we are authorized to treat the payment as a distribution of cash to the relevant unitholder or general partner. Where the tax is payable on behalf of all unitholders or we cannot determine the specific unitholder on whose behalf the tax is payable, we are authorized to treat the payment as a distribution to all current unitholders. Payments by us as described above could give rise to an overpayment of tax on behalf of a unitholder, in which event the unitholder may be entitled to claim a refund of the overpayment amount. Unitholders are urged to consult their tax advisors to determine the consequences to them of any tax payment we make on their behalf.

Allocation of Income, Gain, Loss and Deduction

In general, if we have a net profit, our items of income, gain, loss and deduction will be allocated amongst our unitholders in accordance with their percentage interests in us. If we have a net loss, our items of income, gain, loss and deduction will be allocated first among our unitholders in accordance with their percentage interests in us to the extent of their positive capital accounts and thereafter to our general partner. At any time that distributions are made with respect to common units and not with respect to subordinated units, or that incentive distributions are made to our sponsor, gross income will be allocated to the recipients to the extent of such distributions.

Specified items of our income, gain, loss and deduction will be allocated under Section 704(c) of the Code to account for any difference between the tax basis and fair market value of our assets at the time such assets are contributed to us and at the time of any subsequent offering of our units (a “Book-Tax Disparity”). In addition, items of recapture income will be specially allocated to the extent possible to the unitholder who was allocated the deduction giving rise to that recapture income in order to minimize the recognition of ordinary income by other unitholders.

Treatment of Securities Loans

A unitholder whose units are loaned (for example, a loan to “short seller” to cover a short sale of units) may be treated as having disposed of those units. If so, such unitholder would no longer be treated for tax purposes as a partner with respect to those units during the period of the loan and may recognize gain or loss from the disposition. As a result, during this period (i) any of our income, gain, loss or deduction allocated to those units would not be reportable by the lending unitholder, and (ii) any cash distributions received by the unitholder as to those units may be treated as ordinary taxable income.

Due to a lack of controlling authority, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has not rendered an opinion regarding the tax treatment of a unitholder that enters into a securities loan with respect to its units. Unitholders desiring to assure their status as partners and avoid the risk of income recognition from a loan of their units are urged to modify any applicable brokerage account agreements to prohibit their brokers from borrowing and lending their units. The IRS has announced that it is studying issues relating to the tax treatment of short sales of partnership interests. Please read “—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss.”

 

176


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Tax Rates

Under current law, the highest marginal federal income tax rates for individuals applicable to ordinary income and long-term capital gains (generally, gains from the sale or exchange of certain investment assets held for more than one year) are 35% and 15%, respectively. However, absent new legislation extending the current rates, beginning January 1, 2013, the highest marginal federal income tax rate applicable to ordinary income and long-term capital gains of individuals will increase to 39.6% and 20%, respectively. These rates are subject to change by new legislation at any time.

A 3.8% Medicare tax on certain investment income earned by individuals, estates, and trusts will apply for taxable years beginning after December 31, 2012. For these purposes, investment income generally includes a unitholder’s allocable share of our income and gain realized by a unitholder from a sale of units. In the case of an individual, the tax will be imposed on the lesser of (i) the unitholder’s net investment income from all investments, or (ii) the amount by which the unitholder’s modified adjusted gross income exceeds $250,000 (if the unitholder is married and filing jointly or a surviving spouse), $125,000 (if married filing separately) or $200,000 (if the unitholder is unmarried). In the case of an estate or trust, the tax will be imposed on the lesser of (i) undistributed net investment income, or (ii) the excess adjusted gross income over the dollar amount at which the highest income tax bracket applicable to an estate or trust begins.

Section 754 Election

We will make the election permitted by Section 754 of the Code that permits us to adjust the tax bases in our assets as to specific purchasers of our units under Section 743(b) of the Code. The Section 743(b) adjustment separately applies to each purchaser of units based upon the values and bases of our assets at the time of the relevant purchase, and the adjustment will reflect the purchase price paid. The Section 743(b) adjustment does not apply to a person who purchases units directly from us.

The IRS may challenge the positions we adopt with respect to depreciating or amortizing the Section 743(b) adjustment we take to preserve the uniformity of units due to lack of controlling authority. Because a unitholder’s tax basis for its units is reduced by its share of our items of deduction or loss, any position we take that understates deductions will overstate a unitholder’s basis in its units, and may cause the unitholder to understate gain or overstate loss on any sale of such units. Please read “—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss.” If a challenge to such treatment were sustained, the gain from the sale of units may be increased without the benefit of additional deductions.

The calculations involved in the Section 754 election are complex and will be made on the basis of assumptions as to the value of our assets and other matters. The IRS could seek to reallocate some or all of any Section 743(b) adjustment we allocated to our assets subject to depreciation or depletion to goodwill or nondepreciable assets. Goodwill, as an intangible asset, is generally nonamortizable or amortizable over a longer period of time or under a less accelerated method than our tangible assets. We cannot assure any unitholder that the determinations we make will not be successfully challenged by the IRS or that the resulting deductions will not be reduced or disallowed altogether. Should the IRS require a different tax basis adjustment to be made, and should, in our opinion, the expense of compliance exceed the benefit of the election, we may seek permission from the IRS to revoke our Section 754 election. If permission is granted, a subsequent purchaser of units may be allocated more income than it would have been allocated had the election not been revoked.

 

177


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Tax Treatment of Operations

Accounting Method and Taxable Year

We will use the year ending December 31 as our taxable year and the accrual method of accounting for federal income tax purposes. Each unitholder will be required to include in income its share of our income, gain, loss and deduction for each taxable year ending within or with its taxable year. In addition, a unitholder who has a taxable year ending on a date other than December 31 and who disposes of all of its units following the close of our taxable year but before the close of its taxable year must include its share of our income, gain, loss and deduction in income for its taxable year, with the result that it will be required to include in income for its taxable year its share of more than one year of our income, gain, loss and deduction. Please read “—Disposition of Units—Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees.”

Tax Basis, Depreciation and Amortization

The tax basis of our assets will be used for purposes of computing depreciation and cost recovery deductions and, ultimately, gain or loss on the disposition of these assets. The federal income tax burden associated with the difference between the fair market value of our assets and their tax basis immediately prior to an offering generally will be borne by our partners holding interests in us prior to this offering. Please read “—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Allocation of Income, Gain, Loss and Deduction.”

If we dispose of depreciable property by sale, foreclosure or otherwise, all or a portion of any gain, determined by reference to the amount of depreciation and depletion deductions previously taken, may be subject to the recapture rules and taxed as ordinary income rather than capital gain. Similarly, a unitholder who has taken cost recovery or depreciation deductions with respect to property we own will likely be required to recapture some or all of those deductions as ordinary income upon a sale of its interest in us. Please read “—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Allocation of Income, Gain, Loss and Deduction” and “—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss.”

The costs we incur in offering and selling our units (called “syndication expenses”) must be capitalized and cannot be deducted currently, ratably or upon our termination. While there are uncertainties regarding the classification of costs as organization expenses, which may be amortized by us, and as syndication expenses, which may not be amortized by us, the underwriting discounts and commissions we incur will be treated as syndication expenses.

Valuation and Tax Basis of Our Properties

The federal income tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of units will depend in part on our estimates of the relative fair market values and the initial tax bases of our assets. Although we may from time to time consult with professional appraisers regarding valuation matters, we will make many of the relative fair market value estimates ourselves. These estimates and determinations of tax basis are subject to challenge and will not be binding on the IRS or the courts. If the estimates of fair market value or basis are later found to be incorrect, the character and amount of items of income, gain, loss or deduction previously reported by unitholders could change, and unitholders could be required to adjust their tax liability for prior years and incur interest and penalties with respect to those adjustments.

Sand Depletion

In general, we are entitled to depletion deductions with respect to silica (sand) mined from the underlying mineral property. We generally are entitled to the greater of cost depletion limited to the basis of the property or percentage depletion. The percentage depletion rate for sand is 5%.

Depletion deductions we claim generally will reduce the tax basis of the underlying mineral property. Percentage depletion deductions can, however, exceed the total tax basis of the mineral property. Upon the

 

178


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

disposition of the mineral property, a portion of the gain, if any, equal to the lesser of the deductions for depletion which reduce the adjusted tax basis of the mineral property plus deductible development and mining exploration expenses, or the amount of gain recognized on the disposition, will be treated as ordinary income to us.

Sales of Sand Reserves

If any silica reserves are sold or otherwise disposed of in a taxable transaction, we will recognize gain or loss measured by the difference between the amount realized (including the amount of any indebtedness assumed by the purchaser upon such disposition or to which such property is subject) and the adjusted tax basis of the property sold. Generally, the character of any gain or loss recognized upon that disposition will depend upon whether our silica reserves sold are held by us:

 

   

for sale to customers in the ordinary course of business (i.e., we are a “dealer” with respect to that property);

 

   

for use in a trade or business within the meaning of Section 1231 of the Code; or

 

   

as a capital asset within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code.

In determining dealer status with respect to silica reserves and other types of real estate, courts have identified a number of factors for distinguishing between a particular property held for sale in the ordinary course of business and one held for investment. Any determination must be based on all facts and circumstances surrounding the particular property for sale in question.

We intend to hold our silica reserves for use in a trade or business and to achieve long-term capital appreciation. Although our general partner may consider strategic sales of silica reserves consistent with achieving long-term capital appreciation, our general partner does not anticipate frequent sales of silica reserves. Thus, we do not believe we will be viewed as a dealer. Nonetheless, our purposes for holding our properties may change and our future activities could cause us to be a “dealer” in silica reserves.

If we are not a dealer with respect to our silica reserves and we have held the disposed reserves for more than a one-year period primarily for use in our trade or business, the character of any gain or loss realized from a disposition of the property will be determined under Section 1231 of the Code. If we have not held the property for more than one year at the time of the sale, gain or loss from the sale will be taxable as ordinary income.

A unitholder’s distributive share of any Section 1231 gain or loss generated by us will be aggregated with any other gains or losses realized by that unitholder from the disposition of property used in a trade or business, as defined in Section 1231(b) of the Code. If a net gain results, all such gains and losses will be long-term capital gains and losses. If a net loss results, all such gains and losses will be ordinary income and losses. Net Section 1231 gains will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of prior Section 1231 losses of the taxpayer or predecessor taxpayer for the five most recent prior taxable years to the extent such losses have not previously been offset against Section 1231 gains. Losses are deemed recaptured in the chronological order in which they arose.

If we are not a dealer with respect to our silica reserves and that property is not used in a trade or business, the property will be a “capital asset” within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code. Gain or loss recognized from the disposition of that property will be taxable as long term capital gain or loss if we have held such reserves for more than one year and short term gain or loss if we have not satisfied that holding period.

Upon a disposition of silica reserves, a portion of the gain, if any, equal to the lesser of (i) the depletion deductions that reduced the tax basis of the disposed mineral property, plus deductible mining and exploration and development expenses, or (ii) the amount of gain recognized on the disposition, will be treated as ordinary income to us.

 

179


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Disposition of Units

Recognition of Gain or Loss

A unitholder will be required to recognize gain or loss on a sale of units equal to the difference between the unitholder’s amount realized and tax basis in the units sold. A unitholder’s amount realized generally will equal the sum of the cash or the fair market value of other property it receives plus its share of our liabilities with respect to such units. Because the amount realized includes a unitholder’s share of our liabilities, the gain recognized on the sale of units could result in a tax liability in excess of any cash received from the sale.

Except as noted below, gain or loss recognized by a unitholder on the sale or exchange of a unit held for more than one year generally will be taxable as long-term capital gain or loss. However, gain or loss recognized on the disposition of units will be separately computed and taxed as ordinary income or loss under Section 751 of the Code to the extent attributable to Section 751 Assets, such as depreciation or depletion recapture. Ordinary income attributable to Section 751 Assets may exceed net taxable gain realized on the sale of a unit and may be recognized even if there is a net taxable loss realized on the sale of a unit. Thus, a unitholder may recognize both ordinary income and capital gain or loss upon a sale of units. Net capital loss may offset capital gains and, in the case of individuals, up to $3,000 of ordinary income per year.

The IRS has ruled that a partner who acquires interests in a partnership in separate transactions must combine those interests and maintain a single adjusted tax basis for all those interests. Upon a sale or other disposition of less than all of those interests, a portion of that tax basis must be allocated to the interests sold using an “equitable apportionment” method, which generally means that the tax basis allocated to the interest sold equals an amount that bears the same relation to the partner’s tax basis in its entire interest in the partnership as the value of the interest sold bears to the value of the partner’s entire interest in the partnership.

Treasury Regulations under Section 1223 of the Code allow a selling unitholder who can identify units transferred with an ascertainable holding period to elect to use the actual holding period of the units transferred. Thus, according to the ruling discussed above, a unitholder will be unable to select high or low basis units to sell as would be the case with corporate stock, but, according to the Treasury Regulations, it may designate specific units sold for purposes of determining the holding period of units transferred. A unitholder electing to use the actual holding period of units transferred must consistently use that identification method for all subsequent sales or exchanges of our units. A unitholder considering the purchase of additional units or a sale of units purchased in separate transactions is urged to consult its tax advisor as to the possible consequences of this ruling and application of the Treasury Regulations.

Specific provisions of the Code affect the taxation of some financial products and securities, including partnership interests, by treating a taxpayer as having sold an “appreciated” financial position, including a partnership interest with respect to which gain would be recognized if it were sold, assigned or terminated at its fair market value, in the event the taxpayer or a related person enters into:

 

   

a short sale;

 

   

an offsetting notional principal contract; or

 

   

a futures or forward contract with respect to the partnership interest or substantially identical property.

Moreover, if a taxpayer has previously entered into a short sale, an offsetting notional principal contract or a futures or forward contract with respect to the partnership interest, the taxpayer will be treated as having sold that position if the taxpayer or a related person then acquires the partnership interest or substantially identical property. The Secretary of the Treasury is authorized to issue regulations that treat a taxpayer that enters into transactions or positions that have substantially the same effect as the preceding transactions as having constructively sold the financial position.

 

180


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Allocations Between Transferors and Transferee

In general, our taxable income or loss will be determined annually, will be prorated on a monthly basis and will be subsequently apportioned among the unitholders in proportion to the number of units owned by each of them as of the opening of the applicable exchange on the first business day of the month (the “Allocation Date”). However, gain or loss realized on a sale or other disposition of our assets or, in the discretion of the general partner, any other extraordinary item of income, gain, loss or deduction will be allocated among the unitholders on the Allocation Date in the month in which such income, gain, loss or deduction is recognized. As a result, a unitholder transferring units may be allocated income, gain, loss and deduction realized after the date of transfer.

Although simplifying conventions are contemplated by the Code and most publicly-traded partnerships use similar simplifying conventions, the use of this method may not be permitted under existing Treasury Regulations. Recently, however, the Department of the Treasury and the IRS issued proposed Treasury Regulations that provide a safe harbor pursuant to which a publicly-traded partnership may use a similar monthly simplifying convention to allocate tax items among transferor and transferee unitholders, although such tax items must be prorated on a daily basis. Nonetheless, the proposed regulations do not specifically authorize the use of the proration method we have adopted. Accordingly, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. is unable to opine on the validity of this method of allocating income and deductions between transferee and transferor unitholders. If this method is not allowed under the final Treasury Regulations, or only applies to transfers of less than all of the unitholder’s interest, our taxable income or losses could be reallocated among our unitholders. We are authorized to revise our method of allocation between transferee and transferor unitholders, as well as among unitholders whose interests vary during a taxable year, to conform to a method permitted under future Treasury Regulations.

A unitholder who disposes of units prior to the record date set for a cash distribution for that quarter will be allocated items of our income, gain, loss and deduction attributable to the month of disposition but will not be entitled to receive a cash distribution for that period.

Notification Requirements

A unitholder who sells or purchases any of its units is generally required to notify us in writing of that transaction within 30 days after the transaction (or, if earlier, January 15 of the year following the transaction). Upon receiving such notifications, we are required to notify the IRS of that transaction and to furnish specified information to the transferor and transferee. Failure to notify us of a transfer of units may, in some cases, lead to the imposition of penalties. However, these reporting requirements do not apply to a sale by an individual who is a citizen of the United States and who effects the sale through a broker who will satisfy such requirements.

Constructive Termination

We will be considered to have “constructively” terminated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes upon the sale or exchange of 50% or more of the total interests in our capital and profits within a twelve-month period. For such purposes, multiple sales of the same unit are counted only once. A constructive termination results in the closing of our taxable year for all unitholders. In the case of a unitholder reporting on a taxable year other than the calendar year, the closing of our taxable year may result in more than twelve months of our taxable income or loss being includable in such unitholder’s taxable income for the year of termination.

A constructive termination occurring on a date other than December 31 generally would require that we file two tax returns for one fiscal year and the cost of the preparation of these returns will be borne by all unitholders. However, pursuant to an IRS relief procedure the IRS may allow a constructively terminated partnership to provide a single Schedule K-1 for the calendar year in which a termination occurs. Following a constructive termination, we would be required to make new tax elections, including a new election under Section 754 of the Code, and the termination would result in a deferral of our deductions for depreciation. A termination could also result in penalties if we were unable to determine that the termination had occurred. Moreover, a termination may

 

181


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

either accelerate the application of, or subject us to, any tax legislation enacted before the termination that would not otherwise have been applied to us as a continuing as opposed to a terminating partnership.

Uniformity of Units

Because we cannot match transferors and transferees of units and other reasons, we must maintain uniformity of the economic and tax characteristics of the units to a purchaser of these units. In the absence of uniformity, we may be unable to completely comply with a number of federal income tax requirements. Any non-uniformity could have a negative impact on the value of the units. Please read “—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election.”

Our partnership agreement permits our general partner to take positions in filing our tax returns that preserve the uniformity of our units. These positions may include reducing the depreciation, amortization or loss deductions to which a unitholder would otherwise be entitled or reporting a slower amortization of Section 743(b) adjustments for some unitholders than that to which they would otherwise be entitled. Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. is unable to opine as to validity of such filing positions.

A unitholder’s basis in units is reduced by its share of our deductions (whether or not such deductions were claimed on an individual income tax return) so that any position that we take that understates deductions will overstate the unitholder’s basis in its units, and may cause the unitholder to understate gain or overstate loss on any sale of such units. Please read “—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss” above and “—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election” above. The IRS may challenge one or more of any positions we take to preserve the uniformity of units. If such a challenge were sustained, the uniformity of units might be affected, and, under some circumstances, the gain from the sale of units might be increased without the benefit of additional deductions.

Tax-Exempt Organizations and Other Investors

Ownership of units by employee benefit plans, other tax-exempt organizations, non-resident aliens, non-U.S. corporations and other non-U.S. persons raises issues unique to those investors and, as described below, may have substantially adverse tax consequences to them. Prospective unitholders that are tax-exempt entities or non-U.S. persons should consult their tax advisors before investing in our units. Employee benefit plans and most other tax-exempt organizations, including IRAs and other retirement plans, are subject to federal income tax on unrelated business taxable income. Virtually all of our income will be unrelated business taxable income and will be taxable to a tax-exempt unitholder.

Non-resident aliens and foreign corporations, trusts or estates that own units will be considered to be engaged in business in the United States because of their ownership of our units. Consequently, they will be required to file federal tax returns to report their share of our income, gain, loss or deduction and pay federal income tax at regular rates on their share of our net income or gain. Moreover, under rules applicable to publicly-traded partnerships, distributions to non-U.S. unitholders are subject to withholding at the highest applicable effective tax rate. Each non-U.S. unitholder must obtain a taxpayer identification number from the IRS and submit that number to our transfer agent on a Form W-8BEN or applicable substitute form in order to obtain credit for these withholding taxes.

In addition, because a foreign corporation that owns units will be treated as engaged in a United States trade or business, that corporation may be subject to the U.S. branch profits tax at a rate of 30%, in addition to regular federal income tax, on its share of our income and gain, as adjusted for changes in the foreign corporation’s “U.S. net equity,” which is effectively connected with the conduct of a United States trade or business. That tax may be reduced or eliminated by an income tax treaty between the United States and the country in which the foreign corporate unitholder is a “qualified resident.” In addition, this type of unitholder is subject to special information reporting requirements under Section 6038C of the Code.

 

182


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

A non U.S. unitholder who sells or otherwise disposes of a unit will be subject to federal income tax on gain realized from the sale or disposition of that unit to the extent the gain is effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business of the non U.S. unitholder. Under a ruling published by the IRS, interpreting the scope of “effectively connected income,” part or all of a non U.S. unitholder’s gain may be treated as effectively connected with that unitholder’s indirect U.S. trade or business constituted by its investment in us. Moreover, under the Foreign Investment in Real Property Tax Act, a non U.S. unitholder generally will be subject to federal income tax upon the sale or disposition of a unit if (i) it owned (directly or constructively applying certain attribution rules) more than 5% of our units at any time during the five-year period ending on the date of such disposition and (ii) 50% or more of the fair market value of all of our assets consisted of U.S. real property interests at any time during the shorter of the period during which such unitholder held the units or the 5-year period ending on the date of disposition. More than 50% of our assets may consist of U.S. real property interests. Therefore, non U.S. unitholders may be subject to federal income tax on gain from the sale or disposition of their units.

Administrative Matters

Information Returns and Audit Procedures

We intend to furnish to each unitholder, within 90 days after the close of each taxable year, specific tax information, including a Schedule K-1, which describes its share of our income, gain, loss and deduction for our preceding taxable year. In preparing this information, which will not be reviewed by counsel, we will take various accounting and reporting positions, some of which have been mentioned earlier, to determine each unitholder’s share of income, gain, loss and deduction. We cannot assure our unitholders that those positions will yield a result that conforms to all of the requirements of the Code, Treasury Regulations or administrative interpretations of the IRS.

The IRS may audit our federal income tax information returns. Neither we nor Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. can assure prospective unitholders that the IRS will not successfully challenge the positions we adopt, and such a challenge could adversely affect the value of the units. Adjustments resulting from an IRS audit may require each unitholder to adjust a prior year’s tax liability and may result in an audit of the unitholder’s own return. Any audit of a unitholder’s return could result in adjustments unrelated to our returns.

Publicly traded partnerships generally are treated as entities separate from their owners for purposes of federal income tax audits, judicial review of administrative adjustments by the IRS and tax settlement proceedings. The tax treatment of partnership items of income, gain, loss and deduction are determined in a partnership proceeding rather than in separate proceedings of the partners. The Code requires that one partner be designated as the “Tax Matters Partner” for these purposes, and our partnership agreement designates our general partner.

The Tax Matters Partner can extend the statute of limitations for assessment of tax deficiencies against unitholders for items in our returns. The Tax Matters Partner may bind a unitholder with less than a 1% profits interest in us to a settlement with the IRS unless that unitholder elects, by filing a statement with the IRS, not to give that authority to the Tax Matters Partner. The Tax Matters Partner may seek judicial review, by which all the unitholders are bound, of a final partnership administrative adjustment and, if the Tax Matters Partner fails to seek judicial review, judicial review may be sought by any unitholder having at least a 1% interest in profits or by any group of unitholders having in the aggregate at least a 5% interest in profits. However, only one action for judicial review may go forward, and each unitholder with an interest in the outcome may participate in that action.

A unitholder must file a statement with the IRS identifying the treatment of any item on its federal income tax return that is not consistent with the treatment of the item on our return. Intentional or negligent disregard of this consistency requirement may subject a unitholder to substantial penalties.

 

183


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Nominee Reporting

Persons who hold an interest in us as a nominee for another person are required to furnish to us:

(1) the name, address and taxpayer identification number of the beneficial owner and the nominee;

(2) a statement regarding whether the beneficial owner is:

(a) a non-U.S. person;

(b) a non-U.S. government, an international organization or any wholly owned agency or instrumentality of either of the foregoing; or

(c) a tax-exempt entity;

(3) the amount and description of units held, acquired or transferred for the beneficial owner; and

(4) specific information including the dates of acquisitions and transfers, means of acquisitions and transfers, and acquisition cost for purchases, as well as the amount of net proceeds from sales.

Brokers and financial institutions are required to furnish additional information, including whether they are U.S. persons and specific information on units they acquire, hold or transfer for their own account. A penalty of $100 per failure, up to a maximum of $1.5 million per calendar year, is imposed by the Code for failure to report that information to us. The nominee is required to supply the beneficial owner of the units with the information furnished to us.

Accuracy-Related Penalties

An additional tax equal to 20% of the amount of any portion of an underpayment of tax that is attributable to one or more specified causes, including negligence or disregard of rules or regulations, substantial understatements of income tax and substantial valuation misstatements, is imposed by the Code. No penalty will be imposed, however, for any portion of an underpayment if it is shown that there was a reasonable cause for the underpayment of that portion and that the taxpayer acted in good faith regarding the underpayment of that portion.

State, Local and Other Tax Considerations

In addition to federal income taxes, unitholders may be subject to other taxes, including state and local income taxes, unincorporated business taxes, and estate, inheritance or intangibles taxes that may be imposed by the various jurisdictions in which we conduct business or own property now or in the future or in which the unitholder is a resident. We currently conduct business or own property only in Texas and Wisconsin. Wisconsin imposes a personal income tax and an income tax on corporations and other entities. Moreover, we may also own property or do business in other states in the future that impose income or similar taxes on nonresident individuals. Although an analysis of those various taxes is not presented here, each prospective unitholder should consider their potential impact on its investment in us.

It is the responsibility of each unitholder to investigate the legal and tax consequences, under the laws of pertinent states and localities, of its investment in us. Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has not rendered an opinion on the state, local, or non-U.S. tax consequences of an investment in us. We strongly recommend that each prospective unitholder consult, and depend on, its own tax counsel or other advisor with regard to those matters. It is the responsibility of each unitholder to file all tax returns that may be required of it.

 

184


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

INVESTMENT IN HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP BY

EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

An investment in us by an employee benefit plan is subject to additional considerations because the investments of these plans are subject to the fiduciary responsibility and prohibited transaction provisions of ERISA and restrictions imposed by Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code. For these purposes the term “employee benefit plan” includes, but is not limited to, qualified pension, profit-sharing and stock bonus plans, Keogh plans, simplified employee pension plans and tax deferred annuities or IRAs established or maintained by an employer or employee organization. Among other things, consideration should be given to:

 

   

whether the investment is prudent under Section 404(a)(1)(B) of ERISA;

 

   

whether in making the investment, that plan will satisfy the diversification requirements of Section 404(a)(1)(C) of ERISA; and

 

   

whether the investment will result in recognition of unrelated business taxable income by the plan and, if so, the potential after-tax investment return. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Tax-Exempt Organizations and Other Investors.”

The person with investment discretion with respect to the assets of an employee benefit plan, often called a fiduciary, should determine whether an investment in us is authorized by the appropriate governing instrument and is a proper investment for the plan.

Section 406 of ERISA and Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code prohibit employee benefit plans from engaging in specified transactions involving “plan assets” with parties that are “parties in interest” under ERISA or “disqualified persons” under the Internal Revenue Code with respect to the plan.

In addition to considering whether the purchase of common units is a prohibited transaction, a fiduciary of an employee benefit plan should consider whether the plan will, by investing in us, be deemed to own an undivided interest in our assets, with the result that our operations would be subject to the regulatory restrictions of ERISA, including its prohibited transaction rules, as well as the prohibited transaction rules of the Internal Revenue Code.

The Department of Labor regulations provide guidance with respect to whether the assets of an entity in which employee benefit plans acquire equity interests would be deemed “plan assets” under some circumstances. Under these regulations, an entity’s assets would not be considered to be “plan assets” if, among other things:

(1) the equity interests acquired by employee benefit plans are publicly offered securities—i.e., the equity interests are widely held by 100 or more investors independent of the issuer and each other, freely transferable and registered under some provisions of the federal securities laws;

(2) the entity is an “operating company”—i.e., it is primarily engaged in the production or sale of a product or service other than the investment of capital either directly or through a majority-owned subsidiary or subsidiaries; or

(3) there is no significant investment by benefit plan investors, which is defined to mean that less than 25% of the value of each class of equity interest is held by the employee benefit plans referred to above.

Plan fiduciaries contemplating a purchase of common units should consult with their own counsel regarding the consequences under ERISA and the Internal Revenue Code in light of the serious penalties imposed on persons who engage in prohibited transactions or other violations.

 

185


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

UNDERWRITING

We, the selling unitholder (Hi-Crush Proppants LLC) and the underwriters named below have entered into an underwriting agreement with respect to the common units being offered, which underwriting agreement will be filed as an exhibit to the registration statement. Barclays Capital Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC are acting as representatives of the underwriters named below and, along with Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC and UBS Securities LLC, as joint book-running managers of this offering. Under the terms of the underwriting agreement and subject to the conditions therein, each of the underwriters named below has severally agreed to purchase from us the number of common units shown opposite the underwriter’s name below:

 

Underwriters

   Number of
Common Units

Barclays Capital Inc.

  

Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC

  

Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC

  

UBS Securities LLC

  

Raymond James & Associates, Inc. 

  

RBC Capital Markets, LLC

  

Robert W. Baird & Co. Incorporated

  
  

 

Total

  
  

 

The underwriting agreement provides that the underwriters’ obligation to purchase the common units included in this offering depends on the satisfaction of the conditions contained in the underwriting agreement including:

 

   

the obligation to purchase all of the common units offered hereby (other than those common units covered by their option to purchase additional common units as described below), if any of the common units are purchased;

 

   

the representations and warranties made by us and Hi-Crush Proppants LLC to the underwriters are true;

 

   

there is no material change in our business or the financial markets; and

 

   

we and Hi-Crush Proppants LLC deliver customary closing documents to the underwriters.

Commissions and Expenses

The following tables show the per common unit and total underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid to the underwriters by the selling unitholder. These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units from the selling unitholder. The underwriting fee is the difference between the initial price to the public and the amount the underwriters pay to us or to the selling unitholder for the common units.

 

     No
Exercise
     Full
Exercise
 

Per common unit

   $         $     

Total

   $         $     

The selling unitholder will pay a structuring fee equal to     % of the gross proceeds from this offering (including any proceeds from the exercise of the option to purchase additional common units) to Barclays Capital Inc. for the evaluation, analysis and structuring of our partnership.

The representatives of the underwriters have advised us that the underwriters propose to offer the common units directly to the public at the public offering price on the cover of this prospectus and to selected dealers, which may include the underwriters, at such offering price less a selling concession not in excess of $         per common unit. After the offering, the representatives may change the offering price and other selling terms. Sales of common units made outside of the United States may be made by affiliates of the underwriters.

 

186


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

We estimate that the expenses of this offering will be approximately $         (excluding underwriting discounts and commissions and structuring fees) all of which will be paid by the selling unitholder.

Option to Purchase Additional Common Units

The selling unitholder has granted the underwriters an option, exercisable for 30 days after the date of the underwriting agreement, to purchase, from time to time, in whole or in part, up to an aggregate of              additional common units at the public offering price less underwriting discounts and commissions. This option may be exercised if the underwriters sell more than              common units in connection with this offering. To the extent that this option is exercised, each underwriter will be obligated, subject to certain conditions, to purchase its pro rata portion of these additional common units based on the underwriter’s underwriting commitment in the offering as indicated in the table at the beginning of this Underwriting Section.

Lock-Up Agreements

We, our subsidiaries, our general partner and its affiliates, including the selling unitholder, Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, and the directors and executive officers of our general partner have agreed that, without the prior written consent of Barclays Capital Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, we and they will not, directly or indirectly, (1) offer for sale, sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of (or enter into any transaction or device that is designed to, or could be expected to, result in the disposition by any person at any time in the future of) any of our common units (including, without limitation, common units that may be deemed to be beneficially owned by us or them in accordance with the rules and regulations of the SEC and common units that may be issued upon exercise of any options or warrants) or securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for common units, (2) enter into any swap or other derivatives transaction that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of the economic consequences of ownership of the common units, (3) make any demand for or exercise any right or file or cause to be filed a registration statement, including any amendments thereto, with respect to the registration of any common units or securities convertible, exercisable or exchangeable into common units or any of our other securities, or (4) publicly disclose the intention to do any of the foregoing for a period of 180 days after the date of this prospectus.

These restrictions do not apply to, among other things:

 

   

the sale of common units pursuant to the underwriting agreement;

 

   

issuances of common units by us pursuant to any employee benefit plan in effect as of the date of the underwriting agreement; and

 

   

the filing of one or more registration statements on Form S-8 relating to any employee benefit plan in effect as of the date of the underwriting agreement.

The 180-day restricted period described in the preceding paragraph will be extended if:

 

   

during the last 17 days of the 180-day restricted period we issue an earnings release or material news or a material event relating to us occurs; or

 

   

prior to the expiration of the 180-day restricted period, we announce that we will release earnings results during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 180-day period,

in which case the restrictions described in the preceding paragraph will continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the announcement of the material news or occurrence of material event unless such extension is waived in writing by Barclays Capital Inc.

Barclays Capital Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, in their sole discretion, may release the common units and other securities subject to the lock-up agreements described above in whole or in part at any time with

 

187


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

or without notice. When determining whether or not to release common units and other securities from lock-up agreements, Barclays Capital Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC will consider, among other factors, the holder’s reasons for requesting the release, the number of common units and other securities for which the release is being requested and market conditions at the time. Barclays Capital Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC have no present intent or arrangement to release any of the securities that would be subject to these lock-up agreements.

At the request of our sponsor, the underwriters have reserved up to                 % of the common units for sale at the initial public offering price to persons who are directors, officers or employees, or who are otherwise associated with us through a directed unit program. The number of common units available for sale to the general public will be reduced by the number of directed units purchased by participants in the program. Each participant in the directed unit program has agreed that, for a period of 180 days from the date of this prospectus, he or she will not, without the prior written consent of                 , sell, pledge or assign any common units or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for our common units with respect to common units purchased in the program.                  in its sole discretion may release any of the securities subject to these lock-up agreements at any time without notice. Any directed units not purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same basis as all other common units offered. Our sponsor has agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities and expenses, including liabilities under the Securities Act, in connection with the sales of the directed units.

Offering Price Determination

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common units. The initial public offering price will be negotiated among the representatives and us. In determining the initial public offering price of our common units, the representatives expect to consider:

 

   

the history and prospects for the industry in which we operate;

 

   

our financial information;

 

   

the ability of our management and our business potential and earning prospects;

 

   

the prevailing securities markets at the time of this offering; and

 

   

the recent market prices of, and the demand for, publicly traded common units of generally comparable companies.

Indemnification

We and certain of our affiliates have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act and to contribute to payments that the underwriters may be required to make for these liabilities. The selling unitholder has also agreed that it will indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, and to contribute payments that the underwriters may be required to make for these liabilities, in each case as set forth in the underwriting agreement up to the net proceeds received by the selling unitholder from this offering.

Stabilization, Short Positions and Penalty Bids

The representatives may engage in stabilizing transactions, short sales and purchases to cover positions created by short sales, and penalty bids or purchases for the purpose of pegging, fixing or maintaining the price of the common units, in accordance with Regulation M under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

 

   

Stabilizing transactions permit bids to purchase the underlying security so long as the stabilizing bids do not exceed a specified maximum.

 

188


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

A short position involves a sale by the underwriters of common units in excess of the number of common units the underwriters are obligated to purchase in the offering, which creates the syndicate short position. This short position may be either a covered short position or a naked short position. In a covered short position, the number of common units involved in the sales made by the underwriters in excess of the number of common units they are obligated to purchase is not greater than the number of common units that they may purchase by exercising their option to purchase additional common units. In a naked short position, the number of common units involved is greater than the number of common units in their option to purchase additional common units. The underwriters may close out any short position by either exercising their option to purchase additional common units and/or purchasing common units in the open market. In determining the source of common units to close out the short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of common units available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase common units through their option to purchase additional common units. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there could be downward pressure on the price of the common units in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering.

 

   

Syndicate covering transactions involve purchases of the common units in the open market after the distribution has been completed in order to cover syndicate short positions.

 

   

Penalty bids permit the representatives to reclaim a selling concession from a syndicate member when the common units originally sold by the syndicate member is purchased in a stabilizing or syndicate covering transaction to cover syndicate short positions.

These stabilizing transactions, syndicate covering transactions and penalty bids may have the effect of raising or maintaining the market price of our common units or preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of the common units. As a result, the price of the common units may be higher than the price that might otherwise exist in the open market. These transactions may be effected on the NYSE or otherwise and, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.

Neither we nor any of the underwriters make any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of the common units. In addition, neither we nor any of the underwriters make any representation that the representatives will engage in these stabilizing transactions or that any transaction, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.

Electronic Distribution

A prospectus in electronic format may be made available on the Internet sites or through other online services maintained by one or more of the underwriters and/or selling group members participating in this offering, or by their affiliates. In those cases, prospective investors may view offering terms online and, depending upon the particular underwriter or selling group member, prospective investors may be allowed to place orders online. The underwriters may agree with us to allocate a specific number of common units for sale to online brokerage account holders. Any such allocation for online distributions will be made by the representatives on the same basis as other allocations.

Other than the prospectus in electronic format, the information on any underwriter’s or selling group member’s web site and any information contained in any other web site maintained by an underwriter or selling group member is not part of the prospectus or the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part, has not been approved and/or endorsed by us or any underwriter or selling group member in its capacity as underwriter or selling group member and should not be relied upon by investors.

 

189


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

New York Stock Exchange

Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “HCLP,” subject to official notice of issuance. The underwriters have undertaken to sell the minimum number of common units to the minimum number of beneficial owners necessary to meet the New York Stock Exchange distribution requirements for trading.

Discretionary Sales

The underwriters have informed us that they do not intend to confirm sales to discretionary accounts that exceed 5% of the total number of common units offered by them.

Stamp Taxes

If you purchase common units offered in this prospectus, you may be required to pay stamp taxes and other charges under the laws and practices of the country of purchase, in addition to the offering price listed on the cover page of this prospectus.

Relationships

The underwriters and their respective affiliates are full service financial institutions engaged in various activities, which may include securities trading, commercial and investment banking, financial advisory, investment management, investment research, principal investment, hedging, financing and brokerage activities. Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future perform, various financial advisory, investment banking, commercial banking and other services for us, our general partner and Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, for which they received or will receive customary fees and expenses. Affiliates of the underwriters for this offering may or may not be lenders under our new credit facility.

Furthermore, certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates may, from time to time, enter into arms-length transactions with us or Hi-Crush Proppants LLC in the ordinary course of their business. In the ordinary course of their various business activities, the underwriters and their respective affiliates may make or hold a broad array of investments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of their customers, and such investment and securities activities may involve our securities or instruments or the securities or instruments of our general partner or Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. The underwriters and their respective affiliates may also make investment recommendations or publish or express independent research views in respect of such securities or instruments and may at any time hold, or recommend to clients that they acquire, long or short positions in such securities and instruments.

FINRA

Because the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc., or FINRA, is expected to view the common units offered hereby as interests in a direct participation program, the offering is being made in compliance with Rule 2310 of the FINRA Rules. Investor suitability with respect to the common units should be judged similarly to the suitability with respect to other securities that are listed for trading on a national securities exchange.

 

190


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Selling Restrictions

European Economic Area

In relation to each member state of the European Economic Area that has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a “relevant member state”), other than Germany, with effect from and including the date on which the Prospectus Directive is implemented in that relevant member state, an offer of securities described in this prospectus may not be made to the public in that relevant member state other than:

 

   

to any legal entity which is a qualified investor as defined in the Prospectus Directive;

 

   

to fewer than 100 or, if the relevant member state has implemented the relevant provision of the 2010 PD Amending Directive, 150, natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined in the Prospectus Directive), as permitted under the Prospectus Directive, subject to obtaining the prior consent of the relevant dealer or dealers nominated by the issuer for any such offer; or

 

   

in any other circumstances falling within Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive;

provided that no such offer of securities shall require us or any underwriter to publish a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive.

For purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer of securities to the public” in any relevant member state means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and the securities to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe for the securities, as the expression may be varied in that member state by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that member state, and the expression “Prospectus Directive” means Directive 2003/71/EC (and amendments thereto, including the 2010 PD Amending Directive, to the extent implemented in the relevant member state), and includes any relevant implementing measure in each relevant member state. The expression “2010 PD Amending Directive” means Directive 2010/73/EU.

We have not authorized and do not authorize the making of any offer of securities through any financial intermediary on their behalf, other than offers made by the underwriters with a view to the final placement of the securities as contemplated in this prospectus. Accordingly, no purchaser of the securities, other than the underwriters, is authorized to make any further offer of the securities on behalf of us or the underwriters.

United Kingdom

We may constitute a “collective investment scheme” as defined by section 235 of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, or FSMA, that is not a “recognized collective investment scheme” for the purposes of FSMA, or CIS, and that has not been authorized or otherwise approved. As an unregulated scheme, it cannot be marketed in the United Kingdom to the general public, except in accordance with FSMA. This prospectus is only being distributed in the United Kingdom to, and is only directed at:

 

  (i) if we are a CIS and are marketed by a person who is an authorized person under FSMA, (a) investment professionals falling within Article 14(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Promotion of Collective Investment Schemes) (Exemptions) Order 2001, as amended, or the CIS Promotion Order, or (b) high net worth companies and other persons falling within Article 22(2)(a) to (d) of the CIS Promotion Order; or

 

  (ii) otherwise, if marketed by a person who is not an authorized person under FSMA, (a) persons who fall within Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005, as amended, or Financial Promotion Order, or (b) Article 49(2)(a) to (d) of the Financial Promotion Order; and

 

  (iii) in both cases (i) and (ii) to any other person to whom it may otherwise lawfully be made (all such persons together being referred to as “relevant persons”).

 

191


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The common units are only available to, and any invitation, offer or agreement to subscribe, purchase or otherwise acquire such common units will be engaged in only with, relevant persons. Any person who is not a relevant person should not act or rely on this prospectus or any of its contents.

An invitation or inducement to engage in investment activity (within the meaning of Section 21 of FSMA) in connection with the issue or sale of any common units which are the subject of the offering contemplated by this prospectus will only be communicated or caused to be communicated in circumstances in which Section 21(1) of FSMA does not apply to us.

Switzerland

This prospectus is being communicated in Switzerland to a small number of selected investors only. Each copy of this prospectus is addressed to a specifically named recipient and may not be copied, reproduced, distributed or passed on to third parties. The common units are not being offered to the public in Switzerland, and neither this prospectus nor any other offering materials relating to the common units may be distributed in connection with any such public offering.

We have not been registered with the Swiss Financial Market Supervisory Authority FINMA as a foreign collective investment scheme pursuant to Article 120 of the Collective Investment Schemes Act of June 23, 2006, or the CISA. Accordingly, the common units may not be offered to the public in or from Switzerland, and neither this prospectus nor any other offering materials relating to the common units may be made available through a public offering in or from Switzerland. The common units may only be offered and this prospectus may only be distributed in or from Switzerland by way of private placement exclusively to qualified investors (as this term is defined in the CISA and its implementing ordinance).

Germany

This document has not been prepared in accordance with the requirements for a securities or sales prospectus under the German Securities Prospectus Act (Wertpapierprospektgesetz), the German Sales Prospectus Act (Verkaufsprospektgesetz), or the German Investment Act (Investmentgesetz). Neither the German Federal Financial Services Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht—BaFin) nor any other German authority has been notified of the intention to distribute our common units in Germany. Consequently, our common units may not be distributed in Germany by way of public offering, public advertisement or in any similar manner and this document and any other document relating to the offering, as well as information or statements contained therein, may not be supplied to the public in Germany or used in connection with any offer for subscription of our common units to the public in Germany or any other means of public marketing. Our common units are being offered and sold in Germany only to qualified investors which are referred to in Section 3, paragraph 2 no. 1, in connection with Section 2, no. 6, of the German Securities Prospectus Act, Section 8f paragraph 2 no. 4 of the German Sales Prospectus Act, and in Section 2 paragraph 11 sentence 2 no. 1 of the German Investment Act. This document is strictly for use of the person who has received it. It may not be forwarded to other persons or published in Germany.

The offering does not constitute an offer to sell or the solicitation or an offer to buy our common units in any circumstances in which such offer or solicitation is unlawful.

Netherlands

Our common units may not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, in the Netherlands, other than to qualified investors (gekwalificeerde beleggers) within the meaning of Article 1:1 of the Dutch Financial Supervision Act (Wet op het financieel toezicht).

 

192


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

VALIDITY OF OUR COMMON UNITS

The validity of our common units will be passed upon for us by Vinson & Elkins L.L.P., Houston, Texas. Certain legal matters in connection with our common units offered hereby will be passed upon for the underwriters by Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P., Houston, Texas.

EXPERTS

The financial statements of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC as of December 31, 2010 and 2011, for the period from inception to December 31, 2010 and for the year ended December 31, 2011 included in this prospectus have been so included in reliance on the report of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, given on authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

The statement of financial position of Hi-Crush Partners LP as of May 8, 2012 (date of inception), included in this prospectus, has been so included in reliance on the report of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, given on authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

The information appearing in this prospectus concerning estimates of our proven mineral reserves was derived from the report of John T. Boyd Company, independent mining engineers and geologists, and has been included herein on the authority of John T. Boyd Company as experts with respect to the matters covered by such report and in giving such report.

The information appearing in this prospectus concerning the crush strength of our frac sand and attributed to Stim-Lab, Inc. or PropTester, Inc. was derived from the results of third party testing performed by, and summarized in reports of, each of these companies and has been included herein on the authority of each of these companies as experts with respect to the matters covered by such reports and in giving such reports.

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-1 regarding our common units. This prospectus, which constitutes part of the registration statement, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement. For further information regarding us and our common units offered in this prospectus, we refer you to the registration statement and the exhibits and schedule filed as part of the registration statement. The registration statement, including the exhibits, may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. Copies of this material can also be obtained upon written request from the Public Reference Section of the SEC at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549, at prescribed rates or from the SEC’s web site on the Internet at http://www.sec.gov. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on public reference rooms.

As a result of the offering, we will file with or furnish to the SEC periodic reports and other information. These reports and other information may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC or obtained from the SEC’s website as provided above. Our website address on the Internet will be www.hicrushpartners.com, and we intend to make our periodic reports and other information filed with or furnished to the SEC available, free of charge, through our website, as soon as reasonably practicable after those reports and other information are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Information on our website or any other website is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus and does not constitute a part of this prospectus. After this offering, documents filed by us can also be inspected at the offices of the New York Stock Exchange Inc., 20 Broad Street, New York, New York 10002.

We intend to furnish or make available to our unitholders annual reports containing our audited financial statements prepared in accordance with GAAP. We also intend to furnish or make available to our unitholders quarterly reports containing our unaudited interim financial information, including the information required by Form 10-Q, for the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year.

 

193


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

Some of the information in this prospectus may contain forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements give our current expectations, contain projections of results of operations or of financial condition, or forecasts of future events. Words such as “may,” “assume,” “forecast,” “position,” “predict,” “strategy,” “expect,” “intend,” “plan,” “estimate,” “anticipate,” “believe,” “project,” “budget,” “potential,” or “continue,” and similar expressions are used to identify forward-looking statements. They can be affected by assumptions used or by known or unknown risks or uncertainties. Consequently, no forward-looking statements can be guaranteed. When considering these forward-looking statements, you should keep in mind the risk factors and other cautionary statements in this prospectus. Actual results may vary materially. You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements. You should also understand that it is not possible to predict or identify all such factors and should not consider the following list to be a complete statement of all potential risks and uncertainties. Factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from the results contemplated by such forward-looking statements include:

 

   

the amount of frac sand we are able to excavate and process, which could be adversely affected by, among other things, operating difficulties and unusual or unfavorable geologic conditions;

 

   

the volume of frac sand we are able to sell;

 

   

the price at which we are able to sell frac sand;

 

   

changes in the price and availability of natural gas or electricity;

 

   

changes in prevailing economic conditions;

 

   

unanticipated ground, grade or water conditions;

 

   

inclement or hazardous weather conditions, including flooding, and the physical impacts of climate change;

 

   

environmental hazards;

 

   

industrial accidents;

 

   

changes in laws and regulations (or the interpretation thereof) related to the mining and hydraulic fracturing industries, silica dust exposure or the environment;

 

   

inability to acquire or maintain necessary permits or mining or water rights;

 

   

facility shutdowns in response to environmental regulatory actions;

 

   

inability to obtain necessary production equipment or replacement parts;

 

   

reduction in the amount of water available for processing;

 

   

technical difficulties or failures;

 

   

labor disputes and disputes with our excavation contractor;

 

   

late delivery of supplies;

 

   

difficulty collecting receivables;

 

   

inability of our customers to take delivery;

 

   

changes in the price and availability of transportation;

 

   

fires, explosions or other accidents;

 

   

cave-ins, pit wall failures or rock falls;

 

   

our ability to borrow funds and access capital markets; and

 

   

certain factors discussed elsewhere in this prospectus.

All forward-looking statements are expressly qualified in their entirety by the foregoing cautionary statements.

 

194


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

     F-2   

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-2   

Introduction

     F-2   

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet as of June 30, 2012

     F-3   

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations for the six months ended June 30, 2012

     F-4   

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations for the six months ended June 30, 2011

     F-5   

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations for the year ended December  31, 2011

     F-6   

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-7   

Historical Balance Sheet

     F-9   

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-9   

Balance Sheet as of May 8, 2012

     F-10   

Note to Balance Sheet

     F-11   

HI-CRUSH PROPPANTS LLC

     F-12   

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-12   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

     F-13   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the year ended December  31, 2011 and period from October 28, 2010 (inception) to December 31, 2010

     F-14   

Consolidated Statements of Members’ Equity for the year ended December  31, 2011 and period from October 28, 2010 (inception) to December 31, 2010

     F-15   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended December  31, 2011 and period from October 28, 2010 (inception) to December 31, 2010

     F-16   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-17   

HI-CRUSH PROPPANTS LLC

     F-26   

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011

     F-26   

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations for the three and six months ended June 30, 2012 and 2011

     F-27   

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the six months ended June 30, 2012 and 2011

     F-28   

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

     F-29   

 

F-1


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

Introduction

The following unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements of Hi-Crush Partners LP (the “Partnership”) reflect the historical consolidated results of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC (the “predecessor”) on a pro forma basis to give effect to the contribution by the predecessor of selected assets and related operations to the Partnership in exchange for newly issued common units, subordinated units and incentive distribution rights representing limited partner interests in the Partnership. For additional information, please read “Summary—Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure.”

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated balance sheet of the Partnership is based on the unaudited historical consolidated balance sheet of the predecessor as of June 30, 2012 and includes pro forma adjustments to give effect to the contribution as if it occurred on June 30, 2012.

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statements of operations of the Partnership are based on the unaudited historical consolidated statements of operations of the predecessor for the six month periods ended June 30, 2012 and 2011 and the audited historical consolidated statement of operations of the predecessor for the year ended December 31, 2011 and includes pro forma adjustments to give effect to the contribution as if it occurred on January 1, 2011.

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared on the basis that the Partnership will be treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes. The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the notes accompanying these unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements and with the historical consolidated financial statements and related notes of the predecessor, found elsewhere in this prospectus.

The pro forma adjustments to the audited and unaudited historical financial statements are based on currently available information and certain estimates and assumptions. The actual effect of the contribution discussed in the accompanying notes ultimately may differ from the unaudited pro forma adjustments included herein. However, management believes that the assumptions used to prepare the pro forma adjustments provide a reasonable basis for presenting the significant effects of the contribution as currently contemplated and that the unaudited pro forma adjustments are factually supportable, give appropriate effect to the expected impact of events that are directly attributable to the contribution, and reflect those items expected to have a continuing impact on the Partnership.

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements of the Partnership are not necessarily indicative of the results that actually would have occurred if the Partnership had completed the contribution on the dates indicated or that could be achieved in the future.

 

F-2


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet

as of June 30, 2012

 

     Predecessor
Historical
     Predecessor
Retained
Operations (a)
    Hi-Crush
Partners LP

Pro  Forma (b)
 
     (in thousands)  

Assets

       

Current assets

       

Cash

   $ 11,750       $ (11,750   $   
       
       

Accounts receivable

     11,618                11,618   

Inventories

     3,110                3,110   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     2,047         (553     1,494   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     28,525         (12,303     16,222   

Property, plant and equipment, net

     111,842         (55,736     56,106   

Deferred charges

     2,547         (2,547       
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 142,914       $ (70,586   $ 72,328   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities & members’ equity/partners’ capital

       

Current liabilities

       

Accounts payable

   $ 13,752       $ (11,476   $ 2,276   

Accrued liabilities

     3,885         (1,024     2,861   

Current portion of long-term debt

     6,500         (6,500       
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     24,137         (19,000     5,137   

Long-term debt

     89,921         (89,921       

Asset retirement obligation

     844                844   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     114,902         (108,921     5,981   

Commitments and contingencies

       

Members’ equity/Partners’ capital

     28,012         38,335        66,347 (c) 
       
       
       
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities & members’ equity/partners’ capital

   $ 142,914       $ (70,586   $ 72,328   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-3


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations

for the six months ended June 30, 2012

 

     Predecessor
Historical
     Predecessor
Retained
Operations (a)
    Hi-Crush
Partners LP

Pro  Forma
 
     (in thousands, except per unit data)  

Revenue

   $ 34,175       $      $ 34,175 (d) 

Cost of goods sold (including depreciation and depletion)

     10,271                10,271 (d) 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     23,904                23,904   

Operating costs and expenses

       

General and administrative

     3,137         (1,560     1,577 (e) 

Exploration expense

     419         (419       

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

     12                12 (d) 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from operations

     20,336         1,979        22,315   

Other expenses

       

Interest expense

     2,385         (2,385       
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 17,951       $ 4,364      $ 22,315   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Calculation of net income per limited partner unit:

       

Limited partners’ interest in net income

       

Net income per common unit

       

Net income per subordinated unit

       

Weighted average number of common units outstanding

       

Weighted average number of subordinated units outstanding

       

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-4


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations

for the six months ended June 30, 2011

 

     Predecessor
Historical
    Predecessor
Retained
Operations (a)
     Hi-Crush
Partners LP

Pro  Forma
 
     (in thousands, except per unit data)  

Revenue

   $      $         —       $ (d) 

Cost of goods sold (including depreciation and depletion)

                    (d) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

                      

Operating costs and expenses

       

General and administrative

     647                647 (e) 

Exploration expense

                      

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

                    (d) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     (647             (647

Other expenses

       

Interest expense

                      
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ (647   $       $ (647
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Calculation of net income per limited partner unit:

       

Limited partners’ interest in net loss

       

Net loss per common unit

       

Net loss per subordinated unit

       

Weighted average number of common units outstanding

       

Weighted average number of subordinated units outstanding

       

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-5


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations

for the year ended December 31, 2011

 

     Predecessor
Historical
     Predecessor
Retained
Operations (a)
    Hi-Crush
Partners LP

Pro  Forma
 
     (in thousands, except per unit data)  

Revenue

   $ 20,353       $      $ 20,353 (d) 

Cost of goods sold (including depreciation and depletion)

     6,447                6,447 (d) 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     13,906                13,906   

Operating costs and expenses

       

General and administrative

     2,324         (635     1,689 (e) 

Exploration expense

     381         (381       

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

     28                28 (d) 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from operations

     11,173         1,016        12,189   

Other expenses

       

Interest expense

     1,893         (1,893       
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 9,280       $ 2,909      $ 12,189   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Calculation of net income per limited partner unit:

       

Limited partners’ interest in net income

       

Net income per common unit

       

Net income per subordinated unit

       

Weighted average number of common units outstanding

       

Weighted average number of subordinated units outstanding

       

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-6


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1—Basis of Presentation

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated balance sheet of Hi-Crush Partners LP (the “Partnership”) as of June 30, 2012 is based on the unaudited historical consolidated balance sheet of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC (“predecessor”) and includes pro forma adjustments to give effect to the contribution as described below as if it occurred on June 30, 2012.

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statements of operations of the Partnership are based on the unaudited historical consolidated statements of operations of the predecessor for the three month periods ended June 30, 2012 and 2011 and the audited historical consolidated statement of operations of the predecessor for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and includes pro forma adjustments to give effect to the contribution as described below as if it occurred on January 1, 2011.

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements give effect to the contribution as follows:

 

   

The contribution by the predecessor of selected assets, liabilities and related operations (the “Partnership Operations”) to the Partnership;

 

   

The retention by the predecessor of certain assets, liabilities and operations not sold or contributed to the Partnership; and

 

   

The issuance by the Partnership of              common units,             subordinated units and the incentive distribution rights to the predecessor in exchange for the contribution of the Partnership Operations.

Because the Partnership Operations are owned by the predecessor and the predecessor will control the Partnership, the contribution of the Partnership Operations to the Partnership has been accounted for as a combination of entities under common control, whereby the assets and liabilities sold and contributed and have been recognized based on the predecessor’s historical cost.

Note 2—Pro Forma Adjustments and Assumptions

Unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated balance sheet

(a) Adjustments to reflect the assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses that will be retained by the predecessor, and thus will not be contributed to the Partnership. The adjustment was based on the carrying value of specific assets and liabilities and the specific direct operating revenues and expenses attributable to the Partnership Operations. General and administrative expenses are allocated based on either the direct costs attributable to the Partnership Operations and the operations that will be retained by the predecessor or management’s estimates of the costs incurred by centralized departments in providing services to the Partnership Operations and the operations that will be retained by the predecessor, as applicable. In allocating the costs incurred by centralized departments, management’s estimates were based on separate evaluations of expenses by department for each period presented.

(b) Reflects the Partnership Operations to be contributed to the Partnership by the predecessor. The net book value of the Partnership Operations is based on the historical carrying amounts of the Partnership Operations.

(c) To reflect the issuance by the Partnership of              common units,              subordinated units, incentive distribution rights to the predecessor as consideration for the contribution of the Partnership Operations.

 

F-7


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Unaudited pro forma statements of operations

(d) Reflects the revenues and direct operating expenses associated with the Partnership Operations based on the actual results of the Partnership Operations.

(e) To allocate general and administrative expenses related to the Partnership Operations. The allocation is based on the predecessor’s historical general and administrative expense, reflecting the direct costs attributable to the Partnership Operations and management’s estimates of the share of costs incurred by centralized departments in providing services to the Partnership Operations. In allocating the costs incurred by centralized departments, management’s estimates were based on separate evaluations of expenses by department for each period presented and activity of the operations.

Note 3—Pro Forma Net Income Per Limited Partner Unit

Pro forma net income per limited partner unit is determined by dividing the pro forma net income available to the limited partners by the number of common units and subordinated units expected to be outstanding following the Offering. For purposes of this calculation, management assumed the aggregate number of common units was                  and subordinated units was             . All units were assumed to have been outstanding since January 1, 2011. Basic and diluted pro forma net income per unit are equivalent because there will be no dilutive units at the date of the closing of the Offering.

 

F-8


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Members of

Hi-Crush Partners LP

In our opinion, the accompanying balance sheet presents fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Hi-Crush Partners LP (the “Partnership”) at May 8, 2012, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Partnership’s management; our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit. We conducted our audit of these statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Houston, Texas

May 11, 2012

 

F-9


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

BALANCE SHEET

May 8, 2012

 

Assets

  

Cash

   $   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

   $   
  

 

 

 

Partners’ capital

  

Limited partner’s capital

   $ 1,000   

General partner’s capital

     0   

Receivable from partners

     (1,000
  

 

 

 

Total partners’ capital

   $   
  

 

 

 

See accompanying note to balance sheet.

 

F-10


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Partners LP

NOTE TO BALANCE SHEET

 

1. Organization and Operations

Hi-Crush Partners LP (the “Partnership”) is a Delaware limited partnership formed on May 8, 2012 to acquire selected sand reserves and related processing and transportation facilities of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC. In connection with its formation, the Partnership has issued (a) a non-economic general partner interest to Hi-Crush GP LLC, its general partner, and (b) a 100.0% limited partner interest to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, its organizational limited partner.

The accompanying balance sheet reflects the financial position of the Partnership immediately subsequent to its initial capitalization. There have been no other transactions involving the Partnership as of May 11, 2012.

 

F-11


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

HI-CRUSH PROPPANTS LLC

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Members of

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of operations, members’ equity and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and its subsidiaries (the “Company”) at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2011 and period from October 28, 2010 (inception) to December 31, 2010, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management; our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits of these statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Houston, Texas

April 25, 2012

 

F-12


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Consolidated Balance Sheets

as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

 

         2011              2010      
     (In thousands)  

Assets

     

Current assets

     

Cash

   $ 11,054       $   

Restricted cash

     30           

Accounts receivable

     4,026           

Inventories

     2,374           

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     294           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current assets

     17,778           

Property, plant and equipment, net

     52,708         364   

Deferred charges, net

     1,743           

Other assets

             250   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 72,229       $ 614   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities and Members’ Equity

     

Current liabilities

     

Accounts payable

   $ 4,954       $ 304   

Accrued liabilities

     866           

Deferred revenue

     9,178           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     14,998         304   

Long-term debt

     46,112           

Asset retirement obligation, net

     832           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     61,942         304   

Commitments and contingencies

     

Members’ equity

     10,287         310   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities and members’ equity

   $ 72,229       $ 614   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-13


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Consolidated Statements of Operations

Year Ended December 31, 2011 and Period from

October 28, 2010 (Inception) to December 31, 2010

 

         2011              2010      
     (In thousands)  

Revenues

   $ 20,353       $   

Costs of goods sold (including depreciation and depletion)

     6,447           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     13,906           

Operating costs and expenses

     

General & administrative

     2,324         26   

Exploration expense

     381           

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

     28           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     11,173         (26

Other expenses

     

Interest expense

     1,893           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 9,280       $ (26
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-14


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Consolidated Statements of Members’ Equity

Year Ended December 31, 2011 and Period from

October 28, 2010 (Inception) to December 31, 2010

 

     Members’ Equity
(Class A Units at
$1.00)
    Accumulated
Earnings
    Total  
     (In thousands, except per unit amounts)  

Balance at October 28, 2010 (Inception)

   $      $      $   

Contributions

     336               336   

Net loss

            (26     (26
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2010

     336        (26     310   

Distributions

     (400            (400

Contributions

     1,097               1,097   

Net income

            9,280        9,280   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2011

   $ 1,033      $ 9,254      $ 10,287   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-15


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Year Ended December 31, 2011 and Period from

October 28, 2010 (Inception) to December 31, 2010

 

         2011             2010      
     (In thousands)  

Operating activities

    

Net income (loss)

   $ 9,280      $ (26

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities

    

Depreciation and depletion

     449          

Deferred charges amortization

     154          

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

     28          

Non-cash interest

     2,421          

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

    

Accounts receivable

     (4,026       

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     (294       

Inventories

     (2,374       

Accounts payable

     3,156        12   

Accrued liabilities

     816          

Deferred revenue

     9,178          
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

     18,788        (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

    

Capital expenditures for property, plant and equipment

     (50,169     (72

Restricted cash

     (30       

Other assets

            (250
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (50,199     (322
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

    

Proceeds from long term debt

     48,692          

Repayment of debt

     (5,000       

Loan origination costs

     (1,924       

Contributions received

     697        336   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     42,465        336   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase in cash

     11,054          

Cash

    

Beginning of period

              
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

End of period

   $ 11,054      $   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Disclosure of cash flow information

    

Cash paid for interest

   $ 45      $   

Non-cash investing and financing activities

    

Increase in accounts payable for additions to property, plant and equipment

   $ 1,494      $ 292   

Increase in accrued liabilities for additions to property, plant and equipment

     50          

Non-cash transfer from other assets to property, plant and equipment

     250          

Non-cash transfer from deferred charges to property, plant and equipment

     27          

Distribution to a related party

     (400       

Contribution from an affiliate

     400          

Increase in property, plant and equipment for asset retirement cost

     804          

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-16


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

December 31, 2011 and 2010

(Dollars in Thousands, unless otherwise noted)

1. Business and Organization

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC (the “Company”) is a Delaware limited liability company formed on October 28, 2010. The Company is governed by the Limited Liability Company Agreement of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and is the sole member of Hi-Crush Operating LLC, Hi-Crush Wyeville LLC, Hi-Crush Chambers LLC, Hi-Crush Tomah LLC, Hi-Crush Railroad LLC and Hi-Crush Buffalo LLC. The financial statements for the Company and the related entities are presented on a consolidated basis and are referred to as (the “Company”) in the accompanying financial statements and footnotes. All intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

The Company was formed by certain members of senior management and was wholly owned by Red Oak Capital Management LLC (“ROCM”) until April 1, 2011. In April 2011, ROCM transferred 50% of its interest to RER Legacy Investments LLC and 50 % to JMW Legacy Investments LLC. During the initial start-up period, ROCM contributed $400 by paying for costs related to the Company and that was treated as a non-cash contribution.

In April 2011, Blessed & Favored Investments LLC purchased Class A units in the Company and on August 25, 2011, the members of the Company sold Class A Units to ACP Hip Splitter L.P., ACP Hip Splitter (Offshore) L.P., LasRosas Capital LLC, RGW Interests LLC and John and Karen Huff, Tenants-in-Common.

Hi-Crush Proppants is engaged in the excavation and processing of raw frac sand for use in hydraulic fracturing operations for oil and natural gas wells. In 2011, the Company purchased land in Monroe County, Wisconsin for the purpose of excavating sand for sale into the oil and natural gas market. In July 2011, the Company completed the construction of the Wyeville Sand Processing Plant (“Wyeville Plant”), which was fully operational on July 21, 2011. The Wyeville Plant processes sand from the Company-owned reserves for use in the oil and natural gas industry as proppant.

2. Significant Accounting Policies

Use of Estimates

The preparation of the financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amount of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents consist of all cash balances and highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less.

Restricted Cash

Restricted cash relates to cash collateral in the form of a certificate of deposit as required by a certain letter of credit in the amount of $30 at December 31, 2011.

 

F-17


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Accounts Receivable

Trade receivables relate to sales of commercial sand for which credit is extended based on the customer’s credit history and are recorded at the invoiced amount and do not bear interest. The Company regularly reviews the collectability of accounts receivable. When it is probable that all or part of an outstanding balance will not be collected, the Company establishes or adjusts an allowance as necessary using the specific identification method. Account balances are charged against the allowance after all means of collection have been exhausted and potential recovery is considered remote. There were no reserves for uncollectible amounts as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.

Prepaid Expenses and Other Current Assets

Prepaid expenses and other current assets consist primarily of prepaid insurance and payments to landowners on exclusivity contracts where the Company acquires an exclusive option for a period of time to assess the land purchase. These contracts are for a period less than one year.

Deferred Charges

Costs related to debt financing have been capitalized and are being amortized using the straight-line method over the life of the debt. Amortization expense is included in interest expense and was $154 and $0 for December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

The following is a summary of future amortization expense:

 

For the years ending December 31

  

2012

   $ 385   

2013

     385   

2014

     385   

2015

     385   

2016

     203   
  

 

 

 
   $ 1,743   
  

 

 

 

Inventories

The sand inventory consists of raw material (sand that has been excavated but not processed), work-in-progress (sand that has undergone some of the process but not all) and finished product (sand that has been processed and is ready for sale). The spare parts inventory consists of critical spares, materials and supplies. Detail reviews are performed related to the net realizable value of the spare parts inventory, giving consideration to quality, excessive levels, obsolescence and other factors.

The sand inventory is stated at the lower of cost or market using the average cost method. Costs applied to the inventory include direct excavation costs, processing costs, overhead allocation, depreciation and depletion. Stockpiles tonnages are calculated by measuring the number of tons added and removed from the stockpile. Costs are calculated on a per ton basis and are applied to the stockpiles based on the number of tons in the stockpile.

Spare parts inventory are accounted for on a first-in, first-out basis, at the lower cost or market.

Property, Plant and Equipment

Additions and improvements occurring through the normal course of business are capitalized at cost. When assets are retired or disposed, the cost and the accumulated depreciation and depletion are eliminated from the

 

F-18


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

accounts and any gain or loss is reflected in the income statement. Expenditures for normal repairs and maintenance are expensed as incurred. Construction-in-progress is primarily composed of machinery and equipment which has not been placed in service.

Mine development costs include engineering, mineralogical studies, drilling and other related costs to develop the mine, the removal of overburden to initially expose the mineral and building access ways. Exploration costs are expensed as incurred and classified as exploration expense. Capitalization of mine development project costs begins once the deposit is classified as proven and probable reserves.

Drilling and related costs are capitalized for deposits where proven and probable reserves exist and the activities are directed at obtaining additional information on the deposit or converting non-reserve minerals to proven and probable reserves and the benefit is to be realized over a period greater than one year.

Mine development costs are amortized using the units-of-production (“UOP”) method on estimated measured tons in in-place reserves. The impact of revisions to reserve estimates is recognized on a prospective basis.

Capitalized costs incurred by the Company during the year for major improvement and capital projects that are not placed in service are recorded as construction-in-progress. Construction-in-progress is not depreciated until the related assets or improvements are ready to be placed in service. The Company capitalizes interest cost as part of the historical cost of constructing an asset and getting it ready for its intended use. These interest costs are included in the property, plant and equipment line in the balance sheet. Capitalized interest for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 was $756 and $0, respectively.

Fixed assets other than plant facilities and buildings associated with productive, depletable properties are carried at historical cost and are depreciated using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, as follows:

 

Computer equipment

     3 Years   

Furniture and fixtures

     7 Years   

Vehicles

     5 Years   

Equipment

     5-15 Years   

Rail spurs

     39 Years   

Plant facilities and buildings associated with productive, depletable properties that contain frac sand reserves are carried at historical cost and are depreciated using the units-of-production method. Units-of-production rates are based on the amount of proved developed frac sand reserves that are estimated to be recoverable from existing facilities using current operating methods.

The Company was in a developmental stage from the date of formation until the Wyeville Plant was deemed to be operational on July 21, 2011.

Other Assets

Other assets consist of deposits paid for the acquisition of land and mineral rights.

Impairment of Long-lived Assets

Recoverability of investments in property, plant and equipment and mineral rights is evaluated periodically. Estimated future undiscounted net cash flows are calculated using estimates of proven and probable sand reserves, estimated future sales prices (considering historical and current prices, price trends and related factors) and operating costs and anticipated capital expenditures. Reductions in the carrying value of the Company’s investment are only recorded if the undiscounted cash flows are less than the Company’s book basis in its assets.

 

F-19


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Impairment losses are recognized based on the extent that the remaining investment exceeds the fair value, which is determined based upon the estimated future discounted net cash flows to be generated by the property, plant and equipment and mineral rights.

Management’s estimates of prices, recoverable proven and probable reserves and operating and capital costs are subject to certain risks and uncertainties which may affect the recoverability of the Company’s investments in property, plant and equipment. Although management has made its best estimate of these factors based on current conditions, it is reasonably possible that changes could occur in the near term, which could adversely affect management’s estimate of the net cash flows expected to be generated from its operating property. No impairment charges were recorded during 2011 and in 2010.

Revenue Recognition

Revenue is recognized when legal title passes at the time of shipment to the customer, evidence of a contractual arrangement exists and collectability is reasonably assured. All sales are FOB plant and title passes as the product is loaded into rail cars. Amounts received from customers in advance of revenue recognition are recorded as deferred revenue.

During 2011, the Company sold its products primarily under long-term, take-or-pay supply agreements with two customers with initial terms expiring between 2014 and 2016. These agreements define, among other commitments, the volume of product that the Company must provide, the price that will be charged to the customer and the volume that the customer must purchase.

The Company invoices its customers as product is shipped, usually on a daily basis. The shipments are grouped by customer purchase order and destination and an invoice is generated for each customer/purchase order/destination. Standard terms are net 30 days, but these terms are sometimes extended.

Deferred Revenue

In January 2011, the Company received $16,500 in an advance payment from a customer for a certain volume of product to be delivered over a one year period starting in August 2011. Revenue is recognized as product is delivered and the deferred revenue is reduced. At December 31, 2011 and 2010 the balances of the deferred revenue was $9,178 and $0, respectively.

Asset Retirement Obligation

In accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 410-20, Asset Retirement Obligations, the Company recognizes reclamation obligations when incurred and records them as liabilities at fair value. In addition, a corresponding increase in the carrying amount of the related asset is recorded and depreciated over such asset’s useful life. The reclamation liability is accreted to expense over the estimated productive life of the related asset and is subject to adjustments to reflect changes in value resulting from the passage of time and revisions to the estimates of either the timing or amount of the reclamation costs.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The amounts reported in the balance sheet as current assets or liabilities, including cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued liabilities approximate fair value due to the short-term maturities of these instruments. The fair value of the long-term debt outstanding under the Company’s credit agreement at December 31, 2011 was approximately $45,427, reflecting the application of current interest rates offered for debt with similar remaining terms and maturities.

 

F-20


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Income taxes

The Company is a pass-through entity and is not considered a taxing entity for federal tax purposes and therefore there is not a provision for income taxes in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. The Company’s net income or loss is allocated to the members in accordance with the limited liability company agreement. The members are taxed individually on their share of the Company’s earnings. At December 31, 2010 and 2011, the Company did not have any uncertain tax position liability or gross unrecognized tax benefit.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In May 2011, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820): Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in US GAAP and IFRS, which clarifies Topic 820 and provides guidance on changes to certain principles or requirements for measuring fair value. The amendment is effective during interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company does not believe that adoption of this guidance will have a significant impact on its consolidated financial statements.

In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Presentation of Comprehensive Income, which eliminates the option to present components of other comprehensive income as part of the statement of changes in stockholders’ equity and other reclassifications presented in the financial statements. The update is effective for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2011. Certain provisions of ASU 2011-05 have been amended by ASU No. 2011-12, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassifications of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05, to effectively defer only those changes in ASU 2011-05 that relate to the presentation of reclassification adjustments out of accumulated other comprehensive income. The Company does not believe adoption of the guidance in these two updates will have a significant impact on its consolidated financial statements.

3. Inventories

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, inventories consisted of the following:

 

         2011              2010      

Raw materials

   $       $   

Work-in-progress

     2,095           

Spare parts

     279           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 2,374       $   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

4. Property, Plant and Equipment

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, property, plant and equipment consisted of the following:

 

         2011             2010      

Buildings

   $ 417      $   

Mining property and mine development

     8,939        288   

Plant and equipment

     27,539        33   

Rail and rail equipment

     5,232        43   

Construction-in-progress

     11,085          
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     53,212        364   

Less: Accumulated depreciation and depletion

     (504       
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 52,708      $ 364   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-21


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Depreciation and depletion expense for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 totaled $449 and $0, respectively, and such amounts are included in costs of sales on the consolidated statement of operations. In addition, $55 of depreciation expense is included in the work-in-progress sand inventory.

5. Accrued Liabilities

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, accrued liabilities consisted of the following:

 

         2011              2010      

Royalties

   $ 353       $   

Bonus and payroll

     342           

Other

     171           
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 866       $   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

6. Long-Term Debt

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, long-term debt consisted of the following:

 

         2011              2010      

Promissory note agreement with related party due July 2016 in one balloon payment plus cash or paid-in-kind interest

   $ 46,112       $   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 46,112       $   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit Agreement

The Company entered into a $50,000 credit agreement under the conditions set forth under the promissory note dated May 25, 2011 (the “Promissory Note Agreement”) with related parties, ACP Hip Splitter, L.P. and ACP Hip Splitter (Offshore), L.P., due July 2016. On July 20, 2011, the Promissory Note Agreement was amended to allow additional participants and increased the facility to $52,167. The Promissory Note Agreement is for a term of 5 years and is collateralized by substantially all of the assets of the Company. As of December 31, 2011, $8,475 was undrawn and available.

Advances under the Promissory Note Agreement bear interest of 10% for cash interest or 12% for paid in kind (“PIK”) interest. Interest is calculated monthly. PIK interest increases the outstanding balance of the promissory note. At December 31, 2011, $2,421 had been recorded as PIK interest and is included in the promissory note balance.

In April 2011, the Company entered into a $5,000 Promissory Note, this note and the associated interest was extinguished on May 25, 2011 with proceeds from the $50,000 credit agreement.

Contractual maturities of the Company’s long-term debt at December 31, 2011 are as follows:

 

For the years ending December 31

  

2012

   $   

2013

       

2014

       

2015

       

2016

     46,112   
  

 

 

 
   $ 46,112   
  

 

 

 

 

F-22


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

7. Related Party Transactions

On May 25, 2011, the Company entered into a Management Services Agreement (“Services Agreement”) with Red Oak Capital Management LLC (“Service Provider”). The Service Provider is owned by two members who are also equity members in the Company. The Services Agreement provides for certain management and administrative support services for a term of one year and that thereafter remains in place upon the same terms and conditions. Either party may terminate the agreement by delivering written notice within 90 days prior to the date of expiration of the initial term or any time after the expiration of the initial term, by delivering written notice 90 days prior to the desired date of termination. The Company reimburses the Service Provider 95% of the Service Provider’s actual costs limited to $850 per year. Total management services fees for 2011 and 2010 were $370 and $0, respectively, and are included in general and administrative costs. These amounts approximate the costs the Company would have incurred on a standalone basis.

The Company pays quarterly director fees to directors that may be members and/or holders of the Company debt. Total director fees incurred in 2011 and 2010 were $60 and $0, respectively, and are included in general and administrative costs.

8. Segment Reporting

Operating segments are defined as components of an enterprise for which discrete financial information is available that is evaluated regularly by the chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and in assessing performance. As the company earns all of its revenues through the sale of frac sand excavated from and processed at a single facility, we have concluded that we have one operating segment for reporting purposes.

All of the company’s assets are located within the United States and all of its revenues are attributable to domestic customers.

9. Commitments and Contingencies

At December 31, 2011, the Company had approximately $4,300 of remaining contractual commitments for construction and acquisition of property and equipment in connection with the expansion of its Wyeville Plant, all of which are expected to be incurred in the first quarter of 2012.

On or before June 30, 2012, the Company has an obligation to purchase a tract of land in Monroe County for $6,250.

In 2011, the Company entered into take-or-pay contracts with its customers. These contracts have yearly volume commitments with terms varying from 3 to 5 years.

The Company has entered into royalty agreements where the Company is under a commitment to pay royalties on sand sold, delivered and paid for. Royalty expense is recorded as the sand is sold and the royalty payment is paid based on sand volumes sold, delivered and paid for by the customer. Royalty expense for 2011 and 2010 was $2,045 and $0, respectively, and is included in cost of goods sold.

From time to time the Company may be subject to various claims and legal proceedings which arise in the normal course of business. Management is not aware of any legal matters that are likely to have material adverse effect on the Company’s financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

10. Asset Retirement Obligation

Although the ultimate amount of reclamation and closure costs to be incurred is uncertain, the Company had a post closure reclamation and site restoration obligation of approximately $832 as of December 31, 2011. The Company did not own any land or property as of December 31, 2010, therefore the recording of an asset retirement obligation for 2010 was not needed.

 

F-23


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

The following is a reconciliation of the total reclamation liability for asset retirement obligations:

 

Balances at December 31, 2010

   $   

Additions to liabilities

     804   

Accretion expense

     28   
  

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2011

   $ 832   
  

 

 

 

11. Concentration of Credit Risk

The Company is a producer of sand mainly used by the oil and natural gas industry for fracing wells. The Company’s business is, therefore, dependent upon economic activity within this market. Sales to two customers accounted for 100% of the Company’s revenue in 2011.

Throughout the year, the Company has cash balances in excess of federally insured amounts on deposit with financial institutions.

12. Subsequent Events

In March 2012, the Company borrowed the remaining $8,475 available under its credit agreement. As of March 31, 2012, the balance outstanding under the credit agreement was $55,973, and no further capacity was available.

During the first quarter of 2012, the Company commenced construction of a new facility in Augusta, WI. The Company executed contracts associated with this construction in the amount of $28,288. Construction is expected to be completed during 2012.

On April 6, 2012, the Company entered into a four-year $62,500 secured credit facility (the “Credit Facility”) with Amegy Bank, N.A. and a syndicate of other financial institutions (collectively, the “Lending Banks”). The Credit Facility consists of the following commitments on the part of the Lending Banks: (1) a $25,000 term loan (“Tranche A”), (2) a $30,000 term loan (“Tranche B”) and (3) a $7,500 revolving loan commitment. In addition, the Credit Facility includes sub-facilities providing for letters of credit and swing line borrowings of up to $2,500 each.

Borrowings under the Credit Facility bear interest at a floating rate equal to, at our option, either (a) a base rate plus a range of 225 basis points to 325 basis points per annum or (b) a Eurodollar rate, which is based on one-month LIBOR, plus a range of 325 basis points to 425 basis points per annum. The base rate is established as the higher of (i) the U.S. prime rate last quoted by The Wall Street Journal, (ii) the federal funds rate plus 50 basis points or (iii) LIBOR plus 100 basis points. To the extent that the Company has not borrowed funds under the Tranche B term loan, any unused commitment under Tranche B will expire on December 31, 2012. The Revolving Credit Facility and the Tranche B term loan provides for a commitment fee of 0.5% on the unused portion.

The Credit Facility contains a number of covenants that restrict the Company’s ability to incur additional indebtedness, acquire assets, create liens on assets, sell assets, make investments, and make distributions, among other things. In addition, the Company is required to comply with certain financial covenants, including a maximum effective leverage ratio of 2.75 to 1 prior to March 31, 2013 and 2.0 to 1 thereafter, a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of 1.25 to 1, and limitations on capital expenditures.

As of April 6, 2012, the Company had $25,000 in outstanding borrowings under the Credit Facility, at a rate of 4.23%, all of which was drawn under the Tranche A term loan commitment. The proceeds from the Tranche A loan are to be used for certain identified capital expenditures and to fund general operations. Repayment of

 

F-24


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

outstanding principal under this borrowing are required to be made quarterly, on March 31, June 30, September 30 and December 31 each year, based on a minimum of 5% of the borrowed original principal amount of the loan. In addition, if the Company’s leverage ratio is equal to or greater than 1.0 to 1, it will be required to make additional annual repayments of outstanding principal on May 15 of each year, from 25% to 50% of its excess cash flows, depending on its leverage ratio, all as defined in the terms of the Credit Facility. In the event the Company were to complete an equity issuance, a portion of the proceeds would be required to be used to repay all or a portion of any remaining outstanding principal. If not repaid earlier, the outstanding principal amount is required to be repaid by April 6, 2016.

The Company has performed an evaluation of subsequent events through April 25, 2012, which is the date that the financial statements were made available for issuance.

 

F-25


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

HI-CRUSH PROPPANTS LLC

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets

 

     June 30,
2012
     December 31,
2011
 
     (in thousands)  

Assets

     

Current assets

     

Cash

   $ 11,750       $ 11,054   

Restricted cash

             30   

Accounts receivable

     11,618         4,026   

Inventories

     3,110         2,374   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     2,047         294   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current assets

     28,525         17,778   

Property, plant and equipment, net

     111,842         52,708   

Deferred charges, net

     2,547         1,743   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 142,914       $ 72,229   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities and Members’ Equity

     

Current liabilities

     

Accounts payable

   $ 13,752       $ 4,954   

Accrued liabilities

     3,885         866   

Current portion of long-term debt

     6,500           

Deferred revenue

             9,178   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     24,137         14,998   

Long-term debt

     89,921         46,112   

Asset retirement obligation, net

     844         832   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     114,902         61,942   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies (Note 9)

     

Members’ equity

     28,012         10,287   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities and members’ equity

   $ 142,914       $ 72,229   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-26


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations

 

     Three Months Ended
June 30,
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
         2012              2011             2012              2011      
            (in thousands)         

Revenues

   $ 20,643       $      $ 34,175       $   

Costs of goods sold (including depreciation and depletion)

     5,495                10,271           
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     15,148                23,904           
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating costs and expenses

          

General and administrative

     1,650         473        3,137         647   

Exploration expense

     220                419           

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

     6                12           
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     13,272         (473     20,336         (647

Other expenses

          

Interest expense

     1,457                2,385           
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 11,815       $ (473   $ 17,951       $ (647
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-27


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2012     2011  
     (in thousands)  

Operating activities

    

Net income (loss)

   $ 17,951      $ (647

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

    

Depreciation and depletion

     668          

Deferred charges amortization

     267          

Accretion of asset retirement obligation

     12          

Non-cash interest

     3,083        185   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

    

Accounts receivable

     (7,592       

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     (1,752     (83

Inventories

     (620       

Accounts payable

     (795     (668

Accrued liabilities

     3,019        494   

Deferred revenue

     (9,178     16,500   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

     5,063        15,781   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

    

Capital expenditures for property, plant and equipment

     (50,326     (28,745

Restricted cash

     30        (30
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (50,296     (28,775
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

    

Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt

     48,475        20,000   

Repayment of long-term debt

     (1,250     (5,000

Loan origination costs

     (1,071     (800

Distributions paid

     (225       

Contributions received

            263   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     45,929        14,463   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase in cash

     696        1,469   

Cash

    

Beginning of period

     11,054          
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

End of period

   $ 11,750      $ 1,469   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-cash investing and financing activities

    

Increase in accounts payable for additions to property, plant and equipment

   $ 9,593      $ 4,757   

Non-cash transfer from other assets to property, plant and equipment

            250   

Distribution to a related party

            (400

Contribution from an affiliate

            400   

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-28


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

(Dollars in thousands, except per ton amounts, or where otherwise noted)

Note 1. Business and Organization

Hi-Crush Proppants LLC (“the Company”) is a Delaware limited liability company formed on October 28, 2010. The Company is governed by the Limited Liability Company Agreement of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and is the sole member of Hi-Crush Operating LLC, Hi-Crush Wyeville LLC, Hi-Crush Chambers LLC, Hi-Crush Tomah LLC, Hi-Crush Railroad LLC, Hi-Crush Buffalo County LLC, Hi-Crush Augusta LLC (formed in March 2012), Hi-Crush GP LLC (formed in May 2012), Hi-Crush Partners LP (formed in May 2012) and Hi-Crush Services LLC (formed in June 2012). The financial statements for the Company and the related entities are presented on a consolidated basis and are referred to as the Company in the accompanying condensed consolidated financial statements and footnotes. All intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

Note 2. Basis of Presentation and Use of Estimates

The accompanying unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements (“interim statements”) of Hi-Crush Proppants, LLC and its subsidiaries (collectively, “Hi-Crush” or the “Company”) have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”) for interim financial information and with the instructions to Form 10-Q and Article 10 of Regulation S-X issued by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. Accordingly, they do not include all of the information and footnotes required by GAAP for complete financial statements. In the opinion of management, all adjustments and disclosures necessary for a fair presentation of these interim statements have been included. The results reported in these interim statements are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be reported for the entire year. These interim statements should be read in conjunction with Hi-Crush’s Consolidated Financial Statements for the year ended December 31, 2011. The year-end balance sheet data was derived from the audited financial statements, but does not include all disclosures required by GAAP.

The preparation of the financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Note 3. Significant Accounting Policies

Revenue Recognition

Revenue is recognized when legal title passes at the time of shipment to the customer, evidence of a contractual arrangement exists and collectability is reasonably assured. All sales are FOB plant and title passes as the product is loaded into rail cars. Amounts received from customers in advance of satisfying all revenue recognition criteria are recorded as deferred revenue.

The Company sells its products primarily under long-term take-or-pay supply agreements, the current terms of which expire between 2014 and 2018. During the period from July 21, 2011 through April 30, 2012, the Company delivered products under such agreements to two customers, and beginning in May 2012, it commenced shipments to two additional customers under similar agreements. The take-or-pay agreements define, among other commitments, the volume of product that the Company must provide, the price that will be charged to the customer and the volume that the customer must purchase.

Deferred Revenue

In January 2011 the Company received $16,500 in an advance payment from a customer for a certain volume of product to be delivered over a one-year period starting in July 2011. Revenue is recognized as product

 

F-29


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

is delivered and the deferred revenue obligation is reduced. At December 31, 2011, the remaining deferred revenue balance associated with this prepayment was $9,178. No balance remained as of June 30, 2012, as all product subject to the prepayment had been delivered to the customer.

In July 2012 the Company received an $8,250 advance payment from a customer for a certain volume of frac sand to be delivered over a six-month period starting in July 2012. The deferred revenue liability recorded in connection with this payment will be recognized as revenue, and the liability will be relieved, as product is delivered to the customer through December 31, 2012.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The amounts reported in the balance sheet as current assets or liabilities, including cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued liabilities approximate fair value due to the short-term maturities of these instruments. In addition, the amount recorded on the balance sheet pertaining to the long-term debt outstanding under the Company’s senior secured credit facility approximates its fair value due to its floating interest rate. The fair value of this debt is categorized as a Level 2 measurement per the hierarchy within ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements, as it is based on observable inputs. See Note 6—Long-Term Debt for information regarding borrowings under the senior secured credit facility.

The fair value of the fixed rate long-term debt outstanding under the Company’s subordinated promissory notes at June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011 was approximately $64,886 and $45,427, respectively, reflecting the application of current interest rates offered for debt with similar remaining terms and maturities. While certain of the inputs used in calculating this fair value measurement were observable, others were based upon unobservable inputs. As such, the measurement is categorized as a Level 3 measurement per the fair value hierarchy within ASC 820. See Note 6—Long-Term Debt for information regarding changes in the carrying value of borrowings under these subordinated promissory notes.

Income taxes

The Company is a pass-through entity and is not considered a taxable entity for federal tax purposes and therefore there is not a provision for income taxes in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. The Company’s net income or loss is allocated to its members in accordance with the limited liability company agreement. The members are taxed individually on their share of the Company’s earnings. At June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011, the Company did not have any liabilities for uncertain tax positions or gross unrecognized tax benefit.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In May 2011, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820): Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in US GAAP and IFRS, which clarifies Topic 820 and provides guidance on changes to certain principles or requirements for measuring fair value. The amendment is effective during interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company adopted this guidance during the first quarter of 2012. The adoption of this guidance did not have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements.

 

F-30


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Note 4. Inventories

Inventories consisted of the following:

 

     June 30,
2012
     December 31,
2011
 

Raw materials

   $ 23       $   

Work-in-progress

     2,651         2,095   

Finished goods

     1           

Spare parts

     435         279   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 3,110       $ 2,374   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Note 5. Property, Plant and Equipment

Property, plant and equipment consisted of the following:

 

     June 30,
2012
    December 31,
2011
 

Buildings

   $ 417      $ 417   

Mining property and mine development

     23,041        8,939   

Plant and equipment

     42,562        27,539   

Rail and rail equipment

     5,499        5,232   

Construction-in-progress

     41,612        11,085   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     113,131        53,212   

Less: Accumulated depreciation and depletion

     (1,289     (504
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 111,842      $ 52,708   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Depreciation and depletion expense totaled $489 and $668 for the three and six months ended June 30, 2012, respectively. These amounts are recorded within cost of goods sold. There was no depreciation and depletion expense recorded for either the three or six months ended June 30, 2011.

Note 6. Long-Term Debt

Long-term debt consisted of the following:

 

     June 30,
2012
    December 31,
2011
 

Promissory note agreements with related parties due July 2016 in one balloon payment plus cash or paid-in-kind interest

   $ 57,671      $ 46,112   

Secured credit facility borrowings:

    

Tranche A—term loan

     23,750          

Tranche B—term loan

     15,000          
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 96,421      $ 46,112   

Less: current portion of long-term debt

     (6,500       
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 89,921      $ 46,112   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-31


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Credit Agreement – Subordinated Promissory Notes

Between May 25, 2011 and July 20, 2011, the Company entered into various subordinated promissory notes with certain of its equity investors and their affiliates in an aggregate initial principal amount of $52,167. Borrowings under the subordinated promissory notes bear interest, at the Company’s option, at a rate of 10% for cash interest and 12% for paid-in-kind interest (“PIK interest”). Accruals for PIK interest increase the outstanding principal balance of these promissory notes. At June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011, there was $57,671 and $46,112, respectively, outstanding under the Company’s subordinated promissory notes and there is no further borrowing capacity available as of June 30, 2012. The outstanding balance includes $5,504 and $2,421 of PIK interest at June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011, respectively. The subordinated promissory notes mature in July 2016.

New Subordinated Credit Agreement

In order to fund a royalty termination payment (See Note 9 – Commitments and Contingencies), the Company entered into a new subordinated credit agreement in July 2012 with certain of its equity investors and

their affiliates in an aggregate initial principal amount of $14,981. Consistent with its existing subordinated promissory notes, borrowings under the new subordinated credit agreement bear interest, at the Company’s option, at a rate of 10% for cash interest and 12% for PIK interest. If the principal amount is not repaid in full by September 30, 2012, then the applicable cash and PIK interest rates are subject to quarterly escalations of 1% beginning with the quarter ending December 31, 2012, capped at 16% for cash interest and 18% for PIK interest. In the event the Company was to complete an equity issuance, a portion of the proceeds would be required to be used to repay all remaining outstanding principal under this credit agreement.

Senior Secured Credit Facility

On April 6, 2012, the Company entered into a four-year $62,500 secured credit facility (the “Credit Facility”) with Amegy Bank, N.A. and a syndicate of other financial institutions (collectively, the “Lending Banks”). The Credit Facility consists of the following commitments on the part of the Lending Banks: (1) a $25,000 term loan (“Tranche A”), (2) a $30,000 term loan (“Tranche B”) and (3) a $7,500 revolving loan commitment. In addition, the Credit Facility includes sub-facilities providing for letters of credit and swing line borrowings of up to $5,000 and $2,500, respectively.

Borrowings under the Credit Facility bear interest at a floating rate equal to, at our option, either (a) a base rate plus a range of 225 basis points to 325 basis points per annum or (b) a Eurodollar rate, which is based on one-month LIBOR, plus a range of 325 basis points to 425 basis points per annum. The base rate is established as the highest of (i) the U.S. prime rate last quoted by The Wall Street Journal, (ii) the federal funds rate plus 50 basis points or (iii) daily one-month LIBOR plus 100 basis points. To the extent that the Company has not borrowed funds under the Tranche B term loan, any unused commitment under Tranche B will expire on December 31, 2012. The Credit Facility and the Tranche B term loan provides for a commitment fee of 0.5% on the unused portion.

The Credit Facility contains a number of covenants that restrict the Company’s ability to incur additional indebtedness, acquire assets, create liens on assets, sell assets, make investments, and make distributions, among other things. In addition, the Company is required to comply with certain financial covenants, including a maximum effective leverage ratio of 2.75 to 1 prior to March 31, 2013 and 2.0 to 1 thereafter, a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of 1.25 to 1, and certain limitations on capital expenditures.

As of June 30, 2012, the Company had $38,750 in outstanding borrowings under the Credit Facility, at a weighted average rate of 3.6%, of which $23,750 was drawn under Tranche A and $15,000 was drawn under Tranche B. The proceeds from Tranche A are primarily intended to fund certain identified capital expenditures and for general corporate purposes and the proceeds from the Tranche B loan are primarily used to fund certain identified capital expenditures. Repayments of outstanding principal under these borrowings are required to be

 

F-32


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

made quarterly, on March 31, June 30, September 30 and December 31 each year, based on a minimum of 5% of the borrowed original principal amount of the loan. Such repayments commenced on June 30, 2012 for Tranche A and will begin on March 31, 2013 for Tranche B. In addition, if the Company’s leverage ratio is equal to or greater than 1.0 to 1, it will be required to make additional annual repayments of outstanding principal on May 15 of each year, from 25% to 50% of its excess cash flows, depending on its leverage ratio, all as defined in the terms of the Credit Facility. In the event the Company were to complete an equity issuance, a portion of the proceeds would be required to be used to repay all or a portion of any remaining outstanding principal. If not repaid earlier, the outstanding principal amount under these borrowings is required to be repaid by April 6, 2016.

All of the Company’s long-term debt outstanding at June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011 was guaranteed by its subsidiaries.

Note 7. Related Party Transactions

On May 25, 2011, the Company entered into a Management Services Agreement (“Services Agreement”) with Red Oak Capital Management LLC (“Service Provider”). The Service Provider is owned by two members who are also equity members in the Company. The Services Agreement provides for certain management and administrative support services to be provided to the Company for a term of one year and that thereafter remains

in place upon the same terms and conditions. Either party may terminate the agreement by delivering written notice within 90 days prior to the date of expiration of the initial term or any time after the expiration of the initial term, by delivering written notice 90 days prior to the desired date of termination. The Company reimburses the Service Provider 95% of the Service Provider’s actual costs limited to $850 per year. Total management services fees were $153 and $315 for the three months and six month periods ended June 30, 2012, respectively, and $62 for both the three and six month periods ended June 30, 2011. These fees are included in general and administrative expenses.

The Company pays quarterly director fees to non-management directors that may be members and/or holders of the Company debt. Total director fees for the three months and six months ended June 30, 2012 were $25 and $50, respectively, and are included in general and administrative expenses. The Company incurred no director fees during the three or six months ended June 30, 2011.

Note 8. Segment Reporting

As the Company earns all of its revenues through the sale of frac sand excavated from and processed at a single facility, we have concluded that we have one operating segment for reporting purposes.

Note 9. Commitments and Contingencies

During the first quarter of 2012, the Company commenced construction of a new facility in Augusta, Wisconsin. In connection with this construction, the Company has executed contracts under which approximately $21,982 in remaining payments (as of June 30, 2012) will become due as the construction is completed, which is anticipated to occur during the third quarter of 2012.

The Company has an obligation to purchase a tract of land in Monroe County, Wisconsin for $6,250. The terms of this arrangement originally required the Company to make payment on before June 30, 2012; however, as a result of a delay by the seller in providing certain information required as a condition precedent to the sale, there have been several extensions beyond the June 30 deadline. The current extension is set to expire on July 27, 2012.

In 2011 and 2012, the Company entered into take-or-pay sales contracts with four customers. These contracts establish minimum annual sand volumes that the Company is required to make available to such customers under initial terms ranging from 3 to 6 years.

The Company has entered into royalty agreements under which the Company is under a commitment to pay royalties on sand sold and paid for. Royalty expense is recorded as the sand is sold and the royalty payment is paid based on sand volumes sold and paid for by the customer. Royalty expense for the three months and six

 

F-33


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

months ended June 30, 2012 was $1,947 and $3,316, respectively, and is included in cost of goods sold. There was no royalty expense incurred in the three months or six months ended June 30, 2011, as the Company had not yet commenced its sand excavation and processing operations.

On July 13, 2012 the Company paid $14,000 in cash to terminate one of its existing royalty agreements. As a result of this payment, the Company is no longer required to make ongoing future royalty payments to the applicable counterparties for each ton of frac sand that is excavated, processed and sold to the Company’s customers.

From time to time the Company may be subject to various claims and legal proceedings which arise in the normal course of business. Management is not aware of any legal matters that are likely to have material adverse effect on the Company’s financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

Note 10. Asset Retirement Obligation

Although the ultimate amount of reclamation and closure costs to be incurred is uncertain, the Company had a post closure reclamation and site restoration obligation of approximately $844 and $832, as of June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011, respectively.

The following table is a reconciliation of the total reclamation liability for asset retirement obligations:

 

Balance at December 31, 2011

   $ 832   

Additions to liabilities

       

Accretion expense

     12   
  

 

 

 

Balance at June 30, 2012

   $ 844   
  

 

 

 

Note 11. Subsequent Events

The Company has performed an evaluation of subsequent events through July 24, 2012, which is the date that the financial statements were available to be issued.

 

F-34


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Appendix A

 

 

 

FORM OF

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED

AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

OF

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

   ARTICLE I   
   DEFINITIONS   
Section 1.1   

Definitions

     A-1   
Section 1.2   

Construction

     A-18   
   ARTICLE II   
   ORGANIZATION   
Section 2.1   

Formation

     A-19   
Section 2.2   

Name

     A-19   
Section 2.3   

Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices

     A-19   
Section 2.4   

Purpose and Business

     A-19   
Section 2.5   

Powers

     A-19   
Section 2.6   

Term

     A-20   
Section 2.7   

Title to Partnership Assets

     A-20   
   ARTICLE III   
   RIGHTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS   
Section 3.1   

Limitation of Liability

     A-20   
Section 3.2   

Management of Business

     A-20   
Section 3.3   

Outside Activities of the Limited Partners

     A-20   
Section 3.4   

Rights of Limited Partners

     A-21   
   ARTICLE IV   
   CERTIFICATES; RECORD HOLDERS; TRANSFER OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS; REDEMPTION OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS   
Section 4.1   

Certificates

     A-21   
Section 4.2   

Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates

     A-22   
Section 4.3   

Record Holders

     A-22   
Section 4.4   

Transfer Generally

     A-23   
Section 4.5   

Registration and Transfer of Limited Partner Interests

     A-23   
Section 4.6   

Transfer of the General Partner’s General Partner Interest

     A-24   
Section 4.7   

Restrictions on Transfers

     A-24   
Section 4.8   

Eligibility Certificates; Ineligible Holders

     A-25   
Section 4.9   

Redemption of Partnership Interests of Ineligible Holders

     A-26   
   ARTICLE V   
   CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS AND ISSUANCE OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS   
Section 5.1   

Organizational Contributions

     A-27   
Section 5.2   

Contributions by the General Partner and its Affiliates

     A-27   
Section 5.3   

Contributions by Initial Limited Partners

     A-27   

 

A-i


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
Section 5.4   

Interest and Withdrawal

     A-27   
Section 5.5   

Capital Accounts

     A-27   
Section 5.6   

Issuances of Additional Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments

     A-30   
Section 5.7   

Conversion of Subordinated Units

     A-30   
Section 5.8   

Limited Preemptive Right

     A-31   
Section 5.9   

Splits and Combinations

     A-31   
Section 5.10   

Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Limited Partner Interests

     A-31   
Section 5.11   

Issuance of Common Units in Connection with Reset of Incentive Distribution Rights

     A-31   
   ARTICLE VI   
   ALLOCATIONS AND DISTRIBUTIONS   
Section 6.1   

Allocations for Capital Account Purposes

     A-33   
Section 6.2   

Allocations for Tax Purposes

     A-40   
Section 6.3   

Distributions; Characterization of Distributions; Distributions to Record Holders

     A-41   
Section 6.4   

Distributions from Operating Surplus

     A-41   
Section 6.5   

Distributions from Capital Surplus

     A-42   
Section 6.6   

Adjustment of Target Distribution Levels

     A-43   
Section 6.7   

Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Subordinated Units

     A-43   
Section 6.8   

Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of IDR Reset Common Units.

     A-44   
Section 6.9   

Entity-Level Taxation

     A-44   
   ARTICLE VII   
   MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS   
Section 7.1   

Management

     A-44   
Section 7.2   

Replacement of Fiduciary Duties.

     A-46   
Section 7.3   

Certificate of Limited Partnership

     A-46   
Section 7.4   

Restrictions on the General Partner’s Authority

     A-47   
Section 7.5   

Reimbursement of the General Partner

     A-47   
Section 7.6   

Outside Activities

     A-48   
Section 7.7   

Indemnification

     A-48   
Section 7.8   

Liability of Indemnitees

     A-50   
Section 7.9   

Standards of Conduct and Modification of Duties

     A-50   
Section 7.10   

Other Matters Concerning the General Partner and Indemnitees

     A-51   
Section 7.11   

Purchase or Sale of Partnership Interests

     A-52   
Section 7.12   

Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates

     A-52   
Section 7.13   

Reliance by Third Parties

     A-54   
   ARTICLE VIII   
   BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS   
Section 8.1   

Records and Accounting

     A-54   
Section 8.2   

Fiscal Year

     A-55   
Section 8.3   

Reports

     A-55   

 

A-ii


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   ARTICLE IX   
   TAX MATTERS   
Section 9.1   

Tax Returns and Information

     A-55   
Section 9.2   

Tax Elections

     A-55   
Section 9.3   

Tax Controversies

     A-56   
Section 9.4   

Withholding; Tax Payments

     A-56   
   ARTICLE X   
   ADMISSION OF PARTNERS   
Section 10.1   

Admission of Limited Partners

     A-56   
Section 10.2   

Admission of Successor General Partner

     A-57   
Section 10.3   

Amendment of Agreement and Certificate of Limited Partnership

     A-57   
   ARTICLE XI   
   WITHDRAWAL OR REMOVAL OF PARTNERS   
Section 11.1   

Withdrawal of the General Partner

     A-58   
Section 11.2   

Removal of the General Partner

     A-59   
Section 11.3   

Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner

     A-59   
Section 11.4    Termination of Subordination Period, Conversion of Subordinated Units and Extinguishment of Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages      A-61   
Section 11.5   

Withdrawal of Limited Partners

     A-61   
   ARTICLE XII   
   DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION   
Section 12.1   

Dissolution

     A-61   
Section 12.2   

Continuation of the Business of the Partnership After Dissolution

     A-62   
Section 12.3   

Liquidator

     A-62   
Section 12.4   

Liquidation

     A-62   
Section 12.5   

Cancellation of Certificate of Limited Partnership

     A-63   
Section 12.6   

Return of Contributions

     A-63   
Section 12.7   

Waiver of Partition

     A-63   
Section 12.8   

Capital Account Restoration

     A-63   
   ARTICLE XIII   
   AMENDMENT OF PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT; MEETINGS; RECORD DATE   
Section 13.1   

Amendments to be Adopted Solely by the General Partner

     A-64   
Section 13.2   

Amendment Procedures

     A-65   
Section 13.3   

Amendment Requirements

     A-65   
Section 13.4   

Special Meetings

     A-66   
Section 13.5   

Notice of a Meeting

     A-66   
Section 13.6   

Record Date

     A-66   
Section 13.7   

Adjournment

     A-67   

 

A-iii


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
Section 13.8   

Waiver of Notice; Approval of Meeting; Approval of Minutes

     A-67   
Section 13.9   

Quorum and Voting

     A-67   
Section 13.10   

Conduct of a Meeting

     A-67   
Section 13.11   

Action Without a Meeting

     A-68   
Section 13.12   

Right to Vote and Related Matters.

     A-69   
Section 13.13   

Voting of Incentive Distribution Rights.

     A-69   
   ARTICLE XIV   
   MERGER OR CONSOLIDATION   
Section 14.1   

Authority

     A-69   
Section 14.2   

Procedure for Merger or Consolidation

     A-69   
Section 14.3   

Approval by Limited Partners

     A-70   
Section 14.4   

Certificate of Merger

     A-71   
Section 14.5   

Effect of Merger or Consolidation

     A-71   
   ARTICLE XV   
   RIGHT TO ACQUIRE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS   
Section 15.1   

Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests

     A-72   
   ARTICLE XVI   
   GENERAL PROVISIONS   
Section 16.1   

Addresses and Notices; Written Communications

     A-73   
Section 16.2   

Further Action

     A-74   
Section 16.3   

Binding Effect

     A-74   
Section 16.4   

Integration

     A-74   
Section 16.5   

Creditors

     A-74   
Section 16.6   

Waiver

     A-74   
Section 16.7   

Third-Party Beneficiaries

     A-74   
Section 16.8   

Counterparts

     A-74   
Section 16.9   

Applicable Law; Forum; Venue and Jurisdiction

     A-74   
Section 16.10   

Invalidity of Provisions

     A-75   
Section 16.11   

Consent of Partners

     A-75   
Section 16.12   

Facsimile Signatures

     A-75   

 

A-iv


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT

OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

THIS FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP dated as of             , 2012, is entered into by and between Hi-Crush GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, as the General Partner, and Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, as the Organizational Limited Partner, together with any other Persons who become Partners in the Partnership or parties hereto as provided herein. In consideration of the covenants, conditions and agreements contained herein, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I

DEFINITIONS

 

  Section 1.1  Definitions.  The following definitions shall be for all purposes, unless otherwise clearly indicated to the contrary, applied to the terms used in this Agreement.

Additional Book Basis” means the portion of any remaining Carrying Value of an Adjusted Property that is attributable to positive adjustments made to such Carrying Value as a result of Book-Up Events. For purposes of determining the extent that Carrying Value constitutes Additional Book Basis:

(a) Any negative adjustment made to the Carrying Value of an Adjusted Property as a result of either a Book-Down Event or a Book-Up Event shall first be deemed to offset or decrease that portion of the Carrying Value of such Adjusted Property that is attributable to any prior positive adjustments made thereto pursuant to a Book-Up Event or Book-Down Event.

(b) If Carrying Value that constitutes Additional Book Basis is reduced as a result of a Book-Down Event and the Carrying Value of other property is increased as a result of such Book-Down Event, an allocable portion of any such increase in Carrying Value shall be treated as Additional Book Basis; provided, that the amount treated as Additional Book Basis pursuant hereto as a result of such Book-Down Event shall not exceed the amount by which the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments after such Book-Down Event exceeds the remaining Additional Book Basis attributable to all of the Partnership’s Adjusted Property after such Book-Down Event (determined without regard to the application of this clause (b) to such Book-Down Event).

Additional Book Basis Derivative Items” means any Book Basis Derivative Items that are computed with reference to Additional Book Basis. To the extent that the Additional Book Basis attributable to all of the Partnership’s Adjusted Property as of the beginning of any taxable period exceeds the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of the beginning of such period (the “Excess Additional Book Basis”), the Additional Book Basis Derivative Items for such period shall be reduced by the amount that bears the same ratio to the amount of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items determined without regard to this sentence as the Excess Additional Book Basis bears to the Additional Book Basis as of the beginning of such period. With respect to a Disposed of Adjusted Property, the Additional Book Basis Derivative Items shall be the amount of Additional Book Basis taken into account in computing gain or loss from the disposition of such Disposed of Adjusted Property.

Adjusted Capital Account” means the Capital Account maintained for each Partner as of the end of each taxable period of the Partnership, (a) increased by any amounts that such Partner is obligated to restore under the standards set by Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(c) (or is deemed obligated to restore under

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-1


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(g) and 1.704-2(i)(5)) and (b) decreased by (i) the amount of all losses and deductions that, as of the end of such taxable period, are reasonably expected to be allocated to such Partner in subsequent taxable periods under Sections 704(e)(2) and 706(d) of the Code and Treasury Regulation Section 1.751-1(b)(2)(ii), and (ii) the amount of all distributions that, as of the end of such taxable period, are reasonably expected to be made to such Partner in subsequent taxable periods in accordance with the terms of this Agreement or otherwise to the extent they exceed offsetting increases to such Partner’s Capital Account that are reasonably expected to occur during (or prior to) the taxable period in which such distributions are reasonably expected to be made (other than increases as a result of a minimum gain chargeback pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(i) or 6.1(d)(ii)). The foregoing definition of Adjusted Capital Account is intended to comply with the provisions of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d) and shall be interpreted consistently therewith. The “Adjusted Capital Account” of a Partner in respect of any Partnership Interest shall be the amount that such Adjusted Capital Account would be if such Partnership Interest were the only interest in the Partnership held by such Partner from and after the date on which such Partnership Interest was first issued.

Adjusted Operating Surplus” means, with respect to any period, (a) Operating Surplus generated with respect to such period; (b) less (i) the amount of any net increase in Working Capital Borrowings (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of any net increase in Working Capital Borrowings in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) with respect to that period; and (ii) the amount of any net decrease in cash reserves (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of any net decrease in cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for Operating Expenditures with respect to such period not relating to an Operating Expenditure made with respect to such period; and (c) plus (i) the amount of any net decrease in Working Capital Borrowings (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of any net decrease in Working Capital Borrowings in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) with respect to that period; (ii) the amount of any net increase in cash reserves (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of any net increase in cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for Operating Expenditures with respect to such period required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium; and (iii) the amount of any net decrease made in subsequent periods in cash reserves for Operating Expenditures initially established with respect to such period to the extent such decrease results in a reduction in Adjusted Operating Surplus in subsequent periods pursuant to clause (b)(ii). Adjusted Operating Surplus does not include that portion of Operating Surplus included in clause (a)(i) of the definition of Operating Surplus.

Adjusted Property” means any property the Carrying Value of which has been adjusted pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

Affiliate” means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used herein, the term “control” means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units” is defined in Section 5.11(a).

Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments” means, as of the end of any taxable period, the sum of the Remaining Net Positive Adjustments of all the Partners.

Agreed Allocation” means any allocation, other than a Required Allocation, of an item of income, gain, loss or deduction pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.1, including a Curative Allocation (if appropriate to the context in which the term “Agreed Allocation” is used).

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-2


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Agreed Value” of any Contributed Property means the fair market value of such property at the time of contribution and in the case of an Adjusted Property, the fair market value of such Adjusted Property on the date of the revaluation event as described in Section 5.5(d), in both cases as determined by the General Partner.

Agreement” means this First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Hi-Crush Partners LP, as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

Associate” means, when used to indicate a relationship with any Person, (a) any corporation or organization of which such Person is a director, officer, manager, general partner or managing member or is, directly or indirectly, the owner of 20% or more of any class of voting stock or other voting interest; (b) any trust or other estate in which such Person has at least a 20% beneficial interest or as to which such Person serves as trustee or in a similar fiduciary capacity; and (c) any relative or spouse of such Person, or any relative of such spouse, who has the same principal residence as such Person.

Board of Directors” means the board of directors of the General Partner.

Book Basis Derivative Items” means any item of income, deduction, gain or loss that is computed with reference to the Carrying Value of an Adjusted Property (e.g., depreciation, depletion, or gain or loss with respect to an Adjusted Property).

Book-Down Event” means an event that triggers a negative adjustment to the Capital Accounts of the Partners pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

Book-Tax Disparity” means with respect to any item of Contributed Property or Adjusted Property, as of the date of any determination, the difference between the Carrying Value of such Contributed Property or Adjusted Property and the adjusted basis thereof for U.S. federal income tax purposes as of such date. A Partner’s share of the Partnership’s Book-Tax Disparities in all of its Contributed Property and Adjusted Property will be reflected by the difference between such Partner’s Capital Account balance as maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 and the hypothetical balance of such Partner’s Capital Account computed as if it had been maintained strictly in accordance with U.S. federal income tax accounting principles.

Book-Up Event” means an event that triggers a positive adjustment to the Capital Accounts of the Partners pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

Business Day” means Monday through Friday of each week, except that a legal holiday recognized as such by the government of the United States of America or the State of Texas shall not be regarded as a Business Day.

Capital Account” means the capital account maintained for a Partner pursuant to Section 5.5. The “Capital Account” of a Partner in respect of any Partnership Interest shall be the amount that such Capital Account would be if such Partnership Interest were the only interest in the Partnership held by such Partner from and after the date on which such Partnership Interest was first issued.

Capital Contribution” means any cash, cash equivalents or the Net Agreed Value of Contributed Property that a Partner contributes to the Partnership or that is contributed or deemed contributed to the Partnership on behalf of a Partner (including, in the case of an underwritten offering of Units, the amount of any underwriting discounts or commissions).

Capital Improvement” means any (a) addition or improvement to the capital assets owned by any Group Member, (b) acquisition (through an asset acquisition, merger, stock acquisition or other form of investment) of existing, or the construction of new, capital assets by any Group Member, or (c) capital contribution by a Group

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-3


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Member to a Person that is not a Subsidiary, in which a Group Member has, or after such capital contribution will have, an equity interest to fund the Group Member’s pro rata share of the cost of the acquisition of existing, or the construction of new or the improvement of existing, capital assets, in each case if such addition, improvement, acquisition or construction is made to increase the long-term operating capacity of the Partnership Group from the long-term operating capacity of the Partnership Group, in the case of clauses (a) and (b), or such Person, in the case of clause (c), from that existing immediately prior to such addition, improvement, acquisition or construction.

Capital Surplus” means cash and cash equivalents distributed by the Partnership in excess of Operating Surplus, as described in Section 6.3(b).

Carrying Value” means (a) with respect to a Contributed Property or an Adjusted Property, the Agreed Value of such property reduced (but not below zero) by all depreciation, amortization and cost recovery deductions charged to the Partners’ Capital Accounts in respect of such property, and (b) with respect to any other Partnership property, the adjusted basis of such property for U.S. federal income tax purposes, all as of the time of determination. The Carrying Value of any property shall be adjusted from time to time in accordance with Section 5.5(d) and to reflect changes, additions or other adjustments to the Carrying Value for dispositions and acquisitions of Partnership properties, as deemed appropriate by the General Partner.

Cause” means a court of competent jurisdiction has entered a final, non-appealable judgment finding the General Partner is liable to the Partnership or any Limited Partner for actual fraud or willful misconduct in its capacity as a general partner of the Partnership.

Certificate” means a certificate in such form (including in global form if permitted by applicable rules and regulations) as may be adopted by the General Partner, issued by the Partnership evidencing ownership of one or more Partnership Interests. The initial form of certificate approved by the General Partner for Common Units is attached as Exhibit A to this Agreement.

Certificate of Limited Partnership” means the Certificate of Limited Partnership of the Partnership filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as referenced in Section 7.3, as such Certificate of Limited Partnership may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

Citizenship Eligibility Trigger” is defined in Section 4.8(a)(ii).

claim” (as used in Section 7.12(c)) is defined in Section 7.12(c).

Closing Date” means the first date on which Common Units are issued and delivered by the Partnership to the Underwriters pursuant to the provisions of the Underwriting Agreement.

Closing Price” means, in respect of any class of Limited Partner Interests, as of the date of determination, the last sale price on such day, regular way, or in case no such sale takes place on such day, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on such day, regular way, in either case as reported in the principal consolidated transaction reporting system with respect to securities listed or admitted to trading on the principal National Securities Exchange on which such Limited Partner Interests are listed or admitted to trading or, if such Limited Partner Interests are not listed or admitted to trading on any National Securities Exchange, the last quoted price on such day or, if not so quoted, the average of the high bid and low asked prices on such day in the over-the-counter market, as reported by the primary reporting system then in use in relation to such Limited Partner Interests of such class, or, if on any such day such Limited Partner Interests of such class are not quoted by any such organization, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on such day as furnished by a professional market maker making a market in such Limited Partner Interests of such class selected by the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-4


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

General Partner, or if on any such day no market maker is making a market in such Limited Partner Interests of such class, the fair value of such Limited Partner Interests on such day as determined by the General Partner.

Code” means the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended and in effect from time to time. Any reference herein to a specific section or sections of the Code shall be deemed to include a reference to any corresponding provision of any successor law.

Combined Interest” is defined in Section 11.3(a).

Commences Commercial Service” means the date a Capital Improvement or replacement capital asset, as applicable, is first put into commercial service by a Group Member following, if applicable, completion of construction, acquisition, development and testing, as applicable.

Commission” means the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.

Common Unit” means a Partnership Interest having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Common Units in this Agreement. The term “Common Unit” does not refer to or include any Subordinated Unit prior to its conversion into a Common Unit pursuant to the terms hereof.

Common Unit Arrearage” means, with respect to any Common Unit, whenever issued, with respect to any Quarter wholly within the Subordination Period, the excess, if any, of (a) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution with respect to a Common Unit in respect of such Quarter over (b) the sum of all cash and cash equivalents distributed with respect to a Common Unit in respect of such Quarter pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(i).

Conflicts Committee” means a committee of the Board of Directors composed entirely of one or more directors, each of whom (a) is not an officer or employee of the General Partner (b) is not an officer or employee of any Affiliate of the General Partner or a director of any Affiliate of the General Partner (other than any Group Member), (c) is not a holder of any ownership interest in the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, including any Group Member, other than Common Units and awards that are granted to such director under the LTIP and (d) is determined by the Board of Directors of the General Partner to be independent under the independence standards for directors who serve on an audit committee of a board of directors established by the Securities Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder and by the National Securities Exchange on which any class of Partnership Interests is listed or admitted to trading.

Contributed Property” means each property, in such form as may be permitted by the Delaware Act, but excluding cash, contributed to the Partnership. Once the Carrying Value of a Contributed Property is adjusted pursuant to Section 5.5(d), such property shall no longer constitute a Contributed Property, but shall be deemed an Adjusted Property.

Contribution Agreement” means that certain Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement, dated as of             , 2012, among the General Partner, the Partnership, Hi-Crush Proppants and certain other parties, together with the additional conveyance documents and instruments contemplated or referenced thereunder, as such may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage” means, with respect to any Common Unit, whenever issued, and as of the end of any Quarter, the excess, if any, of (a) the sum of the Common Unit Arrearages with respect to an Initial Common Unit for each of the Quarters wholly within the Subordination Period ending on or before the last day of such Quarter over (b) the sum of any distributions theretofore made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(ii) and Section 6.5(b) with respect to an Initial Common Unit (including any distributions to be made in respect of the last of such Quarters).

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-5


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Curative Allocation” means any allocation of an item of income, gain, deduction, loss or credit pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.1(d)(xi).

Current Market Price” means, in respect of any class of Limited Partner Interests, as of the date of determination, the average of the daily Closing Prices per Limited Partner Interest of such class for the 20 consecutive Trading Days immediately prior to such date.

Delaware Act” means the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act, 6 Del C. Section 17-101, et seq., as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time, and any successor to such statute.

Departing General Partner” means a former General Partner from and after the effective date of any withdrawal or removal of such former General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2.

Derivative Instruments” means options, right, warrants, appreciation rights, tracking, profit and phantom interests and other derivative instruments relating to, convertible into or exchangeable for Partnership Interests.

Disposed of Adjusted Property” is defined in Section 6.1(d)(xii)(B).

Economic Risk of Loss” has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-2(a).

Eligibility Certificate” is defined in Section 4.8(b).

Eligible Holder” means a Limited Partner whose (a) U.S. federal income tax status would not, in the determination of the General Partner, have the material adverse effect described in Section 4.8(a)(i) or (b) nationality, citizenship or other related status would not, in the determination of the General Partner, create a substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture as described in Section 4.8(a)(ii).

Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount” is defined in Section 6.9.

Estimated Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures” means an estimate made in good faith by the Board of Directors (with the concurrence of the Conflicts Committee) of the average quarterly Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures that the Partnership will need to incur over the long term to maintain the operating capacity of the Partnership Group (including the Partnership’s proportionate share of the average quarterly Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures of its Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) existing at the time the estimate is made. The Board of Directors (with the concurrence of the Conflicts Committee) will be permitted to make such estimate in any manner it determines reasonable. The estimate will be made at least annually and whenever an event occurs that is likely to result in a material adjustment to the amount of future Estimated Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures. The Partnership shall disclose to its Partners any change in the amount of Estimated Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures in its reports made in accordance with Section 8.3 to the extent not previously disclosed. Any adjustments to Estimated Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures shall be prospective only.

Event of Withdrawal” is defined in Section 11.1(a).

Excess Additional Book Basis” is defined in the definition of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items.

Excess Distribution” is defined in Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A).

Excess Distribution Unit” is defined in Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A).

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-6


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Expansion Capital Expenditures” means cash expenditures for Capital Improvements, and shall not include Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures or Investment Capital Expenditures. Expansion Capital Expenditures shall include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement and paid in respect of the period beginning on the date that a Group Member enters into a binding obligation to commence construction of a Capital Improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such Capital Improvement Commences Commercial Service and the date that such Capital Improvement is abandoned or disposed of. Debt incurred to fund such construction period interest payments or to fund distributions in respect of equity issued (including incremental Incentive Distributions related thereto) to fund the construction of a Capital Improvement as described in clause (a)(iv) of the definition of Operating Surplus shall also be deemed to be debt incurred to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement. Where capital expenditures are made in part for Expansion Capital Expenditures and in part for other purposes, the General Partner shall determine the allocation between the amounts paid for each.

Final Subordinated Units” is defined in Section 6.1(d)(x)(A).

First Liquidation Target Amount” is defined in Section 6.1(c)(i)(D).

First Target Distribution” means $         per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period, and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 5.11, Section 6.6 and Section 6.9.

Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis” means, when calculating the number of Outstanding Units for any period, a basis that includes (1) the weighted average number of Units Outstanding during such period plus (2) all Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments (a) that are convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for Units or for which Units are issuable, each case that are senior to or pari passu with the Subordinated Units, (b) whose conversion, exercise or exchange price is less than the Current Market Price on the date of such calculation, (c) that may be converted into or exercised or exchanged for such Units prior to or during the Quarter immediately following the end of the period for which the calculation is being made without the satisfaction of any contingency beyond the control of the holder other than the payment of consideration and the compliance with administrative mechanics applicable to such conversion, exercise or exchange and (d) that were not converted into or exercised or exchanged for such Units during the period for which the calculation is being made; provided, however, that for purposes of determining the number of Outstanding Units on a Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis when calculating whether the Subordination Period has ended or the Subordinated Units are entitled to convert into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7, such Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments shall be deemed to have been Outstanding Units only for the four Quarters that comprise the last four Quarters of the measurement period; provided, further, that if consideration will be paid to any Group Member in connection with such conversion, exercise or exchange, the number of Units to be included in such calculation shall be that number equal to the difference between (i) the number of Units issuable upon such conversion, exercise or exchange and (ii) the number of Units that such consideration would purchase at the Current Market Price.

General Partner” means Hi-Crush GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, and its successors and permitted assigns that are admitted to the Partnership as general partner of the Partnership, in their capacities as general partner of the Partnership (except as the context otherwise requires).

General Partner Interest” means the management and ownership interest of the General Partner in the Partnership (in its capacity as a general partner and without reference to any Limited Partner Interest held by it) and includes any and all rights, powers and benefits to which the General Partner is entitled as provided in this Agreement, together with all obligations of the General Partner to comply with the terms and provisions of this

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-7


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Agreement. The General Partner Interest does not include any rights to profits or losses or any rights to receive distributions from operations or upon the liquidation or winding-up of the Partnership.

Gross Liability Value” means, with respect to any Liability of the Partnership described in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-7(b)(3)(i), the amount of cash that a willing assignor would pay to a willing assignee to assume such Liability in an arm’s-length transaction.

Group” means two or more Persons that with or through any of their respective Affiliates or Associates have any contract, arrangement, understanding or relationship for the purpose of acquiring, holding, voting (except voting pursuant to a revocable proxy or consent given to such Person in response to a proxy or consent solicitation made to 10 or more Persons), exercising investment power or disposing of any Partnership Interests with any other Person that beneficially owns, or whose Affiliates or Associates beneficially own, directly or indirectly, Partnership Interests.

Group Member” means a member of the Partnership Group.

Group Member Agreement” means the partnership agreement of any Group Member, other than the Partnership, that is a limited or general partnership, the limited liability company agreement of any Group Member that is a limited liability company, the certificate of incorporation and bylaws or similar organizational documents of any Group Member that is a corporation, the joint venture agreement or similar governing document of any Group Member that is a joint venture and the governing or organizational or similar documents of any other Group Member that is a Person other than a limited or general partnership, limited liability company, corporation or joint venture, as such may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

Hedge Contract” means any exchange, swap, forward, cap, floor, collar, option or other similar agreement or arrangement entered into for the purpose of reducing the exposure of the Partnership Group to fluctuations in the price of hydrocarbons, interest rates, basis differentials or currency exchange rates in their operations or financing activities, in each case, other than for speculative purposes.

Hi-Crush Proppants” means Hi-Crush Proppants LLC, a Delaware limited liability company.

Holder” as used in Section 7.12, is defined in Section 7.12(a).

IDR Reset Common Unit” is defined in Section 5.11(a).

IDR Reset Election” is defined in Section 5.11(a).

Incentive Distribution Right” means a Limited Partner Interest having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Incentive Distribution Rights in this Agreement.

Incentive Distributions” means any amount of cash distributed to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights pursuant to Section 6.4.

Incremental Income Taxes” is defined in Section 6.9.

Indemnified Persons” is defined in Section 7.12(c).

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-8


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Indemnitee” means (a) any General Partner, (b) any Departing General Partner, (c) any Person who is or was an Affiliate of the General Partner or any Departing General Partner, (d) any Person who is or was a manager, managing member, general partner, director, officer, employee, agent, fiduciary or trustee of any Group Member, a General Partner, any Departing General Partner or any of their respective Affiliates, (e) any Person who is or was serving at the request of a General Partner, any Departing General Partner or any of their respective Affiliates as an officer, director, manager, managing member, general partner, employee, agent, fiduciary or trustee of another Person owing a fiduciary or similar duty to any Group Member; provided that a Person shall not be an Indemnitee by reason of providing, on a fee-for-services basis, trustee, fiduciary or custodial services, (f) any Person who controls a General Partner or Departing General Partner and (g) any Person the General Partner designates as an “Indemnitee” for purposes of this Agreement because such Person’s service, status or relationship exposes such Person to potential claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings relating to the Partnership Group’s business and affairs.

Ineligible Holder” is defined in Section 4.8(c).

Initial Common Units” means the Common Units sold in the Initial Offering.

Initial Limited Partners” means the Organizational Limited Partner (with respect to the Common Units, Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights received by it as described in Section 5.2) and the Underwriters, in each case upon being admitted to the Partnership in accordance with Section 10.1.

Initial Offering” means the initial offering and sale of Common Units to the public, as described in the Registration Statement, including any offer and sale of Common Units pursuant to the exercise of the Over-Allotment Option.

Initial Unit Price” means (a) with respect to the Common Units and the Subordinated Units, the initial public offering price per Common Unit at which the Underwriters first offered the Common Units to the public for sale as set forth on the cover page of the prospectus included as part of the Registration Statement and first issued at or after the time the Registration Statement first became effective or (b) with respect to any other class or series of Units, the price per Unit at which such class or series of Units is initially sold by the Partnership, as determined by the General Partner, in each case adjusted as the General Partner determines to be appropriate to give effect to any distribution, subdivision or combination of Units.

Interim Capital Transactions” means the following transactions if they occur prior to the Liquidation Date: (a) borrowings, refinancings or refundings of indebtedness (other than Working Capital Borrowings and other than for items purchased on open account or for a deferred purchase price in the ordinary course of business) by any Group Member and sales of debt securities of any Group Member; (b) sales of equity interests of any Group Member (including the Common Units sold to the Underwriters pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement) and (c) sales or other voluntary or involuntary dispositions of any assets of any Group Member other than (i) sales or other dispositions of inventory, accounts receivable and other assets in the ordinary course of business, and (ii) sales or other dispositions of assets as part of normal retirements or replacements.

Investment Capital Expenditures” means capital expenditures other than Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures and Expansion Capital Expenditures.

Liability” means any liability or obligation of any nature, whether accrued, contingent or otherwise.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-9


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Limited Partner” means, unless the context otherwise requires, each Initial Limited Partner, each additional Person that becomes a Limited Partner pursuant to the terms of this Agreement and any Departing General Partner upon the change of its status from General Partner to Limited Partner pursuant to Section 11.3, in each case, in such Person’s capacity as a limited partner of the Partnership.

Limited Partner Interest” means the ownership interest of a Limited Partner in the Partnership, which may be evidenced by Common Units, Subordinated Units, Incentive Distribution Rights or other Partnership Interests or a combination thereof or interest therein, and includes any and all benefits to which such Limited Partner is entitled as provided in this Agreement, together with all obligations of such Limited Partner to comply with the terms and provisions of this Agreement.

Liquidation Date” means (a) in the case of an event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership of the type described in clauses (a) and (b) of the first sentence of Section 12.2, the date on which the applicable time period during which the holders of Outstanding Units have the right to elect to continue the business of the Partnership has expired without such an election being made, and (b) in the case of any other event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership, the date on which such event occurs.

Liquidator” means one or more Persons selected by the General Partner to perform the functions described in Section 12.4 as liquidating trustee of the Partnership within the meaning of the Delaware Act.

LTIP” means the Long-Term Incentive Plan of the General Partner, as may be amended, or any equity compensation plan successor thereto.

Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures” means cash expenditures (including expenditures for the addition or improvement to or replacement of the capital assets owned by any Group Member or for the acquisition of existing, or the construction or development of new, capital assets) if such expenditures are made to maintain the long-term operating capacity of the Partnership Group. Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures shall include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions in respect of equity issued, in each case, to finance the construction or development of a replacement capital asset and paid in respect of the period beginning on the date that a Group Member enters into a binding obligation to commence constructing or developing a replacement capital asset and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such replacement capital asset Commences Commercial Service and the date that such replacement capital asset is abandoned or disposed of. Debt incurred to pay or equity issued to fund construction or development period interest payments, or such construction or development period distributions in respect of equity, shall also be deemed to be debt or equity, as the case may be, incurred to finance the construction or development of a replacement capital asset and the incremental Incentive Distributions paid relating to newly issued equity shall be deemed to be distributions paid on equity issued to finance the construction or development of a replacement capital asset.

Merger Agreement” is defined in Section 14.1.

Minimum Quarterly Distribution” means $         per Unit per Quarter (or with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 5.11, Section 6.6 and Section 6.9.

National Securities Exchange” means an exchange registered with the Commission under Section 6(a) of the Securities Exchange Act (or any successor to such Section) and any other securities exchange (whether or not registered with the Commission under Section 6(a) (or successor to such Section) of the Securities Exchange Act) that the General Partner shall designate as a National Securities Exchange for purposes of this Agreement.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-10


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Net Agreed Value” means, (a) in the case of any Contributed Property, the Agreed Value of such property reduced by any Liabilities either assumed by the Partnership upon such contribution or to which such property is subject when contributed and (b) in the case of any property distributed to a Partner by the Partnership, the Partnership’s Carrying Value of such property (as adjusted pursuant to Section 5.5(d)(ii)) at the time such property is distributed, reduced by any Liabilities either assumed by such Partner upon such distribution or to which such property is subject at the time of distribution.

Net Income” means, for any taxable period, the excess, if any, of the Partnership’s items of income and gain (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period over the Partnership’s items of loss and deduction (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period. The items included in the calculation of Net Income shall be determined in accordance with Section 5.5 but shall not include any items specially allocated under Section 6.1(d); provided, that the determination of the items that have been specially allocated under Section 6.1(d) shall be made without regard to any reversal of such items under Section 6.1(d)(xii).

Net Loss” means, for any taxable period, the excess, if any, of the Partnership’s items of loss and deduction (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period over the Partnership’s items of income and gain (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period. The items included in the calculation of Net Loss shall be determined in accordance with Section 5.5 but shall not include any items specially allocated under Section 6.1(d); provided, that the determination of the items that have been specially allocated under Section 6.1(d) shall be made without regard to any reversal of such items under Section 6.1(d)(xii).

Net Positive Adjustments” means, with respect to any Partner, the excess, if any, of the total positive adjustments over the total negative adjustments made to the Capital Account of such Partner pursuant to Book-Up Events and Book-Down Events.

Net Termination Gain” means, for any taxable period, the sum, if positive, of all items of income, gain, loss or deduction (determined in accordance with Section 5.5) that are (a) recognized (i) after the Liquidation Date or (ii) upon the sale, exchange or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group, taken as a whole, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions (excluding any disposition to a member of the Partnership Group), or (b) deemed recognized by the Partnership pursuant to Section 5.5(d); provided, however, the items included in the determination of Net Termination Gain shall not include any items of income, gain or loss specially allocated under Section 6.1(d).

Net Termination Loss” means, for any taxable period, the sum, if negative, of all items of income, gain, loss or deduction (determined in accordance with Section 5.5) that are (a) recognized (i) after the Liquidation Date or (ii) upon the sale, exchange or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group, taken as a whole, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions (excluding any disposition to a member of the Partnership Group), or (b) deemed recognized by the Partnership pursuant to Section 5.5(d); provided, however, items included in the determination of Net Termination Loss shall not include any items of income, gain or loss specially allocated under Section 6.1(d).

Nonrecourse Built-in Gain” means with respect to any Contributed Properties or Adjusted Properties that are subject to a mortgage or pledge securing a Nonrecourse Liability, the amount of any taxable gain that would be allocated to the Partners pursuant to Section 6.2(b) if such properties were disposed of in a taxable transaction in full satisfaction of such liabilities and for no other consideration.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-11


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Nonrecourse Deductions” means any and all items of loss, deduction or expenditure (including any expenditure described in Section 705(a)(2)(B) of the Code) that, in accordance with the principles of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(b), are attributable to a Nonrecourse Liability.

Nonrecourse Liability” has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-1(a)(2).

Notice of Election to Purchase” is defined in Section 15.1(b).

Operating Expenditures” means all Partnership Group cash expenditures (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of expenditures in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned), including taxes, reimbursements of expenses of the General Partner and its Affiliates, payments made in the ordinary course of business under any Hedge Contracts, officer compensation, repayment of Working Capital Borrowings, debt service payments and Estimated Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures, subject to the following:

(a) repayments of Working Capital Borrowings deducted from Operating Surplus pursuant to clause (b)(iii) of the definition of “Operating Surplus” shall not constitute Operating Expenditures when actually repaid;

(b) payments (including prepayments and prepayment penalties) of principal of and premium on indebtedness other than Working Capital Borrowings shall not constitute Operating Expenditures;

(c) Operating Expenditures shall not include (i) Expansion Capital Expenditures, (ii) actual Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures, (iii) Investment Capital Expenditures, (iv) payment of transaction expenses (including taxes) relating to Interim Capital Transactions, (v) distributions to Partners, or (vi) repurchases of Partnership Interests, other than repurchases of Partnership Interests to satisfy obligations under employee benefit plans, or reimbursements of expenses of the General Partner for such purchases. Where capital expenditures are made in part for Maintenance and Replacement Capital Expenditures and in part for other purposes, the General Partner shall determine the allocation between the amounts paid for each; and

(d) (i) payments made in connection with the initial purchase of any Hedge Contract shall be amortized over the life of such Hedge Contract and (ii) payments made in connection with the termination of any Hedge Contract prior to its stipulated settlement or termination date shall be included in equal quarterly installments over what would have been the remaining scheduled term of such Hedge Contract had it not been so terminated.

Operating Surplus” means, with respect to any period ending prior to the Liquidation Date, on a cumulative basis and without duplication,

(a) the sum of (i)         $         million, (ii) all cash receipts of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash receipts in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of such period, but excluding cash receipts from Interim Capital Transactions and provided that cash receipts from the termination of any Hedge Contract prior to its stipulated settlement or termination date shall be included in equal quarterly installments over what would have been the remaining scheduled life of such Hedge Contract had it not been so terminated, (iii) all cash receipts of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash receipts in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) after the end of such period but on or before the date of determination of Operating Surplus with respect to such period resulting from Working Capital Borrowings, (iv) the amount of cash distributions paid (including incremental Incentive Distributions) in respect of equity issued to finance all or a portion of the construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement or replacement capital asset and paid in respect of the period beginning on the date that the Group Member enters into a binding obligation to commence the construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement or replacement capital asset and ending on the earlier to occur of the date the Capital Improvement or replacement capital asset Commences Commercial Service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of (equity issued to fund the construction period interest payments on debt incurred, or construction period distributions on equity issued, to finance the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-12


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement or replacement capital asset shall also be deemed to be equity issued to finance the construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement or replacement capital asset for purposes of this clause (iv)) and (v) an amount of cash equal to $[            ] (which is the amount of cash to be indirectly contributed to the Partnership in accordance with the Contribution Agreement equal to the amount of deferred revenue that would have been reflected on its balance sheet on the Closing Date under GAAP), which shall be included in Operating Surplus for the Quarters ending September 30, 2012 and December 31, 2012 in amounts calculated, for each Quarter, by multiplying $             by a fraction, (x) the numerator of which is the number of days in such Quarter and (y) the denominator of which is the aggregate number of days in the Quarters ending September 30, 2012 and December 31, 2012, less

(b) the sum of (i) Operating Expenditures for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of such period; (ii) the amount of cash reserves established by the General Partner (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) to provide funds for future Operating Expenditures; (iii) all Working Capital Borrowings not repaid within twelve (12) months after having been incurred and (iv) any cash loss realized on disposition of an Investment Capital Expenditure;

provided, however, that the General Partner’s estimates of disbursements made (including contributions to a Group Member or disbursements on behalf of a Group Member), cash received or cash reserves established, increased or reduced after the end of such period but on or before the date on which cash or cash equivalents will be distributed with respect to such period shall be deemed to have been made, received, established, increased or reduced, for purposes of determining Operating Surplus, within such period if the General Partner so determines.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, “Operating Surplus” with respect to the Quarter in which the Liquidation Date occurs and any subsequent Quarter shall equal zero. Cash receipts from an Investment Capital Expenditure shall be treated as cash receipts only to the extent they are a return on principal, but in no event shall a return of principal be treated as cash receipts.

Opinion of Counsel” means a written opinion of counsel (who may be regular counsel to the Partnership or the General Partner or any of its Affiliates) acceptable to the General Partner.

Option Closing Date” means the date or dates on which any Common Units are sold by Hi-Crush Proppants to the Underwriters upon exercise of the Over-Allotment Option.

Organizational Limited Partner” means Hi-Crush Proppants, in its capacity as the organizational limited partner of the Partnership pursuant to this Agreement.

Outstanding” means, with respect to Partnership Interests, all Partnership Interests that are issued by the Partnership and reflected as outstanding on the Partnership’s books and records as of the date of determination; provided, however, that if at any time any Person or Group (other than the General Partner or its Affiliates) beneficially owns 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of any class then Outstanding, none of the Partnership Interests owned by such Person or Group shall be entitled to be voted on any matter or be considered to be Outstanding when sending notices of a meeting of Limited Partners to vote on any matter (unless otherwise required by law), calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes under this Agreement, except that Partnership Interests so owned shall be considered to be Outstanding for purposes of Section 11.1(b)(iv) (such Partnership Interests shall not, however, be treated as a separate class of Partnership Interests for purposes of this Agreement or the Delaware Act); provided, further, that the foregoing limitation shall not apply to (i) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of any class then Outstanding directly from the General Partner or its Affiliates (other than the Partnership), (ii) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of any class then Outstanding directly or indirectly from a Person or Group described in clause (i) provided that the General Partner shall have notified such Person or Group in writing that such limitation shall

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-13


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

not apply, or (iii) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of any Partnership Interests issued by the Partnership provided that the General Partner shall have notified such Person or Group in writing that such limitation shall not apply.

Over-Allotment Option” means the over-allotment option granted to the Underwriters by Hi-Crush Proppants pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement.

Partner Nonrecourse Debt” has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(b)(4).

Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain” has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i)(2).

Partner Nonrecourse Deductions” means any and all items of loss, deduction or expenditure (including any expenditure described in Section 705(a)(2)(B) of the Code) that, in accordance with the principles of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i), are attributable to a Partner Nonrecourse Debt.

Partners” means the General Partner and the Limited Partners.

Partnership” means Hi-Crush Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership.

Partnership Group” means, collectively, the Partnership and its Subsidiaries.

Partnership Interest” means any class or series of equity interest in the Partnership, which shall include any General Partner Interest and Limited Partner Interests but shall exclude any Derivative Instruments.

Partnership Minimum Gain” means that amount determined in accordance with the principles of Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(b)(2) and 1.704-2(d).

Percentage Interest” means as of any date of determination (a) as to any Unitholder with respect to Units, the quotient obtained by dividing (A) the number of Units held by such Unitholder by (B) the total number of Outstanding Units. The Percentage Interest with respect to an Incentive Distribution Right shall at all times be zero. The Percentage Interest with respect to the General Partner Interest shall at all times be zero.

Person” means an individual or a corporation, firm, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated organization, association, government agency or political subdivision thereof or other entity.

Per Unit Capital Amount” means, as of any date of determination, the Capital Account, stated on a per Unit basis, underlying any class of Units held by a Person other than the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner who holds Units.

Pro Rata” means (a) when used with respect to Units or any class thereof, apportioned equally among all designated Units in accordance with their relative Percentage Interests, (b) when used with respect to Partners or Record Holders, apportioned among all Partners or Record Holders in accordance with their relative Percentage Interests and (c) when used with respect to holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, apportioned equally among all holders of Incentive Distribution Rights in accordance with the relative number or percentage of Incentive Distribution Rights held by each such holder.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-14


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Purchase Date” means the date determined by the General Partner as the date for purchase of all Outstanding Limited Partner Interests of a certain class (other than Limited Partner Interests owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates) pursuant to Article XV.

Quarter” means, unless the context requires otherwise, a fiscal quarter of the Partnership, or, with respect to the fiscal quarter of the Partnership in which the Closing Date occurs, the portion of such fiscal quarter after the Closing Date.

Rate Eligibility Trigger” is defined in Section 4.8(a)(i).

Recapture Income” means any gain recognized by the Partnership (computed without regard to any adjustment required by Section 734 or Section 743 of the Code) upon the disposition of any property or asset of the Partnership, which gain is characterized as ordinary income because it represents the recapture of deductions previously taken with respect to such property or asset.

Record Date” means the date established by the General Partner or otherwise in accordance with this Agreement for determining (a) the identity of the Record Holders entitled to notice of, or to vote at, any meeting of Limited Partners or entitled to vote by ballot or give approval of Partnership action in writing without a meeting or entitled to exercise rights in respect of any lawful action of Limited Partners or (b) the identity of Record Holders entitled to receive any report or distribution or to participate in any offer.

Record Holder” means (a) with respect to any class of Partnership Interests for which a Transfer Agent has been appointed, the Person in whose name a Partnership Interest of such class is registered on the books of the Transfer Agent as of the closing of business on a particular Business Day, or (b) with respect to other classes of Partnership Interests, the Person in whose name any such other Partnership Interest is registered on the books that the General Partner has caused to be kept as of the closing of business on such Business Day.

Redeemable Interests” means any Partnership Interests for which a redemption notice has been given, and has not been withdrawn, pursuant to Section 4.9.

Registration Statement” means the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-182754) as it has been or as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, filed by the Partnership with the Commission under the Securities Act to register the offering and sale of the Common Units in the Initial Offering.

Remaining Net Positive Adjustments” means as of the end of any taxable period, (i) with respect to the Unitholders holding Common Units or Subordinated Units, the excess of (a) the Net Positive Adjustments of the Unitholders holding Common Units or Subordinated Units as of the end of such period over (b) the sum of those Partners’ Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items for each prior taxable period and (ii) with respect to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, the excess of (a) the Net Positive Adjustments of the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights as of the end of such period over (b) the sum of the Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items of the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights for each prior taxable period.

Required Allocations” means any allocation of an item of income, gain, loss or deduction pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(i), Section 6.1(d)(ii), Section 6.1(d)(iv), Section 6.1(d)(v), Section 6.1(d)(vi), Section 6.1(d)(vii) or Section 6.1(d)(ix).

Reset MQD” is defined in Section 5.11(a).

Reset Notice” is defined in Section 5.11(b).

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-15


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Second Liquidation Target Amount” is defined in Section 6.1(c)(i)(E).

Second Target Distribution” means $         per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period, and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 5.11, Section 6.6 and Section 6.9.

Securities Act” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time and any successor to such statute.

Securities Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time and any successor to such statute.

Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items” means in connection with any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items for any taxable period, (i) with respect to the Unitholders holding Common Units or Subordinated Units, the amount that bears the same ratio to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items as the Unitholders’ Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of the end of such taxable period bears to the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of that time and (ii) with respect to the Partners holding Incentive Distribution Rights, the amount that bears the same ratio to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items as the Remaining Net Positive Adjustments of the Partners holding the Incentive Distribution Rights as of the end of such period bears to the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of that time.

Special Approval” means approval by a majority of the members of the Conflicts Committee or, if the Conflicts Committee has only one member, the sole member of the Conflicts Committee.

Subordinated Unit” means a Partnership Interest having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Subordinated Units in this Agreement. The term “Subordinated Unit” does not refer to or include a Common Unit. A Subordinated Unit that is convertible into a Common Unit shall not constitute a Common Unit until such conversion occurs.

Subordination Period” means the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on the first to occur of the following dates:

(a) the first Business Day following the distribution pursuant to Section 6.3(a) in respect of any Quarter beginning with the Quarter ending [June] 30, 2015 in respect of which (i) (A) distributions from Operating Surplus on each of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case with respect to each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-Quarter periods immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded the sum of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case in respect of such periods and (B) the Adjusted Operating Surplus for each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-Quarter periods immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded the sum of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all of the Common Units, Subordinated Units and any other Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case that were Outstanding during such periods on a Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis, and (ii) there are no Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages;

(b) the first Business Day following the distribution pursuant to Section 6.3(a) in respect of any Quarter in respect of which (i) (A) distributions from Operating Surplus on each of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case with respect to the four-Quarter period immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded 150% of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all of the Outstanding Common Units and

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-16


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case in respect of such period, and (B) the Adjusted Operating Surplus for the four-Quarter period immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded 150% of the sum of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all of the Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case that were Outstanding during such period on a Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis and the corresponding Incentive Distributions and (ii) there are no Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages; and

(c) the first date on which there are no longer outstanding any Subordinated Units due to the conversion of Subordinated Units into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7 or otherwise.

Subsidiary” means, with respect to any Person, (a) a corporation of which more than 50% of the voting power of shares entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors or other governing body of such corporation is owned, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, by such Person, by one or more Subsidiaries of such Person or a combination thereof, (b) a partnership (whether general or limited) in which such Person or a Subsidiary of such Person is, at the date of determination, a general partner of such partnership, but only if such Person, directly or by one or more Subsidiaries of such Person, or a combination thereof, controls such partnership on the date of determination or (c) any other Person in which such Person, one or more Subsidiaries of such Person, or a combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, has (i) at least a majority ownership interest or (ii) the power to elect or direct the election of a majority of the directors or other governing body of such Person.

Surviving Business Entity” is defined in Section 14.2(b)(ii).

Target Distribution” means each of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution, the First Target Distribution, Second Target Distribution and Third Target Distribution.

Third Target Distribution” means $         per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period, and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 5.11, Section 6.6 and Section 6.9.

Trading Day” means, for the purpose of determining the Current Market Price of any class of Limited Partner Interests, a day on which the principal National Securities Exchange on which such class of Limited Partner Interests is listed or admitted to trading is open for the transaction of business or, if Limited Partner Interests of a class are not listed or admitted to trading on any National Securities Exchange, a day on which banking institutions in New York City generally are open.

transfer” is defined in Section 4.4(a).

Transfer Agent” means such bank, trust company or other Person (including the General Partner or one of its Affiliates) as may be appointed from time to time by the Partnership to act as registrar and transfer agent for any class of Partnership Interests; provided, that if no Transfer Agent is specifically designated for any class of Partnership Interests, the General Partner shall act in such capacity.

Underwriter” means each Person named as an underwriter in Schedule I to the Underwriting Agreement who purchases Common Units pursuant thereto.

Underwriting Agreement” means that certain Underwriting Agreement, dated as of         , 2012, among the Underwriters, the Partnership, the General Partner and the other parties thereto, providing for the purchase of Common Units from Hi-Crush Proppants by the Underwriters.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-17


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Unit” means a Partnership Interest that is designated as a “Unit” and shall include Common Units and Subordinated Units but shall not include (i) the General Partner Interest or (ii) Incentive Distribution Rights.

Unitholders” means the holders of Units.

Unit Majority” means (i) during the Subordination Period, at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates), voting as a class, and at least a majority of the Outstanding Subordinated Units, voting as a class, and (ii) after the end of the Subordination Period, at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units.

Unpaid MQD” is defined in Section 6.1(c)(i)(B).

Unrealized Gain” attributable to any item of Partnership property means, as of any date of determination, the excess, if any, of (a) the fair market value of such property as of such date (as determined under Section 5.5(d)) over (b) the Carrying Value of such property as of such date (prior to any adjustment to be made pursuant to Section 5.5(d) as of such date).

Unrealized Loss” attributable to any item of Partnership property means, as of any date of determination, the excess, if any, of (a) the Carrying Value of such property as of such date (prior to any adjustment to be made pursuant to Section 5.5(d) as of such date) over (b) the fair market value of such property as of such date (as determined under Section 5.5(d)).

Unrecovered Initial Unit Price” means at any time, with respect to a Unit, the Initial Unit Price less the sum of all distributions constituting Capital Surplus theretofore made in respect of an Initial Common Unit and any distributions of cash (or the Net Agreed Value of any distributions in kind) in connection with the dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership theretofore made in respect of an Initial Common Unit, adjusted as the General Partner determines to be appropriate to give effect to any distribution, subdivision, or combination of such Units.

Unrestricted Person” means (a) each Indemnitee, (b) each Partner, (c) each Person who is or was a member, partner, director, officer, employee or agent of any Group Member, a General Partner or any Departing General Partner or any Affiliate of any Group Member, a General Partner or any Departing General Partner and (d) any Person the General Partner designates as an “Unrestricted Person” for purposes of this Agreement.

U.S. GAAP” means United States generally accepted accounting principles, as in effect from time to time, consistently applied.

Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel” is defined in Section 11.1(b).

Working Capital Borrowings” means borrowings used solely for working capital purposes or to pay distributions to Partners, made pursuant to a credit facility, commercial paper facility or other similar financing arrangement; provided that when incurred it is the intent of the borrower to repay such borrowings within 12 months from sources other than additional Working Capital Borrowings.

Section 1.2  Construction.

Unless the context requires otherwise: (a) any pronoun used in this Agreement shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine or neuter forms; (b) references to Articles and Sections refer to Articles and Sections of this Agreement; (c) the terms “include”, “includes”, “including” and words of like import shall be deemed to be followed by the words “without limitation”; and (d) the terms “hereof”, “herein” and “hereunder” refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement. The table of contents and headings contained in this Agreement are for reference purposes only, and shall not affect in any way the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-18


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

ARTICLE II

ORGANIZATION

Section 2.1  Formation.

The General Partner and the Organizational Limited Partner have previously formed the Partnership as a limited partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Delaware Act. This amendment and restatement shall become effective on the date of this Agreement. Except as expressly provided to the contrary in this Agreement, the rights, duties (including fiduciary duties), liabilities and obligations of the Partners and the administration, dissolution and termination of the Partnership shall be governed by the Delaware Act.

Section 2.2  Name.

The name of the Partnership shall be “Hi-Crush Partners LP.” The Partnership’s business may be conducted under any other name or names as determined by the General Partner, including the name of the General Partner. The words “Limited Partnership,” “LP,” “Ltd.” or similar words or letters shall be included in the Partnership’s name where necessary for the purpose of complying with the laws of any jurisdiction that so requires. The General Partner may change the name of the Partnership at any time and from time to time and shall notify the Limited Partners of such change in the next regular communication to the Limited Partners.

Section 2.3  Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices.

Unless and until changed by the General Partner, the registered office of the Partnership in the State of Delaware shall be located at Corporation Trust Center, 1209 Orange Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, and the registered agent for service of process on the Partnership in the State of Delaware at such registered office shall be The Corporation Trust Company. The principal office of the Partnership shall be located at Three Riverway, Suite 1550, Houston, TX 77056, or such other place as the General Partner may from time to time designate by notice to the Limited Partners. The Partnership may maintain offices at such other place or places within or outside the State of Delaware as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate. The address of the General Partner shall be Three Riverway, Suite 1550, Houston, TX 77056, or such other place as the General Partner may from time to time designate by notice to the Limited Partners.

Section 2.4  Purpose and Business.

The purpose and nature of the business to be conducted by the Partnership shall be to (a) engage directly in, or enter into or form, hold and dispose of any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other arrangement to engage indirectly in, any business activity that is approved by the General Partner, in its sole discretion, and that lawfully may be conducted by a limited partnership organized pursuant to the Delaware Act and, in connection therewith, to exercise all of the rights and powers conferred upon the Partnership pursuant to the agreements relating to such business activity, and (b) do anything necessary or appropriate to the foregoing, including the making of capital contributions or loans to a Group Member; provided, however, that the General Partner shall not cause the Partnership to engage, directly or indirectly, in any business activity that the General Partner determines would be reasonably likely to cause the Partnership to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes. To the fullest extent permitted by law, the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to propose or approve, and may, in its sole discretion, decline to propose or approve, the conduct by the Partnership of any business.

Section 2.5  Powers.

The Partnership shall be empowered to do any and all acts and things necessary, appropriate, proper, advisable, incidental to or convenient for the furtherance and accomplishment of the purposes and business described in Section 2.4 and for the protection and benefit of the Partnership.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-19


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 2.6  Term.

The term of the Partnership commenced upon the filing of the Certificate of Limited Partnership in accordance with the Delaware Act and shall continue in existence until the dissolution of the Partnership in accordance with the provisions of Article XII. The existence of the Partnership as a separate legal entity shall continue until the cancellation of the Certificate of Limited Partnership as provided in the Delaware Act.

Section 2.7  Title to Partnership Assets.

Title to Partnership assets, whether real, personal or mixed and whether tangible or intangible, shall be deemed to be owned by the Partnership as an entity, and no Partner, individually or collectively, shall have any ownership interest in such Partnership assets or any portion thereof. Title to any or all of the Partnership assets may be held in the name of the Partnership, the General Partner, one or more of its Affiliates or one or more nominees, as the General Partner may determine. The General Partner hereby declares and warrants that any Partnership assets for which record title is held in the name of the General Partner or one or more of its Affiliates or one or more nominees shall be held by the General Partner or such Affiliate or nominee for the use and benefit of the Partnership in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement; provided, however, that the General Partner shall use reasonable efforts to cause record title to such assets (other than those assets in respect of which the General Partner determines that the expense and difficulty of conveyancing makes transfer of record title to the Partnership impracticable) to be vested in the Partnership or one or more of the Partnership’s designated Affiliates as soon as reasonably practicable; provided, further, that, prior to the withdrawal or removal of the General Partner or as soon thereafter as practicable, the General Partner shall use reasonable efforts to effect the transfer of record title to the Partnership and, prior to any such transfer, will provide for the use of such assets in a manner satisfactory to the General Partner. All Partnership assets shall be recorded as the property of the Partnership in its books and records, irrespective of the name in which record title to such Partnership assets is held.

ARTICLE III

RIGHTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS

Section 3.1  Limitation of Liability.

The Limited Partners shall have no liability under this Agreement except as expressly provided in this Agreement or the Delaware Act.

Section 3.2  Management of Business.

No Limited Partner, in its capacity as such, shall participate in the operation, management or control (within the meaning of the Delaware Act) of the Partnership’s business, transact any business in the Partnership’s name or have the power to sign documents for or otherwise bind the Partnership. All actions taken by any Affiliate of the General Partner or any officer, director, employee, manager, member, general partner, agent or trustee of the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, or any officer, director, employee, manager, member, general partner, agent or trustee of a Group Member, in its capacity as such, shall not be deemed to be participating in the control of the business of the Partnership by a limited partner of the Partnership (within the meaning of Section 17-303(a) of the Delaware Act) and shall not affect, impair or eliminate the limitations on the liability of the Limited Partners under this Agreement.

Section 3.3  Outside Activities of the Limited Partners.

Subject to the provisions of Section 7.6, which shall continue to be applicable to the Persons referred to therein, regardless of whether such Persons shall also be Limited Partners, each Limited Partner shall be entitled to and may have business interests and engage in business activities in addition to those relating to the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-20


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Partnership, including business interests and activities in direct competition with the Partnership Group. Neither the Partnership nor any of the other Partners shall have any rights by virtue of this Agreement in any business ventures of any Limited Partner.

Section 3.4  Rights of Limited Partners.

(a) Each Limited Partner shall have the right, for a purpose that is reasonably related, as determined by the General Partner, to such Limited Partner’s interest as a Limited Partner in the Partnership, upon reasonable written demand stating the purpose of such demand and at such Limited Partner’s own expense, to obtain:

(i) true and full information regarding the status of the business and financial condition of the Partnership (provided that the requirements of this Section 3.4(a)(i) shall be satisfied to the extent the Limited Partner is furnished the Partnership’s most recent annual report and any subsequent quarterly or periodic reports required to be filed (or which would be required to be filed) with the Commission pursuant to Section 13 of the Exchange Act);

(ii) a current list of the name and last known business, residence or mailing address of each Record Holder; and

(iii) a copy of this Agreement and the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all amendments thereto, together with copies of the executed copies of all powers of attorney pursuant to which this Agreement, the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all amendments thereto have been executed.

(b) The rights to information granted the Limited Partners pursuant to Section 3.4(a) replace in their entirety any rights to information provided for in Section 17-305(a) of the Delaware Act and each of the Partners and each other Person or Group who acquires an interest in Partnership Interests hereby agrees to the fullest extent permitted by law that they do not have any rights as Partners to receive any information either pursuant to Sections 17-305(a) of the Delaware Act or otherwise except for the information identified in Section 3.4(a).

(c) The General Partner may keep confidential from the Limited Partners, for such period of time as the General Partner deems reasonable, (i) any information that the General Partner reasonably believes to be in the nature of trade secrets or (ii) other information the disclosure of which the General Partner believes (A) is not in the best interests of the Partnership Group, (B) could damage the Partnership Group or its business or (C) that any Group Member is required by law or by agreement with any third party to keep confidential (other than agreements with Affiliates of the Partnership the primary purpose of which is to circumvent the obligations set forth in this Section 3.4).

(d) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement or Section 17-305 of the Delaware Act, each of the Partners, each other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person bound by this Agreement hereby agrees to the fullest extent permitted by law that they do not have rights to receive information from the Partnership or any Indemnitee for the purpose of determining whether to pursue litigation or assist in pending litigation against the Partnership or any Indemnitee relating to the affairs of the Partnership except pursuant to the applicable rules of discovery relating to litigation commenced by such Person.

ARTICLE IV

CERTIFICATES; RECORD HOLDERS; TRANSFER OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS; REDEMPTION OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS

Section 4.1  Certificates.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, unless the General Partner shall determine otherwise in respect of some or all of any or all classes of Partnership Interests, Partnership Interests shall not be evidenced by certificates. Certificates that may be issued shall be executed on behalf of the Partnership by the Chairman of the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-21


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Board, Chief Executive Officer, President or any Executive Vice President or Vice President and the Chief Financial Officer or the Secretary or any Assistant Secretary of the General Partner. No Certificate for a class of Partnership Interests shall be valid for any purpose until it has been countersigned by the Transfer Agent for such class of Partnership Interests; provided, however, that if the General Partner elects to cause the Partnership to issue Partnership Interests of such class in global form, the Certificate shall be valid upon receipt of a certificate from the Transfer Agent certifying that the Partnership Interests have been duly registered in accordance with the directions of the Partnership. Subject to the requirements of Section 6.7(c), if Common Units are evidenced by Certificates, on or after the date on which Subordinated Units are converted into Common Units, the Record Holders of such Subordinated Units (i) if the Subordinated Units are evidenced by Certificates, may exchange such Certificates for Certificates evidencing Common Units or (ii) if the Subordinated Units are not evidenced by Certificates, shall be issued Certificates evidencing Common Units.

Section 4.2  Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates.

(a) If any mutilated Certificate is surrendered to the Transfer Agent, the appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute, and the Transfer Agent shall countersign and deliver in exchange therefor, a new Certificate evidencing the same number and type of Partnership Interests as the Certificate so surrendered.

(b) The appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute and deliver, and the Transfer Agent shall countersign, a new Certificate in place of any Certificate previously issued if the Record Holder of the Certificate:

(i) makes proof by affidavit, in form and substance satisfactory to the General Partner, that a previously issued Certificate has been lost, destroyed or stolen;

(ii) requests the issuance of a new Certificate before the General Partner has notice that the Certificate has been acquired by a purchaser for value in good faith and without notice of an adverse claim;

(iii) if requested by the General Partner, delivers to the General Partner a bond, in form and substance satisfactory to the General Partner, with surety or sureties and with fixed or open penalty as the General Partner may direct to indemnify the Partnership, the Partners, the General Partner and the Transfer Agent against any claim that may be made on account of the alleged loss, destruction or theft of the Certificate; and

(iv) satisfies any other reasonable requirements imposed by the General Partner or the Transfer Agent.

If a Limited Partner fails to notify the General Partner within a reasonable period of time after such Limited Partner has notice of the loss, destruction or theft of a Certificate, and a transfer of the Limited Partner Interests represented by the Certificate is registered before the Partnership, the General Partner or the Transfer Agent receives such notification, the Limited Partner shall be precluded from making any claim against the Partnership, the General Partner or the Transfer Agent for such transfer or for a new Certificate.

(c) As a condition to the issuance of any new Certificate under this Section 4.2, the General Partner may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other expenses (including the fees and expenses of the Transfer Agent) reasonably connected therewith.

Section 4.3  Record Holders.

The Partnership shall be entitled to recognize the Record Holder as the Partner with respect to any Partnership Interest and, accordingly, shall not be bound to recognize any equitable or other claim to, or interest in, such Partnership Interest on the part of any other Person, regardless of whether the Partnership shall have

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-22


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

actual or other notice thereof, except as otherwise provided by law or any applicable rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which such Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading. Without limiting the foregoing, when a Person (such as a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation or an agent of any of the foregoing) is acting as nominee, agent or in some other representative capacity for another Person in acquiring and/or holding Partnership Interests, as between the Partnership on the one hand, and such other Persons on the other, such representative Person shall be (a) the Record Holder of such Partnership Interest and (b) bound by this Agreement and shall have the rights and obligations of a Partner hereunder as, and to the extent, provided herein.

Section 4.4  Transfer Generally.

(a) The term “transfer,” when used in this Agreement with respect to a Partnership Interest, shall mean a transaction (i) by which the General Partner assigns its General Partner Interest to another Person, and includes a sale, assignment, gift, pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation, mortgage, exchange or any other disposition by law or otherwise or (ii) by which the holder of a Limited Partner Interest assigns such Limited Partner Interest to another Person who is or becomes a Limited Partner, and includes a sale, assignment, gift, exchange or any other disposition by law or otherwise, excluding a pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or mortgage but including any transfer upon foreclosure of any pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or mortgage.

(b) No Partnership Interest shall be transferred, in whole or in part, except in accordance with the terms and conditions set forth in this Article IV. Any transfer or purported transfer of a Partnership Interest not made in accordance with this Article IV shall be, to the fullest extent permitted by law, null and void.

(c) Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed to prevent a disposition by any stockholder, member, partner or other owner of any Partner of any or all of the shares of stock, membership interests, partnership interests or other ownership interests in such Partner and the term “transfer” shall not mean any such disposition.

Section 4.5  Registration and Transfer of Limited Partner Interests.

(a) The General Partner shall keep or cause to be kept on behalf of the Partnership a register in which, subject to such reasonable regulations as it may prescribe and subject to the provisions of Section 4.5(b), the Partnership will provide for the registration and transfer of Limited Partner Interests.

(b) The Partnership shall not recognize any transfer of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates until the Certificates evidencing such Limited Partner Interests are surrendered for registration of transfer. No charge shall be imposed by the General Partner for such transfer; provided, that as a condition to the issuance of any new Certificate under this Section 4.5, the General Partner may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed with respect thereto. Upon surrender of a Certificate for registration of transfer of any Limited Partner Interests evidenced by a Certificate, and subject to the provisions hereof, the appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute and deliver, and in the case of Certificates evidencing Limited Partner Interests, the Transfer Agent shall countersign and deliver, in the name of the holder or the designated transferee or transferees, as required pursuant to the holder’s instructions, one or more new Certificates evidencing the same aggregate number and type of Limited Partner Interests as was evidenced by the Certificate so surrendered.

(c) By acceptance of the transfer of any Limited Partner Interests in accordance with this Section 4.5 and except as provided in Section 4.8, each transferee of a Limited Partner Interest (including any nominee holder or an agent or representative acquiring such Limited Partner Interests for the account of another Person) acknowledges and agrees to the provisions of Section 10.1(a).

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-23


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(d) Subject to (i) the foregoing provisions of this Section 4.5, (ii) Section 4.3, (iii) Section 4.7, (iv) with respect to any class or series of Limited Partner Interests, the provisions of any statement of designations or an amendment to this Agreement establishing such class or series, (v) any contractual provisions binding on any Limited Partner and (vi) provisions of applicable law including the Securities Act, Limited Partner Interests shall be freely transferable.

(e) The General Partner and its Affiliates shall have the right at any time to transfer their Subordinated Units, Common Units and Incentive Distribution Rights to one or more Persons.

Section 4.6  Transfer of the General Partner’s General Partner Interest.

(a) The General Partner may at its option transfer all or any part of its General Partner Interest without approval from any other Partner.

(b) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, no transfer by the General Partner of all or any part of its General Partner Interest to another Person shall be permitted unless (i) the transferee agrees to assume the rights and duties of the General Partner under this Agreement and to be bound by the provisions of this Agreement, (ii) the Partnership receives an Opinion of Counsel that such transfer would not result in the loss of limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause the Partnership to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed) and (iii) such transferee also agrees to purchase all (or the appropriate portion thereof, if applicable) of the partnership or membership interest held by the General Partner as the general partner or managing member, if any, of each other Group Member. In the case of a transfer pursuant to and in compliance with this Section 4.6, the transferee or successor (as the case may be) shall, subject to compliance with the terms of Section 10.2, be admitted to the Partnership as the General Partner effective immediately prior to the transfer of the General Partner Interest, and the business of the Partnership shall continue without dissolution.

Section 4.7  Restrictions on Transfers.

(a) Notwithstanding the other provisions of this Article IV, no transfer of any Partnership Interests shall be made if such transfer would (i) violate the then applicable federal or state securities laws or rules and regulations of the Commission, any state securities commission or any other governmental authority with jurisdiction over such transfer, (ii) terminate the existence or qualification of the Partnership under the laws of the jurisdiction of its formation, or (iii) cause the Partnership to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed).

(b) The General Partner may impose restrictions on the transfer of Partnership Interests if it determines, with the advice of counsel, that such restrictions are necessary or advisable to (i) avoid a significant risk of the Partnership becoming taxable as a corporation or otherwise becoming taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes or (ii) preserve the uniformity of the Limited Partner Interests (or any class or classes thereof). The General Partner may impose such restrictions by amending this Agreement; provided, however, that any amendment that would result in the delisting or suspension of trading of any class of Limited Partner Interests on the principal National Securities Exchange on which such class of Limited Partner Interests is then listed or admitted to trading must be approved, prior to such amendment being effected, by the holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Limited Partner Interests of such class.

(c) Nothing contained in this Agreement, other than Section 4.7(a), shall preclude the settlement of any transactions involving Partnership Interests entered into through the facilities of any National Securities Exchange on which such Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-24


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 4.8  Eligibility Certificates; Ineligible Holders.

(a) If at any time the General Partner determines, with the advice of counsel, that:

(i) the U.S. federal income tax status (or lack of proof of the U.S. federal income tax status) of one or more Limited Partners or their beneficial owners has or is reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the rates that can be charged to customers by any Group Member with respect to assets that are subject to regulation by the Federal Energy Regulatory Commission or similar regulatory body (a “Rate Eligibility Trigger”); or

(ii) any Group Member is subject to any federal, state or local law or regulation that would create a substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any property in which the Group Member has an interest based on the nationality, citizenship or other related status of a Limited Partner (a Citizenship Eligibility Trigger);

 

     then, the General Partner may adopt such amendments to this Agreement as it determines to be necessary or appropriate to (x) in the case of a Rate Eligibility Trigger, obtain such proof of the U.S. federal income tax status of the Limited Partners and, to the extent relevant, their beneficial owners, as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to reduce risk of the occurrence of a material adverse effect on the rates that can be charged to customers by any Group Member or (y) in the case of a Citizenship Eligibility Trigger, obtain such proof of the nationality, citizenship or other related status of the Limited Partner and, to the extent relevant, their beneficial owners as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to eliminate or mitigate a significant risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any properties or interests therein of a Group Member.

(b) Such amendments may include provisions requiring all Partners to certify as to their (and their beneficial owners’) status as Eligible Holders upon demand and on a regular basis, as determined by the General Partner, and may require transferees of Units to so certify prior to being admitted to the Partnership as a Partner (any such required certificate, an Eligibility Certificate).

(c) Such amendments may provide that any Partner who fails to furnish to the General Partner within a reasonable period requested proof of its (and its beneficial owners’) status as an Eligible Holder or if upon receipt of such Eligibility Certificate or other requested information the General Partner determines that a Limited Partner (or its beneficial owner) is not an Eligible Holder (an Ineligible Holder), the Partnership Interests owned by such Limited Partner shall be subject to redemption in accordance with the provisions of Section 4.9. In addition, the General Partner shall be substituted and treated as the owner of all Partnership Interests owned by an Ineligible Holder.

(d) The General Partner shall, in exercising voting rights in respect of Partnership Interests held by it on behalf of Ineligible Holders, cast such votes in the same manner and in the same ratios as the votes of Partners (including the General Partner and its Affiliates) in respect of Partnership Interests other than those of Ineligible Holders are cast.

(e) Upon dissolution of the Partnership, an Ineligible Holder shall have no right to receive a distribution in kind pursuant to Section 12.4 but shall be entitled to the cash equivalent thereof, and the Partnership shall provide cash in exchange for an assignment of the Ineligible Holder’s share of any distribution in kind. Such payment and assignment shall be treated for purposes hereof as a purchase by the Partnership from the Ineligible Holder of the portion of his Partnership Interest representing his right to receive his share of such distribution in kind.

(f) At any time after he can and does certify that he has become an Eligible Holder, an Ineligible Holder may, upon application to the General Partner, request that with respect to any Partnership Interests of such

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-25


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Ineligible Holder not redeemed pursuant to Section 4.9, such Ineligible Holder be admitted as a Partner, and upon approval of the General Partner, such Ineligible Holder shall be admitted as a Partner and shall no longer constitute an Ineligible Holder and the General Partner shall cease to be deemed to be the owner in respect of such Ineligible Holder’s Partnership Interests.

Section 4.9  Redemption of Partnership Interests of Ineligible Holders.

(a) If at any time a Partner fails to furnish an Eligibility Certificate or other information requested within the period of time specified in amendments adopted pursuant to Section 4.8 or if upon receipt of such Eligibility Certificate, the General Partner determines, with the advice of counsel, that a Partner is an Ineligible Holder, the Partnership may, unless the Partner establishes to the satisfaction of the General Partner that such Partner is an Eligible Holder or has transferred his Limited Partner Interests to a Person who is an Eligible Holder and who furnishes an Eligibility Certificate to the General Partner prior to the date fixed for redemption as provided below, redeem the Partnership Interest of such Partner as follows:

(i) The General Partner shall, not later than the 30th day before the date fixed for redemption, give notice of redemption to the Partner, at his last address designated on the records of the Partnership or the Transfer Agent, as applicable, by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid. The notice shall be deemed to have been given when so mailed. The notice shall specify the Redeemable Interests, the date fixed for redemption, the place of payment, that payment of the redemption price will be made upon redemption of the Redeemable Interests (or, if later in the case of Redeemable Interests evidenced by Certificates, upon surrender of the Certificate evidencing the Redeemable Interests) and that on and after the date fixed for redemption no further allocations or distributions to which the Partner would otherwise be entitled in respect of the Redeemable Interests will accrue or be made.

(ii) The aggregate redemption price for Redeemable Interests shall be an amount equal to the Current Market Price (the date of determination of which shall be the date fixed for redemption) of Partnership Interests of the class to be so redeemed multiplied by the number of Partnership Interests of each such class included among the Redeemable Interests. The redemption price shall be paid, as determined by the General Partner, in cash or by delivery of a promissory note of the Partnership in the principal amount of the redemption price, bearing interest at the rate of 8% annually and payable in three equal annual installments of principal together with accrued interest, commencing one year after the redemption date.

(iii) The Partner or his duly authorized representative shall be entitled to receive the payment for the Redeemable Interests at the place of payment specified in the notice of redemption on the redemption date (or, if later in the case of Redeemable Interests evidenced by Certificates, upon surrender by or on behalf of the Partner at the place specified in the notice of redemption, of the Certificate evidencing the Redeemable Interests, duly endorsed in blank or accompanied by an assignment duly executed in blank).

(iv) After the redemption date, Redeemable Interests shall no longer constitute issued and Outstanding Limited Partner Interests.

(b) The provisions of this Section 4.9 shall also be applicable to Partnership Interests held by a Partner as nominee of a Person determined to be an Ineligible Holder.

(c) Nothing in this Section 4.9 shall prevent the recipient of a notice of redemption from transferring his Partnership Interest before the redemption date if such transfer is otherwise permitted under this Agreement. Upon receipt of notice of such a transfer, the General Partner shall withdraw the notice of redemption, provided the transferee of such Partnership Interest certifies to the satisfaction of the General Partner that he is an Eligible Holder. If the transferee fails to make such certification, such redemption will be effected from the transferee on the original redemption date.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-26


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

ARTICLE V

CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS AND ISSUANCE OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS

Section 5.1  Organizational Contributions.

In connection with the formation of the Partnership under the Delaware Act, the General Partner has been admitted as the General Partner of the Partnership. The Organizational Limited Partner made an initial Capital Contribution to the Partnership in the amount of $1,000.00 in exchange for a Limited Partner Interest equal to a 100% Percentage Interest and has been admitted as a Limited Partner of the Partnership. As of the Closing Date, and effective with the admission of another Limited Partner to the Partnership, the interests of the Organizational Limited Partner will be redeemed as provided in the Contribution Agreement and the initial Capital Contributions of the Organizational Limited Partner will be refunded. One-hundred percent of any interest or other profit that may have resulted from the investment or other use of such initial Capital Contributions will be allocated and distributed to the Organizational Limited Partner.

Section 5.2  Contributions by the General Partner and its Affiliates.

(a) On the Closing Date and pursuant to the Contribution Agreement, the Organizational Limited Partner shall contribute to the Partnership, as a Capital Contribution, the Contributed Subsidiaries (as defined in the Contribution Agreement) in exchange for [            ] Common Units, [            ] Subordinated Units and the Incentive Distribution Rights.

Section 5.3  Initial Offering.

(a) On the Closing Date and pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement, each Underwriter shall pay cash to Hi-Crush Proppants in exchange for the sale by Hi-Crush Proppants of Common Units to each Underwriter, all as set forth in the Underwriting Agreement.

(b) Upon the exercise, if any, of the Over-Allotment Option, each Underwriter shall pay cash to Hi-Crush Proppants in exchange for the sale by Hi-Crush Proppants of Common Units to each Underwriter, all as set forth in the Underwriting Agreement.

Section 5.4  Interest and Withdrawal.

No interest shall be paid by the Partnership on Capital Contributions. No Partner shall be entitled to the withdrawal or return of its Capital Contribution, except to the extent, if any, that distributions made pursuant to this Agreement or upon liquidation of the Partnership may be considered as such by law and then only to the extent provided for in this Agreement. Except to the extent expressly provided in this Agreement, no Partner shall have priority over any other Partner either as to the return of Capital Contributions or as to profits, losses or distributions. Any such return shall be a compromise to which all Partners agree within the meaning of Section 17-502(b) of the Delaware Act.

Section 5.5  Capital Accounts.

(a) The Partnership shall maintain for each Partner (or a beneficial owner of Partnership Interests held by a nominee in any case in which the nominee has furnished the identity of such owner to the Partnership in accordance with Section 6031(c) of the Code or any other method acceptable to the General Partner) owning a Partnership Interest a separate Capital Account with respect to such Partnership Interest in accordance with the rules of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv). Such Capital Account shall be increased by (i) the amount of all Capital Contributions made to the Partnership with respect to such Partnership Interest and (ii) all items of Partnership income and gain (including income and gain exempt from tax) computed in accordance with

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-27


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 5.5(b) and allocated with respect to such Partnership Interest pursuant to Section 6.1, and decreased by (x) the amount of cash or Net Agreed Value of all actual and deemed distributions of cash or property made with respect to such Partnership Interest and (y) all items of Partnership deduction and loss computed in accordance with Section 5.5(b) and allocated with respect to such Partnership Interest pursuant to Section 6.1.

(b) For purposes of computing the amount of any item of income, gain, loss or deduction that is to be allocated pursuant to Article VI and is to be reflected in the Partners’ Capital Accounts, the determination, recognition and classification of any such item shall be the same as its determination, recognition and classification for U.S. federal income tax purposes (including any method of depreciation, cost recovery or amortization used for that purpose), provided, that:

(i) Solely for purposes of this Section 5.5, the Partnership shall be treated as owning directly its proportionate share (as determined by the General Partner based upon the provisions of the applicable Group Member Agreement) of all property owned by (x) any other Group Member that is classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and (y) any other partnership, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other entity classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes of which a Group Member is, directly or indirectly, a partner, member or other equity holder.

(ii) All fees and other expenses incurred by the Partnership to promote the sale of (or to sell) a Partnership Interest that can neither be deducted nor amortized under Section 709 of the Code, if any, shall, for purposes of Capital Account maintenance, be treated as an item of deduction at the time such fees and other expenses are incurred and shall be allocated among the Partners pursuant to Section 6.1.

(iii) Except as otherwise provided in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(m), the computation of all items of income, gain, loss and deduction shall be made without regard to any election under Section 754 of the Code that may be made by the Partnership and, as to those items described in Section 705(a)(1)(B) or 705(a)(2)(B) of the Code, without regard to the fact that such items are not includable in gross income or are neither currently deductible nor capitalized for U.S. federal income tax purposes. To the extent an adjustment to the adjusted tax basis of any Partnership asset pursuant to Section 734(b) or 743(b) of the Code is required, pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(m), to be taken into account in determining Capital Accounts, the amount of such adjustment in the Capital Accounts shall be treated as an item of gain or loss.

(iv) Any income, gain or loss attributable to the taxable disposition of any Partnership property shall be determined as if the adjusted basis of such property as of such date of disposition were equal in amount to the property’s Carrying Value as of such date.

(v) Any deductions for depreciation, cost recovery or amortization attributable to any Contributed Property or Adjusted Property shall be determined under the rules prescribed by Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-3(d)(2) as if the adjusted basis of such property were equal to the Carrying Value of such property immediately following such adjustment.

(vi) The Gross Liability Value of each Liability of the Partnership described in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-7(b)(3)(i) shall be adjusted at such times as provided in this Agreement for an adjustment to Carrying Values. The amount of any such adjustment shall be treated for purposes hereof as an item of loss (if the adjustment increases the Carrying Value of such Liability of the Partnership) or an item of gain (if the adjustment decreases the Carrying Value of such Liability of the Partnership).

(c) (i) Except as otherwise provided in this Section 5.5(c), a transferee of a Partnership Interest shall succeed to a pro rata portion of the Capital Account of the transferor relating to the Partnership Interest so transferred.

(ii) Subject to Section 6.7(b), immediately prior to the transfer of a Subordinated Unit or of a Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit pursuant to Section 5.7 by a holder thereof (in

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-28


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

each case, other than a transfer to an Affiliate unless the General Partner elects to have this subparagraph 5.5(c)(ii) apply), the Capital Account maintained for such Person with respect to its Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units will (A) first, be allocated to the Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units to be transferred in an amount equal to the product of (x) the number of such Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units to be transferred and (y) the Per Unit Capital Amount for a Common Unit, and (B) second, any remaining balance in such Capital Account will be retained by the transferor, regardless of whether it has retained any Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units. Following any such allocation, the transferor’s Capital Account, if any, maintained with respect to the retained Subordinated Units or retained converted Subordinated Units, if any, will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (B) above, and the transferee’s Capital Account established with respect to the transferred Subordinated Units or transferred converted Subordinated Units will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (A) above.

(iii) Subject to Section 6.8(b), immediately prior to the transfer of an IDR Reset Common Unit by a holder thereof (other than a transfer to an Affiliate unless the General Partner elects to have this subparagraph 5.5(c)(iii) apply), the Capital Account maintained for such Person with respect to its IDR Reset Common Units will (A) first, be allocated to the IDR Reset Common Units to be transferred in an amount equal to the product of (x) the number of such IDR Reset Common Units to be transferred and (y) the Per Unit Capital Amount for a Common Unit, and (B) second, any remaining balance in such Capital Account will be retained by the transferor, regardless of whether it has retained any IDR Reset Common Units. Following any such allocation, the transferor’s Capital Account, if any, maintained with respect to the retained IDR Reset Common Units, if any, will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (B) hereinabove, and the transferee’s Capital Account established with respect to the transferred IDR Reset Common Units will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (A) above.

(d) (i) Consistent with Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(f), on an issuance of additional Partnership Interests for cash or Contributed Property, the issuance of Partnership Interests as consideration for the provision of services, or the conversion of the Combined Interest to Common Units pursuant to Section 11.3(b), the Carrying Value of each Partnership property immediately prior to such issuance shall be adjusted upward or downward to reflect any Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss attributable to such Partnership property, and any such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss shall be treated, for purposes of maintaining Capital Accounts, as if it had been recognized on an actual sale of each such property for an amount equal to its fair market value immediately prior to such issuance and had been allocated among the Partners at such time pursuant to Section 6.1 in the same manner as any item of gain or loss actually recognized following an event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership would have been allocated; provided, however, that in the event of an issuance of Partnership Interests for a de minimis amount of cash or Contributed Property, or in the event of an issuance of a de minimis amount of Partnership Interests as consideration for the provision of services, the General Partner may determine that such adjustments are unnecessary for the proper administration of the Partnership. In determining such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss, the aggregate fair market value of all Partnership property (including cash or cash equivalents) immediately prior to the issuance of additional Partnership Interests shall be determined by the General Partner using such method of valuation as it may adopt. In making its determination of the fair market values of individual properties, the General Partner may determine that it is appropriate to first determine an aggregate value for the Partnership, based on the current trading price of the Common Units, and taking fully into account the fair market value of the Partnership Interests of all Partners at such time, and then allocate such aggregate value among the individual properties of the Partnership (in such manner as it determines appropriate).

(ii) In accordance with Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(f), immediately prior to any actual or deemed distribution to a Partner of any Partnership property (other than a distribution of cash that is not in redemption or retirement of a Partnership Interest), the Carrying Value of all Partnership property shall be adjusted upward or downward to reflect any Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss attributable to such Partnership

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-29


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

property, and any such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss shall be treated, for purposes of maintaining Capital Accounts, as if it had been recognized on an actual sale of each such property immediately prior to such distribution for an amount equal to its fair market value, and had been allocated among the Partners, at such time, pursuant to Section 6.1 in the same manner as any item of gain or loss actually recognized following an event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership would have been allocated. In determining such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss the aggregate fair market value of all Partnership property (including cash or cash equivalents) immediately prior to a distribution shall (A) in the case of an actual or deemed distribution other than a distribution made pursuant to Section 12.4, be determined in the same manner as that provided in Section 5.5(d)(i) or (B) in the case of a liquidating distribution pursuant to Section 12.4, be determined by the Liquidator using such method of valuation as it may adopt.

Section 5.6  Issuances of Additional Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments.

(a) The Partnership may issue additional Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments for any Partnership purpose at any time and from time to time to such Persons for such consideration and on such terms and conditions as the General Partner shall determine, all without the approval of any Limited Partners.

(b) Each additional Partnership Interest authorized to be issued by the Partnership pursuant to Section 5.6(a) may be issued in one or more classes, or one or more series of any such classes, with such designations, preferences, rights, powers and duties (which may be senior to existing classes and series of Partnership Interests), as shall be fixed by the General Partner, including (i) the right to share in Partnership profits and losses or items thereof; (ii) the right to share in Partnership distributions; (iii) the rights upon dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership; (iv) whether, and the terms and conditions upon which, the Partnership may or shall be required to redeem the Partnership Interest (including sinking fund provisions); (v) whether such Partnership Interest is issued with the privilege of conversion or exchange and, if so, the terms and conditions of such conversion or exchange; (vi) the terms and conditions upon which each Partnership Interest will be issued, evidenced by Certificates and assigned or transferred; (vii) the method for determining the Percentage Interest as to such Partnership Interest; and (viii) the right, if any, of each such Partnership Interest to vote on Partnership matters, including matters relating to the relative rights, preferences and privileges of such Partnership Interest.

(c) The General Partner shall take all actions that it determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with (i) each issuance of Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments pursuant to this Section 5.6, (ii) the conversion of the Combined Interest into Units pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, (iii) the issuance of Common Units pursuant to Section 5.11, (iv) reflecting admission of such additional Limited Partners in the books and records of the Partnership as the Record Holders of such Limited Partner Interests and (v) all additional issuances of Partnership Interests. The General Partner shall determine the relative rights, powers and duties of the holders of the Units or other Partnership Interests being so issued. The General Partner shall do all things necessary to comply with the Delaware Act and is authorized and directed to do all things that it determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with any future issuance of Partnership Interests or in connection with the conversion of the Combined Interest into Units pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, including compliance with any statute, rule, regulation or guideline of any federal, state or other governmental agency or any National Securities Exchange on which the Units or other Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading.

(d) No fractional Units shall be issued by the Partnership.

Section 5.7  Conversion of Subordinated Units.

(a) All of the Subordinated Units shall convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis on the first Business Day following the distribution pursuant to Section 6.4(a) in respect of the final Quarter of the Subordination Period.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-30


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(b) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, all of the then Outstanding Subordinated Units may convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis as set forth in, and pursuant to the terms of, Section 11.4.

Section 5.8  Limited Preemptive Right.

Except as provided in this Section 5.8 or as otherwise provided in a separate agreement by the Partnership, no Person shall have any preemptive, preferential or other similar right with respect to the issuance of any Partnership Interest, whether unissued, held in the treasury or hereafter created. The General Partner shall have the right, which it may from time to time assign in whole or in part to any of its Affiliates, to purchase Partnership Interests from the Partnership whenever, and on the same terms that, the Partnership issues Partnership Interests to Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates, to the extent necessary to maintain the Percentage Interests of the General Partner and its Affiliates equal to that which existed immediately prior to the issuance of such Partnership Interests.

Section 5.9  Splits and Combinations.

(a) Subject to Section 5.9(d), the Partnership may make a Pro Rata distribution of Partnership Interests to all Record Holders or may effect a subdivision or combination of Partnership Interests so long as, after any such event, each Partner shall have the same Percentage Interest in the Partnership as before such event, and any amounts calculated on a per Unit basis (including any Common Unit Arrearage or Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage) or stated as a number of Units are proportionately adjusted retroactive to the beginning of the Partnership.

(b) Whenever such a distribution, subdivision or combination of Partnership Interests is declared, the General Partner shall select a Record Date as of which the distribution, subdivision or combination shall be effective and shall send notice thereof at least 20 days prior to such Record Date to each Record Holder as of a date not less than 10 days prior to the date of such notice. The General Partner also may cause a firm of independent public accountants selected by it to calculate the number of Partnership Interests to be held by each Record Holder after giving effect to such distribution, subdivision or combination. The General Partner shall be entitled to rely on any certificate provided by such firm as conclusive evidence of the accuracy of such calculation.

(c) Promptly following any such distribution, subdivision or combination, the Partnership may issue Certificates to the Record Holders of Partnership Interests as of the applicable Record Date representing the new number of Partnership Interests held by such Record Holders, or the General Partner may adopt such other procedures that it determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect such changes. If any such combination results in a smaller total number of Partnership Interests Outstanding, the Partnership shall require, as a condition to the delivery to a Record Holder of such new Certificate, the surrender of any Certificate held by such Record Holder immediately prior to such Record Date.

(d) The Partnership shall not issue fractional Units upon any distribution, subdivision or combination of Units. If a distribution, subdivision or combination of Units would result in the issuance of fractional Units but for the provisions of Section 5.6(d) and this Section 5.9(d), each fractional Unit shall be rounded to the nearest whole Unit (and a 0.5 Unit shall be rounded to the next higher Unit).

Section 5.10  Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Limited Partner Interests.

All Limited Partner Interests issued pursuant to, and in accordance with the requirements of, this Article V shall be fully paid and non-assessable Limited Partner Interests in the Partnership, except as such non-assessability may be affected by Section 17-607 or 17-804 of the Delaware Act.

Section 5.11  Issuance of Common Units in Connection with Reset of Incentive Distribution Rights.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-31


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(a) Subject to the provisions of this Section 5.11, the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights) shall have the right, at any time when there are no Subordinated Units outstanding and the Partnership has made a distribution pursuant to Section 6.4(b)(v) for each of the four most recently completed Quarters, to make an election (the “IDR Reset Election”) to cause the Target Distributions to be reset in accordance with the provisions of Section 5.11(e) and, in connection therewith, the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights will become entitled to receive their respective proportionate share of a number of Common Units (the “IDR Reset Common Units”) derived by dividing (i) the amount of cash distributions made by the Partnership for the Quarter immediately preceding the giving of the Reset Notice in respect of the Incentive Distribution Rights by (ii) the cash distribution made by the Partnership in respect of each Common Unit for the Quarter immediately preceding the giving of the Reset Notice (the “Reset MQD”) (the number of Common Units determined by such quotient is referred to herein as the “Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units”). The making of the IDR Reset Election in the manner specified in Section 5.11(b) shall cause the Target Distributions to be reset in accordance with the provisions of Section 5.11(e) and, in connection therewith, the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights will become entitled to receive Common Units on the basis specified above, without any further approval required by the General Partner or the Unitholders, at the time specified in Section 5.11(c) unless the IDR Reset Election is rescinded pursuant to Section 5.11(d).

(b) To exercise the right specified in Section 5.11(a), the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights) shall deliver a written notice (the “Reset Notice”) to the Partnership. Within 10 Business Days after the receipt by the Partnership of such Reset Notice, the Partnership shall deliver a written notice to the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights of the Partnership’s determination of the aggregate number of Common Units that each holder of Incentive Distribution Rights will be entitled to receive.

(c) The holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights will be entitled to receive the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units on the fifteenth Business Day after receipt by the Partnership of the Reset Notice; provided, however, that the issuance of Common Units to the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights shall not occur prior to the approval of the listing or admission for trading of such Common Units by the principal National Securities Exchange upon which the Common Units are then listed or admitted for trading if any such approval is required pursuant to the rules and regulations of such National Securities Exchange.

(d) If the principal National Securities Exchange upon which the Common Units are then traded has not approved the listing or admission for trading of the Common Units to be issued pursuant to this Section 5.11 on or before the 30th calendar day following the Partnership’s receipt of the Reset Notice and such approval is required by the rules and regulations of such National Securities Exchange, then the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights) shall have the right to either rescind the IDR Reset Election or elect to receive other Partnership Interests having such terms as the General Partner may approve, with the approval of the Conflicts Committee, that will provide (i) the same economic value, in the aggregate, as the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units would have had at the time of the Partnership’s receipt of the Reset Notice, as determined by the General Partner, and (ii) for the subsequent conversion (on terms acceptable to the National Securities Exchange upon which the Common Units are then traded) of such Partnership Interests into Common Units within not more than 12 months following the Partnership’s receipt of the Reset Notice upon the satisfaction of one or more conditions that are reasonably acceptable to the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights).

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-32


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(e) The Target Distributions shall be adjusted at the time of the issuance of Common Units or other Partnership Interests pursuant to this Section 5.11 such that (i) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution shall be reset to be equal to the Reset MQD, (ii) the First Target Distribution shall be reset to equal 115% of the Reset MQD, (iii) the Second Target Distribution shall be reset to equal 125% of the Reset MQD and (iv) the Third Target Distribution shall be reset to equal 150% of the Reset MQD.

(f) Upon the issuance of IDR Reset Common Units pursuant to Section 5.11(a) (or other Partnership Interests as described in Section 5.11(d), the Capital Account maintained with respect to the Incentive Distribution Rights shall (A) first, be allocated to IDR Reset Common Units (or other Partnership Interests) in an amount equal to the product of (x) the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units (or other Partnership Interests) and (y) the Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit, and (B) second, any remaining balance in such Capital Account will be retained by the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights. If there is not a sufficient Capital Account associated with the Incentive Distribution Rights to allocate the full Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit to the IDR Reset Common Units in accordance with clause (A) of this Section 5.11(f), the IDR Reset Common Units shall be subject to Sections 6.1(d)(x)(B) and (C).

ARTICLE VI

ALLOCATIONS AND DISTRIBUTIONS

Section 6.1  Allocations for Capital Account Purposes.

For purposes of maintaining the Capital Accounts and in determining the rights of the Partners among themselves, the Partnership’s items of income, gain, loss and deduction (computed in accordance with Section 5.5(b)) for each taxable period shall be allocated among the Partners as provided herein below.

(a) Net Income. Net Income for each taxable period (including a pro rata part of each item of income, gain, loss and deduction taken into account in computing Net Income for such taxable period) shall be allocated as follows:

(i) First, to the General Partner until the aggregate of the Net Income allocated to the General Partner pursuant to this Section 6.1(a)(i) and the Net Termination Gain allocated to the General Partner pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(i)(A) or Section 6.1(c)(iv)(A) for the current and all previous taxable periods is equal to the aggregate of the Net Loss allocated to the General Partner pursuant to Section 6.1(b)(ii) for all previous taxable periods and the Net Termination Loss allocated to the General Partner pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(ii)(D) or Section 6.1(c)(iii)(B) for the current and all previous taxable periods; and

(ii) The balance, if any, 100% to the Unitholders, Pro Rata.

(b) Net Loss. Net Loss for each taxable period (including a pro rata part of each item of income, gain, loss and deduction taken into account in computing Net Loss for such taxable period) shall be allocated as follows:

(i) First, to the Unitholders, Pro Rata; provided, that Net Loss shall not be allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(b)(i) to the extent that such allocation would cause any Unitholder to have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account at the end of such taxable period (or increase any existing deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account); and

(ii) The balance, if any, 100% to the General Partner.

(c) Net Termination Gains and Losses. Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss for each taxable period shall be allocated in the manner set forth in this Section 6.1(c). All allocations under this Section 6.1(c)

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-33


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

shall be made after Capital Account balances have been adjusted by all other allocations provided under this Section 6.1 and after all distributions of cash and cash equivalents provided under Section 6.4 and Section 6.5 have been made; provided, however , that solely for purposes of this Section 6.1(c), Capital Accounts shall not be adjusted for distributions made pursuant to Section 12.4.

(i) Except as provided in Section 6.1(c)(iv), Net Termination Gain (including a pro rata part of each item of income, gain, loss, and deduction taken into account in computing Net Termination Gain) shall be allocated:

(A) First, to the General Partner until the aggregate of the Net Termination Gain allocated to the General Partner pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(i)(A) or Section 6.1(c)(iv)(A) and the Net Income allocated to the General Partner pursuant to Section 6.1(a)(i) for the current and all previous taxable periods is equal to the aggregate of the Net Loss allocated to the General Partner pursuant to Section 6.1(b)(ii) for all previous taxable periods and the Net Termination Loss allocated to the General Partner pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(ii)(D) or Section 6.1(c)(iii)(B) for all previous taxable periods;

(B) Second, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) its Unrecovered Initial Unit Price, (2) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for the Quarter during which the Liquidation Date occurs, reduced by any distribution pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(i) or Section 6.4(b)(i) with respect to such Common Unit for such Quarter (the amount determined pursuant to this clause (2) is hereinafter referred to as the “Unpaid MQD”) and (3) any then existing Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage;

(C) Third, if such Net Termination Gain is recognized (or is deemed to be recognized) prior to the conversion of the last Outstanding Subordinated Unit into a Common Unit, to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding equals the sum of (1) its Unrecovered Initial Unit Price, determined for the taxable period (or portion thereof) to which this allocation of gain relates, and (2) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for the Quarter during which the Liquidation Date occurs, reduced by any distribution pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(iii) with respect to such Subordinated Unit for such Quarter;

(D) Fourth, to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) its Unrecovered Initial Unit Price, (2) the Unpaid MQD, (3) any then existing Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage, and (4) the excess of (aa) the First Target Distribution less the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for each Quarter of the Partnership’s existence over (bb) the cumulative per Unit amount of any distributions of cash or cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(iv) and Section 6.4(b)(ii) (the sum of (1), (2), (3) and (4) is hereinafter referred to as the “First Liquidation Target Amount”);

(E) Fifth, 15% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, and 85.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) the First Liquidation Target Amount, and (2) the excess of (aa) the Second Target Distribution less the First Target Distribution for each Quarter of the Partnership’s existence over (bb) the cumulative per Unit amount of any distributions of cash or cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(v) and Section 6.4(b)(iii) (the sum of (1) and (2) is hereinafter referred to as the “Second Liquidation Target Amount”);

(F) Sixth, 25% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, and 75% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) the Second Liquidation Target Amount, and (2) the excess of (aa) the Third Target Distribution less the Second Target Distribution for each Quarter of the Partnership’s existence over (bb) the cumulative per Unit amount of any distributions of cash or cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(vi) and Section 6.4(b)(iv); and

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-34


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(G) Finally, 50% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, and 50% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata.

(ii) Except as otherwise provided by Section 6.1(c)(iii) Net Termination Loss shall be allocated:

(A) First, if Subordinated Units remain Outstanding, to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding has been reduced to zero;

(B) Second, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding has been reduced to zero;

(C) Third, to the Unitholders, Pro Rata; provided that Net Termination Loss shall not be allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(ii)(C) to the extent such allocation would cause any Unitholder to have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account (or increase any existing deficit in its Adjusted Capital Account); and

(D) Fourth, the balance, if any, 100% to the General Partner.

(iii) Any Net Termination Loss deemed recognized pursuant to Section 5.5(d) prior to the Liquidation Date shall be allocated:

(A) First, to the Unitholders, Pro Rata; provided that Net Termination Loss shall not be allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(iii)(A) to the extent such allocation would cause any Unitholder to have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account at the end of such taxable period (or increase any existing deficit in its Adjusted Capital Account); and

(B) The balance, if any, to the General Partner.

(iv) If a Net Termination Loss has been allocated pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(iii), any subsequent Net Termination Gain deemed recognized pursuant to Section 5.5(d) prior to the Liquidation Date shall be allocated:

(A) First, to the General Partner until the aggregate Net Termination Gain allocated to the General Partner pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(iv)(A) is equal to the aggregate Net Termination Loss previously allocated pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(iii)(B);

(B) Second, to the Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the aggregate Net Termination Gain allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(iv)(B) is equal to the aggregate Net Termination Loss previously allocated pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(iii)(A); and

(C) The balance, if any, pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.1(c)(i).

(d) Special Allocations. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1, the following special allocations shall be made for each taxable period:

(i) Partnership Minimum Gain Chargeback. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1, if there is a net decrease in Partnership Minimum Gain during any Partnership taxable period, each Partner shall be allocated items of Partnership income and gain for such period (and, if necessary, subsequent periods) in the manner and amounts provided in Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(f)(6), 1.704-2(g)(2) and 1.704-2(j)(2)(i), or any successor provision. For purposes of this Section 6.1(d), each Partner’s Adjusted Capital Account balance shall be determined, and the allocation of income or gain required hereunder shall be effected, prior to the application of any other allocations pursuant to this Section 6.1(d) with respect to such taxable period (other than an allocation pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(vi) and Section 6.1(d)(vii)). This Section 6.1(d)(i) is intended to comply with the Partnership Minimum Gain chargeback requirement in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(f) and shall be interpreted consistently therewith.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-35


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(ii) Chargeback of Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain. Notwithstanding the other provisions of this Section 6.1 (other than Section 6.1(d)(i)), except as provided in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i)(4), if there is a net decrease in Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain during any Partnership taxable period, any Partner with a share of Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain at the beginning of such taxable period shall be allocated items of Partnership income and gain for such period (and, if necessary, subsequent periods) in the manner and amounts provided in Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(i)(4) and 1.704-2(j)(2)(ii), or any successor provisions. For purposes of this Section 6.1(d), each Partner’s Adjusted Capital Account balance shall be determined, and the allocation of income or gain required hereunder shall be effected, prior to the application of any other allocations pursuant to this Section 6.1(d), other than Section 6.1(d)(i) and other than an allocation pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(vi) and Section 6.1(d)(vii), with respect to such taxable period. This Section 6.1(d)(ii) is intended to comply with the chargeback of items of income and gain requirement in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i)(4) and shall be interpreted consistently therewith.

(iii) Priority Allocations.

(A) If the amount of cash or the Net Agreed Value of any property distributed (except cash or property distributed pursuant to Section 12.4) with respect to a Unit for a taxable period exceeds the amount of cash or the Net Agreed Value of property distributed with respect to another Unit within the same taxable period (the amount of the excess, an “Excess Distribution” and the Unit with respect to which the greater distribution is paid, an “Excess Distribution Unit”), then there shall be allocated gross income and gain to each Unitholder receiving an Excess Distribution with respect to the Excess Distribution Unit until the aggregate amount of such items allocated with respect to such Excess Distribution Unit pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A) for the current taxable period and all previous taxable periods is equal to the amount of the Excess Distribution.

(B) After the application of Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A), the remaining items of Partnership gross income or gain for the taxable period, if any, shall be allocated to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, until the aggregate amount of such items allocated to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(iii)(B) for the current taxable period and all previous taxable periods is equal to the cumulative amount of all Incentive Distributions made to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights from the Closing Date to a date 45 days after the end of the current taxable period.

(iv) Qualified Income Offset. In the event any Partner unexpectedly receives any adjustments, allocations or distributions described in Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d)(4), 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d)(5), or 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d)(6), items of Partnership gross income and gain shall be specially allocated to such Partner in an amount and manner sufficient to eliminate, to the extent required by the Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 704(b) of the Code, the deficit balance, if any, in its Adjusted Capital Account created by such adjustments, allocations or distributions as quickly as possible; provided, that an allocation pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(iv) shall be made only if and to the extent that such Partner would have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account after all other allocations provided for in this Section 6.1 have been tentatively made as if this Section 6.1(d)(iv) were not in this Agreement.

(v) Gross Income Allocation. In the event any Partner has a deficit balance in its Capital Account at the end of any taxable period in excess of the sum of (A) the amount such Partner is required to restore pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement and (B) the amount such Partner is deemed obligated to restore pursuant to Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(g) and 1.704-2(i)(5), such Partner shall be specially allocated items of Partnership gross income and gain in the amount of such excess as quickly as possible; provided, that an allocation pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(v) shall be made only if and to the extent that such Partner would have a deficit balance in its Capital Account after all other allocations provided for in this Section 6.1 have been tentatively made as if Section 6.1(d)(iv) and this Section 6.1(d)(v) were not in this Agreement.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-36


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(vi) Nonrecourse Deductions. Nonrecourse Deductions for any taxable period shall be allocated to the Partners Pro Rata. If the General Partner determines that the Partnership’s Nonrecourse Deductions should be allocated in a different ratio to satisfy the safe harbor requirements of the Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 704(b) of the Code, the General Partner is authorized to revise the prescribed ratio to the numerically closest ratio that does satisfy such requirements.

(vii) Partner Nonrecourse Deductions. Partner Nonrecourse Deductions for any taxable period shall be allocated 100% to the Partner that bears the Economic Risk of Loss with respect to the Partner Nonrecourse Debt to which such Partner Nonrecourse Deductions are attributable in accordance with Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i). If more than one Partner bears the Economic Risk of Loss with respect to a Partner Nonrecourse Debt, the Partner Nonrecourse Deductions attributable thereto shall be allocated between or among such Partners in accordance with the ratios in which they share such Economic Risk of Loss.

(viii) Nonrecourse Liabilities. For purposes of Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-3(a)(3), the Partners agree that Nonrecourse Liabilities of the Partnership in excess of the sum of (A) the amount of Partnership Minimum Gain and (B) the total amount of Nonrecourse Built-in Gain shall be allocated among the Partners Pro Rata.

(ix) Code Section 754 Adjustments. To the extent an adjustment to the adjusted tax basis of any Partnership asset pursuant to Section 734(b) or 743(b) of the Code is required, pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(m), to be taken into account in determining Capital Accounts as a result of a distribution to a Partner in complete liquidation of such Partner’s interest in the Partnership, the amount of such adjustment to the Capital Accounts shall be treated as an item of gain (if the adjustment increases the basis of the asset) or loss (if the adjustment decreases such basis) taken into account pursuant to Section 5.5, and such item of gain or loss shall be specially allocated to the Partners in a manner consistent with the manner in which their Capital Accounts are required to be adjusted pursuant to such Section of the Treasury Regulations.

(x) Economic Uniformity; Changes in Law.

(A) At the election of the General Partner with respect to any taxable period ending upon, or after, the termination of the Subordination Period, all or a portion of the remaining items of Partnership gross income or gain for such taxable period, after taking into account allocations pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(iii), shall be allocated 100% to each Partner holding Subordinated Units that are Outstanding as of the termination of the Subordination Period (“Final Subordinated Units”) in the proportion of the number of Final Subordinated Units held by such Partner to the total number of Final Subordinated Units then Outstanding, until each such Partner has been allocated an amount of gross income or gain that increases the Capital Account maintained with respect to such Final Subordinated Units to an amount that after taking into account the other allocations of income, gain, loss and deduction to be made with respect to such taxable period will equal the product of (A) the number of Final Subordinated Units held by such Partner and (B) the Per Unit Capital Amount for a Common Unit. The purpose of this allocation is to establish uniformity between the Capital Accounts underlying Final Subordinated Units and the Capital Accounts underlying Common Units held by Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates immediately prior to the conversion of such Final Subordinated Units into Common Units. This allocation method for establishing such economic uniformity will be available to the General Partner only if the method for allocating the Capital Account maintained with respect to the Subordinated Units between the transferred and retained Subordinated Units pursuant to Section 5.5(c)(ii) does not otherwise provide such economic uniformity to the Final Subordinated Units.

(B) With respect to an event triggering an adjustment to the Carrying Value of Partnership property pursuant to Section 5.5(d) during any taxable period of the Partnership ending upon, or after,

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-37


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

the issuance of IDR Reset Common Units pursuant to Section 5.11, after the application of Section 6.1(d)(x)(A), any Unrealized Gains and Unrealized Losses shall be allocated among the Partners in a manner that to the nearest extent possible results in the Capital Accounts maintained with respect to such IDR Reset Common Units issued pursuant to Section 5.11 equaling the product of (A) the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units and (B) the Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit.

(C) With respect to any taxable period during which an IDR Reset Unit is transferred to any Person who is not an Affiliate of the transferor, all or a portion of the remaining items of Partnership gross income or gain for such taxable period shall be allocated 100% to the transferor Partner of such transferred IDR Reset Unit until such transferor Partner has been allocated an amount of gross income or gain that increases the Capital Account maintained with respect to such transferred IDR Reset Unit to an amount equal to the Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit.

(D) For the proper administration of the Partnership and for the preservation of uniformity of the Limited Partner Interests (or any class or classes thereof), the General Partner shall (i) adopt such conventions as it deems appropriate in determining the amount of depreciation, amortization and cost recovery deductions; (ii) make special allocations of income, gain, loss, deduction, Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss; and (iii) amend the provisions of this Agreement as appropriate (x) to reflect the proposal or promulgation of Treasury Regulations under Section 704(b) or Section 704(c) of the Code or (y) otherwise to preserve or achieve uniformity of the Limited Partner Interests (or any class or classes thereof). The General Partner may adopt such conventions, make such allocations and make such amendments to this Agreement as provided in this Section 6.1(d)(x)(D) only if such conventions, allocations or amendments would not have a material adverse effect on the Partners, the holders of any class or classes of Outstanding Limited Partner Interests or the Partnership.

(xi) Curative Allocation.

(A) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1, other than the Required Allocations, the Required Allocations shall be taken into account in making the Agreed Allocations so that, to the extent possible, the net amount of items of gross income, gain, loss and deduction allocated to each Partner pursuant to the Required Allocations and the Agreed Allocations, together, shall be equal to the net amount of such items that would have been allocated to each such Partner under the Agreed Allocations had the Required Allocations and the related Curative Allocation not otherwise been provided in this Section 6.1. In exercising its discretion under this Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A), the General Partner may take into account future Required Allocations that, although not yet made, are likely to offset other Required Allocations previously made. Allocations pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A) shall only be made with respect to Required Allocations to the extent the General Partner determines that such allocations will otherwise be inconsistent with the economic agreement among the Partners.

(B) The General Partner shall, with respect to each taxable period, (1) apply the provisions of Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A) in whatever order is most likely to minimize the economic distortions that might otherwise result from the Required Allocations, and (2) divide all allocations pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A) among the Partners in a manner that is likely to minimize such economic distortions.

(xii) Corrective and Other Allocations. In the event of any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items or any Book-Down Event or any recognition of a Net Termination Loss, the following rules shall apply:

(A) Except as provided in Section 6.1(d)(xii)(B), in the case of any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items (other than an allocation of Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss under

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-38


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 5.5(d) hereof), the General Partner shall allocate such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items to (1) the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights to the same extent that the Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss giving rise to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items was allocated to them pursuant to Section 5.5(d) and (2) all Unitholders, Pro Rata, to the extent that the Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss giving rise to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items was allocated to any Unitholders pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

(B) In the case of any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items (other than an allocation of Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss under Section 5.5(d) hereof or an allocation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss pursuant to Section 6.1(c) hereof) as a result of a sale or other taxable disposition of any Partnership asset that is an Adjusted Property (“Disposed of Adjusted Property”), the General Partner shall allocate (1) additional items of gross income and gain (aa) away from the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights and (bb) to the Unitholders, or (2) additional items of deduction and loss (aa) away from the Unitholders and (bb) to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, to the extent that the Additional Book Basis Derivative Items allocated to the Unitholders exceed their Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items with respect to such Disposed of Adjusted Property. Any allocation made pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(xii)(B) shall be made after all of the other Agreed Allocations have been made as if this Section 6.1(d)(xii) were not in this Agreement and, to the extent necessary, shall require the reallocation of items that have been allocated pursuant to such other Agreed Allocations.

(C) In the case of any negative adjustments to the Capital Accounts of the Partners resulting from a Book-Down Event or from the recognition of a Net Termination Loss, such negative adjustment (1) shall first be allocated, to the extent of the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments, in such a manner, as determined by the General Partner, that to the extent possible the aggregate Capital Accounts of the Partners will equal the amount that would have been the Capital Account balances of the Partners if no prior Book-Up Events had occurred, and (2) any negative adjustment in excess of the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments shall be allocated pursuant to Section 6.1(c) hereof.

(D) For purposes of this Section 6.1(d)(xii), the Unitholders shall be treated as being allocated Additional Book Basis Derivative Items to the extent that such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items have reduced the amount of income that would otherwise have been allocated to the Unitholders under this Agreement. In making the allocations required under this Section 6.1(d)(xii), the General Partner may apply whatever conventions or other methodology it determines will satisfy the purpose of this Section 6.1(d)(xii). Without limiting the foregoing, if an Adjusted Property is contributed by the Partnership to another entity classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes (the “lower tier partnership”), the General Partner may make allocations similar to those described in Sections 6.1(d)(xii)(A)–(C) to the extent the General Partner determines such allocations are necessary to account for the Partnership’s allocable share of income, gain, loss and deduction of the lower tier partnership that relate to the contributed Adjusted Property in a manner that is consistent with the purpose of this Section 6.1(d)(xii).

(xiii) Special Curative Allocation in Event of Liquidation Prior to End of Subordination Period. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1 (other than the Required Allocations), if the Liquidation Date occurs prior to the conversion of the last Outstanding Subordinated Unit, then items of income, gain, loss and deduction for the taxable period that includes the Liquidation Date (and, if necessary, items arising in previous taxable periods to the extent the General Partner determines such items may be so allocated), shall be specially allocated among the Partners in the manner determined appropriate by the General Partner so as to cause, to the maximum extent possible, the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit to equal the amount such Capital Account would have been if all prior allocations of Net Termination Gain and Net Termination Loss had been made pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(i) or Section 6.1(c)(ii), as applicable.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-39


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 6.2  Allocations for Tax Purposes.

(a) Except as otherwise provided herein, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, each item of income, gain, loss and deduction shall be allocated among the Partners in the same manner as its correlative item of “book” income, gain, loss or deduction is allocated pursuant to Section 6.1.

(b) In an attempt to eliminate Book-Tax Disparities attributable to a Contributed Property or Adjusted Property, items of income, gain, loss, depreciation, amortization and cost recovery deductions shall be allocated for U.S. federal income tax purposes among the Partners in the manner provided under Section 704(c) of the Code, and the Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 704(b) and 704(c) of the Code, as determined appropriate by the General Partner (taking into account the General Partner’s discretion under Section 6.1(d)(x)(D)); provided, that the General Partner shall apply the principles of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-3(d) in all events.

(c) The General Partner may determine to depreciate or amortize the portion of an adjustment under Section 743(b) of the Code attributable to unrealized appreciation in any Adjusted Property (to the extent of the unamortized Book-Tax Disparity) using a predetermined rate derived from the depreciation or amortization method and useful life applied to the unamortized Book-Tax Disparity of such property, despite any inconsistency of such approach with Treasury Regulation Section 1.167(c)-l(a)(6) or any successor regulations thereto. If the General Partner determines that such reporting position cannot reasonably be taken, the General Partner may adopt depreciation and amortization conventions under which all purchasers acquiring Limited Partner Interests in the same month would receive depreciation and amortization deductions, based upon the same applicable rate as if they had purchased a direct interest in the Partnership’s property. If the General Partner chooses not to utilize such aggregate method, the General Partner may use any other depreciation and amortization conventions to preserve the uniformity of the intrinsic tax characteristics of any Limited Partner Interests, so long as such conventions would not have a material adverse effect on the Limited Partners or the Record Holders of any class or classes of Limited Partner Interests.

(d) In accordance with Treasury Regulation Sections 1.1245-1(e) and 1.1250-1(f), any gain allocated to the Partners upon the sale or other taxable disposition of any Partnership asset shall, to the extent possible, after taking into account other required allocations of gain pursuant to this Section 6.2, be characterized as Recapture Income in the same proportions and to the same extent as such Partners (or their predecessors in interest) have been allocated any deductions directly or indirectly giving rise to the treatment of such gains as Recapture Income.

(e) All items of income, gain, loss, deduction and credit recognized by the Partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and allocated to the Partners in accordance with the provisions hereof shall be determined without regard to any election under Section 754 of the Code that may be made by the Partnership; provided, however, that such allocations, once made, shall be adjusted (in the manner determined by the General Partner) to take into account those adjustments permitted or required by Sections 734 and 743 of the Code.

(f) Each item of Partnership income, gain, loss and deduction shall, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, be determined for each taxable period and prorated on a monthly basis and shall be allocated to the Partners as of the opening of the National Securities Exchange on which Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading on the first Business Day of each month; provided, however, such items for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of the month in which the Over-Allotment Option is exercised in full or the expiration of the Over-Allotment Option occurs shall be allocated to the Partners as of the opening of the National Securities Exchange on which Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading on the first Business Day of the next succeeding month; and provided, further, that gain or loss on a sale or other disposition of any assets of the Partnership or any other extraordinary item of income, gain, loss or deduction as determined by the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-40


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

General Partner, shall be allocated to the Partners as of the opening of the National Securities Exchange on which Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading on the first Business Day of the month in which such item is recognized for federal income tax purposes. The General Partner may revise, alter or otherwise modify such methods of allocation to the extent permitted or required by Section 706 of the Code and the regulations or rulings promulgated thereunder.

(g) Allocations that would otherwise be made to a Limited Partner under the provisions of this Article VI shall instead be made to the beneficial owner of Limited Partner Interests held by a nominee in any case in which the nominee has furnished the identity of such owner to the Partnership in accordance with Section 6031(c) of the Code or any other method determined by the General Partner.

Section 6.3  Distributions; Characterization of Distributions; Distributions to Record Holders.

(a) The General Partner may adopt a cash distribution policy, which it may change from time to time without amendment to this Agreement. Distributions will be made as and when declared by the General Partner.

(b) All amounts of cash and cash equivalents distributed by the Partnership on any date from any source shall be deemed to be Operating Surplus until the sum of all amounts of cash and cash equivalents theretofore distributed by the Partnership to the Partners pursuant to Section 6.4 equals the Operating Surplus from the Closing Date through the close of the immediately preceding Quarter. Any remaining amounts of cash and cash equivalents distributed by the Partnership on such date shall, except as otherwise provided in Section 6.5, be deemed to be “Capital Surplus.” All distributions required to be made under this Agreement or otherwise made by the Partnership shall be made subject to Sections 17-607 and 17-804 of the Delaware Act.

(c) Notwithstanding Section 6.3(b), in the event of the dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership, all Partnership assets shall be applied and distributed solely in accordance with, and subject to the terms and conditions of, Section 12.4.

(d) Each distribution in respect of a Partnership Interest shall be paid by the Partnership, directly or through any Transfer Agent or through any other Person or agent, only to the Record Holder of such Partnership Interest as of the Record Date set for such distribution. Such payment shall constitute full payment and satisfaction of the Partnership’s liability in respect of such payment, regardless of any claim of any Person who may have an interest in such payment by reason of an assignment or otherwise.

Section 6.4  Distributions from Operating Surplus.

(a) During Subordination Period. Cash and cash equivalents distributed in respect of any Quarter wholly within the Subordination Period that is deemed to be Operating Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.3 or 6.5 shall be distributed as follows:

(i) First, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

(ii) Second, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage existing with respect to such Quarter;

(iii) Third, to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-41


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(iv) Fourth, to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the First Target Distribution over the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

(v) Fifth, (A) 15% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 85% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Second Target Distribution over the First Target Distribution for such Quarter;

(vi) Sixth, (A) 25% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 75% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Third Target Distribution over the Second Target Distribution for such Quarter; and

(vii) Thereafter, 50% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 50% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata;

provided, however, if the Target Distributions have been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.6(a), the distribution of cash and cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus with respect to any Quarter will be made solely in accordance with Section 6.4(a)(vii).

(b) After Subordination Period. Cash and cash equivalents distributed in respect of any Quarter ending after the Subordination Period has ended that is deemed to be Operating Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.3 or Section 6.5 shall be distributed as follows:

(i) First, to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

(ii) Second, to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the First Target Distribution over the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

(iii) Third, (A) 15% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 85% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Second Target Distribution over the First Target Distribution for such Quarter;

(iv) Fourth, (A) 25% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 75% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Third Target Distribution over the Second Target Distribution for such Quarter; and

(v) Thereafter, (A) 50% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 50% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata;

provided, however, if the Target Distributions have been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.6(a), the distribution of cash or cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus with respect to any Quarter will be made solely in accordance with Section 6.4(b)(v).

Section 6.5  Distributions from Capital Surplus.

Cash and cash equivalents that are distributed and deemed to be Capital Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.3(b) shall be distributed, unless the provisions of Section 6.3 require otherwise:

(a) First, 100% to the Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Minimum Quarterly Distribution has been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.6(a);

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-42


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(b) Second, 100% to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage; and

(c) Thereafter, all cash and cash equivalents that are distributed shall be distributed as if it were Operating Surplus and shall be distributed in accordance with Section 6.4.

Section 6.6  Adjustment of Target Distribution Levels.

(a) The Target Distributions, Common Unit Arrearages and Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages shall be proportionately adjusted in the event of any distribution, combination or subdivision (whether effected by a distribution payable in Units or otherwise) of Units or other Partnership Interests. In the event of a distribution of cash or cash equivalents that is deemed to be from Capital Surplus, the then applicable Target Distributions shall be reduced in the same proportion that the distribution had to the fair market value of the Common Units immediately prior to the announcement of the distribution. If the Common Units are publicly traded on a National Securities Exchange, the fair market value will be the Current Market Price before the ex-dividend date. If the Common Units are not publicly traded, the fair market value will be determined by the Board of Directors.

(b) The Target Distributions shall also be subject to adjustment pursuant to Section 5.11 and Section 6.9.

Section 6.7  Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Subordinated Units.

(a) Except with respect to the right to vote on or approve matters requiring the vote or approval of a percentage of the holders of Outstanding Common Units and the right to participate in allocations of income, gain, loss and deduction and distributions made with respect to Common Units, the holder of a Subordinated Unit shall have all of the rights and obligations of a Unitholder holding Common Units hereunder; provided, however, that immediately upon the conversion of Subordinated Units into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7, the Unitholder holding Subordinated Units shall possess all of the rights and obligations of a Unitholder holding Common Units hereunder with respect to such converted Subordinated Units, including the right to vote as a Common Unitholder and the right to participate in allocations of income, gain, loss and deduction and distributions made with respect to Common Units; provided, however, that such converted Subordinated Units shall remain subject to the provisions of Section 5.5(c)(ii), Section 6.1(d)(x), and Section 6.7(b) and (c).

(b) A Unitholder shall not be permitted to transfer a Subordinated Unit or a Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit pursuant to Section 5.7 (other than a transfer to an Affiliate) if the remaining balance in the transferring Unitholder’s Capital Account with respect to the retained Subordinated Units or retained converted Subordinated Units would be negative after giving effect to the allocation under Section 5.5(c)(ii)(B).

(c) The Unitholder holding a Common Unit that has resulted from the conversion of a Subordinated Unit pursuant to Section 5.7 shall not be issued a Common Unit Certificate pursuant to Section 4.1, if the Common Units are evidenced by Certificates, and shall not be permitted to transfer such Common Unit to a Person that is not an Affiliate of the holder until such time as the General Partner determines, based on advice of counsel, that each such Common Unit should have, as a substantive matter, like intrinsic economic and federal income tax characteristics, in all material respects, to the intrinsic economic and federal income tax characteristics of an Initial Common Unit. In connection with the condition imposed by this Section 6.7(c), the General Partner may take whatever steps are required to provide economic uniformity to such Common Units in preparation for a transfer of such Common Units, including the application of Sections 5.5(c)(ii), 6.1(d)(x) and 6.7(b); provided, however, that no such steps may be taken that would have a material adverse effect on the Unitholders holding a Common Unit.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-43


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 6.8  Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of IDR Reset Common Units.

(a) A Unitholder shall not be permitted to transfer an IDR Reset Common Unit (other than a transfer to an Affiliate) if the remaining balance in the transferring Unitholder’s Capital Account with respect to the retained IDR Reset Common Units would be negative after giving effect to the allocation under Section 5.5(c)(iii).

(b) A Unitholder holding an IDR Reset Common Unit shall not be permitted to transfer such Common Unit to a Person that is not an Affiliate of the holder until such time as the General Partner determines, based on advice of counsel, that upon transfer each such Common Unit should have, as a substantive matter, like intrinsic economic and U.S. federal income tax characteristics to the transferee, in all material respects, to the intrinsic economic and U.S. federal income tax characteristics of an Initial Common Unit to such transferee. In connection with the condition imposed by this Section 6.8(b), the General Partner may apply Sections 5.5(c)(iii), 6.1(d)(x) and 6.8(a) or, to the extent not resulting in a material adverse effect on the Unitholders holding Common Units, take whatever steps are required to provide economic uniformity to such Common Units in preparation for a transfer of such IDR Reset Common Units.

Section 6.9  Entity-Level Taxation.

If legislation is enacted or the official interpretation of existing legislation is modified by a governmental authority, which after giving effect to such enactment or modification, results in a Group Member becoming subject to federal, state or local or non-U.S. income or withholding taxes in excess of the amount of such taxes due from the Group Member prior to such enactment or modification (including, for the avoidance of doubt, any increase in the rate of such taxation applicable to the Group Member), then the General Partner may, in its sole discretion, reduce the Target Distributions by the amount of income or withholding taxes that are payable by reason of any such new legislation or interpretation (the “Incremental Income Taxes”), or any portion thereof selected by the General Partner, in the manner provided in this Section 6.9. If the General Partner elects to reduce the Target Distributions for any Quarter with respect to all or a portion of any Incremental Income Taxes, the General Partner shall estimate for such Quarter the Partnership Group’s aggregate liability (the “Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount”) for all (or the relevant portion of) such Incremental Income Taxes; provided that any difference between such estimate and the actual liability for Incremental Income Taxes (or the relevant portion thereof) for such Quarter may, to the extent determined by the General Partner, be taken into account in determining the Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount with respect to each Quarter in which any such difference can be determined. For each such Quarter, the Target Distributions, shall be the product obtained by multiplying (a) the amounts therefor that are set out herein prior to the application of this Section 6.9 times (b) the quotient obtained by dividing (i) cash and cash equivalents with respect to such Quarter by (ii) the sum of cash and cash equivalents with respect to such Quarter and the Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount for such Quarter, as determined by the General Partner. For purposes of the foregoing, cash and cash equivalents with respect to a Quarter will be deemed reduced by the Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount for that Quarter.

ARTICLE VII

MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS

Section 7.1  Management.

(a) The General Partner shall conduct, direct and manage all activities of the Partnership. Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, but without limitation on the ability of the General Partner to delegate its rights and power to other Persons, all management powers over the business and affairs of the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-44


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Partnership shall be exclusively vested in the General Partner, and no other Partner shall have any management power over the business and affairs of the Partnership. In addition to the powers now or hereafter granted to a general partner of a limited partnership under applicable law or that are granted to the General Partner under any other provision of this Agreement, the General Partner, subject to Section 7.4, shall have full power and authority to do all things and on such terms as it determines to be necessary or appropriate to conduct the business of the Partnership, to exercise all powers set forth in Section 2.5 and to effectuate the purposes set forth in Section 2.4, including the following:

(i) the making of any expenditures, the lending or borrowing of money, the assumption or guarantee of, or other contracting for, indebtedness and other liabilities, the issuance of evidences of indebtedness, including indebtedness that is convertible or exchangeable into Partnership Interests, and the incurring of any other obligations;

(ii) the making of tax, regulatory and other filings, or rendering of periodic or other reports to governmental or other agencies having jurisdiction over the business or assets of the Partnership;

(iii) the acquisition, disposition, mortgage, pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or exchange of any or all of the assets of the Partnership or the merger or other combination of the Partnership with or into another Person (the matters described in this clause (iii) being subject, however, to any prior approval that may be required by Section 7.4 or Article XIV);

(iv) the use of the assets of the Partnership (including cash on hand) for any purpose consistent with the terms of this Agreement, including the financing of the conduct of the operations of the Partnership Group; the lending of funds to other Persons (including other Group Members); the repayment or guarantee of obligations of any Group Member; and the making of capital contributions to any Group Member;

(v) the negotiation, execution and performance of any contracts, conveyances or other instruments (including instruments that limit the liability of the Partnership under contractual arrangements to all or particular assets of the Partnership, with the other party to the contract to have no recourse against the General Partner or its assets other than its interest in the Partnership, even if the same results in the terms of the transaction being less favorable to the Partnership than would otherwise be the case);

(vi) the distribution of cash or cash equivalents by the Partnership;

(vii) the selection, employment, retention and dismissal of employees (including employees having titles such as “president,” “vice president,” “secretary” and “treasurer”) and agents, outside attorneys, accountants, consultants and contractors of the General Partner or the Partnership Group and the determination of their compensation and other terms of employment or hiring;

(viii) the maintenance of insurance for the benefit of the Partnership Group, the Partners and Indemnitees;

(ix) the formation of, or acquisition of an interest in, and the contribution of property and the making of loans to, any further limited or general partnerships, joint ventures, corporations, limited liability companies or other Persons (including the acquisition of interests in, and the contributions of property to, any Group Member from time to time);

(x) the control of any matters affecting the rights and obligations of the Partnership, including the bringing and defending of actions at law or in equity and otherwise engaging in the conduct of litigation, arbitration or mediation and the incurring of legal expense and the settlement of claims and litigation;

(xi) the indemnification of any Person against liabilities and contingencies to the extent permitted by law;

(xii) the entering into of listing agreements with any National Securities Exchange and the delisting of some or all of the Limited Partner Interests from, or requesting that trading be suspended on, any such exchange;

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-45


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(xiii) the purchase, sale or other acquisition or disposition of Partnership Interests, or the issuance of Derivative Instruments;

(xiv) the undertaking of any action in connection with the Partnership’s participation in the management of any Group Member; and

(xv) the entering into of agreements with any of its Affiliates to render services to a Group Member or to itself in the discharge of its duties as General Partner of the Partnership.

(b) Each of the Partners and each other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person who is otherwise bound by this Agreement hereby (i) approves, ratifies and confirms the execution, delivery and performance by the parties thereto of this Agreement, the Underwriting Agreement, the Contribution Agreement and the other agreements described in or filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement that are related to the transactions contemplated by the Registration Statement (in the case of each agreement other than this Agreement, without giving effect to any amendments, supplements or restatements after the date hereof); (ii) agrees that the General Partner (on its own behalf or on behalf of the Partnership) is authorized to execute, deliver and perform the agreements referred to in clause (i) of this sentence and the other agreements, acts, transactions and matters described in or contemplated by the Registration Statement on behalf of the Partnership without any further act, approval or vote of the Partners, the other Persons who acquire a Partnership Interest and the Persons who are otherwise bound by this Agreement; and (iii) agrees that the execution, delivery or performance by the General Partner, any Group Member or any Affiliate of any of them of this Agreement or any agreement authorized or permitted under this Agreement (including the exercise by the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner of the rights accorded pursuant to Article XV) shall not constitute a breach by the General Partner of any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise that the General Partner may owe the Partnership, the Limited Partners, the other Persons who acquire a Partnership Interest or the Persons who are otherwise bound by this Agreement.

(c) As used in the following provisions of this Article VII other than Section 7.12, the term Partnership Interest shall include any Derivative Instruments.

Section 7.2  Replacement of Fiduciary Duties.

Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, to the extent that any provision of this Agreement purports or is interpreted (a) to have the effect of replacing, restricting or eliminating the duties that might otherwise, as a result of Delaware or other applicable law, be owed by the General Partner or any other Indemnitee to the Partnership, the Limited Partners, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement, or (b) to constitute a waiver or consent by the Partnership, the Limited Partners, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement to any such replacement or restriction, such provision shall be deemed to have been approved by the Partnership, all the Partners, each other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person who is bound by this Agreement.

Section 7.3  Certificate of Limited Partnership.

The General Partner has caused the Certificate of Limited Partnership to be filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as required by the Delaware Act. The General Partner shall use all reasonable efforts to cause to be filed such other certificates or documents that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate for the formation, continuation, qualification and operation of a limited partnership (or a partnership in which the limited partners have limited liability) in the State of Delaware or any other state in which the Partnership may elect to do business or own property. To the extent the General Partner determines such action to be necessary or appropriate, the General Partner shall file amendments to and restatements of the Certificate of

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-46


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Limited Partnership and do all things to maintain the Partnership as a limited partnership (or a partnership or other entity in which the limited partners have limited liability) under the laws of the State of Delaware or of any other state in which the Partnership may elect to do business or own property. Subject to the terms of Section 3.4(a), the General Partner shall not be required, before or after filing, to deliver or mail a copy of the Certificate of Limited Partnership, any qualification document or any amendment thereto to any Partner.

Section 7.4  Restrictions on the General Partner’s Authority.

Except as provided in Article XII and Article XIV, the General Partner may not sell, exchange or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group, taken as a whole, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions without the approval of a Unit Majority; provided, however, that this provision shall not preclude or limit the General Partner’s ability to mortgage, pledge, hypothecate or grant a security interest in all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group and shall not apply to any forced sale of any or all of the assets of the Partnership Group pursuant to the foreclosure of, or other realization upon, any such encumbrance.

Section 7.5  Reimbursement of the General Partner.

(a) The General Partner shall be reimbursed on a monthly basis, or such other basis as the General Partner may determine, for (i) all direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on behalf of the Partnership Group (including salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to any Person (including Affiliates of the General Partner) to perform services for the Partnership Group or for the General Partner in the discharge of its duties to the Partnership Group), and (ii) all other expenses allocable to the Partnership Group or otherwise incurred by the General Partner in connection with operating the Partnership Group’s business (including expenses allocated to the General Partner by its Affiliates). The General Partner shall determine the expenses that are allocable to the General Partner or any member of the Partnership Group. Reimbursements pursuant to this Section 7.5 shall be in addition to any reimbursement to the General Partner as a result of indemnification pursuant to Section 7.7. The General Partner and its Affiliates may charge any member of the Partnership Group a management fee to the extent necessary to allow the Partnership Group to reduce the amount of any state franchise or income tax or any tax based upon revenues or gross margin of any member of the Partnership Group if the tax benefit produced by the payment for such management fee exceeds the amount of such fee.

(b) The General Partner, without the approval of the Limited Partners (who shall have no right to vote in respect thereof), may propose and adopt on behalf of the Partnership benefit plans, programs and practices (including plans, programs and practices involving the issuance of Partnership Interests), or cause the Partnership to issue Partnership Interests in connection with, or pursuant to, any benefit plan, program or practice maintained or sponsored by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, in each case for the benefit of employees, officers, consultants and directors of the General Partner or its Affiliates, in respect of services performed, directly or indirectly, for the benefit of the Partnership Group. The Partnership agrees to issue and sell to the General Partner or any of its Affiliates any Partnership Interests that the General Partner or such Affiliates are obligated to provide to any employees, officers, consultants and directors pursuant to any such benefit plans, programs or practices. Expenses incurred by the General Partner in connection with any such plans, programs and practices (including the net cost to the General Partner or such Affiliates of Partnership Interests purchased by the General Partner or such Affiliates, from the Partnership or otherwise, to fulfill awards under such plans, programs and practices) shall be reimbursed in accordance with Section 7.5(a). Any and all obligations of the General Partner under any benefit plans, programs or practices adopted by the General Partner as permitted by this Section 7.5(b) shall constitute obligations of the General Partner hereunder and shall be assumed by any successor General Partner approved pursuant to Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 or the transferee of or successor to all of the General Partner’s General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-47


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 7.6  Outside Activities.

(a) The General Partner, for so long as it is the General Partner of the Partnership shall not engage in any business or activity or incur any debts or liabilities except in connection with or incidental to (i) its performance as general partner or managing member, if any, of one or more Group Members or as described in or contemplated by the Registration Statement, (ii) the acquiring, owning or disposing of debt securities or equity interests in any Group Member or (iii) the direct or indirect provision of management, advisory, and administrative services to its Affiliates or to other Persons.

(b) Each Unrestricted Person (other than the General Partner) shall have the right to engage in businesses of every type and description and other activities for profit and to engage in and possess an interest in other business ventures of any and every type or description, whether in businesses engaged in or anticipated to be engaged in by any Group Member, independently or with others, including business interests and activities in direct competition with the business and activities of any Group Member. No such business interest or activity shall constitute a breach of this Agreement, any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise, or obligation of any type whatsoever to the Partnership or other Group Member, any Partner, any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any Person who is otherwise bound by this Agreement.

(c) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the doctrine of corporate opportunity, or any analogous doctrine, shall not apply to any Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner). No Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner) who acquires knowledge of a potential transaction, agreement, arrangement or other matter that may be an opportunity for the Partnership, shall have any duty to communicate or offer such opportunity to any Group Member, and such Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner) shall not be liable to the Partnership or any other Group Member, any Partner any person who acquires a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is otherwise bound by this Agreement for breach of any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise by reason of the fact that such Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner) pursues or acquires such opportunity for itself, directs such opportunity to another Person or does not communicate such opportunity or information to any Group Member.

(d) The General Partner and each of its Affiliates may acquire Units or other Partnership Interests in addition to those acquired on the Closing Date and, except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, shall be entitled to exercise, at their option, all rights relating to all Units or other Partnership Interests acquired by them. The term “Affiliates” when used in this Section 7.6(d) with respect to the General Partner shall not include any Group Member.

Section 7.7  Indemnification.

(a) To the fullest extent permitted by law, all Indemnitees shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Partnership from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all threatened pending or completed claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, and whether formal or informal and including appeals, in which any Indemnitee may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, by reason of its status as an Indemnitee and acting (or refraining to act) in such capacity; provided, that the Indemnitee shall not be indemnified and held harmless if there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Agreement, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee’s conduct was unlawful. Any indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7 shall be made only out of the assets of the Partnership, it being agreed that the General Partner shall not be personally liable for such indemnification and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Partnership to enable it to effectuate such indemnification.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-48


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(b) To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses (including legal fees and expenses) incurred by an Indemnitee who is indemnified pursuant to Section 7.7(a) in appearing at, participating in or defending any claim, demand, action, suit or proceeding shall, from time to time, be advanced by the Partnership prior to a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7, the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified upon receipt by the Partnership of any undertaking by or on behalf of the Indemnitee to repay such amount if it shall be ultimately determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized by this Section 7.7.

(c) The indemnification provided by this Section 7.7 shall be in addition to any other rights to which an Indemnitee may be entitled under any agreement, pursuant to any vote of the holders of Outstanding Limited Partner Interests, as a matter of law, in equity or otherwise, both as to actions in the Indemnitee’s capacity as an Indemnitee and as to actions in any other capacity, and shall continue as to an Indemnitee who has ceased to serve in such capacity and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, successors, assigns and administrators of the Indemnitee.

(d) The Partnership may purchase and maintain (or reimburse the General Partner or its Affiliates for the cost of) insurance, on behalf of an Indemnitee and such other Persons as the General Partner shall determine, against any liability that may be asserted against, or expense that may be incurred by, such Indemnitee in connection with the Partnership’s activities or such Indemnitee’s activities on behalf of the Partnership, regardless of whether the Partnership would have the power to indemnify such Indemnitee against such liability under the provisions of this Agreement.

(e) For purposes of this Section 7.7, the Partnership shall be deemed to have requested an Indemnitee to serve as fiduciary of an employee benefit plan whenever the performance by it of its duties to the Partnership also imposes duties on, or otherwise involves services by, it to the plan or participants or beneficiaries of the plan; excise taxes assessed on an Indemnitee with respect to an employee benefit plan pursuant to applicable law shall constitute “fines” within the meaning of Section 7.7(a); and action taken or omitted by an Indemnitee with respect to any employee benefit plan in the performance of its duties for a purpose reasonably believed by it to be in the best interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plan shall be deemed to be for a purpose that is in the best interests of the Partnership.

(f) In no event may an Indemnitee subject the Limited Partners to personal liability by reason of the indemnification provisions set forth in this Agreement.

(g) An Indemnitee shall not be denied indemnification in whole or in part under this Section 7.7 because the Indemnitee had an interest in the transaction with respect to which the indemnification applies if the transaction was otherwise permitted by the terms of this Agreement.

(h) The provisions of this Section 7.7 are for the benefit of the Indemnitees and their heirs, successors, assigns, executors and administrators and shall not be deemed to create any rights for the benefit of any other Persons.

(i) No amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 7.7 or any provision hereof shall in any manner terminate, reduce or impair the right of any past, present or future Indemnitee to be indemnified by the Partnership, nor the obligations of the Partnership to indemnify any such Indemnitee under and in accordance with the provisions of this Section 7.7 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-49


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 7.8  Liability of Indemnitees.

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement, no Indemnitee shall be liable for monetary damages to the Partnership, the Partners or any other Persons who have acquired interests in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement, for losses sustained or liabilities incurred as a result of any act or omission of an Indemnitee unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter in question, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee’s conduct was criminal. In the case where an Indemnitee is liable for damages, those damages shall only be direct damages and shall not include punitive damages, consequential damages or lost profits.

(b) The General Partner may exercise any of the powers granted to it by this Agreement and perform any of the duties imposed upon it hereunder either directly or by or through its agents, and the General Partner shall not be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of any such agent appointed by the General Partner in good faith.

(c) To the extent that, at law or in equity, an Indemnitee has duties (including fiduciary duties) and liabilities relating thereto to the Partnership, the Partners, any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement, the General Partner and any other Indemnitee acting in connection with the Partnership’s business or affairs shall not be liable, to the fullest extent permitted by law, to the Partnership, the Partners, any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement, for its reliance on the provisions of this Agreement.

(d) Any amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 7.8 or any provision hereof shall be prospective only and shall not in any way affect the limitations on the liability of the Indemnitees under this Section 7.8 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

Section 7.9  Standards of Conduct and Modification of Duties.

(a) Whenever the General Partner, the Board of Directors or any committee of the Board of Directors (including the Conflicts Committee), makes a determination or takes or declines to take any other action, or any Affiliates of the General Partner cause the General Partner to do so, in its capacity as the general partner of the Partnership as opposed to in its individual capacity, whether under this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or otherwise, then, unless another express standard is provided for in this Agreement, the General Partner, the Board of Directors, such committee or such Affiliates causing the General Partner to do so, shall make such determination or take or decline to take such other action in good faith and shall not be subject to any higher standard contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. A determination, other action or failure to act by the General Partner, the Board of Directors of the General Partner or any committee thereof (including the Conflicts Committee) will be deemed to be in good faith unless the General Partner, the Board of Directors of the General Partner or any committee thereof (including the Conflicts Committee) believed such determination, other action or failure to act was adverse to the interests of the Partnership. In any proceeding brought by the Partnership, any Limited Partner, or any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement challenging such action, determination or failure to act, the Person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding shall have the burden of proving that such determination, action or failure to act was not in good faith.

(b) Whenever the General Partner makes a determination or takes or declines to take any other action, or any of its Affiliates causes it to do so, in its individual capacity as opposed to in its capacity as the general partner of

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-50


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

the Partnership, whether under this Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or otherwise, then the General Partner, or such Affiliates causing it to do so, are entitled, to the fullest extent permitted by law, to make such determination or to take or decline to take such other action free of any fiduciary duty or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership, any Limited Partner, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who otherwise is bound by this Agreement, and the General Partner, or such Affiliates causing it to do so, shall not, to the fullest extent permitted by law, be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. By way of illustration and not of limitation, whenever the phrases, “at the option of the General Partner,” “in its sole discretion” or some variation of those phrases, are used in this Agreement, it indicates that the General Partner is acting in its individual capacity. For the avoidance of doubt, whenever the General Partner votes or transfers its Partnership Interests, or refrains from voting or transferring its Partnership Interests, it shall be acting in its individual capacity.

(c) Whenever a potential conflict of interest exists or arises between the General Partner or any Affiliates, on the one hand, and the Partnership, any Group Member or any Partner, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement on the other hand, the General Partner may in its discretion submit any resolution or course of action with respect to such conflict of interest for (i) Special Approval or (ii) approval by the vote of a majority of the Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates). If such course of action or resolution receives Special Approval or approval of a majority of the Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates), then such course of action or resolution shall be conclusively deemed approved by the Partnership, all the Partners, each Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person who is bound by this Agreement, and shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement, of any Group Member Agreement, of any agreement contemplated herein or therein, or of any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise or obligation of any type whatsoever.

(d) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the General Partner and its Affiliates or any other Indemnitee shall have no duty or obligation, express or implied, to (i) sell or otherwise dispose of any asset of the Partnership Group other than in the ordinary course of business or (ii) permit any Group Member to use any facilities or assets of the General Partner and its Affiliates, except as may be provided in contracts entered into from time to time specifically dealing with such use. Any determination by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates to enter into such contracts shall be in its sole discretion.

(e) The Partners, each Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement hereby authorize the General Partner, on behalf of the Partnership as a partner or member of a Group Member, to approve actions by the general partner or managing member of such Group Member similar to those actions permitted to be taken by the General Partner pursuant to this Section 7.9.

Section 7.10  Other Matters Concerning the General Partner and Indemnitees.

(a) The General Partner and any other Indemnitee may rely upon, and shall be protected in acting or refraining from acting upon, any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, consent, order, bond, debenture or other paper or document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper party or parties.

(b) The General Partner and any other Indemnitee may consult with legal counsel, accountants, appraisers, management consultants, investment bankers and other consultants and advisers selected by it, and any act taken or omitted in reliance upon the advice or opinion (including an Opinion of Counsel) of such Persons as to matters that the General Partner reasonably believes to be within such Person’s professional or expert competence shall

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-51


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

be conclusively presumed to have been done or omitted in good faith and in accordance with such advice or opinion.

(c) The General Partner shall have the right, in respect of any of its powers or obligations hereunder, to act through any of its duly authorized officers, a duly appointed attorney or attorneys-in-fact or the duly authorized officers of any Group Member.

Section 7.11  Purchase or Sale of Partnership Interests.

The General Partner may cause the Partnership to purchase or otherwise acquire Partnership Interests. As long as Partnership Interests are held by any Group Member, such Partnership Interests shall not be considered Outstanding for any purpose, except as otherwise provided herein. The General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner may also purchase or otherwise acquire and sell or otherwise dispose of Partnership Interests for its own account, subject to the provisions of Articles IV and X.

Section 7.12  Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates.

(a) If (i) the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner (including for purposes of this Section 7.12, any Person that is an Affiliate of the General Partner at the date hereof notwithstanding that it may later cease to be an Affiliate of the General Partner) holds Partnership Interests that it desires to sell and (ii) Rule 144 of the Securities Act (or any successor rule or regulation to Rule 144) or another exemption from registration is not available to enable such holder of Partnership Interests (the “Holder”) to dispose of the number of Partnership Interests it desires to sell at the time it desires to do so without registration under the Securities Act, then at the option and upon the request of the Holder, the Partnership shall file with the Commission as promptly as practicable after receiving such request, and use all commercially reasonable efforts to cause to become effective and remain effective for a period of not less than six months following its effective date or such shorter period as shall terminate when all Partnership Interests covered by such registration statement have been sold, a registration statement under the Securities Act registering the offering and sale of the number of Partnership Interests specified by the Holder; provided, however, that the Partnership shall not be required to effect more than three registrations pursuant to this Section 7.12(a); and provided further, however, that if the General Partner determines that a postponement of the requested registration would be in the best interests of the Partnership and its Partners due to a pending transaction, investigation or other event, the filing of such registration statement or the effectiveness thereof may be deferred for up to six months, but not thereafter. In connection with any registration pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence, the Partnership shall (i) promptly prepare and file (A) such documents as may be necessary to register or qualify the securities subject to such registration under the securities laws of such states as the Holder shall reasonably request; provided, however, that no such qualification shall be required in any jurisdiction where, as a result thereof, the Partnership would become subject to general service of process or to taxation or qualification to do business as a foreign corporation or partnership doing business in such jurisdiction solely as a result of such registration, and (B) such documents as may be necessary to apply for listing or to list the Partnership Interests subject to such registration on such National Securities Exchange as the Holder shall reasonably request, and (ii) do any and all other acts and things that may be necessary or appropriate to enable the Holder to consummate a public sale of such Partnership Interests in such states. Except as set forth in Section 7.12(c), all costs and expenses of any such registration and offering (other than the underwriting discounts and commissions) shall be paid by the Partnership, without reimbursement by the Holder.

(b) If the Partnership shall at any time propose to file a registration statement under the Securities Act for an offering of Partnership Interests for cash (other than an offering relating solely to a benefit plan), the Partnership shall use all commercially reasonable efforts to include such number or amount of Partnership Interests held by any Holder in such registration statement as the Holder shall request; provided, that the Partnership is not required to make any effort or take any action to so include the Partnership Interests of the Holder once the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-52


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

registration statement becomes or is declared effective by the Commission, including any registration statement providing for the offering from time to time of Partnership Interests pursuant to Rule 415 of the Securities Act. If the proposed offering pursuant to this Section 7.12(b) shall be an underwritten offering, then, in the event that the managing underwriter or managing underwriters of such offering advise the Partnership and the Holder that in their opinion the inclusion of all or some of the Holder’s Partnership Interests would adversely and materially affect the timing or success of the offering, the Partnership shall include in such offering only that number or amount, if any, of Partnership Interests held by the Holder that, in the opinion of the managing underwriter or managing underwriters, will not so adversely and materially affect the offering. Except as set forth in Section 7.12(c), all costs and expenses of any such registration and offering (other than the underwriting discounts and commissions) shall be paid by the Partnership, without reimbursement by the Holder.

(c) If underwriters are engaged in connection with any registration referred to in this Section 7.12, the Partnership shall provide indemnification, representations, covenants, opinions and other assurance to the underwriters in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to such underwriters. Further, in addition to and not in limitation of the Partnership’s obligation under Section 7.7, the Partnership shall, to the fullest extent permitted by law, indemnify and hold harmless the Holder, its officers, directors and each Person who controls the Holder (within the meaning of the Securities Act) and any agent thereof (collectively, “Indemnified Persons”) from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, in which any Indemnified Person may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, under the Securities Act or otherwise (hereinafter referred to in this Section 7.12(c) as a “claim” and in the plural as “claims”) based upon, arising out of or resulting from any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of any material fact contained in any registration statement under which any Partnership Interests were registered under the Securities Act or any state securities or Blue Sky laws, in any preliminary prospectus (if used prior to the effective date of such registration statement), or in any summary or final prospectus or issuer free writing prospectus or in any amendment or supplement thereto (if used during the period the Partnership is required to keep the registration statement current), or arising out of, based upon or resulting from the omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements made therein not misleading; provided, however, that the Partnership shall not be liable to any Indemnified Person to the extent that any such claim arises out of, is based upon or results from an untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made in such registration statement, such preliminary, summary or final prospectus or free writing prospectus or such amendment or supplement, in reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Partnership by or on behalf of such Indemnified Person specifically for use in the preparation thereof.

(d) The provisions of Section 7.12(a) and Section 7.12(b) shall continue to be applicable with respect to the General Partner (and any of the General Partner’s Affiliates) after it ceases to be a general partner of the Partnership, during a period of two years subsequent to the effective date of such cessation and for so long thereafter as is required for the Holder to sell all of the Partnership Interests with respect to which it has requested during such two-year period inclusion in a registration statement otherwise filed or that a registration statement be filed; provided, however, that the Partnership shall not be required to file successive registration statements covering the same Partnership Interests for which registration was demanded during such two-year period. The provisions of Section 7.12(c) shall continue in effect thereafter.

(e) The rights to cause the Partnership to register Partnership Interests pursuant to this Section 7.12 may be assigned (but only with all related obligations) by a Holder to a transferee or assignee of such Partnership Interests, provided (i) the Partnership is, within a reasonable time after such transfer, furnished with written notice of the name and address of such transferee or assignee and the Partnership Interests with respect to which such registration rights are being assigned; and (ii) such transferee or assignee agrees in writing to be bound by and subject to the terms set forth in this Section 7.12.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-53


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(f)  Any request to register Partnership Interests pursuant to this Section 7.12 shall (i) specify the Partnership Interests intended to be offered and sold by the Person making the request, (ii) express such Person’s present intent to offer such Partnership Interests for distribution, (iii) describe the nature or method of the proposed offer and sale of Partnership Interests, and (iv) contain the undertaking of such Person to provide all such information and materials and take all action as may be required in order to permit the Partnership to comply with all applicable requirements in connection with the registration of such Partnership Interests.

Section 7.13  Reliance by Third Parties.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, any Person dealing with the Partnership shall be entitled to assume that the General Partner and any officer of the General Partner authorized by the General Partner to act on behalf of and in the name of the Partnership has full power and authority to encumber, sell or otherwise use in any manner any and all assets of the Partnership and to enter into any authorized contracts on behalf of the Partnership, and such Person shall be entitled to deal with the General Partner or any such officer as if it were the Partnership’s sole party in interest, both legally and beneficially. Each Limited Partner hereby waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, any and all defenses or other remedies that may be available against such Person to contest, negate or disaffirm any action of the General Partner or any such officer in connection with any such dealing. In no event shall any Person dealing with the General Partner or any such officer or its representatives be obligated to ascertain that the terms of this Agreement have been complied with or to inquire into the necessity or expedience of any act or action of the General Partner or any such officer or its representatives. Each and every certificate, document or other instrument executed on behalf of the Partnership by the General Partner or its representatives shall be conclusive evidence in favor of any and every

Person relying thereon or claiming thereunder that (a) at the time of the execution and delivery of such certificate, document or instrument, this Agreement was in full force and effect, (b) the Person executing and delivering such certificate, document or instrument was duly authorized and empowered to do so for and on behalf of the Partnership and (c) such certificate, document or instrument was duly executed and delivered in accordance with the terms and provisions of this Agreement and is binding upon the Partnership.

ARTICLE VIII

BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS

Section 8.1  Records and Accounting.

The General Partner shall keep or cause to be kept at the principal office of the Partnership appropriate books and records with respect to the Partnership’s business, including all books and records necessary to provide to the Limited Partners any information required to be provided pursuant to Section 3.4(a). Any books and records maintained by or on behalf of the Partnership in the regular course of its business, including the record of the Record Holders of Units or other Partnership Interests, books of account and records of Partnership proceedings, may be kept on, or be in the form of, computer disks, hard drives, magnetic tape, photographs, micrographics or any other information storage device; provided, that the books and records so maintained are convertible into clearly legible written form within a reasonable period of time. The books of the Partnership shall be maintained, for financial reporting purposes, on an accrual basis in accordance with U.S. GAAP. The Partnership shall not be required to keep books maintained on a cash basis and the General Partner shall be permitted to calculate cash-based measures, including Operating Surplus and Adjusted Operating Surplus, by making such adjustments to its accrual basis books to account for non-cash items and other adjustments as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-54


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 8.2  Fiscal Year.

The fiscal year of the Partnership shall be a fiscal year ending December 31.

Section 8.3  Reports.

(a) As soon as practicable, but in no event later than 105 days after the close of each fiscal year of the Partnership, the General Partner shall cause to be mailed or made available, by any reasonable means, to each Record Holder of a Unit or other Partnership Interest as of a date selected by the General Partner, an annual report containing financial statements of the Partnership for such fiscal year of the Partnership, presented in accordance with U.S. GAAP, including a balance sheet and statements of operations, Partnership equity and cash flows, such statements to be audited by a firm of independent public accountants selected by the General Partner, and such other information as may be required by applicable law, regulation or rule of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, or as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

(b) As soon as practicable, but in no event later than 50 days after the close of each Quarter except the last Quarter of each fiscal year, the General Partner shall cause to be mailed or made available, by any reasonable means to each Record Holder of a Unit or other Partnership Interest, as of a date selected by the General Partner, a report containing unaudited financial statements of the Partnership and such other information as may be required by applicable law, regulation or rule of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, or as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

(c) The General Partner shall be deemed to have made a report available to each Record Holder as required by this Section 8.3 if it has either (i) filed such report with the Commission via its Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system and such report is publicly available on such system or (ii) made such report available on any publicly available website maintained by the Partnership.

ARTICLE IX

TAX MATTERS

Section 9.1  Tax Returns and Information.

The Partnership shall timely file all returns of the Partnership that are required for federal, state and local income tax purposes on the basis of the accrual method and the taxable period or year that it is required by law to adopt, from time to time, as determined by the General Partner. In the event the Partnership is required to use a taxable period other than a year ending on December 31, the General Partner shall use reasonable efforts to change the taxable period of the Partnership to a year ending on December 31. The tax information reasonably required by Record Holders for federal, state and local income tax reporting purposes with respect to a taxable period shall be furnished to them within 90 days of the close of the calendar year in which the Partnership’s taxable period ends. The classification, realization and recognition of income, gain, losses and deductions and other items shall be on the accrual method of accounting for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Section 9.2  Tax Elections.

(a) The Partnership shall make the election under Section 754 of the Code in accordance with applicable regulations thereunder, subject to the reservation of the right to seek to revoke any such election upon the General Partner’s determination that such revocation is in the best interests of the Limited Partners.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-55


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Notwithstanding any other provision herein contained, for the purposes of computing the adjustments under Section 743(b) of the Code, the General Partner shall be authorized (but not required) to adopt a convention whereby the price paid by a transferee of a Limited Partner Interest will be deemed to be the lowest quoted closing price of the Limited Partner Interests on any National Securities Exchange on which such Limited Partner Interests are listed or admitted to trading during the calendar month in which such transfer is deemed to occur pursuant to Section 6.2(f) without regard to the actual price paid by such transferee.

(b) Except as otherwise provided herein, the General Partner shall determine whether the Partnership should make any other elections permitted by the Code.

Section 9.3  Tax Controversies.

Subject to the provisions hereof, the General Partner is designated as the Tax Matters Partner (as defined in the Code) and is authorized and required to represent the Partnership (at the Partnership’s expense) in connection with all examinations of the Partnership’s affairs by tax authorities, including resulting administrative and judicial proceedings, and to expend Partnership funds for professional services and costs associated therewith. Each Partner agrees to cooperate with the General Partner and to do or refrain from doing any or all things reasonably required by the General Partner to conduct such proceedings.

Section 9.4  Withholding; Tax Payments.

(a) The General Partner may treat taxes paid by the Partnership on behalf of, all or less than all of the Partners, either as a distribution of cash to such Partners or as a general expense of the Partnership, as determined appropriate under the circumstances by the General Partner.

(b) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, the General Partner is authorized to take any action that may be required to cause the Partnership and other Group Members to comply with any withholding requirements established under the Code or any other federal, state or local law including pursuant to Sections 1441, 1442, 1445 and 1446 of the Code. To the extent that the Partnership is required or elects to withhold and pay over to any taxing authority any amount resulting from the allocation or distribution of income or from a distribution to any Partner (including by reason of Section 1446 of the Code), the General Partner may treat the amount withheld as a distribution of cash pursuant to Section 6.3 in the amount of such withholding from such Partner.

ARTICLE X

ADMISSION OF PARTNERS

Section 10.1  Admission of Limited Partners.

(a) A Person shall be admitted as a Limited Partner and shall become bound by the terms of this Agreement if such Person purchases or otherwise lawfully acquires any Limited Partner Interest and becomes the Record Holder of such Limited Partner Interests in accordance with the provisions of Article IV or Article V hereof. Upon the issuance by the Partnership of Common Units, Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights to the Organizational Limited Partner as described in Article V, such parties will be automatically admitted to the Partnership as Initial Limited Partners in respect of the Common Units, Subordinated Units or Incentive Distribution Rights issued to them.

(b) By acceptance of the transfer of any Limited Partner Interests in accordance with Article IV or the acceptance of any Limited Partner Interests issued pursuant to Article V or pursuant to a merger or consolidation

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-56


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

or conversion pursuant to Article XIV, and except as provided in Section 4.8, each transferee of, or other such Person acquiring, a Limited Partner Interest (including any nominee holder or an agent or representative acquiring such Limited Partner Interests for the account of another Person) (i) shall be admitted to the Partnership as a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interests so transferred or issued to such Person when any such transfer or admission is reflected in the books and records of the Partnership and such Limited Partner becomes the Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interests so transferred, (ii) shall become bound, and shall be deemed to have agreed to be bound, by the terms of this Agreement, (iii) represents that the transferee or other recipient has the capacity, power and authority to enter into this Agreement and (iv) makes the consents, acknowledgements and waivers contained in this Agreement, all with or without execution of this Agreement by such Person. The transfer of any Limited Partner Interests and the admission of any new Limited Partner shall not constitute an amendment to this Agreement. A Person may become a Limited Partner or Record Holder of a Limited Partner Interest without the consent or approval of any of the Partners. A Person may not become a Limited Partner without acquiring a Limited Partner Interest and until such Person is reflected in the books and records of the Partnership as the Record Holder of such Limited Partner Interest. The rights and obligations of a Person who is an Ineligible Holder shall be determined in accordance with Section 4.8.

(c) The name and mailing address of each Record Holder shall be listed on the books and records of the Partnership maintained for such purpose by the Partnership or the Transfer Agent. The General Partner shall update the books and records of the Partnership from time to time as necessary to reflect accurately the information therein (or shall cause the Transfer Agent to do so, as applicable). A Limited Partner Interest may be represented by a Certificate, as provided in Section 4.1.

(d) Any transfer of a Limited Partner Interest shall not entitle the transferee to share in the profits and losses, to receive distributions, to receive allocations of income, gain, loss, deduction or credit or any similar item or to any other rights to which the transferor was entitled until the transferee becomes a Limited Partner pursuant to Section 10.1(b).

Section 10.2  Admission of Successor General Partner.

A successor General Partner approved pursuant to Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 or the transferee of or successor to all of the General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6 who is proposed to be admitted as a successor General Partner shall be admitted to the Partnership as the General Partner, effective immediately prior to the withdrawal or removal of the predecessor or transferring General Partner, pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2 or the transfer of the General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6, provided, however, that no such successor shall be admitted to the Partnership until compliance with the terms of Section 4.6 has occurred and such successor has executed and delivered such other documents or instruments as may be required to effect such admission. Any such successor shall, subject to the terms hereof, carry on the business of the members of the Partnership Group without dissolution.

Section 10.3  Amendment of Agreement and Certificate of Limited Partnership.

To effect the admission to the Partnership of any Partner, the General Partner shall take all steps necessary or appropriate under the Delaware Act to amend the records of the Partnership to reflect such admission and, if necessary, to prepare as soon as practicable an amendment to this Agreement and, if required by law, the General Partner shall prepare and file an amendment to the Certificate of Limited Partnership.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-57


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

ARTICLE XI

WITHDRAWAL OR REMOVAL OF PARTNERS

Section 11.1  Withdrawal of the General Partner.

(a) The General Partner shall be deemed to have withdrawn from the Partnership upon the occurrence of any one of the following events (each such event herein referred to as an “Event of Withdrawal”);

(i) The General Partner voluntarily withdraws from the Partnership by giving written notice to the other Partners;

(ii) The General Partner transfers all of its General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6;

(iii) The General Partner is removed pursuant to Section 11.2;

(iv) The General Partner (A) makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors; (B) files a voluntary bankruptcy petition for relief under Chapter 7 of the United States Bankruptcy Code; (C) files a petition or answer seeking for itself a liquidation, dissolution or similar relief (but not a reorganization) under any law; (D) files an answer or other pleading admitting or failing to contest the material allegations of a petition filed against the General Partner in a proceeding of the type described in clauses (A)-(C) of this Section 11.1(a)(iv); or (E) seeks, consents to or acquiesces in the appointment of a trustee (but not a debtor-in-possession), receiver or liquidator of the General Partner or of all or any substantial part of its properties;

(v) A final and non-appealable order of relief under Chapter 7 of the United States Bankruptcy Code is entered by a court with appropriate jurisdiction pursuant to a voluntary or involuntary petition by or against the General Partner; or

(vi) (A) if the General Partner is a corporation, a certificate of dissolution or its equivalent is filed for the General Partner, or 90 days expire after the date of notice to the General Partner of revocation of its charter without a reinstatement of its charter, under the laws of its state of incorporation; (B) if the General Partner is a partnership or a limited liability company, the dissolution and commencement of winding up of the General Partner; (C) if the General Partner is acting in such capacity by virtue of being a trustee of a trust, the termination of the trust; (D) if the General Partner is a natural person, his death or adjudication of incompetency; and (E) otherwise upon the termination of the General Partner.

If an Event of Withdrawal specified in Section 11.1(a)(iv), (v) or (vi)(A), (B), (C) or (E) occurs, the withdrawing General Partner shall give notice to the Limited Partners within 30 days after such occurrence. The Partners hereby agree that only the Events of Withdrawal described in this Section 11.1 shall result in the withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership.

(b) Withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership upon the occurrence of an Event of Withdrawal shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement under the following circumstances: (i) at any time during the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending at 11:59 pm, prevailing Central Time, on [June 30], 2022, the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days’ advance notice of its intention to withdraw to the Limited Partners; provided, that prior to the effective date of such withdrawal, the withdrawal is approved by Unitholders holding at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates) and the General Partner delivers to the Partnership an Opinion of Counsel (“Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel”) that such withdrawal (following the selection of the successor General Partner) would not result in the loss of the limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause any Group Member to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed); (ii) at any time after

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-58


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

11:59 pm, prevailing Central Time, on [June 30], 2022, the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days’ advance notice to the Unitholders, such withdrawal to take effect on the date specified in such notice; (iii) at any time that the General Partner ceases to be the General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(ii) or is removed pursuant to Section 11.2; or (iv) notwithstanding clause (i) of this sentence, at any time that the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days’ advance notice of its intention to withdraw to the Limited Partners, such withdrawal to take effect on the date specified in the notice, if at the time such notice is given one Person and its Affiliates (other than the General Partner and its Affiliates) own beneficially or of record or control at least 50% of the Outstanding Units. The withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership upon the occurrence of an Event of Withdrawal shall also constitute the withdrawal of the General Partner as general partner or managing member, if any, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members. If the General Partner gives a notice of withdrawal pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(i), a Unit Majority, may, prior to the effective date of such withdrawal, elect a successor General Partner. The Person so elected as successor General Partner shall automatically become the successor general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. If, prior to the effective date of the General Partner’s withdrawal pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(i), a successor is not selected by the Unitholders as provided herein or the Partnership does not receive a Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel, the Partnership shall be dissolved in accordance with Section 12.1 unless the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2. Any successor General Partner elected in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.1 shall be subject to the provisions of Section 10.2.

Section 11.2  Removal of the General Partner.

The General Partner may be removed if such removal is approved by the Unitholders holding at least 66 2/3% of the Outstanding Units (including Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates) voting as a single class. Any such action by such holders for removal of the General Partner must also provide for the election of a successor General Partner by the Unitholders holding a majority of the Outstanding Common Units, voting as a class, and a majority of the Outstanding Subordinated Units, voting as a class (including, in each case, Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates). Such removal shall be effective immediately following the admission of a successor General Partner pursuant to Section 10.2. The removal of the General Partner shall also automatically constitute the removal of the General Partner as general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. If a Person is elected as a successor General Partner in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.2, such Person shall, upon admission pursuant to Section 10.2, automatically become a successor general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. The right of the holders of Outstanding Units to remove the General Partner shall not exist or be exercised unless the Partnership has received an opinion opining as to the matters covered by a Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel. Any successor General Partner elected in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.2 shall be subject to the provisions of Section 10.2.

Section 11.3  Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner.

(a) In the event of (i) withdrawal of the General Partner under circumstances where such withdrawal does not violate this Agreement or (ii) removal of the General Partner by the holders of Outstanding Units under circumstances where Cause does not exist, if the successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or Section 11.2, the Departing General Partner shall have the option, exercisable prior to the effective date of the withdrawal or removal of such Departing General Partner, to require its successor to purchase its General Partner Interest and its or its Affiliates’ general partner interest (or equivalent interest), if any, in the other Group Members and all of its or its Affiliates’ Incentive Distribution Rights (collectively, the “Combined Interest”) in exchange for an amount in cash equal to the fair market value of such Combined Interest, such amount to be determined and payable as of the effective date of its withdrawal or removal. If the General Partner is removed by the Unitholders under circumstances where Cause exists or if the General Partner

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-59


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

withdraws under circumstances where such withdrawal violates this Agreement, and if a successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 (or if the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2 and the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner), such successor shall have the option, exercisable prior to the effective date of the withdrawal or removal of such Departing General Partner (or, in the event the business of the Partnership is continued, prior to the date the business of the Partnership is continued), to purchase the Combined Interest for such fair market value of such Combined Interest. In either event, the Departing General Partner shall be entitled to receive all reimbursements due such Departing General Partner pursuant to Section 7.5, including any employee-related liabilities (including severance liabilities), incurred in connection with the termination of any employees employed by the Departing General Partner or its Affiliates (other than any Group Member) for the benefit of the Partnership or the other Group Members.

For purposes of this Section 11.3(a), the fair market value of the Combined Interest shall be determined by agreement between the Departing General Partner and its successor or, failing agreement within 30 days after the effective date of such Departing General Partner’s withdrawal or removal, by an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert selected by the Departing General Partner and its successor, which, in turn, may rely on other experts, and the determination of which shall be conclusive as to such matter. If such parties cannot agree upon one independent investment banking firm or other independent expert within 45 days after the effective date of such withdrawal or removal, then the Departing General Partner shall designate an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert, the Departing General Partner’s successor shall designate an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert, and such firms or experts shall mutually select a third independent investment banking firm or independent expert, which third independent investment banking firm or other independent expert shall determine the fair market value of the Combined Interest. In making its determination, such third independent investment banking firm or other independent expert may consider the value of the Units, including the then current trading price of Units on any National Securities Exchange on which Units are then listed or admitted to trading, the value of the Partnership’s assets, the rights and obligations of the Departing General Partner, the value of the Incentive Distribution Rights and the General Partner Interest and other factors it may deem relevant.

(b) If the Combined Interest is not purchased in the manner set forth in Section 11.3(a), the Departing General Partner (and its Affiliates, if applicable) shall become a Limited Partner and the Combined Interest shall be converted into Common Units pursuant to a valuation made by an investment banking firm or other independent expert selected pursuant to Section 11.3(a), without reduction in such Partnership Interest (but subject to proportionate dilution by reason of the admission of its successor). Any successor General Partner shall indemnify the Departing General Partner as to all debts and liabilities of the Partnership arising on or after the date on which the Departing General Partner becomes a Limited Partner. For purposes of this Agreement, conversion of the Combined Interest to Common Units will be characterized as if the Departing General Partner (and its Affiliates, if applicable) contributed the Combined Interest to the Partnership in exchange for the newly issued Common Units.

(c) If a successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 (or if the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2 and the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner) and the option described in Section 11.3(a) is not exercised by the party entitled to do so, the successor General Partner shall, at the effective date of its admission to the Partnership, contribute to the Partnership cash in the amount equal to the product of (x) the quotient obtained by dividing (A) the Percentage Interest of the General Partner Interest of the Departing General Partner by (B) a percentage equal to 100% less the Percentage Interest of the General Partner Interest of the Departing General Partner and (y) the Net Agreed Value of the Partnership’s assets on such date. In such event, such successor General Partner shall, subject to the following sentence, be entitled to its Percentage Interest of all Partnership allocations and distributions to which the Departing General Partner was entitled. In addition, the successor General Partner shall

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-60


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

cause this Agreement to be amended to reflect that, from and after the date of such successor General Partner’s admission, the successor General Partner’s interest in all Partnership distributions and allocations shall be its Percentage Interest.

Section 11.4  Termination of Subordination Period, Conversion of Subordinated Units and Extinguishment of Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages.

Notwithstanding any provision of this Agreement, if the General Partner is removed as general partner of the Partnership under circumstances where Cause does not exist:

(a) the Subordinated Units held by any Person will immediately and automatically convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis, provided (i) neither such Person nor any of its Affiliates voted any of its Units in favor of the removal and (ii) such Person is not an Affiliate of the successor General Partner; and

(b) if all of the Subordinated Units convert into Common Units pursuant to Section 11.4(a), all Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages on the Common Units will be extinguished and the Subordination Period will end;

provided, however, that such converted Subordinated Units shall remain subject to the provisions of Section 5.5(c)(ii), Section 6.1(d)(x), Section 6.7(b) and Section 6.7(c).

Section 11.5  Withdrawal of Limited Partners.

No Limited Partner shall have any right to withdraw from the Partnership; provided, however, that when a transferee of a Limited Partner’s Limited Partner Interest becomes a Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interest so transferred, such transferring Limited Partner shall cease to be a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interest so transferred.

ARTICLE XII

DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION

Section 12.1  Dissolution.

The Partnership shall not be dissolved by the admission of additional Limited Partners or by the admission of a successor General Partner in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. Upon the removal or withdrawal of the General Partner, if a successor General Partner is elected pursuant to Section 11.1, Section 11.2 or Section 12.2, the Partnership shall not be dissolved and such successor General Partner is hereby authorized to, and shall, continue the business of the Partnership. Subject to Section 12.2, the Partnership shall dissolve, and its affairs shall be wound up, upon:

(a) an Event of Withdrawal of the General Partner as provided in Section 11.1(a) (other than Section 11.1(a)(ii)), unless a successor is elected and such successor is admitted to the Partnership pursuant to this Agreement;

(b) an election to dissolve the Partnership by the General Partner that is approved by a Unit Majority;

(c) the entry of a decree of judicial dissolution of the Partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Delaware Act; or

(d) at any time there are no Limited Partners, unless the Partnership is continued without dissolution in accordance with the Delaware Act.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-61


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 12.2  Continuation of the Business of the Partnership After Dissolution.

Upon (a) an Event of Withdrawal caused by the withdrawal or removal of the General Partner as provided in Section 11.1(a)(i) or (iii) and the failure of the Partners to select a successor to such Departing General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1 or Section 11.2, then within 90 days thereafter, or (b) an event constituting an Event of Withdrawal as defined in Section 11.1(a)(iv), (v) or (vi), then, to the maximum extent permitted by law, within 180 days thereafter, a Unit Majority may elect to continue the business of the Partnership on the same terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement by appointing as a successor General Partner a Person approved by a Unit Majority. Unless such an election is made within the applicable time period as set forth above, the Partnership shall conduct only activities necessary to wind up its affairs. If such an election is so made, then:

(i) the Partnership shall continue without dissolution unless earlier dissolved in accordance with this Article XII;

(ii) if the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner, then the interest of the former General Partner shall be treated in the manner provided in Section 11.3; and

(iii) the successor General Partner shall be admitted to the Partnership as General Partner, effective as of the Event of Withdrawal, by agreeing in writing to be bound by this Agreement; provided, that the right of a Unit Majority to approve a successor General Partner and to continue the business of the Partnership shall not exist and may not be exercised unless the Partnership has received an Opinion of Counsel that (x) the exercise of the right would not result in the loss of limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner and (y) neither the Partnership nor any Group Member would be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise be taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon the exercise of such right to continue (to the extent not already so treated or taxed).

Section 12.3  Liquidator.

Upon dissolution of the Partnership, unless the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2, the General Partner shall select one or more Persons to act as Liquidator. The Liquidator (if other than the General Partner) shall be entitled to receive such compensation for its services as may be approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units, voting as a single class. The Liquidator (if other than the General Partner) shall agree not to resign at any time without 15 days’ prior notice and may be removed at any time, with or without cause, by notice of removal approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units, voting as a single class. Upon dissolution, removal or resignation of the Liquidator, a successor and substitute Liquidator (who shall have and succeed to all rights, powers and duties of the original Liquidator) shall within 30 days thereafter be approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units, voting as a single class. The right to approve a successor or substitute Liquidator in the manner provided herein shall be deemed to refer also to any such successor or substitute Liquidator approved in the manner herein provided. Except as expressly provided in this Article XII, the Liquidator approved in the manner provided herein shall have and may exercise, without further authorization or consent of any of the parties hereto, all of the powers conferred upon the General Partner under the terms of this Agreement (but subject to all of the applicable limitations, contractual and otherwise, upon the exercise of such powers, other than the limitation on sale set forth in Section 7.4) necessary or appropriate to carry out the duties and functions of the Liquidator hereunder for and during the period of time required to complete the winding up and liquidation of the Partnership as provided for herein.

Section 12.4  Liquidation.

The Liquidator shall proceed to dispose of the assets of the Partnership, discharge its liabilities, and otherwise wind up its affairs in such manner and over such period as determined by the Liquidator, subject to Section 17-804 of the Delaware Act and the following:

(a) The assets may be disposed of by public or private sale or by distribution in kind to one or more Partners on such terms as the Liquidator and such Partner or Partners may agree. If any property is distributed in kind, the

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-62


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Partner receiving the property shall be deemed for purposes of Section 12.4(c) to have received cash equal to its fair market value; and contemporaneously therewith, appropriate cash distributions must be made to the other Partners. The Liquidator may defer liquidation or distribution of the Partnership’s assets for a reasonable time if it determines that an immediate sale or distribution of all or some of the Partnership’s assets would be impractical or would cause undue loss to the Partners. The Liquidator may distribute the Partnership’s assets, in whole or in part, in kind if it determines that a sale would be impractical or would cause undue loss to the Partners.

(b) Liabilities of the Partnership include amounts owed to the Liquidator as compensation for serving in such capacity (subject to the terms of Section 12.3) and amounts to Partners otherwise than in respect of their distribution rights under Article VI. With respect to any liability that is contingent, conditional or unmatured or is otherwise not yet due and payable, the Liquidator shall either settle such claim for such amount as it thinks appropriate or establish a reserve of cash or other assets to provide for its payment. When paid, any unused portion of the reserve shall be distributed as additional liquidation proceeds.

(c) All property and all cash in excess of that required to discharge liabilities as provided in Section 12.4(b) shall be distributed to the Partners in accordance with, and to the extent of, the positive balances in their respective Capital Accounts, as determined after taking into account all Capital Account adjustments (other than those made by reason of distributions pursuant to this Section 12.4(c)) for the taxable period of the Partnership during which the liquidation of the Partnership occurs (with such date of occurrence being determined pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(g)), and such distribution shall be made by the end of such taxable period (or, if later, within 90 days after said date of such occurrence).

Section 12.5  Cancellation of Certificate of Limited Partnership.

Upon the completion of the distribution of Partnership cash and property as provided in Section 12.4 in connection with the liquidation of the Partnership, the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all qualifications of the Partnership as a foreign limited partnership in jurisdictions other than the State of Delaware shall be canceled and such other actions as may be necessary to terminate the Partnership shall be taken.

Section 12.6  Return of Contributions.

The General Partner shall not be personally liable for, and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Partnership to enable it to effectuate, the return of the Capital Contributions of the Limited Partners or Unitholders, or any portion thereof, it being expressly understood that any such return shall be made solely from Partnership assets.

Section 12.7  Waiver of Partition.

To the maximum extent permitted by law, each Partner hereby waives any right to partition of the Partnership property.

Section 12.8  Capital Account Restoration.

No Limited Partner shall have any obligation to restore any negative balance in its Capital Account upon liquidation of the Partnership. The General Partner shall be obligated to restore any negative balance in its Capital Account upon liquidation of its interest in the Partnership by the end of the taxable period of the Partnership during which such liquidation occurs, or, if later, within 90 days after the date of such liquidation.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-63


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

ARTICLE XIII

AMENDMENT OF PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT; MEETINGS; RECORD DATE

Section 13.1  Amendments to be Adopted Solely by the General Partner.

Each Partner agrees that the General Partner, without the approval of any Partner, may amend any provision of this Agreement and execute, swear to, acknowledge, deliver, file and record whatever documents may be required in connection therewith, to reflect:

(a) a change in the name of the Partnership, the location of the principal place of business of the Partnership, the registered agent of the Partnership or the registered office of the Partnership;

(b) admission, substitution, withdrawal or removal of Partners in accordance with this Agreement;

(c) a change that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to qualify or continue the qualification of the Partnership as a limited partnership or a partnership in which the Limited Partners have limited liability under the laws of any state or to ensure that the Group Members will not be treated as associations taxable as corporations or otherwise taxed as entities for U.S. federal income tax purposes;

(d) a change that the General Partner determines (i) does not adversely affect the Limited Partners (including any particular class of Partnership Interests as compared to other classes of Partnership Interests) in any material respect, (ii) to be necessary or appropriate to (A) satisfy any requirements, conditions or guidelines contained in any opinion, directive, order, ruling or regulation of any federal or state agency or judicial authority or contained in any federal or state statute (including the Delaware Act) or (B) facilitate the trading of the Units (including the division of any class or classes of Outstanding Units into different classes to facilitate uniformity of tax consequences within such classes of Units) or comply with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are or will be listed or admitted to trading, (iii) to be necessary or appropriate in connection with action taken by the General Partner pursuant to Section 5.9 or (iv) is required to effect the intent expressed in the Registration Statement or the intent of the provisions of this Agreement or is otherwise contemplated by this Agreement;

(e) a change in the fiscal year or taxable period of the Partnership and any other changes that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate as a result of a change in the fiscal year or taxable period of the Partnership including, if the General Partner shall so determine, a change in the definition of “Quarter” and the dates on which distributions are to be made by the Partnership;

(f) an amendment that is necessary, in the Opinion of Counsel, to prevent the Partnership, or the General Partner or its directors, officers, trustees or agents from in any manner being subjected to the provisions of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended, or “plan asset” regulations adopted under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, regardless of whether such are substantially similar to plan asset regulations currently applied or proposed by the United States Department of Labor;

(g) an amendment that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with the creation, authorization or issuance of any class or series of Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments pursuant to Section 5.6;

(h) any amendment expressly permitted in this Agreement to be made by the General Partner acting alone;

(i) an amendment effected, necessitated or contemplated by a Merger Agreement approved in accordance with Section 14.3;

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-64


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(j) an amendment that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect and account for the formation by the Partnership of, or investment by the Partnership in, any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other entity, in connection with the conduct by the Partnership of activities permitted by the terms of Section 2.4 or Section 7.1(a);

(k) a merger, conveyance or conversion pursuant to Section 14.3(d); or

(l) any other amendments substantially similar to the foregoing.

Section 13.2  Amendment Procedures.

Amendments to this Agreement may be proposed only by the General Partner. To the fullest extent permitted by law, the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to propose or approve any amendment to this Agreement and may decline to do so in its sole discretion, and, in declining to propose or approve an amendment, to the fullest extent permitted by law shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. An amendment shall be effective upon its approval by the General Partner and, except as otherwise provided by Section 13.1 or 13.3, a Unit Majority, unless a greater or different percentage is required under this Agreement or by Delaware law. Each proposed amendment that requires the approval of the holders of a specified percentage of Outstanding Units shall be set forth in a writing that contains the text of the proposed amendment. If such an amendment is proposed, the General Partner shall seek the written approval of the requisite percentage of Outstanding Units or call a meeting of the Unitholders to consider and vote on such proposed amendment. The General Partner shall notify all Record Holders upon final adoption of any amendments. The General Partner shall be deemed to have notified all Record Holders as required by this Section 13.2 if it has either (i) filed such amendment with the Commission via its Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system and such amendment is publicly available on such system or (ii) made such amendment available on any publicly available website maintained by the Partnership

Section 13.3  Amendment Requirements.

(a) Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 13.1 and Section 13.2, no provision of this Agreement (other than Section 11.2 or Section 13.4) that establishes a percentage of Outstanding Units (including Units deemed owned by the General Partner) or requires a vote or approval of Partners (or a subset of Partners) holding a specified Percentage Interest required to take any action shall be amended, altered, changed, repealed or rescinded in any respect that would have the effect of reducing or increasing such percentage, unless such amendment is approved by the written consent or the affirmative vote of holders of Outstanding Units whose aggregate Outstanding Units constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced or increased, as applicable, or the affirmative vote of Partners whose aggregate Percentage Interests constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced or increased, as applicable.

(b) Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 13.1 and Section 13.2, no amendment to this Agreement may (i) enlarge the obligations of (including requiring any holder of a class of Partnership Interests to make additional Capital Contributions to the Partnership) any Limited Partner without its consent, unless such shall be deemed to have occurred as a result of an amendment approved pursuant to Section 13.3(c), or (ii) enlarge the obligations of, restrict, change or modify in any way any action by or rights of, or reduce in any way the amounts distributable, reimbursable or otherwise payable to, the General Partner or any of its Affiliates without its consent, which consent may be given or withheld at its option.

(c) Except as provided in Section 14.3 or Section 13.1, any amendment that would have a material adverse effect on the rights or preferences of any class of Partnership Interests in relation to other classes of Partnership

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-65


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Interests must be approved by the holders of not less than a majority of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of the class affected. If the General Partner determines an amendment does not satisfy the requirements of Section 13.1(d)(i) because it adversely affects one or more classes of Partnership Interests, as compared to other classes of Partnership Interests, in any material respect, such amendment shall only be required to be approved by the adversely affected class or classes.

(d) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, except for amendments pursuant to Section 13.1 and except as otherwise provided by Section 14.3(b), no amendments shall become effective without the approval of the holders of at least 90% of the Percentage Interests of all Limited Partners voting as a single class unless the Partnership obtains an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that such amendment will not affect the limited liability of any Limited Partner under applicable partnership law of the state under whose laws the Partnership is organized.

(e) Except as provided in Section 13.1, this Section 13.3 shall only be amended with the approval of Partners (including the General Partner and its Affiliates) holding at least 90% of the Percentage Interests of all Limited Partners.

Section 13.4  Special Meetings.

All acts of Limited Partners to be taken pursuant to this Agreement shall be taken in the manner provided in this Article XIII. Special meetings of the Limited Partners may be called by the General Partner or by Limited Partners owning 20% or more of the Outstanding Units of the class or classes for which a meeting is proposed. Limited Partners shall call a special meeting by delivering to the General Partner one or more requests in writing stating that the signing Limited Partners wish to call a special meeting and indicating the general or specific purposes for which the special meeting is to be called. Within 60 days after receipt of such a call from Limited Partners or within such greater time as may be reasonably necessary for the Partnership to comply with any statutes, rules, regulations, listing agreements or similar requirements governing the holding of a meeting or the solicitation of proxies for use at such a meeting, the General Partner shall send a notice of the meeting to the Limited Partners either directly or indirectly through the Transfer Agent. A meeting shall be held at a time and place determined by the General Partner on a date not less than 10 days nor more than 60 days after the time notice of the meeting is given as provided in Section 16.1. Limited Partners shall not vote on matters that would cause the Limited Partners to be deemed to be taking part in the management and control of the business and affairs of the Partnership so as to jeopardize the Limited Partners’ limited liability under the Delaware Act or the law of any other state in which the Partnership is qualified to do business.

Section 13.5  Notice of a Meeting.

Notice of a meeting called pursuant to Section 13.4 shall be given to the Record Holders of the class or classes of Units for which a meeting is proposed in writing by mail or other means of written communication in accordance with Section 16.1. The notice shall be deemed to have been given at the time when deposited in the mail or sent by other means of written communication.

Section 13.6  Record Date.

For purposes of determining the Limited Partners entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of the Limited Partners or to give approvals without a meeting as provided in Section 13.11 the General Partner may set a Record Date, which shall not be less than 10 nor more than 60 days before (a) the date of the meeting (unless such requirement conflicts with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading or U.S. federal securities laws, in which case the rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of such National Securities Exchange or U.S. federal securities laws shall govern) or (b) in the event that approvals are sought without a meeting, the date by which Limited Partners

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-66


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

are requested in writing by the General Partner to give such approvals. If the General Partner does not set a Record Date, then (a) the Record Date for determining the Limited Partners entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of the Limited Partners shall be the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which notice is given, and (b) the Record Date for determining the Limited Partners entitled to give approvals without a meeting shall be the date the first written approval is deposited with the Partnership in care of the General Partner in accordance with Section 13.11.

Section 13.7  Adjournment.

When a meeting is adjourned to another time or place, notice need not be given of the adjourned meeting and a new Record Date need not be fixed, if the time and place thereof are announced at the meeting at which the adjournment is taken, unless such adjournment shall be for more than 45 days. At the adjourned meeting, the Partnership may transact any business which might have been transacted at the original meeting. If the adjournment is for more than 45 days or if a new Record Date is fixed for the adjourned meeting, a notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given in accordance with this Article XIII.

Section 13.8  Waiver of Notice; Approval of Meeting; Approval of Minutes.

The transaction of business at any meeting of Limited Partners, however called and noticed, and whenever held, shall be as valid as if it had occurred at a meeting duly held after regular call and notice, if a quorum is present either in person or by proxy. Attendance of a Limited Partner at a meeting shall constitute a waiver of notice of the meeting, except when the Limited Partner attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or convened; and except that attendance at a meeting is not a waiver of any right to disapprove the consideration of matters required to be included in the notice of the meeting, but not so included, if the disapproval is expressly made at the meeting.

Section 13.9  Quorum and Voting.

The holders of a majority, by Percentage Interest, of Partnership Interests of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called (including Partnership Interests deemed owned by the General Partner) represented in person or by proxy shall constitute a quorum at a meeting of Partners of such class or classes unless any such action by the Partners requires approval by holders of a greater Percentage Interest, in which case the quorum shall be such greater Percentage Interest. At any meeting of the Partners duly called and held in accordance with this Agreement at which a quorum is present, the act of Partners holding Partnership Interests that, in the aggregate, represent a majority of the Percentage Interest of those present in person or by proxy at such meeting shall be deemed to constitute the act of all Partners, unless a greater or different percentage is required with respect to such action under the provisions of this Agreement, in which case the act of the Partners holding Partnership Interests that in the aggregate represent at least such greater or different percentage shall be required; provided, however, that if, as a matter of law or amendment to this Agreement, approval by plurality vote of Partners (or any class thereof) is required to approve any action, no minimum quorum shall be required. The Partners present at a duly called or held meeting at which a quorum is present may continue to transact business until adjournment, notwithstanding the withdrawal of enough Partners to leave less than a quorum, if any action taken (other than adjournment) is approved by Partners holding the required Percentage Interest specified in this Agreement. In the absence of a quorum any meeting of Partners may be adjourned from time to time by the affirmative vote of Partners with at least a majority, by Percentage Interest, of the Partnership Interests entitled to vote at such meeting (including Partnership Interests deemed owned by the General Partner) represented either in person or by proxy, but no other business may be transacted, except as provided in Section 13.7.

Section 13.10  Conduct of a Meeting.

The General Partner shall have full power and authority concerning the manner of conducting any meeting of the Limited Partners or solicitation of approvals in writing, including the determination of Persons entitled to

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-67


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

vote, the existence of a quorum, the satisfaction of the requirements of Section 13.4, the conduct of voting, the validity and effect of any proxies and the determination of any controversies, votes or challenges arising in connection with or during the meeting or voting. The General Partner shall designate a Person to serve as chairman of any meeting and shall further designate a Person to take the minutes of any meeting. All minutes shall be kept with the records of the Partnership maintained by the General Partner. The General Partner may make such other regulations consistent with applicable law and this Agreement as it may deem advisable concerning the conduct of any meeting of the Limited Partners or solicitation of approvals in writing, including regulations in regard to the appointment of proxies, the appointment and duties of inspectors of votes and approvals, the submission and examination of proxies and other evidence of the right to vote, and the revocation of approvals in writing.

Section 13.11  Action Without a Meeting.

If authorized by the General Partner, any action that may be taken at a meeting of the Limited Partners may be taken without a meeting, without a vote and without prior notice, if an approval in writing setting forth the action so taken is signed by Limited Partners owning not less than the minimum percentage, by Percentage Interest, of the Partnership Interests of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called (including Partnership Interests deemed owned by the General Partner), as the case may be, that would be necessary to authorize or take such action at a meeting at which all the Limited Partners entitled to vote at such meeting were present and voted (unless such provision conflicts with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, in which case the rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of such National Securities Exchange shall govern). Prompt notice of the taking of action without a meeting shall be given to the Limited Partners who have not approved in writing. The General Partner may specify that any written ballot submitted to Limited Partners for the purpose of taking any action without a meeting shall be returned to the Partnership within the time period, which shall be not less than 20 days, specified by the General Partner. If a ballot returned to the Partnership does not vote all of the Units held by the Limited Partners, the Partnership shall be deemed to have failed to receive a ballot for the Units that were not voted. If approval of the taking of any action by the Limited Partners is solicited by any Person other than by or on behalf of the General Partner, the written approvals shall have no force and effect unless and until (a) they are deposited with the Partnership in care of the General Partner and (b) an Opinion of Counsel is delivered to the General Partner to the effect that the exercise of such right and the action proposed to be taken with respect to any particular matter (i) will not cause the Limited Partners to be deemed to be taking part in the management and control of the business and affairs of the Partnership so as to jeopardize the Limited Partners’ limited liability, and (ii) is otherwise permissible under the state statutes then governing the rights, duties and liabilities of the Partnership and the Partners. Nothing contained in this Section 13.11 shall be deemed to require the General Partner to solicit all Limited Partners in connection with a matter approved by the holders of the requisite percentage of Units acting by written consent without a meeting.

(a) Only those Record Holders of the Outstanding Units on the Record Date set pursuant to Section 13.6 shall be entitled to notice of, and to vote at, a meeting of Limited Partners or to act with respect to matters as to which the holders of the Outstanding Units have the right to vote or to act. All references in this Agreement to votes of, or other acts that may be taken by, the Outstanding Units shall be deemed to be references to the votes or acts of the Record Holders of such Outstanding Units.

(b) With respect to Units that are held for a Person’s account by another Person (such as a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation, or an agent of any of the foregoing), in whose name such Units are registered, such other Person shall, in exercising the voting rights in respect of such Units on any matter, and unless the arrangement between such Persons provides otherwise, vote such Units in favor of, and at the direction of, the Person who is the beneficial owner, and the Partnership shall be entitled to assume it is so acting without further inquiry. The provisions of this Section 13.12(b) (as well as all other provisions of this Agreement) are subject to the provisions of Section 4.3.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-68


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 13.12  Voting of Incentive Distribution Rights.

(a) For so long as a majority of the Incentive Distribution Rights are held by the General Partner and its Affiliates, the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights shall not be entitled to vote such Incentive Distribution Rights on any Partnership matter except as may otherwise be required by law and the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, in their capacity as such, shall be deemed to have approved any matter approved by the General Partner.

(b) If less than a majority of the Incentive Distribution Rights are held by the General Partner and its Affiliates, the Incentive Distribution Rights will be entitled to vote on all matters submitted to a vote of Unitholders, other than amendments and other matters that the General Partner determines do not adversely affect the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights as a whole in any material respect. On any matter in which the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights are entitled to vote, such holders will vote together with the Subordinated Units, prior to the end of the Subordination Period, or together with the Common Units, thereafter, in either case as a single class except as otherwise required by Section 13.3(c), and such Incentive Distribution Rights shall be treated in all respects as Subordinated Units or Common Units, as applicable, when sending notices of a meeting of Limited Partners to vote on any matter (unless otherwise required by law), calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes under this Agreement. The relative voting power of the Incentive Distribution Rights and the Subordinated Units or Common Units, as applicable, will be set in the same proportion as cumulative cash distributions, if any, in respect of the Incentive Distribution Rights for the four consecutive Quarters prior to the record date for the vote bears to the cumulative cash distributions in respect of such class of Units for such four Quarters.

(c) In connection with any equity financing, or anticipated equity financing, by the Partnership of an Expansion Capital Expenditure, the General Partner may, without the approval of the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, temporarily or permanently reduce the amount of Incentive Distributions that would otherwise be distributed to such holders, provided that in the judgment of the General Partner, such reduction will be in the long-term best interest of such holders.

ARTICLE XIV

MERGER OR CONSOLIDATION

Section 14.1  Authority.

The Partnership may merge or consolidate with or into one or more corporations, limited liability companies, statutory trusts or associations, real estate investment trusts, common law trusts or unincorporated businesses, including a partnership (whether general or limited (including a limited liability partnership)) or convert into any such entity, whether such entity is formed under the laws of the State of Delaware or any other state of the United States of America, pursuant to a written plan of merger or consolidation (“Merger Agreement”) in accordance with this Article XIV.

Section 14.2  Procedure for Merger or Consolidation.

(a)  Merger or consolidation of the Partnership pursuant to this Article XIV requires the prior consent of the General Partner, provided, however, that, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to consent to any merger or consolidation of the Partnership and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership, any Limited Partner and, in declining to consent to a merger or consolidation, shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-69


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(b) If the General Partner shall determine to consent to the merger or consolidation, the General Partner shall approve the Merger Agreement, which shall set forth:

(i) the name and jurisdiction of formation or organization of each of the business entities proposing to merge or consolidate;

(ii) the name and jurisdiction of formation or organization of the business entity that is to survive the proposed merger or consolidation (the “Surviving Business Entity”);

(iii) the terms and conditions of the proposed merger or consolidation;

(iv) the manner and basis of exchanging or converting the equity interests of each constituent business entity for, or into, cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity; and (i) if any interests, securities or rights of any constituent business entity are not to be exchanged or converted solely for, or into, cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity, then the cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of any general or limited partnership, corporation, trust, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other entity (other than the Surviving Business Entity) which the holders of such interests, securities or rights are to receive in exchange for, or upon conversion of their interests, securities or rights, and (ii) in the case of equity interests represented by certificates, upon the surrender of such certificates, which cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity or any general or limited partnership, corporation, trust, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other entity (other than the Surviving Business Entity), or evidences thereof, are to be delivered;

(v) a statement of any changes in the constituent documents or the adoption of new constituent documents (the articles or certificate of incorporation, articles of trust, declaration of trust, certificate or agreement of limited partnership, certificate of formation or limited liability company agreement or other similar charter or governing document) of the Surviving Business Entity to be effected by such merger or consolidation;

(vi) the effective time of the merger, which may be the date of the filing of the certificate of merger pursuant to Section 14.4 or a later date specified in or determinable in accordance with the Merger Agreement (provided, that if the effective time of the merger is to be later than the date of the filing of such certificate of merger, the effective time shall be fixed at a date or time certain and stated in the certificate of merger); and

(vii) such other provisions with respect to the proposed merger or consolidation that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

Section 14.3  Approval by Limited Partners.

(a) Except as provided in Section 14.3(d), the General Partner, upon its approval of the Merger Agreement shall direct that the Merger Agreement and the merger or consolidation contemplated thereby, as applicable, be submitted to a vote of Limited Partners, whether at a special meeting or by written consent, in either case in accordance with the requirements of Article XIII. A copy or a summary of the Merger Agreement, as the case may be, shall be included in or enclosed with the notice of a special meeting or the written consent.

(b) Except as provided in Sections 14.3(d) and 14.3(e), the Merger Agreement shall be approved upon receiving the affirmative vote or consent of the holders of a Unit Majority unless the Merger Agreement contains any provision that, if contained in an amendment to this Agreement, the provisions of this Agreement or the Delaware Act would require for its approval the vote or consent of a greater percentage of the Outstanding Units or of any class of Limited Partners, in which case such greater percentage vote or consent shall be required for approval of the Merger Agreement.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-70


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(c) Except as provided in Sections 14.3(d) and 14.3(e), after such approval by vote or consent of the Limited Partners, and at any time prior to the filing of the certificate of merger pursuant to Section 14.4, the merger or consolidation may be abandoned pursuant to provisions therefor, if any, set forth in the Merger Agreement.

(d) Notwithstanding anything else contained in this Article XIV or in this Agreement, the General Partner is permitted, without Limited Partner approval, to convert the Partnership or any Group Member into a new limited liability entity, to merge the Partnership or any Group Member into, or convey all of the Partnership’s assets to, another limited liability entity that shall be newly formed and shall have no assets, liabilities or operations at the time of such merger or conveyance other than those it receives from the Partnership or other Group Member if (i) the General Partner has received an Opinion of Counsel that the merger or conveyance, as the case may be, would not result in the loss of the limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause the Partnership or any Group Member to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already treated as such), (ii) the sole purpose of such merger, or conveyance is to effect a mere change in the legal form of the Partnership into another limited liability entity and (iii) the governing instruments of the new entity provide the Limited Partners and the General Partner with substantially the same rights and obligations as are herein contained.

(e) Additionally, notwithstanding anything else contained in this Article XIV or in this Agreement, the General Partner is permitted, without Limited Partner approval, to merge or consolidate the Partnership with or into another entity if (A) the General Partner has received an Opinion of Counsel that the merger or consolidation, as the case may be, would not result in the loss of the limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause the Partnership or any Group Member to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already treated as such), (B) the merger or consolidation would not result in an amendment to this Agreement, other than any amendments that could be adopted pursuant to Section 13.1, (C) the Partnership is the Surviving Business Entity in such merger or consolidation, (D) each Partnership Interest outstanding immediately prior to the effective date of the merger or consolidation is to be an identical Partnership Interest of the Partnership after the effective date of the merger or consolidation, and (E) the number of Partnership Interests to be issued by the Partnership in such merger or consolidation does not exceed 20% of the Partnership Interests (other than Incentive Distribution Rights) Outstanding immediately prior to the effective date of such merger or consolidation.

(f) Pursuant to Section 17-211(g) of the Delaware Act, an agreement of merger or consolidation approved in accordance with this Article XIV may (a) effect any amendment to this Agreement or (b) effect the adoption of a new partnership agreement for the Partnership if it is the Surviving Business Entity. Any such amendment or adoption made pursuant to this Section 14.3 shall be effective at the effective time or date of the merger or consolidation.

Section 14.4  Certificate of Merger.

Upon the required approval by the General Partner and the Unitholders of a Merger Agreement, a certificate of merger shall be executed and filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware in conformity with the requirements of the Delaware Act.

Section 14.5  Effect of Merger or Consolidation.

(a) At the effective time of the certificate of merger:

(i) all of the rights, privileges and powers of each of the business entities that has merged or consolidated, and all property, real, personal and mixed, and all debts due to any of those business entities and all other things and causes of action belonging to each of those business entities, shall be vested in the Surviving Business Entity and after the merger or consolidation shall be the property of the Surviving Business Entity to the extent they were of each constituent business entity;

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-71


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

(ii) the title to any real property vested by deed or otherwise in any of those constituent business entities shall not revert and is not in any way impaired because of the merger or consolidation;

(iii) all rights of creditors and all liens on or security interests in property of any of those constituent business entities shall be preserved unimpaired; and

(iv) all debts, liabilities and duties of those constituent business entities shall attach to the Surviving Business Entity and may be enforced against it to the same extent as if the debts, liabilities and duties had been incurred or contracted by it.

ARTICLE XV

RIGHT TO ACQUIRE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS

Section 15.1  Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests.

(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, if at any time the General Partner and its Affiliates hold more than 80% of the total Limited Partner Interests of any class then Outstanding, the General Partner shall then have the right, which right it may assign and transfer in whole or in part to the Partnership or any Affiliate of the General Partner, exercisable in its sole discretion, to purchase all, but not less than all, of such Limited Partner Interests of such class then Outstanding held by Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates, at the greater of (x) the Current Market Price as of the date three days prior to the date that the notice described in Section 15.1(b) is mailed and (y) the highest price paid by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates for any such Limited Partner Interest of such class purchased during the 90-day period preceding the date that the notice described in Section 15.1(b) is mailed.

(b) If the General Partner, any Affiliate of the General Partner or the Partnership elects to exercise the right to purchase Limited Partner Interests granted pursuant to Section 15.1(a), the General Partner shall deliver to the Transfer Agent notice of such election to purchase (the “Notice of Election to Purchase”) and shall cause the Transfer Agent to mail a copy of such Notice of Election to Purchase to the Record Holders of Limited Partner Interests of such class (as of a Record Date selected by the General Partner) at least 10, but not more than 60, days prior to the Purchase Date. Such Notice of Election to Purchase shall also be published for a period of at least three consecutive days in at least two daily newspapers of general circulation printed in the English language and published in the Borough of Manhattan, New York. The Notice of Election to Purchase shall specify the Purchase Date and the price (determined in accordance with Section 15.1(a)) at which Limited Partner Interests will be purchased and state that the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, elects to purchase such Limited Partner Interests, upon surrender of Certificates representing such Limited Partner Interests in the case of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates, in exchange for payment, at such office or offices of the Transfer Agent as the Transfer Agent may specify, or as may be required by any National Securities Exchange on which such Limited Partner Interests are listed or admitted to trading. Any such Notice of Election to Purchase mailed to a Record Holder of Limited Partner Interests at his address as reflected in the records of the Transfer Agent shall be conclusively presumed to have been given regardless of whether the owner receives such notice. On or prior to the Purchase Date, the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, shall deposit with the Transfer Agent cash in an amount sufficient to pay the aggregate purchase price of all of such Limited Partner Interests to be purchased in accordance with this Section 15.1. If the Notice of Election to Purchase shall have been duly given as aforesaid at least 10 days prior to the Purchase Date, and if on or prior to the Purchase Date the deposit described in the preceding sentence has been made for the benefit of the holders of Limited Partner Interests subject to purchase as provided herein, then from and after the Purchase Date, notwithstanding that any Certificate shall not have been surrendered for purchase, all rights of the holders of such Limited Partner Interests shall thereupon cease, except the right to

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-72


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

receive the purchase price (determined in accordance with Section 15.1(a)) for Limited Partner Interests therefor, without interest, upon surrender to the Transfer Agent of the Certificates representing such Limited Partner Interests in the case of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates, and such Limited Partner Interests shall thereupon be deemed to be transferred to the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, on the record books of the Transfer Agent and the Partnership, and the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner, or the Partnership, as the case may be, shall be deemed to be the owner of all such Limited Partner Interests from and after the Purchase Date and shall have all rights as the owner of such Limited Partner Interests.

(c) In the case of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates, at any time from and after the Purchase Date, a holder of an Outstanding Limited Partner Interest subject to purchase as provided in this Section 15.1 may surrender his Certificate evidencing such Limited Partner Interest to the Transfer Agent in exchange for payment of the amount described in Section 15.1(a), therefor, without interest thereon.

ARTICLE XVI

GENERAL PROVISIONS

Section 16.1  Addresses and Notices; Written Communications.

(a) Any notice, demand, request, report or proxy materials required or permitted to be given or made to a Partner under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed given or made when delivered in person or when sent by first class United States mail or by other means of written communication to the Partner at the address described below. Any notice, payment or report to be given or made to a Partner hereunder shall be deemed conclusively to have been given or made, and the obligation to give such notice or report or to make such payment shall be deemed conclusively to have been fully satisfied, upon sending of such notice, payment or report to the Record Holder of such Partnership Interests at his address as shown on the records of the Transfer Agent or as otherwise shown on the records of the Partnership, regardless of any claim of any Person who may have an interest in such Partnership Interests by reason of any assignment or otherwise. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if (i) a Partner shall consent to receiving notices, demands, requests, reports or proxy materials via electronic mail or by the Internet or (ii) the rules of the Commission shall permit any report or proxy materials to be delivered electronically or made available via the Internet, any such notice, demand, request, report or proxy materials shall be deemed given or made when delivered or made available via such mode of delivery. An affidavit or certificate of making of any notice, payment or report in accordance with the provisions of this Section 16.1 executed by the General Partner, the Transfer Agent or the mailing organization shall be prima facie evidence of the giving or making of such notice, payment or report. If any notice, payment or report given or made in accordance with the provisions of this Section 16.1 is returned marked to indicate that such notice, payment or report was unable to be delivered, such notice, payment or report and, in the case of notices, payments or reports returned by the United States Postal Service (or other physical mail delivery mail service outside the United States of America), any subsequent notices, payments and reports shall be deemed to have been duly given or made without further mailing (until such time as such Record Holder or another Person notifies the Transfer Agent or the Partnership of a change in his address) or other delivery if they are available for the Partner at the principal office of the Partnership for a period of one year from the date of the giving or making of such notice, payment or report to the other Partners. Any notice to the Partnership shall be deemed given if received by the General Partner at the principal office of the Partnership designated pursuant to Section 2.3. The General Partner may rely and shall be protected in relying on any notice or other document from a Partner or other Person if believed by it to be genuine.

(b) The terms “in writing”, “written communications,” “written notice” and words of similar import shall be deemed satisfied under this Agreement by use of e-mail and other forms of electronic communication.

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-73


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Section 16.2  Further Action.

The parties shall execute and deliver all documents, provide all information and take or refrain from taking action as may be necessary or appropriate to achieve the purposes of this Agreement.

Section 16.3  Binding Effect.

This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their heirs, executors, administrators, successors, legal representatives and permitted assigns.

Section 16.4  Integration.

This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement among the parties hereto pertaining to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all prior agreements and understandings pertaining thereto.

Section 16.5  Creditors.

None of the provisions of this Agreement shall be for the benefit of, or shall be enforceable by, any creditor of the Partnership.

Section 16.6  Waiver.

No failure by any party to insist upon the strict performance of any covenant, duty, agreement or condition of this Agreement or to exercise any right or remedy consequent upon a breach thereof shall constitute waiver of any such breach of any other covenant, duty, agreement or condition.

Section 16.7  Third-Party Beneficiaries.

Each Partner agrees that (a) any Indemnitee shall be entitled to assert rights and remedies hereunder as a third-party beneficiary hereto with respect to those provisions of this Agreement affording a right, benefit or privilege to such Indemnitee and (b) any Unrestricted Person shall be entitled to assert rights and remedies hereunder as a third-party beneficiary hereto with respect to those provisions of this Agreement affording a right, benefit or privilege to such Unrestricted Person.

Section 16.8  Counterparts.

This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, all of which together shall constitute an agreement binding on all the parties hereto, notwithstanding that all such parties are not signatories to the original or the same counterpart. Each party shall become bound by this Agreement immediately upon affixing its signature hereto or, in the case of a Person acquiring a Limited Partner Interest, pursuant to Section 10.1(a) without execution hereof.

Section 16.9  Applicable Law; Forum; Venue and Jurisdiction; Waiver of Trial by Jury.

(a) This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware, without regard to the principles of conflicts of law.

(b) Each of the Partners and each Person holding any beneficial interest in the Partnership (whether through a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation or an agent of any of the foregoing or otherwise):

(i) irrevocably agrees that any claims, suits, actions or proceedings (A) arising out of or relating in any way to this Agreement (including any claims, suits or actions to interpret, apply or enforce the provisions of this Agreement or the duties, obligations or liabilities among Partners or of Partners to the Partnership, or the rights or powers of, or restrictions on, the Partners or the Partnership), (B) brought in a derivative manner on behalf of the Partnership, (C) asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any director, officer, or other employee of the Partnership or the General Partner, or owed by the General

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-74


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Partner, to the Partnership or the Partners, (D) asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the Delaware Act or (E) asserting a claim governed by the internal affairs doctrine shall be exclusively brought in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or, if such court does not have subject matter jurisdiction thereof, any other court located in the State of Delaware with subject matter jurisdiction), in each case regardless of whether such claims, suits, actions or proceedings sound in contract, tort, fraud or otherwise, are based on common law, statutory, equitable, legal or other grounds, or are derivative or direct claims;

(ii) irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or, if such court does not have subject matter jurisdiction thereof, any other court located in the State of Delaware with subject matter jurisdiction) in connection with any such claim, suit, action or proceeding;

(iii) agrees not to, and waives any right to, assert in any such claim, suit, action or proceeding that (A) it is not personally subject to the jurisdiction of the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware or of any other court to which proceedings in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware may be appealed, (B) such claim, suit, action or proceeding is brought in an inconvenient forum, or (C) the venue of such claim, suit, action or proceeding is improper;

(iv) expressly waives any requirement for the posting of a bond by a party bringing such claim, suit, action or proceeding; and

(v) consents to process being served in any such claim, suit, action or proceeding by mailing, certified mail, return receipt requested, a copy thereof to such party at the address in effect for notices hereunder, and agrees that such services shall constitute good and sufficient service of process and notice thereof; provided, nothing in clause (v) hereof shall affect or limit any right to serve process in any other manner permitted by law.

Section 16.10  Invalidity of Provisions.

If any provision or part of a provision of this Agreement is or becomes for any reason, invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions and/or parts thereof contained herein shall not be affected thereby and this Agreement shall, to the fullest extent permitted by law, be reformed and construed as if such invalid, illegal or unenforceable provision, or part of a provision, had never been contained herein, and such provision or part reformed so that it would be valid, legal and enforceable to the maximum extent possible.

Section 16.11  Consent of Partners.

Each Partner hereby expressly consents and agrees that, whenever in this Agreement it is specified that an action may be taken upon the affirmative vote or consent of less than all of the Partners, such action may be so taken upon the concurrence of less than all of the Partners and each Partner shall be bound by the results of such action.

Section 16.12  Facsimile Signatures.

The use of facsimile signatures affixed in the name and on behalf of the transfer agent and registrar of the Partnership on Certificates representing Units is expressly permitted by this Agreement.

[REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK.]

 

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

 

A-75


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

 

GENERAL PARTNER:

 

HI-CRUSH GP LLC

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

ORGANIZATIONAL LIMITED PARTNER:

 

HI-CRUSH PROPPANTS LLC

By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

SIGNATURE PAGE

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

EXHIBIT A

to the First Amended and Restated

Agreement of Limited Partnership of

Hi-Crush Partners LP

Certificate Evidencing Common Units

Representing Limited Partner Interests in

Hi-Crush Partners LP

 

No. __________

   __________ Common Units

In accordance with Section 4.1 of the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Hi-Crush Partners LP, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time (the “Partnership Agreement”), Hi-Crush Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “Partnership”), hereby certifies that             (the “Holder”) is the registered owner of             Common Units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (the “Common Units”) transferable on the books of the Partnership, in person or by duly authorized attorney, upon surrender of this Certificate properly endorsed. The rights, preferences and limitations of the Common Units are set forth in, and this Certificate and the Common Units represented hereby are issued and shall in all respects be subject to the terms and provisions of, the Partnership Agreement. Copies of the Partnership Agreement are on file, and will be furnished without charge on delivery of written request to the Partnership, at the principal office of the Partnership located at Three Riverway, Suite 1550, Houston, TX 77056. Capitalized terms used herein but not defined shall have the meanings given them in the Partnership Agreement.

THE HOLDER OF THIS SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGES FOR THE BENEFIT OF HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP THAT THIS SECURITY MAY NOT BE SOLD, OFFERED, RESOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED IF SUCH TRANSFER WOULD (A) VIOLATE THE THEN APPLICABLE FEDERAL OR STATE SECURITIES LAWS OR RULES AND REGULATIONS OF THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION, ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENTAL AUTHORITY WITH JURISDICTION OVER SUCH TRANSFER, (B) TERMINATE THE EXISTENCE OR QUALIFICATION OF HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE, OR (C) CAUSE HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP TO BE TREATED AS AN ASSOCIATION TAXABLE AS A CORPORATION OR OTHERWISE TO BE TAXED AS AN ENTITY FOR FEDERAL INCOME TAX PURPOSES (TO THE EXTENT NOT ALREADY SO TREATED OR TAXED). HI-CRUSH GP LLC, THE GENERAL PARTNER OF HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP, MAY IMPOSE ADDITIONAL RESTRICTIONS ON THE TRANSFER OF THIS SECURITY IF IT DETERMINES, WITH THE ADVICE OF COUNSEL, THAT SUCH RESTRICTIONS ARE NECESSARY OR ADVISABLE (i) TO AVOID A SIGNIFICANT RISK OF HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP BECOMING TAXABLE AS A CORPORATION OR OTHERWISE BECOMING TAXABLE AS AN ENTITY FOR U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX PURPOSES OR (ii) TO PRESERVE THE ECONOMIC UNIFORMITY OF THE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS (OR ANY CLASS OR CLASSES THEREOF). THE RESTRICTIONS SET FORTH ABOVE SHALL NOT PRECLUDE THE SETTLEMENT OF ANY TRANSACTIONS INVOLVING THIS SECURITY ENTERED INTO THROUGH THE FACILITIES OF ANY NATIONAL SECURITIES EXCHANGE ON WHICH THIS SECURITY IS LISTED OR ADMITTED TO TRADING.

The Holder, by accepting this Certificate, (i) shall be admitted to the Partnership as a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interests so transferred to such person when any such transfer or admission is reflected on the books and records of the Partnership and such Limited Partner becomes the Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interests so transferred, (ii) shall become bound by the terms of the Partnership Agreement, (iii) represents that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to enter into the Partnership Agreement and (iv) makes the consents, acknowledgements and waivers contained in the Partnership Agreement, with or without the execution of the Partnership Agreement by the Holder.

 

A-A-1


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

This Certificate shall not be valid for any purpose unless it has been countersigned and registered by the Transfer Agent and Registrar.

 

Dated:                                                           Hi-Crush Partners LP
Countersigned and Registered by:     By: Hi-Crush GP LLC
     
[                      ], N.A.,     By:                                                                                                  
As Transfer Agent and Registrar     Name:                                                                                             
    Title:                                                                                               
    By:                                                                                                  
    Name:                                                                                             
    Title:                                                                                               

 

A-A-2


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

[Reverse of Certificate]

ABBREVIATIONS

The following abbreviations, when used in the inscription on the face of this Certificate, shall be construed as follows according to applicable laws or regulations:

 

TEN COM - as tenants in common

TEN ENT - as tenants by the entireties

JT  TEN -         as joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common

  

UNIF GIFT/TRANSFERS MIN ACT

                 Custodian                 

 

(Cust)                                     (Minor)

Under Uniform Gifts/Transfers to CD Minors Act (State)

Additional abbreviations, though not in the above list, may also be used.

ASSIGNMENT OF COMMON UNITS OF

HI-CRUSH PARTNERS LP

FOR VALUE RECEIVED,               hereby assigns, conveys, sells and transfers unto

 

(Please print or typewrite name and address of assignee)

  

(Please insert Social Security or other identifying number of assignee)

                      Common Units representing limited partner interests evidenced by this Certificate, subject to the Partnership Agreement, and does hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint               as its attorney-in-fact with full power of substitution to transfer the same on the books of Hi-Crush Partners LP

Date:                                                                  

   NOTE: The signature to any endorsement hereon must correspond with the name as written upon the face of this Certificate in every particular. without alteration, enlargement or change.
THE SIGNATURE(S) MUST BE GUARANTEED BY AN ELIGIBLE GUARANTOR INSTITUTION (BANKS, STOCKBROKERS, SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATIONS AND CREDIT UNIONS WITH MEMBERSHIP IN AN APPROVED SIGNATURE GUARANTEE MEDALLION PROGRAM), PURSUANT TO S.E.C.
RULE 17Ad-15
  

(Signature)

 

(Signature)

  

 

A-A-3


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Appendix B

GLOSSARY OF TERMS

adjusted operating surplus: Adjusted operating surplus is intended to reflect the cash generated from operations during a particular period and therefore excludes net increases in working capital borrowings and net drawdowns of reserves of cash generated in prior periods. Adjusted operating surplus consists of:

 

   

operating surplus generated with respect to that period (excluding any amounts attributable to the items described in the first bullet point under “—Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus—Operating Surplus” above); less

 

   

any net increase in working capital borrowings with respect to that period; less

 

   

any net decrease in cash reserves for operating expenditures with respect to that period not relating to an operating expenditure made with respect to that period; plus

 

   

any net decrease in working capital borrowings with respect to that period; plus

 

   

any net increase in cash reserves for operating expenditures with respect to that period required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium; plus

 

   

any net decrease made in subsequent periods in cash reserves for operating expenditures initially established with respect to such period to the extent such decrease results in a reduction of adjusted operating surplus in subsequent periods pursuant to the third bullet point above.

API: American Petroleum Institute

BTU: British Thermal Unit

capital surplus: Any distribution of cash or cash equivalents in excess of our operating surplus. Accordingly, capital surplus would generally be generated only by the following (which we refer to as “interim capital transactions”):

 

   

borrowings other than working capital borrowings;

 

   

sales of our equity and debt securities; and

 

   

sales or other dispositions of assets for cash, other than inventory, accounts receivable and other assets sold in the ordinary course of business or as part of normal retirement or replacement of assets.

ceramic proppant: An artificially manufactured proppant of consistent size and sphere shape that offers a high crush strength.

coarse grade sand: Sand of mesh size equal to or less than 70.

crush strength: Ability to withstand high pressures. Crush strength is measured according to the pounds per square inch of pressure that can be withstood before the proppant breaks down into finer granules.

distributable cash flow: Distributable cash flow is defined as EBITDA less cash paid for interest expense, maintenance and replacement capital expenditures, including accrual for reserve replacement, and costs associated with inventory buildup plus accretion of asset retirement obligations and costs allocated to inventory drawdown.

dry plant: Facility used to further process sand after it has been washed.

EBITDA: A non-GAAP supplemental financial measure defined as net income (loss) before net interest expense, income tax expense and depreciation and depletion expense.

 

B-1


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

expansion capital expenditures: Capital expenditures that we expect will increase our operating capacity over the long term.

frac sand: A proppant used in the completion and re-completion of unconventional oil and natural gas wells to stimulate and maintain oil and natural gas production through the process of hydraulic fracturing.

GAAP: Generally accepted accounting principles in the United States.

hydraulic fracturing: The process of pumping fluids, mixed with granular proppants, into a geological formation at pressures sufficient to create fractures in the hydrocarbon-bearing rock.

investment capital expenditures: Capital expenditures that are neither maintenance and replacement capital expenditures nor expansion capital expenditures.

maintenance and replacement capital expenditures: Capital expenditures required to maintain, over the long term, the operating capacity of our capital assets. Examples of maintenance and replacement capital expenditures include expenditures associated with the replacement of equipment and sand reserves, to the extent such expenditures are made to maintain our long-term operating capacity.

mesh size: Measurement of the size of a grain of sand indicating it will pass through a sieve of a certain size.

monocrystalline: Consisting of a single crystal rather than multiple crystals bonded together (polycrystalline). Monocrystalline frac sand typically exhibits higher crush strength than polycrystalline sand, as these structures are more prone to breaking down under high pressures than a single crystal.

Northern White sand: A monocrystalline sand with greater sphericity and roundness enabling higher crush strengths and conductivity. Within the industry, a common alternative term for “Northern White” sand is “Ottawa” sand.

operating expenditures: Generally means all of our cash expenditures, including, but not limited to, taxes, reimbursement of expenses to our general partner or its affiliates, payments made under interest rate hedge agreements or commodity hedge agreements (provided that (1) with respect to amounts paid in connection with the initial purchase of an interest rate hedge contract or a commodity hedge contract, such amounts will be amortized over the life of the applicable interest rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract and (2) payments made in connection with the termination of any interest rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract prior to the expiration of its stipulated settlement or termination date will be included in operating expenditures in equal quarterly installments over the remaining scheduled life of such interest rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract), officer compensation, repayment of working capital borrowings, debt service payments and estimated maintenance and replacement capital expenditures (as discussed in further detail below), provided that operating expenditures will not include:

 

   

repayment of working capital borrowings deducted from operating surplus pursuant to the penultimate bullet point of the definition of operating surplus above when such repayment actually occurs;

 

   

payments (including prepayments and prepayment penalties and the purchase price of indebtedness that is repurchased and cancelled) of principal of and premium on indebtedness, other than working capital borrowings;

 

   

expansion capital expenditures;

 

   

actual maintenance and replacement capital expenditures (as discussed in further detail below);

 

   

investment capital expenditures;

 

B-2


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
   

payment of transaction expenses relating to interim capital transactions;

 

   

distributions to our partners (including distributions in respect of our incentive distribution rights); or

 

   

repurchases of equity interests except to fund obligations under employee benefit plans.

operating surplus: We define operating surplus as:

 

   

$         million (as described below); plus

 

   

all of our cash receipts after the closing of this offering, excluding cash from interim capital transactions (as defined below); plus

 

   

working capital borrowings made after the end of a period but on or before the date of determination of operating surplus for the period; plus

 

   

cash distributions paid in respect of equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights), other than equity issued on the closing date of this offering, to finance all or a portion of expansion capital expenditures in respect of the period from such financing until the earlier to occur of the date the capital asset commences commercial service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of; plus

 

   

an amount of cash to be indirectly contributed to us in accordance with the contribution agreement equal to the amount of deferred revenue that would have been reflected on our balance sheet on the closing date of this offering, which shall be included in operating surplus for the quarters ending September 30, 2012 and December 31, 2012 in amounts calculated, for each quarter, by multiplying such cash amount by a fraction, (x) the numerator of which is the number of days in such quarter and (y) the denominator of which is the aggregate number of days in the quarters ending September 30, 2012 and December 31, 2012; less

 

   

cash distributions paid in respect of equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights) to pay the construction period interest on debt incurred, or to pay construction period distributions on equity issued, to finance the expansion capital expenditures referred to above, in each case, in respect of the period from such financing until the earlier to occur of the date the capital asset is placed in service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of; less

 

   

all of our operating expenditures (as defined below) after the closing of this offering; less

 

   

the amount of cash reserves established by our general partner to provide funds for future operating expenditures; less

 

   

all working capital borrowings not repaid within twelve months after having been incurred, or repaid within such twelve-month period with the proceeds of additional working capital borrowings; less

 

   

any loss realized on disposition of an investment capital expenditure.

overburden: The material that lies above an area of economic interest.

proppant: A sized particle mixed with fracturing fluid to hold fractures open after a hydraulic fracturing treatment.

proven reserves: Quantity of sand estimated with reasonable certainty, from the analysis of geologic and engineering data, to be recoverable from well-established or known reservoirs with the existing equipment and under the existing operating conditions.

reserves: Sand that can be economically extracted or produced at the time of determination based on relevant legal, economic and technical considerations.

resin-coated sand: Raw sand that is coated with a flexible resin that increases the sand’s crush strength and prevents crushed sand from dispersing throughout the fracture.

 

B-3


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

roundness: A measure of how round the curvatures of an object are. The opposite of round is angular. It is possible for an object to be round but not spherical (e.g. an egg-shaped particle is round, but not spherical). When used to describe proppant, roundness is a reference to having a curved shape which promotes hydrocarbon flow, as the curvature creates a space through which the hydrocarbons can flow.

silica: A chemically resistant dioxide of silicon that occurs in crystalline, amorphous and cryptocrystalline forms.

sphericity: A measure of how well an object is formed in a shape where all points are equidistant from the center. The more spherical a proppant, the more highly it is desired relative to non-spherical proppant, as the gaps created by it are typically the largest and this promotes maximum hydrocarbon flow.

subordination period: The subordination period will begin on the closing date of this offering and expire on the first business day after the distribution to unitholders in respect of any quarter, beginning with the quarter ending                     , 2015, if each of the following has occurred:

 

   

distributions from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common and subordinated units equaled or exceeded the minimum quarterly distribution for each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date;

 

   

the “adjusted operating surplus” (as defined below) generated during each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of the minimum quarterly distribution on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units during those periods on a fully diluted weighted average basis; and

 

   

there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the subordination period will automatically terminate, and all of the subordinated units will convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, on the first business day after the distribution to unitholders in respect of any quarter, beginning with the quarter ending                     , 2013, if each of the following has occurred:

 

   

distributions from operating surplus exceeded $         (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on all outstanding common units and subordinated units, plus the related distributions on the incentive distribution rights for a four-quarter period immediately preceding that date;

 

   

the “adjusted operating surplus” (as defined below) generated during the four-quarter period immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of $         (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units during that period on a fully diluted weighted average basis, plus the related distribution on the incentive distribution rights; and

 

   

there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distributions on the common units.

In addition, if the unitholders remove our general partner other than for cause:

 

   

the subordinated units held by any person will immediately and automatically convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, provided (1) neither such person nor any of its affiliates voted any of its units in favor of the removal and (2) such person is not an affiliate of the successor general partner; and

 

   

if all of the subordinated units convert pursuant to the foregoing, all cumulative common unit arrearages on the common units will be extinguished and the subordination period will end.

turbidity: Measurement of the level of contaminants, such as silt and clay, in a sample.

wet plant: Facility used to wash raw frac sand to remove fine impurities such as clay and organic particles.

 

B-4


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

LOGO

Hi-Crush Partners LP

 

Common Units

Representing Limited Partner Interests

 

 

Prospectus

                    , 2012

 

 

Barclays

Morgan Stanley

Credit Suisse

UBS Investment Bank

 

 

Raymond James

RBC Capital Markets

Baird

Through and including                     , 2012 (25 days after the date of this prospectus), all dealers that buy, sell or trade our common units, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to the dealers’ obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters and with respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

PART II

INFORMATION REQUIRED IN THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT

 

ITEM 13. OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION.

Set forth below are the expenses (other than underwriting discounts) expected to be incurred by the sponsor in connection with the issuance and distribution of the securities registered hereby. With the exception of the Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee, the FINRA filing fee and the New York Stock Exchange listing fee the amounts set forth below are estimates.

 

SEC registration fee

   $ 22,920   

FINRA filing fee

     25,500   

Printing and engraving expenses

     450,000   

Fees and expenses of legal counsel

     1,500,000   

Accounting fees and expenses

     1,450,000   

Transfer agent and registrar fees

     6,000   

New York Stock Exchange listing fee

     *   
  

 

 

 

Total

     *   
  

 

 

 

 

* To be completed by amendment

 

ITEM 14. INDEMNIFICATION OF OFFICERS AND MEMBERS OF OUR BOARD OF DIRECTORS.

Subject to any terms, conditions or restrictions set forth in the partnership agreement, Section 17-108 of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act empowers a Delaware limited partnership to indemnify and hold harmless any partner or other persons from and against all claims and demands whatsoever. The section of the prospectus entitled “The Partnership Agreement—Indemnification” discloses that we will generally indemnify officers, directors and affiliates of the general partner to the fullest extent permitted by the law against all losses, claims, damages or similar events and is incorporated herein by this reference.

Our general partner will purchase insurance covering its officers and directors against liabilities asserted and expenses incurred in connection with their activities as officers and directors of the general partner or any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries.

Our general partner will enter into indemnification agreements (each, an “Indemnification Agreement”) with each of its officers and directors (each, an “Indemnitee”). Each Indemnification Agreement provides that our general partner will indemnify and hold harmless each Indemnitee against all expense, liability and loss (including attorney’s fees, judgments, fines or penalties and amounts to be paid in settlement) actually and reasonably incurred or suffered by the Indemnitee in connection with serving in their capacity as officers and directors of our general partner (or of any subsidiary of our general partner) or in any capacity at the request of our general partner or its board of directors to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, including Section 18-108 of the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act in effect on the date of the agreement or as such laws may be amended to provide more advantageous rights to the Indemnitee. The Indemnification Agreement also provides that the general partner must advance payment of certain expenses to the Indemnitee, including fees of counsel, in advance of final disposition of any proceeding subject to receipt of an undertaking from the Indemnitee to return such advance if it is ultimately determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to indemnification.

The underwriting agreement to be entered into in connection with the sale of the securities offered pursuant to this registration statement, the form of which will be filed as an exhibit to this registration statement, provides for indemnification of Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and our general partner, their officers and directors, and any person who controls Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and our general partner, including indemnification for liabilities under the Securities Act.

 

II-1


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements
ITEM 15. RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES.

On May 8, 2012, in connection with the formation of Hi-Crush Partners LP, we issued (i) the non-economic general partner interest in us to Hi-Crush GP LLC and (ii) the 100.0% limited partner interest in us to Hi-Crush Proppants LLC for $1,000.00. The issuance was exempt from registration under Section 4(2) of the Securities Act. There have been no other sales of unregistered securities within the past three years.

 

ITEM 16. EXHIBITS.

See the Index to Exhibits on the page immediately preceding the exhibits for a list of exhibits filed as part of this registration statement on Form S-1, which Index to Exhibits is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 17. UNDERTAKINGS.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that, for the purpose of determining liability of the registrant under the Securities Act to any purchaser in the initial distribution of the securities, in a primary offering of securities of the undersigned registrant pursuant to this registration statement, regardless of the underwriting method used to sell the securities to the purchaser, if the securities are offered or sold to such purchaser by means of any of the following communications, the undersigned registrant will be a seller to the purchaser and will be considered to offer or sell such securities to such purchaser:

(1) Any preliminary prospectus or prospectus of the undersigned registrant relating to the offering required to be filed pursuant to Rule 424;

(2) Any free writing prospectus relating to the offering prepared by or on behalf of the undersigned registrant or used or referred to by the undersigned registrant;

(3) The portion of any other free writing prospectus relating to the offering containing material information about the undersigned registrant or its securities provided by or on behalf of the undersigned registrant; and

(4) Any other communication that is an offer in the offering made by the undersigned registrant to the purchaser.

The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:

(1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.

(2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities

 

II-2


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

The undersigned registrant undertakes to send to each common unitholder, at least on an annual basis, a detailed statement of any transactions registrant or its subsidiaries, and of fees, commissions, compensation and other benefits paid, or accrued to registrant or its subsidiaries for the fiscal year completed, showing the amount paid or accrued to each recipient and the services performed.

The registrant undertakes to provide to the common unitholders the financial statements required by Form 10-K for the first full fiscal year of operations of the registrant.

 

II-3


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the registrant has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Houston, State of Texas, on, August 3, 2012.

 

Hi-Crush Partners LP

By:

 

Hi-Crush GP LLC, its general partner

By:

 

/s/ Robert E. Rasmus

 

    Robert E. Rasmus

 

    Its: Co-Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, this Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the capacities and the dates indicated.

 

Signature

  

Title

 

Date

/s/ Robert E. Rasmus     

  

Co-Chief Executive Officer

(Co-Principal Executive Officer)

  August 3, 2012
Robert E. Rasmus     

*

  

Co-Chief Executive Officer

(Co-Principal Executive Officer)

  August 3, 2012
James M. Whipkey     

*

  

Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Financial Officer and
Principal Accounting Officer)

  August 3, 2012
Laura C. Fulton     

*

  

Director

  August 3, 2012
Jeffries V. Alston, III     

*

Robert L. Cabes, Jr.

  

Director

  August 3, 2012

*

John R. Huff

  

Director

  August 3, 2012

*

Trevor T. Turbidy

  

Director

  August 3, 2012

*

Steven A. Webster

  

Director

  August 3, 2012

 

*By:

 

/s/ Robert E. Rasmus

  Robert E. Rasmus, Attorney-In-Fact

 

II-4


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

INDEX TO EXHIBITS

 

Exhibit
Number

              

Description

  1.1         à       Form of Underwriting Agreement
  3.1         à       Certificate of Limited Partnership of Hi-Crush Partners LP
  3.2               Form of First Amended and Restated Limited Partnership Agreement of Hi-Crush Partners LP (included as Appendix A in the prospectus included in this Registration Statement)
  4.1         à       Form of Registration Rights Agreement
  5.1          *       Opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. as to the legality of the securities being registered
  8.1               Opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. relating to tax matters
  10.1         à       Form of Contribution Agreement
  10.2         à       Form of Omnibus Agreement
  10.3         à       Form of Hi-Crush Partners LP Long-Term Incentive Plan
  10.4               Form of Credit Agreement
  10.5         à+       Supply Agreement, effective as of January 11, 2011, between Weatherford Artificial Lift Systems, Inc. and Hi-Crush Operating LLC
  10.6         à+       Supply Agreement, effective as of May 24, 2011, between Halliburton Energy Services, Inc. and Hi-Crush Operating LLC
  10.7         à+       First Amendment to Supply Agreement, effective as of November 23, 2011, between Halliburton Energy Services, Inc. and Hi-Crush Operating LLC
  10.8         à+       Supply Agreement, effective as of May 1, 2012, between Baker Hughes Oilfield Operations, Inc. and Hi-Crush Operating LLC
  10.9         à+       First Amendment to Supply Agreement, effective as of May 1, 2012, between Baker Hughes Oilfield Operations, Inc. and Hi-Crush Operating LLC
  10.10       à+       Supply Agreement, effective as of May 1, 2012, between FTS International Services, LLC and Hi-Crush Operating LLC
  10.11       à+       Royalty Agreement dated as of January 10, 2011
  10.12       à+       Royalty Agreement dated as of January 13, 2011
  10.13       à+       Royalty Agreement dated as of March 17, 2011
  10.14       à       Employment Agreement, dated May 25, 2011, between Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and Robert E. Rasmus
  10.15       à       Employment Agreement, dated May 25, 2011, between Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and James M. Whipkey
  10.16       à       Employment Agreement, dated May 25, 2011, between Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and Jefferies V. Alston, III
  10.17       à       Directors’ Compensation Summary
  10.18       à       Management Services Agreement
  10.19       à       Letter Agreement, dated July 13, 2012, between Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and Robert E. Rasmus
  10.20       à       Letter Agreement, dated July 13, 2012, between Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and James M. Whipkey
  10.21       à       Letter Agreement, dated July 13, 2012, between Hi-Crush Proppants LLC and Jeffries V. Alston, III

 

II-5


Table of Contents
Index to Financial Statements

Exhibit
Number

              

Description

  21.1         à       List of Subsidiaries of Hi-Crush Partners LP
  23.1               Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
  23.2         à       Consent of John T. Boyd Company
  23.3         à       Consent of PropTester, Inc.
  23.4         à       Consent of Stim-Lab, Inc.
  23.5         à       Consent of Nominee for Director
  23.6          *       Consent of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. (contained in Exhibit 5.1)
  23.7               Consent of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. (contained in Exhibit 8.1)
  24.1         à       Powers of Attorney (contained on page II-4)
  99.1         à       Confidential Draft Registration Statement submitted May 11, 2012
  99.2         à       Confidential Draft Registration Statement submitted June 14, 2012

 

à Previously filed.
* To be filed by amendment.
+ Portions of this exhibit have been omitted pursuant to a request for confidential treatment.
Compensatory plan or arrangement.

 

II-6